Eclipse FSM 1990-1998 Enginechassibody
Eclipse FSM 1990-1998 Enginechassibody
Eclipse FSM 1990-1998 Enginechassibody
. .
GENERAL How to Use This
MODEL INDICATIONS
The following abbreviations are used in this manual for classification of model types.
M/T Indicates the manual transaxle, or models equipped with the manual transaxle.
A/T Indicates the automatic transaxle, or models equipped with the automatic transaxle.
MFI: Indicates the fuel injection, or engines equipped with the fuel injection.
Turbo: Indicates the engine with turbocharger, or models equipped such an
Non-turbo: Indicates the engine without turbocharger, or models equipped with, such an engine.
FWD: Indicates the front wheel drive vehicles.
AWD: Indicates the all wheel drive vehicles.
ABS: Indicates the anti-lock braking system or models equipped with the braking
GENERAL How to Use This Manual
a
GENERAL How to Use This Manual
gear
. Operating procedures,
TIE-ROD END etc. on removal,
assembly
1. sun tie the cord of the special tool described.
2. Loosen the nut but do not
Troubleshooting of electronic control systems for which the scan tool the basic outline
described below. Furthermore, even in systems for which the scan tool cannot be used, part of these
systems still follow this outline.
TROUBLESHOOTING CONTENTS
1. STANDARD FLOW OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING
The main procedures for diagnostic troubleshooting are shown.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION AND SYMPTOM VERIFICATION TESTS
If verification of the trouble symptoms is difficult, procedures for checking operation and verifying
trouble symptoms are shown.
3. DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
The following diagnostic functions are shown.
l , Method of reading diagnostic trouble codes
Method of erasing diagnostic trouble codes
l Input inspection service points
4. INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
5. INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Indicates the inspection procedures corresponding to each diagnostic trouble code. (Refer to the
next page on how to use the inspection procedures.)
6. INSPECTION CHART FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS
If there are trouble symptoms, even though the scan tool displays no diagnostic inspection
procedures for each trouble symptom will be found by means of this chart.
7. INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS
Indicates the inspection procedures corresponding to each trouble symptoms the Inspection
Chart for Trouble Symptoms. (Refer to the next page on how to use the inspection procedures.)
8. DATA LIST REFERENCE TABLE
Inspection items and normal judgement values have been provided in this chart as reference
9. CHECK AT ECU TERMINALS
Terminal numbers for the ECU connectors, inspection items and standard values have been provided
in this chart as reference information.
Terminal Voltage Checks
1. Connect a needle-nosed wire probe or paper clip to a voltmeter probe.
2. Insert the needle-nosed wire probe into each of the ECU connector from the wire side,
and measure the voltage while referring to the check chart.
NOTE
1. Measure voltage with the ECU connectors connected.
2. You may find it convenient to pull out the ECU to make it easier to reach the connector
terminals.
3. Checks don’t have to be carried out in the order given in the chart.
TSB Revision
GENERAL How to Use Troubleshooting/Inspection Service Points
TSB Revision
GENERAL How to Use Service
. . ,
HOW TO USE THE INSPECTION PROCEDURES
The causes of a high frequency of problems occurring in electronic circuitry are generally
components, the ECU and the harnesses between in that These
follow this order, and they first try to discover a problem with a connector or a
17
Check trouble
Caution
After carrying out connector inspection, always be sure to
I the connector as it was before.
HARNESS INSPECTION
Check for an open or short circuit in the harness between the terminals which were defective according
to the connector measurements. Carry out this inspection while referring to Volume 2 Electrical manual.
Here, “Check harness between power supply and terminal xx” also includes checking for blown fuses.
For inspection service points when there is a blown fuse, refer to “Inspection Service Points for a Blown
Fuse”.
MEASURES TO TAKE AFTER REPLACING THE ECU
If the trouble symptoms have not disappeared even after replacing the ECU, repeat the inspection procedure
from the beginning.
TSB Revision ,
GENERAL How to Use Troubleshooting/Inspection Service ‘Points
CONNECTOR
Turn the ignition switch to when connecting and discon-
necting the connectors, and turn the ignition switch to ON
when measuring if there are no instructions to the contrary.
Revision
GENERAL How to Use
16’30254
00000219
TSB Revision 1
GENERAL How to Use __
SIMULATION TESTS
For these simulation tests, shake, then gently bend, pull,
and twist the wiring of each of these examples to duplicate
the intermittent malfunction.
l Shake the connector up-and-down, and right-and-left.
l Shake the wiring harness up-and-down, and right-and-left.
l Vibrate the part or sensor.
NOTE
In case of difficulty in finding the cause of the intermittent
malfunction, the data recorder function in the scan tool is
effective.
TSB Revision
GENERAL How to Use Troubleshooting/Inspection
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle Identification
VEHICLE
The vehicle identification is
to the top side of the instrument
7 Body hatchback ,
5: “convertible”
Y:
F:
G:
digits* 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 I
year 1997
11 E: Mitsubishi Motor Manufacturing of
America, Inc. I
number 000001 to 999999
NOTE
“Check digit” means a single number or letter used to verify the
accuracy of transcription of vehicle number.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle
2.0 (122.0
[DOHC-MFI-Turbo
Mitsubishi Eclipse
2.0 (122.0
[DOHC-MFI-Turbo
Mitsubishi Eclipse
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle
VEHICLE INFORMATION
Vehicle information plate is riveted onto the
in the engine compartment.
The place shows model code, transaxle model,
and body color code.
No. Item
1 MODEL
Engine
Exterior code
Equipment code
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle Identification
..
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle
LOCATIONS
Target area (A: for original equipment parts, B: for replacement parts)
Engine
Engine (Non-turbo)> Engine (Turbo)>
Manual transaxle
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
Engine (Non-turbo)> A
00003676
Automatic transaxle
00003679
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle .
Target area (A: for original equipment parts, B: for replacement parts)
Fender A D o o r
Hood
00003661
TSB Revision
GENERAL Vehicle
Target area (A: for original equipment parts, B: for replacement parts)
Trunk lid
TSB Revision
GENERAL before Service
Caution
1. Before connecting or disconnecting the negative
be sure to turn off the ignition and
the lighting switch.
(if this is not done, the possibility semi-
conductor parts being damaged.)
2. After completion of the work steps [when the bat-
tery’s negative terminal is connected], warm
up the engine and allow it for approximately
five minutes under the conditions be-
low, in order to stabilize the engine condi-
tions, and then check to be sure that idling’ is
satisfactory.
Engine temperature:
Lights, electric fans, accessories: OFF
Transaxle: Neutral position
(A/T models: “N” or “P”)
Steering neutral (center) position
VEHICLE WASHING
If high-pressure car-washing equipment or steam car-washing
equipment is used to wash the vehicle, be maintain
the spray nozzle at a distance of at ‘least 300 mm (12 in.)
from any plastic parts and all opening parts (doors, luggage
compartment, etc.).
mm (in.)
APPLYING ANTI-CORROSION
OTHER UNDERCOAT AGENTS. ,
Be careful not to adhere oil or grease to the heated oxygen
sensor. If adhered, the sensor may malfunction.
Protect the heated oxygen sensor with a cover before applying
anti-corrosion agent, etc.
Scan tool
SCAN TOOL
To operate the scan tool, refer to the “MUT-II OPERATING
INSTRUCTIONS”.
Caution
Turn the ignition switch off befoie connecting and discon-
ROM pack
necting the scan tool.
GENERAL Towing and Hoisting
type
TSB Revision
GENERAL Towing and Hoisting
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
The following precautions should be towing the
vehicle.
1. DO NOT LIFT OR TOW THE BY ATTACHING
TO OR WRAPPING AROUND BUMPER.
2. Any loose or protruding of vehicle such
as hoods, doors, fenders, etc., should be secured
or removed prior to moving vehicle.
3. Operator should refrain going under a vehicle while
it is lifted by the towing unless the vehicle
is adequately supported by safety stands.
4. Never allow passengers to ride in a towed vehicle.
5. State and local rules and regulations must be followed
when towing a vehicle.
Sling type
Caution
1. If only the front wheels or only. the rear wheels are
lifted for towing, the bumper will be damaged.
In addition, lifting of the rear wheels causes the oil
Wheel lift type to flow forward, and may result in heat damage to
the rear bushing of the transfer, and should never
be done.
2. Do not tow the vehicle ‘with “only front or
only the rear wheels on a dolly, or the viscous
Flat bed type coupling will be damaged. In a case, the vehicle
may jump forward suddenly.
3. If this vehicle is towed, use bed dolly
type equipment.
Dolly type
TSB Revision
GENERAL Towing and Hoisting ..
nember
Piece wood
1 Rear
Caution
Never support any point other than the specified one, or it will be deformed.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Towing and
RIGID RACK
For lifting, put rubber or similar between the side sill and rigid rack, or the side sill area
be damaged.
POST TYPE
Special care should be taken when raising the vehicle on a frame contact type The
be equipped with the proper adapters in order to support the vehicle at the
Caution
When service procedures require removing rear suspension, fuel tank and spare tire, place
weight on rear end of vehicle or anchor vehicle to hoist to prevent tipping of center of
changes.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Special Handling AWD Models
00100740010
BRAKE TEST
In order to stabilize the viscous coupling‘s dragging force,
the brake test should always be conducted after the speedom-
eter test.
FRONT WHEEL MEASUREMENTS
Place the front wheels on’ the brake tester.
2. Perform the brake test.
Caution
The rear wheels should remain on the ground.
3. If the brake dragging force exceeds the specified
jack up the vehicle and each -to
check the rotation condition of each wheel.
NOTE
If the brake dragging force exceeds the specified
the cause may be the effect of the viscous
dragging force, so jack up the front and check
the rotation condition of the wheels in this state for no
effect by the viscous coupling‘s dragging force.
0 0 0 0 3 6 8 5
TSB Revision
GENERAL Special Handling Instructions for Models
WHEEL BALANCE ,
FRONT WHEEL MEASUREMENTS
1. Jack up the rear wheels, and place an axle at
the designated part of the side sill.
2. Jack up the front wheels and set, a pick-up stand and
balancing machine in place.
Caution
1. Set so that the front and rear of the vehicle are
at the same height.
2. Release the parking brake.
3. Rotate each wheel manually and check to be sure
that there is no dragging.
3. Use the engine to drive the tyres, and then make the
measurement.
Caution
1. If an error is indicated in the state of engine drive,
motor drive can be used concurrently.
2. Do not operate the clutch suddenly, or increase
or reduce speed suddenly during the work.
TSB Revision
GENERAL General Data and Specifications“
00199999191
ECLIPSE
7 4
1 l ‘: MD
.
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Vehicle Overall length mm (in.) 1 4,380 (172.4) 4,380 (172.4) 4,380 4,380 (172.4)
Overall width mm 2 1,735 (68.3) 1,735 (68.3) 1,735 (68.3) 1,735 (68.3)
sions Overall height (unladen)
(in.) 3 1,295 (51 1,295 (51 1,295 (51 1,295 (51
mm (in.)
Wheelbase mm (in.) 4 2,510 (98.8) 2,510 (98.8) 2,510 (98.8) 2,510 (98.8)
Tread Front mm (in.) 5 1,515 (59.6) 1,515 (59.6) 1,515 (59.6) 1,515 (59.6)
Tread Rear mm (in.) 6 1,510 (59.4) 1,510 (59.4) 1,510 (59.4) 1,510 (59.4)
Overhang Front 7 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8)
mm (in.)
Overhang Rear 8 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8)
mm (in.)
Minimum running ground 9 145 (5.7) 145 (5.7) 145 (5.7) 145 (5.7)
clearance mm (in.)
A n g l e o f a p p r o a c h 1 0 11.8 11.8 11.8 11.8
degrees
Angle of departure 11 15.8 15.8 15.8 15.8
degrees
Curb weight 1,236 (2,725) 1,266 (2,791) 1,245 (2,745) 1,275 (2,811)
Gross vehicle weight rating 1,660 (3,660) 1,660 (3,660) 1,690 (3,726) 1,690 (3,726)
Gross axle weight rating 1 ,010 (2,227) 1 ,010 (2,227) 1,010 (2,227) 1,010 (2,227)
Front
Gross axle weight rating 800 (1,764) 800 (1,764) 800 (1,764) 800 (1,764)
Rear
capacity 4 4 4 4
Model No. (DOHC) (DOHC) (DOHC) (DOHC)
Piston displacement 1,996 (121.8) 1,996 (121.8) 1,996 (121.8) 1,996 (121.8)
Model No.
manual manual
automatic automatic
Fuel supply system Electronically Electronically Electronically Electronically
controlled multi- controlled multi- controlled multi- controlled multi-
port fuel port fuel port fuel port fuel injec-
tion tion tion tion
TSB Revision I
GENERAL General Data and Specifications
Items
,
Vehicle Overall length mm (in.) 1 (172.4) 4,380 (172.4) 4,380 (172.4) 4,380 (172.4)
Overall width mm (in.) 2 1,735 (68.3) 1,735 (68.3) 1,740 (68.5) 1,740 (68.5)
sions 1,740 1,740
(unladen) 3 1,295 (51 1,295 (51 1,295 (51 1,295 (51
Model No.
manual manual
automatic automatic
Fuel supply system Electronically Electronically Electronically Electronically
ystem controlled multi- controlled multi- controlled multi- controlled multi-
port fuel injec- port fuel injec- port fuel injec- port fuel injec-
tion tion tion tion
NOTE
l 1: Vehicles with side air dam.
TSB Revision
GENERAL General and
Seating capacity 4 4
El controlled controlled
fuel fuel injection
Revision
GENERAL General Data and Specifications
ECLIPSE SPYDER
6
.
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Items
Vehicle Overall length mm (in.) 1 4,380 (172.4) 4,380 (172.4) 4,360 (172.4) 4,380 (172.4)
Overall width mm (in.) 2 1,740 (68.5) 1,740 (68.5) 1,735 (68.3) 1,735 (68.3)
sions 1,740 1,740
Overall height (unladen) 3 1,340 (52.8) 1,340 (52.8) 1,340 (52.8) 1,340 (52.8)
mm (in.)
Wheelbase mm (in.) 4 2,510 (98.8) 2,510 (98.8) 2,510 (98.8)’
Tread Front mm (in.) 5 1,510 (59.4) 1,510 (59.4) 1,510 (59.4)
Tread Rear mm (in.) 6 1,505 (59.2) 1,505 (59.2) 1,505 (59.2) 1,505 (59.2)
Overhang Front 7 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8)
mm (in.)
Overhang Rear 8 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8) 935 (36.8)
mm (in.)
Minimum running ground 9 160 (6.3) 160 (6.3) 160 (6.3) 160 (6.3)
clearance mm (in.)
A n g l e o f a p p r o a c h 1 0 12.2 12.2 12.2 12.2
degrees
Angle of departure 11 15.8 15.8 15.8 1 5 . 6 ’
degrees
Curb weight (3,053) 1,425 (3,142) 1,305 (2,877) 1,335 (2,943)
Gross vehicle 1,850 (4,079) 1,850 1,765 (3,935) 1,785 (3,935)
(Ibs.) Gross axle weight weight rating
rating 1,030 (2,271) 1,030 (2,271) 1 ,010 (2,227) 1,010 (2,227)
Front
Gross axle weight rating 820 (1,808) 820 (1,806) 800 (1,764) 800 (1,764)
Rear
capacity 4 4 4 4
Model No. (DOHC) (DOHC) (SOHC)
Piston displacement 1,997 (121.9) 1,997 (121.9) 2,351 (143.4) 2,351 (143.4)
Model No.
manual manual
automatic automatic
Fuel Fuel supply system Electronically Electronically Electronically Electronically
controlled controlled controlled controlled
port fuel port fuel port fuel port fuel injec-
tion tion tion tion
NOTE
Vehicles with side air dam.
TSB Revision
GENERAL
Each torque value in the table is a standard value The values in the table applicable:
for tightening the following conditions. (1) If toothed washers are ‘inserted.
Bolts, nuts and washers are all made of steel (2) If plastic parts are fastened. .
and plated with zinc. If bolts to plastic or die-cast in-
(2) The threads and bearing surface of bolts and nuts.
nuts are all in condition. (4) If self-tapping screws or self-locking nuts are
used.
Standard bolt and nut tightening torque
1.75 81 (60)
TSB Revision
GENERAL Lubrication arid Maintenance,
00100120067
TSB Revision
Lubrication and
GENERAL Lubricants and Lubricant Capacities Table
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS
Items Recommended lubricants
TSB Revision
GENERAL Recommended Lubricants and Lubricant Table
LUBRICANT CAPACITIES
Description Metric measure U.S. measure
Engine oil Crankcase Engine (Non-turbo) 3.8 4 qts.
(excluding oil filter)
Engine (Turbo) and 4.0 4.2 qts.
Engine
Oil filter Engine (Non-turbo) 0.5 qt.
Engine (Turbo) and 0.3 qt.
Engine
Oil cooler Engine (Turbo)> 0.1 qt.
Cooling system (including heater and engine coolant reserve system) 7.0 7.4 qts.
Manual transaxle FWD 2.0 2.1 qts.
AWD 2.3 2.4
Automatic transaxle Engine (Non-turbo) 8.6 9.1
Engine (Turbo) 6.7 7.1 qts.
2.41 Engine 6.1 6.4 qts.
Transfer 0.5 qt.
Differential (rear axle) 0.85 qt.
Power steering 0.9 q t .
Fuel tank 64
TSB Revision
GENERAL Recommended Lubricants and Capacities
Engine I
PREFERRED
Turbo
COOLANT SELECTION
COOLANT
Relation between Antifreeze Concentration and Specific Gravity
Engine coolant temperature and specific gravity Freezing Safe operating Engine coolant
temperature temperature concentration
10 (50) 20 (68) 30 (86) 40 (104) 50 (122) (Specific volume)
1.054 1.050 1.042 1.036 -16 (3.2) -11 (12.2) 30%
1.063 1.058 1.054 1.049 1.044 -20 (-4) -15 (5) 35%
1.071 1.067 1.062 1.057 1.052 -25 (-13) -20 (-4)
Example
The safe operating temperature is when the measured specific gravity is 1.058 at the coolant
temperature of
Caution
1. If the concentration of the coolant is below the anti-corrosion property, will adversely
affected. In addition, if the concentration is above both the anti-freeze and cooling
properties will decrease, affecting the engine adversely. For these reasons, be sure to maintain
the concentration level within the specified range.
2. Do not use a mixture of different brands of anti-freeze.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Scheduled Maintenance Table
M A IN T E NA NC E
VEHICLE PERFORMANCE
Inspection and services be performed any time a is observed or suspected. Retain
receipts for all vehicle emission services to protect your emission warranty.
I
9
TSB Revision
GENERAL Scheduled Maintenance Table/Maintenance Service
MAINTENANCE SERVICE
1. FUEL SYSTEM (Tank, Pipe
and Fuel Tank Filler Tube (Check
HOSES (Check condition)
1. Check for damage or leakage in” the lines.’ and
connections and looseness of the fuel tank filler tube
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service
Engine (Turbo)>
TSB Revision I
GENERAL Maintenance
5. SPARK PLUGS
1. Spark plugs must spark properly to assure proper engine
performance and reduce exhaust emission
Therefore, they should be periodically with new
ones.
2. The new plugs should be checked gap.
Spark plug gap: ,..
Engine (Turbo)>’
mm
Engine (Non-turbo)> ,
1.22-1.35 mm in.) .
Engine>
in.)
3. Install the spark plug and tighten to the
Tightening torque:
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
25 Nm (18
Engine (Non-turbo)>
28 Nm (20
Incorrect Correct
6. IGNITION CABLES (Replace)
The ignition cables should. be replaced periodically with new
ones. After replacing, make sure that the ignition cables are
routed properly and fully seated.
NOTE
When disconnecting an ignition cable; be sure to hold the
cable boot. If the cable is disconnected by pulling on the
cable alone, an open circuit might result.
Check the tension of the drive belt. Check the drive belt
for evidence of cuts and cracks, and replace it if defective.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Check the belt tension with the tension gauge at the middle
point of the belt, or check the belt deflection by pressing,
the belt point by a force of 98 (22 Ibs.). .
Standard value:
Tension (Ibs.) 400 490 (90 --
Generator pulley
Crankshaft
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service
Engine (Non-turbo)>
1. Pull or push at the mid point of the belt with a force
of 98 (22 Ibs.) to measure dirve belt deflection.
Standard value: mm in.)
2. Use a tension gauge to measure belt
Standard value:
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service
TSB Revision
GENERAL
(5) Coat engine oil to the O-ring new filter:
(6) Screw on the oil filter by hand until it touches the
of the flange and then tighten it with the. . . filter wrench:
.
etc.
Engine (Turbo) and
For One full or 14 ,
l For or 17 ,
Engine
l For turn or 21
(7) Add new engine oil the oil filter...
(8) Start and run engine and check for engine oil leaks.
(9) After stopping engine, check oil level and replenish as
necessary.
MANUAL’TRANSAXLE OIL
(Check oil level)
Check each component for evidence of and check
the oil level by removing filler plug. If is contaminated,
it is necessary to replace it with new
1. With the vehicle parked at a level the filler
plug and check that the oil level. .
2. The level must be up to the the filler plug
hole.
3. Check that the transaxle oil is not noticeably dirty, and
that it has a suitable viscosity.
(Change oil)
1. Remove transaxle drain plug.
2. brain oil.
3. Tighten drain plug to specified torque.
Specified torque:
Engine (Non-turbo)> 30 Nm (22
Engine (Turbo) and
32 Nm (24
4. Remove filler plug and fill with specified oil till the level
comes to the lower portion of filler plug hole.
Oil level
Specified oil:
Engine (Non-turbo)>
TEXACO MTX FLUID FM
Engine (Turbo) and
SAE or
Quantity:
2.0 (2.1 qts.)
2.3 (2.4
GENERAL Maintenance, Service
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance
(Change fluid)
Engine (Non-turbo)>
1. Place a drain container with a large opening, under the
transaxle oil pan.
2. Loosen the pan bolts and tap the at one comer’
to break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then remove the
oil pan.
3. Install a new filter and O-ring on bottom of the valve
body.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service
7. oil pan with new gasket and tighten oil pan bolts.
Oil pan bolt: 11 Nm (8.0
8. Tighten drain plug with gasket to specified torque.
Specified torque:
Engine (Turbo)>
(A) 39 Nm (29
(B) 29-34 Nm (22-25
Engine>
(A) 39 Nm (29
(B) 39 Nm (29
9. Fill new ATF up to the COLD mark on the dipstick.
Transmission fluid:
DIAMOND ATF SP II or equivalent
10. Start engine and allow to idle for at least two minutes.
Then, with parking brake on, move selector lever momen-
tarily to each position, ending in “N” Neutral
11. Check if ATF is filled up to the HOT mark on the dipstick.
TSB Revision I
GENERAL Maintenance Service
Revision
GENERAL Maintenance
2. For non-turbo, remove the ‘drain plug from
Engine (Non-turbo)>
block to drain engine coolant.
For turbo, remove the water hose from the water pipe
assembly (C) to do so.
3. Remove the reserve tank to drain the coolant.
4. When the engine coolant has drained, pour in water from
the cap to clean the engine coolant line.
5. For non-turbo, install the drain plug to the cylinder block.
For turbo, install the water hose to pipe assembly
in plug
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service
Remove the filler plug and check the oil level at bottom of
filler hole. If the oil level is slightly below the filler hole, it
is in satisfactory condition.
GENERAL Maintenance
21 SYSTEM component
damage, to wiring,
harness, etc.)
The SRS must be inspected by an
after the manufacture date the certification
label located on left center ,
Manufacture date
Certification label I
,
“SRS” WARNING LIGHT CHECK
SRS Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position. the
light warning light illuminate for about 7 seconds, turn “OFF” and
then remain extinguished for at least 45 seconds? If yes,
SRS system is functioning properly. If not, refer to GROUP
Troubleshooting.
TSB Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service
CHECK
Check SRS-ECU case and brackets for dents, cracks,
deformities or rust.
Caution
The SRS may not activate if a front impact sensor
not installed properly, which could result serious injury
or death to the driver and
,
<Driver’s side>
AIR BAG MODULE, STEERING CLOCK
SPRING CHECK
1. Remove the air bag module, and clock
spring. (Refer to GROUP and
Clock Spring.)
Caution
The removed air bag be In a
clean, dry place with the pad cover face up.
2. Check pad cover for dents, cracks of deformities.
<Passenger’s side>
0 0 0 0 0 1 6 7
<Passenger’s side>
GENERAL Maintenance
Caution
If the clock spring’s mating mark is not properly
aligned, the steering wheel may not be completely
rotational during a turn, or the flat cable within the
clock spring may be severed, obstructing normal op-
eration of the SRS and possibly leading to serious
injury to the vehicle’s driver and passenger.
9. Install the steering column covers, steering wheel and
the air bag module.
10. Check steering wheel for noise, binds of difficult operation.
11. Check steering wheel for excessive free play.
REPLACE ANY VISUALLY INSPECTED PART IF IT
FAILS THAT INSPECTION.
(Refer to GROUP -Air Bag Module and Clock Spring.)
Caution
The SRS may not activate if any of the above compo-
nents is not installed properly, could result
in serious injury or death to the vehicle’s driver and
passenger.
Revision
GENERAL Maintenance Service;
Revision
GENERAL Main and Adhesive Table
Sealing between rocker cover and camshaft bearing cap DOHC ATD Part No. 8680 or equivalent
and engines only)
1
Sealing between semi-circular packing and rocker cover and between
semi-circular packing and cylinder head
Oil pressure switch (except and engines)
..
Engine coolant temperature switch, Engine coolant temperature sensor, Nut Locking Part No. 4171 or
valve, switch, Joints, Engine coolant temperature lent
gauge unit (large size)
Engine coolant temperature gauge unit (small size, only) ATD Part No. 8660 or equivalent
Sealing between body flange and weatherstrip ATD Part No. 8509 or equivalent
Adhesion of headlining and other interior trim materials Part No. or ATD Part No.
8080 or equivalent
Adhesion of fuel tank to pad
BODY SEALANT
Application Recommended brand I
Sealing of sheet metal, drip rail, floor, body side panel, trunk, front panel ATD No. 8531 or ATD Part No.
and the like joints 8848 or equivalent
Sealing of hinges
TSB Revision
GENERAL Main Sealant and Adhesive Table
Application
Sealing of flange surfaces, threaded portions, packing and dust cover ATD Part No. 8663 or equivalent
l Differential carrier packing
l Dust covers for ball joint and linkage
l Steering gear box packing and shims
l Steering gear housing rack support cover and top cover
l Mating surface of knuckle arm flange
UNDERCOAT
Application Recommended brand
TSB Revision ‘I
ENGINE
CONTENTS
ENGINE ............................................
ENGINE ...........................................
ENGINE .................................................
GENERAL INFORMATION
Items Specifications I
In-line DOHC
Number of cylinders
Bore mm (in.) 85.0
Stroke mm (in.) (3.28)
Piston displacement
Compression ratio 8.5
Firing order
Counterbalance shaft Equipped
Valve timing Intake valve Opens 21 “BTDC
Closes .
Exhaust valve Opens
Closes
Lubrication system I Pressure feed-full flow ,, I
Oil pump type Involute gear type
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
To
Camshaft
Counterbalance
Oil
Crankshaft
Counterbalance shaft
TSB Revision
ENGINE Service Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value Limit
IDrive belt Tension (Ibs.) When checked 255 333 (57.3 75.0)
[For A/C When a new belt is installed 382 441, (86.0 99.2)
When a used belt is installed 255 333 (57.3 75.0)
pressure (at 250 400 (psi) 1250 (178) min. 935 (133)
TSB Revision
ENGINE
SEALANTS
Specified sealant
Semi-circular packing and rocker cover ATD Part No. 8860 or equivalent
Bearing cap (front, rear) and cylinder head
pan, cylinder block and thermostat case assembly MITSUBISHI GENUINE PART or equivalent
SPECIAL TOOLS
Use with
Revision
ENGINE Special Tools
of the transaxle
Crankshaft sprocket
Crankshaft sprocket
TSB Revision
ENGINE ,
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy .
Oil pressure drop Engine oil level too low Check engine oil level
pressure too high Oil relief valve stuck (closed) Repair relief valve
Joisy valves Incorrect lash adjuster Bleed air or replace lash adjuster
Thin or diluted engine oil (low oil pressure) Change engine oil ,
belt noise Incorrect belt tension Adjust belt tension and/or replace tim-
ing belt
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
ON-VEHICLE
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHECK’ AND
ADJUSTMENT
GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
Use the belt tension gauge to check belt the shown
point or deflection by applying 98 (22 tbs.) to
shown point.
v Standard value:
Tension: 245 490 (55.1 110.2
Deflection <Reference
9.0 11.5 mm in.)
98 (22
pulley
Generator
pulley
pulley
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
.
POWER STEERING PUMP DRIVE BELT
ADJUSTMENT
1. Loosen power steering pump: bolt (A,
2. Move power steering tension belt moderately
adjust tension.
Standard value:
items When a new belt is When a used belt is
installed
Tension
(tbs.)
Deflection
mm (in.) , ,
3. Tighten fixing bolt (A).
Tightening torque: 28 Nm (21
4. Tighten the remaining fixing bolts and
Tightening torque:
Bolt and 28 Nm (21
Bolt 22 (18
5. Check the belt deflection amount and readjust if
saty.
Caution
This check should be carried out after turning the
crankshaft one full rotation or more in the forward
direction (to the right).
Use the belt tension gauge to check belt tension at the shown
(a) or (b), or check deflection by applying 98 (22
to the shown point.
Cranksh Standard value:
pulley
Tension: 255 333 (57.3 75.0 tbs.)
pulley Deflection: 6.5 7.5 mm in.)
a
ENGINE On-vehicle
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
NOTE
1. Ignition timing is variable within about even under
operating.
2. And it is automatically further advanced by about
from BTDC at higher altitudes.
Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
Caution
1. Keep away from the spark plug hole when crank-
ing.
2. If compression is measured with water, oil, fuel,
etc., that has come from cracks inside the cylinder,
these materials will become heated and will gush
out from the spark plug hole, which is dangerous.
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
If the air which has mixed in the oil due to the above
causes enters the high pressure chamber in the lash
adjusters, the air in the high pressure chamber will be
pressurized during opening of the valve, which causes
the lash adjusters to shrink excessively, and an abnormal
noise will be generated when the valve is closed. This
is the same phenomenon as the one when the valve
clearance has been excessively adjusted by mistake.
In this case, if the air which has entered the lash adjusters
is bled, things will be normalized.
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
.
2. Start the engine and perform gentle racing* several times
(less than times.)
If the abnormal noise stops by racing, the air is bled
from the high pressure chamber of the lash adjusters
and the function of the lash adjusters is normalized.
After raising the engine speed from idling to 3000
gradually (in 30 seconds), drop the
ally (in 30 seconds) to idling.
NOTE
l If the vehicle is parked on a slope for the oil
in the lash adjusters will be decreased ‘and air may
enter the high pressure chamber when the
is started.
l After the vehicle is parked for long, air may enter
the high pressure chamber because the, oil in the
oil passage will be gone and, it will take a time before
the oil is supplied to the lash adjusters.
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
4. Lash adjuster replacement
Caution
In the cylinder ‘are
will touch the pistons when the valves are
down, so the
piston positions.
In addition, places the
by the cams cannot be the
crankshaft should be the
are not lifted.
(4) Use the special tool to push down the valve, and
install the roller rocker. arm.
NOTE
When installing the roller rocker first set the
pivot side of the rocker arm onto the top of the lash
adjuster, and then after pushing down the valve, set
the slipper side of the rocker arm on top of the end
of the valve
TSB Revision
ENGINE Engine
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Operation Operation
l Fuel Line Pressure Releasing l Radiator Installation
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) (Refer to GROUP 14 Radiator.)
l ‘Hood Removal l Transaxle Assembly Removal
l Engine Coolant Draining Refer to GROUP
Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.) Assembly.)
l Assembly Removal Refer to GROUP Transaxle
Refer to GROUP Transaxle
A Refer to GROUP Transaxle
Refer to GROUP Transaxle
Refer to GROUP Transaxle
Refer to GROUP Transaxle
l Engine oolant
Refer to GROUP Transaxle (Refer to GROUP 00
Assembly.) l Hood
l Radiator Removal (Refer to GROUP 14 Radiator.) l Accelerator Cable Adjustment
l Under Cover Removal (Refer to GROUP 17
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under
l Drive Belt Adjustment
<Power Steering,
6 26 Nm
21
22
16
3 4
Removal steps
1. Power steering pressure switch 5. Generator
connector (Refer to GROUP 16 Generator.)
2. Generator connectors 6. Power steering pump connection
3. Oil pressure switch connector 7. compressor connection
4. Oil pressure gauge unit connector
TSB Revision
ENGINE Engine Assembly
4.9
29
Engine oil
00005320
TSB Revision
ENGINE Assemblv
67
49
Nm
72-67
44
33 25
49 Nm
36
TSB Revision
ENGINE -‘Engine Assembly
COMPRESSOR
Disconnect the compressor connector and remove the
compressor from the compressor bracket the hose
attached.
NOTE
Place the removed A/C compressor in a where it will
not be a hindrance when removing ‘and installing the engine
assembly, and tie it with a cord:
Caution
Do not bend the joint the A/C hose and the
pipe by force.
(4) Place a garage jack against the engine oil pan with a
piece of wood in between, jack up the engine so that
the weight of the engine is no longer being applied to
the engine mount bracket, and then remove the engine
mount bracket.
ENGINE ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
After checking that all cables, hoses and harness connectors,
etc., are disconnected from the engine, lift the chain block
slowly to remove the engine assembly upward from the engine
compartment.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Engine ,
Arrow
bracket
TSB Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Removal steps
1. Drive belt (Generator)
2. Drive belt (Power steering)
3. Drive belt (A/C)
4. Crankshaft pulley
TSB
ENGINE Camshaft and Oil Seal
2.9 Nm
Nm
2.2
3.4 Nm
2.5
Enaine oil
2 in.)
Sealant:
MITSUBISHI GENUINE PART
or equivalent
Cylinder head
sealant: ATD No. 8660 or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE Camshaft and Camshaft ‘Oil -Seal
..
Removal steps Installation steps
1. Accelerator cable connection 19. Intake camshaft
2. Center cover 18. Exhaust camshaft
3. Spark plug cable Rear cap (R.H.)
4. Breather hose 16. Rear bearing cap (L.H.)
5. PCV 15. bearing cap
6. Rocker cover 14. bearing cap
7. Timing belt (Refer to 20. Camshaft
8. Cover 13. Intake camshaft
9. Gasket 12. Exhaust
10. Camshaft position sensing cylinder 11. Camshaft
11. Camshaft position sensor support
12. Exhaust camshaft sprocket
13. Intake camshaft sprocket Cover
14. Front camshaft bearing cap 7. Timing belt (Refer to
15. Camshaft bearing cap 21. Semi-circular packing”
16. Rear camshaft bearing cap (R.H.) 6. Rocker cover
17. Rear camshaft bearing cap (L.H.) hose
18. Exhaust camshaft 4. Breather hose
19. Intake camshaft 3. Spark plug, cable
20. Camshaft oil seal 2. Center cover
21. Semi-circular packing 1. Accelerator cable .
Service.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE Camshaft and Camshaft Oil
Slits 01
NOTE
Install new camshafts using the following procedure.
(1) Remove the rocker arms.
(2) Lay the camshafts on the cylinder head and install
the bearing caps.
(3) that the camshaft can be easily turned by
CAMSHAFT CAP
CAMSHAFT
BEARING CAP
INSTALLATION
Tighten the bearing cap installation bolts to the torque
in two or three steps.
C a u t i o n
Tighten uniformly, otherwise the rocker arms not
straight.
Camshaft position
Camshaft position paint (2) Install the camshaft position sensor support.
sensor (3) Check that the identification paint on the
sensing cylinder is pointing in the same direction as the,
camshaft position sensor installation direction when
camshaft is at the No. 1 compression TDC position.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Oil fan and Oil
Nm
I
6.9 Nm
I
5.1 6.6
6.5
29
Removal steps
1. Transfer assembly 6. Gasket
2. Bell housing cover 7. Oil pan
3. Drain plug 8. Oil screen
4. Gasket 9. Gasket
5. Oil return pipe connection
TSB Revision
ENGINE Oil and
R E M O V A L
PAN
After removing the oil pan mounting bolts; oil
pan with the special tool and a brass bar.
Caution
Do it slowly to avoid of the
GASKET INSTALLATION
Replace the gasket and install it in the direction shown in
the illustration.
Oil pan side
Removal steps
1. Crankshaft sprocket
front oil seal
INSTALLATION SERVICE
FRONT OIL SEAL
(1) Apply engine oil to the entire inside diameter of the oil
seal lip.
(2) Press-fit the oil seal until it is flush with the oil
case.
ENGINE Crankshaft Rear Oil
Nm
Nm
4
Engine oil
Removal steps
1. Flywheel bolt 5. Adapter plate
2. Flywheel 6. plate
3. Crankshaft bushing 7. Crankshaft rear oil
4. Drive plate bolt
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE Crankshaft pear Oil
,
BOLT PLATE BOLT
<AK>
REMOVAL
Use the special tool to secure. the or drive plate,
and remove the bolt.
INSTALLATION SERVICE
CRANKSHAFT REAR OIL SEAL INSTALLATION
(1) Apply a small amount of engine oil to the entire inside
diameter of the oil seal lip.
(2) Tap in the oil seal as shown in the illustration.
(1) Clean off all sealant, oil and other substances which are
adhering to the threaded bolts, crankshaft thread holes
and the flywheel or drive plate
(2) Apply oil to the bearing surface of the flywheel
or drive plate bolt.
(3) Apply oil to the crankshaft thread holes.
(4) Apply sealant to the threaded mounting bolts.
Specified sealant:
Stud locking 4170 or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head
3.6
2.9 Nm
2.2
4.9 Nm
21
22 Engine oil
01 ,
Removal steps
1. Accelerator cable connection 14. position sensor connector
(Refer to GROUP 17 On-vehicle 15. Crankshaft sensor
Service.)
2. Air hose 16. Air conditioning compressor
3. Idle air control motor connector connector
4. Knock sensor connector 17. Control wiring harness
5. Heated oxygen sensor connector 18. Center cover
6. Engine coolant temperature gauge 19. Spark cable
unit connector 20. Brake booster
7. Engine coolant temperature sensor
connector 21. High-pressure fuel hose connection
8. Ignition power transistor connector 22. Fuel return hose connection
9. Throttle position sensor connector 23. By-pass valve hose connection
10. Capacitor connector 24. Water hose connection
11. Manifold differential pressure 25. Vacuum hoses connection
sensor connector 26. Breather hose
12. Injector connectors 27. PCV hose connection
13. Ignition coil connector
TSB Revision
ENGINE Head Gasket’ .
engine>
78 Nm
(58
Nm
Cylinder head
Specified sealant:
Sealant: ATD Part No. 8880 or equivalent MITSUBISHI GENUINE PART
or equivalent
Timing belt
l 36. Thermostat case assembly
(Refer to 37. O-ring
28. Power steering pump 38. Flange bolts and flange nut
29. Rocker cover (Refer to GROUP
30. Semi-circular packing
31. Heat protector (A) 39. Cylinder head
32. Water hose connection 40. Cylinder head assembly
33. Water hose A connection 41. Ring
34. Radiator upper hose connection 42. (A)
35. Radiator lower hose connection Cylinder head gasket
Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head Gasket,
Exhaust side
INSTALLATION SERVICE
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET INSTALLATION
(1) all oil and grease from the gasket mounting
(2) Install the gasket to the cylinder block with the identification
mark facing upwards.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Head
3 Tighten to
Exhaust side 20 Nm (15
4 Tighten of a turn. In the order-shown in-the
. illustration; Mark
Step 4 Step 5 of the cylinder head bolt
I
and cylinder head by
paint. ,
5 Tighten of a turn. shown in the
Check that the
painted of
. lined
the
Painted marks Painted marks
Caution
1. Always make a tightening If
than the head bolt will loosened.
2. If it is more than remove the head bolt , repeat
the procedure 1.
THE RM OS TAT
C A SE A S S E M B LY
(1) Loosen the water inlet pipe bolt shown in
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head Gasket
(2) Align the mating marks on the radiator hose and hose
clamp, and then connect the radiator hose.
Mating marks
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt
TIMING BELT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
l Engine Mount Bracket Removal l Engine Adjustment
(Refer to GROUP 32 Engine Mounting.) l Engine Mount Bracket
(Refer to GROUP 32 Engine Mounting.)
17
48
6.8
6.5 2
25
Removal steps
l Drive Belt Tension Adjustment 7. Crankshaft pulley
1. Drive belt (Generator) 8. Timing belt front upper cover
2. Drive belt (Power steering) 9. Timing belt front center cover
3. Tensioner pulley bracket 10. Timing belt front lower. cover
4. Drive belt (A/C) l Timing belt tension adjustment
5. Water pump pulley 11. Timing belt
6. Water pump pulley (Power 12. Tension pulley
steering) 13. Auto tensioner
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing
INSTALLATION SERVICE
(22-44 AUTO TENSIONER
(1) Apply 98-196 (22-44 force to the auto tensioner
by pressing it against a metal (cylinder ‘and
A
measure the movement of the push rod.
Standard value:
Within 1 mm in.)
tensioner A: Length when it is free (not pressed)
III B: Length when it is pressed
A-B: Movement
(2) If it is out of the standard value, replace the auto tensioner.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt
(4) Once the holes are aligned, insert the set pin.
, Set pin NOTE
When replacing the auto tensioner a new part, the
pin will be in the auto tensioner.
(5) Install the auto tensioner to the engine.
Crankshaft
sprocket
60 mm (2) After aligning the timing mark on the oil pump sprocket,
(2.36 in.) remove the cylinder block plug and insert a Phillips screw-
or more in.) driver with a diameter of 8 mm in.), and check to
be sure that the screwdriver goes in 60 mm (2.36 in.)
or more. If the screwdriver will only go in 20 25 mm
in.) before striking the counterbalance shaft,
turn the sprocket once, realign the timing mark and check
that the screwdriver goes in 60 mm (2.36 in.) or more.
Do not take out the screwdriver until the timing belt is
installed.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
(5) Screw the tool into the engine left bracket until:
its end makes contact with the tensioner
point, screw the tool in some more then remove
the set wire attached to the auto tensioner:
(6) Remove the tool.
(7) Tighten the center bolt to the torque.
Specified torque: 48 Nm (35
TSB Revision
ENGINE Belt
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing
TIMING BELT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Nm (Engine oil)
Removal steps
1. Timing belt (Refer to __
2. Crankshaft sprocket
3. Crankshaft sensing blade
l Timing belt tension adjustment
4. Timing belt tensioner
5. Timing belt
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt
BELT REMOVAL
Caution
If timing belt is ‘to be use chalk to
it with an arrow on its flat side indicating the turning
direction (to the right).
(3) Press the belt at the shown point by a finger ‘to check
belt tension. If not, adjust.
Belt tension side __
Standard value: 5-7 mm In.)
installation bolt
ENGINE Timing Belt
Revision
,
.
NOTES
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Descriptions . . . Specifications
“in-line DOHC
Number of cylinders 4
Closes (ABDC) 51
‘Closes (ATDC)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL ‘Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value Limit
Rocker arms and camshaft
cam height mm (in.) Intake 34.91 (1.37) 34.41
Exhaust 34.91 (1.37) 34.41
Camshaft journal O.D. mm (in.) 25.96 (1.02)
Cylinder head and valve
Cylinder head flatness of gasket surface mm (in.) Less than 0.05 0.2
Cylinder head grinding limit of gasket surface mm (in.) l 9.2
*Total resurfacing depth of both cylinder head and cylinder block
Cylinder head overall height mm (in.) 131.9-132.1
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
REWORK DIMENSIONS
Items Standard value
Cylinder head and valve
Oversize rework dimensions of valve guide 0.05 O.S.
hole (both intake and exhaust) mm (in.)
0.25 O.S. 12.25-12.27 ,
0.50
Intake oversize rework 0.3
dimensions of valve seat hole mm (in.)
0.6 O.S.
Exhaust oversize rework dimensions of valve 0.3 O.S.
seat hole
mm (in.) 0.6 O.S.
Crankshaft, flywheel and drive plate ,
Crankshaft out of roundness and taper of journal and pin mm (in.) Max. 0.01
NOTE
O.D.: Outer diameter
I.D.: Inner diameter
Oversize diameter
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Nm
Generator and ignition system
W a t e rpump
pulley bolt 11 8”
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
items Nm
Piston and connecting rod
Connecting rod cap nut 20 turns 14.5 turns
Crankshaft, flywheel and drive plate
Flywheel bolt 135 9 8
Drive plate bolt 135 98
Oil seal case bolt 11 8
Rear plate bolt 11 8
housing cover bolt 9 7
cap bolt 25 turns 18 turns
Knock sensor 23 1 6
Bracket
Left and right engine support bracket bolt 45 3 3
Front roll stopper bracket bolt 65 47
Rear roll stopper bracket bolt 120 87
Front engine support bracket bolt 60 43
Exhaust pipe support bracket bolt 36
SEALANT
Items Specified sealant I
Camshaft position sensor support Mitsubishi Genuine Part No. or equivalent
Rocker cover ATD Part No. 8660 or equivalent
Semi-circular packing ATD Part No. 8660 or equivalent
Enaine bracket bolt ATD Part No. 8660 or eauivalent
Oil pan Mitsubishi Genuine Part No. or equivalent I
Water outlet fitting Mitsubishi Genuine Part No. or equivalent
Engine coolant temperature gauge unit ATD Part No. 8660 or equivalent
Engine coolant temperature sensor Nut Locking Part No. 4171 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch ATD Part No. 8660 or equivalent
Oil pressure gauge unit ATD Part No. 8660 or equivalent
Rear oil seal case Mitsubishi Genuine Part No. or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL ,
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Supersession Application ,
Installation of
Handle seal
Crankshaft rear
oil seal installer ,
Crankshaft front
oil seal installer
Use with
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
Use with
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Special Tools
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL and 11
8 25 Nm
18
10 Nm
7
5 23 Nm
24 7
17
25 Nm
18
6
Removal steps
1. Drive belt 9. Spark plug
2. Water pump pulley 10. Ignition power transistor
3. Power steering pump pulley 11. Ignition coil
4. Generator brace 12. Plate
5. Generator 13. Gasket
6. Crankshaft pulley 14. Camshaft position sensor
7. Center cover 15. Camshaft position sensor
8. Spark plug cable 16. Camshaft position sensing cylinder
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Generator and
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
TIMING BELT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
24
19 Nm
14
14
13 23
90 Nm
65
1 6
24 Nm
17
4
2
9 Nm
7
55 Nm
40
.
36 Nm
11 27
120 Nm
87
Removal steps
1. Timing belt front upper cover 14. Tensioner
2. Timing belt front center cover 15. Timing belt
3. Timing belt front lower cover 16. Counterbalance shaft’ sprocket
4. Crankshaft position sensor 17. Spacer
5. Timing belt 18. Crankshaft sprocket
6. Tensioner pulley 19. Rocker cover
7. Tensioner arm 20. Semi-circular
8. Auto tensioner 21. Engine support et
9. Idler pulley 22. Camshaft sprocket bolt
10. Oil pump sprocket 23. Camshaft sprocket
11. Crankshaft bolt 24. Timing belt rear right cover
12. Crankshaft sprocket 25. Timing belt rear left upper cover
13. Crankshaft sensing blade 26. Timing belt rear left lower cover
TSB Revision
OVERHAUL Timing. Belt
CRANKSHAFT BOLT
CRANKSHAFT ..
TSB Revision
OVERHAUL Timing
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing Belt ,
SEALANT APPLICATION ON
PACKING
Specified sealant: ATD Part No.
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing Belt
Semi-circular
Cylinder head
in.)
SPACER INSTALLATION
(1) Install the spacer with the chamfered end toward
the oil seal.
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing’
COUNTERBALANCE SHAFT
INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
BOLT
OIL SPROCKET
(1) a Phillips screwdriver [shank diameter 8 mm
in.) shaft] through the plug hole on the the
cylinder block to block the left counterbalance shaft.
(2) the oil pump sprocket. .
(3) Apply a proper amount of engine oil-to the bearing
of the nuts.
(4) Tighten the nuts to the specified‘ torque.
Phillips screwdriver
(3) Push in the rod little by little with the vise the
hole A in the rod is aligned with the hole in the
(4) a wire mm in.) diameter] into the
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
TENSIONER PULLEY INSTALLATION
(1) Install the tensioner pulley in such direction that its two
small holes are arranged vertically.
Cylinder head
top
marks
NOTE
The same camshaft sprocket is used, for the intake and
exhaust camshafts and is provided with two timing marks.
When the sprocket is mounted on the exhaust camshaft,
use the timing mark on the right with the dowel ‘pin hole
on top. For the intake camshaft sprocket, use the one
on the left with the dowel pin hole on top.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
(5) Thread the timing belt over the intake side camshaft
sprocket and fix it at indicated position by a bulldog clip.
(6) Thread the timing belt over the exhaust side sprocket,
aligning the timing marks with the cylinder head top surface
using two wrenches.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing
(8) Thread the timing belt over the idler pulley, the oil pump
sprocket, the crankshaft sprocket and the tensioner pulley
in the order shown.
(9) Remove the two clips.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing
INSPECTION
TIMING BELT
Replace belt if any of the following conditions exist.
(1) Hardening of back rubber.
Back side is glossy without resilience and leaves no indent
when pressed with fingernail.
Cracks’
Abnormal wear
(Fluffy strand)
AUTO TENSIONER
(1) Check the auto tensioner for possible leaks and replace
as necessary.
(2) Check the rod end for wear or damage and replace as
necessary.
(3) Measure the rod protrusion. If it is out of specification,
replace the auto tensioner.
Standard value: 12 mm in.)
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
12 Nm
9
19 Nm
14
9 Nm
7
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Fuel and
INJECTOR
(1) Before installing an injector the rubber O-ring must be
lubricated with a drop of clean engine oil to aid in
installation.
(2) Install injector top end into fuel rail.
Be careful not to damage the O-ring during installation.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Intake Manifold
INTAKE MANIFOLD
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
13 Nm
9
(To oil cooler)
11 N m
8
20 Nm
14
31 Nm
22
Removal steps
1. Water hose 7. Water outlet fitting
2. Water hose 8. Thermostat housing
3. Engine coolant temperature gauge 9. Intake manifold stay
unit 10. Engine hanger
4. Engine coolant temperature sensor 11. Intake manifold
5. Water inlet fitting 12. Gasket
6. Thermostat case
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL
Specified sealant:
Mitsubishi Genuine Part No. or equiva-
lent
NOTE
(1) Be sure to install the housing quickly while the
is wet (within 15 minutes).
diameter
(2) After installation, keep the sealed area away from
bead sealant the oil and coolant for approx. 1 hour.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Exhaust Manifold
. . 27
10
Nm
1 20 13 Nm
2 I
14 29
21
‘-23
Nm
14 Nm 7
I
in
I - Nm
Nm
10
Nm
32
Removal steps
1. Oil dipstick 17. Water pipe
2. Oil dipstick guide 18. Turbocharger
3. O-ring 19. Engine hanger
4. Heat protector “A” 20. Exhaust manifold
5. Heat protector 21. Gasket
6. Heated oxygen sensor 22. Water hose
7. Exhaust fitting 23. Water pipe
8. Gasket 24. Water pipe
9. Oil pipe “A” 25. Water hose
10. Oil pipe 26. Water hose
11. Oil return pipe 27. Water hose
12. Gasket 28. Water hose
13. Turbocharger assembly 29. O-ring
14. Gasket 30. Water inlet pipe
15. Ring 31. Water pump
16. Water pipe “A” 32. Gasket
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Exhaust Manifold and
INSTALLATION SERVICE
O-ring
WATER PIPE/O-RING
Wet the O-ring (with water) to facilitate assembly.
Caution
Keep the O-ring free of oil or grease.
TURBOCHARGER
(1) the cone disc spring in shown direction.
Identification
hole (2) Tighten the turbocharger mounting bolts and to
27 31 Nm 22
Exhaust
manifold
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker Arms and
20
14
8 ,
I!
Removal steps
1. Bearing cap rear 7. cap No. 3
2. Bearing cap front 8. Camshaft
3. Camshaft oil seal 9. Rocker arm
4. Bearing cap No. 5 10. Lash adjuster
5. Bearing cap No. 2 11. Oil delivery body
6. Bearing cap No. 4
.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker, Arms
INSTALLATION SERVICE
LASH ADJUSTER
(1) the lash adjuster in clean diesel fuel.
(2) Using a special tool, move the plunger up and down
4 or 5 times while pushing down lightly on the check
ball in order to bleed out the air.
CAMSHAFT INSTALLATION
Camshaft sprocket side (1) Apply engine oil to journals and cams of the
(2) Install the camshafts on the cylinder head.
Use care not to confuse the intake camshaft with the
exhaust one. The intake camshaft has a slit on its rear
end for driving the crankshaft position sensor.
side
camshaft
Dowel pin (3) Install the crankshaft sprocket or spacer and flange
to an end of the crankshaft, and turn the until
the timing marks are lined up, setting No. cylinder to
the TDC.
(4) Place the camshafts so that their dowel pins are positioned
at top.
2 6
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker
.
INSPECTION
CAMSHAFT
(1) Measure the cam height.
Standard value mm (in.) Limit mm (in.)
Intake 34.91 (1.37) 34.41 (1.36)
Exhaust 34.91 (1.37) 34.41
ROCKER ARM
Roller
(1) Check the roller surface. If any dents, damage or seizure
is evident, replace the rocker arm.
(2) Check rotation of the roller. If it does not rotate smoothly
or if looseness is evident, replace the rocker arm.
(3) Check the inside diameter. If damage or seizure is evident,
replace the rocker arm.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker Arms and
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL
11300690201
CYLINDER HEAD AND VALVES
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Removal steps
1. Cylinder head bolt 11. Exhaust valve
head assembly 12. Valve stem seal
13. Valve spring seat
Retainer lock 14. Valve stem seal
5. Valve spring retainer 15. Valve spring seat
6. Valve spring 16. Intake valve guide
7. Intake valve 17. Exhaust valve guide
8. Retainer lock 18. Intake valve seat
9. Valve spring retainer 19. Exhaust valve seat
10. Valve spring 20. Cylinder head
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and Valves
REMOVAL
PRECAUTION FOR PARTS
(1) Keep removed parts in order according to the cylinder,
number and intake/exhaust.
HEAD BOLTS REMOVAL
(1) Using the special tool, the cylinder bolts.
Loosen evenly, little by little.
LOCK REMOVAL
(1) Store removed valves, springs and other parts,‘ tagged
to indicate their cylinder No. and location for reassembly.
Stem seal
, Spring seat
TSB Revision I
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head
RETAINER LOCK ..
The ‘valve spring, if excessively, compressed, causes the
bottom end of retainer to be in contact with, and damage,:
the stem seal.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and
INSPECTION
CYLINDER HEAD
(1) Check the cylinder head gasket surface for flatness by
using a straightedge and feeler gauge.
Standard value: 0.05 mm in.)
Limit: 0.2 mm in.)
(2) If the service limit is exceeded, correct to meet specifica-
tion.
Grinding limit: mm in.)
Includes combined with cylinder grinding.
Cylinder head height (Specification when
131.9-132.1 mm in.)
VALVE
(1) Check the valve face for correct contact. I/incorrect, reface
using valve Valve seat contact should be main-
tained uniform at the center valve face.
Valve seat (2) the margin exceeds the service limit, replace the valve.
contact
Margin
I
VALVE
(1) Measure the free height of spring and, if it is smaller
than the limit, replace.
Standard value: 47.0 mm in.)
Free Limit: 46.0 mm (1.811 in.)
height
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Head and
GUIDE
(1) Measure the clearance between the valve guide and valve
stem. If the limit is exceeded, replace the valve guide
or valve, or both.
Item Standard value mm (in.) Limit mm (in.)
Intake 0.10
Stem O.D.
Exhaust 0.15
mm
in.)
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and Valves,
TSB Revision I
ENGINE OVERHAUL.
1 3 1
24 Nm
17
10 Nm
7 6
17 Nm
I 18 I I
19 Nm 10
14
..
45 Nm Nm
33 17 I
10 Nm 19 Nm
14
40 Nm
Removal steps
Oil filter 19. Oil filter bracket
2. Oil cooler bolt 20. Oil filter bracket gasket
3. Oil cooler 21. Oil pump cover
4. Drain plug 22. Oil pump driven gear
5. Drain plug gasket 23. Oil pump drive gear
6. Oil pan 24. Crankshaft front oil seal
7. Oil screen 25. Oil pump oil seal
8. Oil screen gasket 26. Counterbalance shaft oil seal
9. Baffle plate 27. Front case
10. Plug 28. Front case gasket
11. O-ring 29. Counterbalance shaft, left
12. Flange bolt 30. Counterbalance shaft, right
13. Oil pressure switch 31. Counterbalance shaft, front
14. Oil pressure gauge unit 32. shaft, rear
15. Relief plug
16. Gasket 33. shaft, rear bearing,
17. Relief spring
18. Relief plunger
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL and Pan
PLUG REMOVAL
(1) If the plug is too tight, hit the plug head with a hammer
two to three times, and the plug will be easily loosened.
Phillips screwdriver
COUNTERBALANCE FRONT
REMOVAL ,
Using the special tool, remove the counterbalance shaft
front bearing from the cylinder block.
NOTE
Be sure to remove the front bearing
If it has not been removed, the Rear Bearing Puller cannot
Front
be used.
bearing
TSB Revision
Front Case,
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
TSB Revision
Front Case, Counterbalance
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
COUNTERBALANCE
INSTALLATION
(1) Using special tools, install front bearing. ,,
Cylinder
block
FRONT CASE
(1) Place the special tool on the front end of crankshaft and
apply a thin coat of engine oil to the outer
of the special tool to install the front
(2) Install the front case assembly through a new front case
gasket and temporarily tighten the flange bolts (other
than those for tightening the filter bracket).
Oil seal
case
TSB Revision
Front Case,,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and ‘Pan
B O L T ,
(1) Phillips screwdriver hole in the left side
of the cylinder block to lock the counterbalance shaft.
Phillips screwdriver
(2) Secure the oil pump driven gear onto the left counterbal-
ance shaft by tightening the flange bolt to specified torque.
PLUG INSTALLATION
(1) Install a new O-ring to the front case.
(2) Using the special tool, install the plug and tighten to speci-
fied torque.
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and. Pan
P A N .
(1) Clean both mating surfaces of and cylinder block.
(2) Apply a 4 mm in.) wide bead of to the entire
circumference of the oil pan flange.
Specified sealant:
MITSUBISHI GENUINE or
equivalent
NOTE ..
Be sure to install the oil pan quickly the sealant’
is wet (within 15 minutes);
(2) After installation, keep the sealed area from,,
the oil and coolant for approx. hour.
, .
8 mm bolts
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
TSB I
Front Case, Counterbalance
ENGINE Shaft and
INSPECTION
FRONT CASE
(1) Check oil holes for clogging and if necessary.
(2)’ Check left counterbalance shaft front bearing for
Wear, damage and seizure. If there is anything wrong’
with the section, replace the front
(3) Check the front case for cracks and other damage.
place cracked or damaged front case.
OIL SEAL
(1) Check the oil seal lip for wear and damage. Replace
oil seal if necessary.
(2) Check the oil seal lip for deterioration. Replace oil seal
if necessary.
COUNTERBALANCE SHAFT
(1) Check oil holes for clogging.
(2) Check journal for seizure, damage and contact with bear-
ing. If there is anything wrong with the journal, replace
counterbalance shaft, bearing or front case assembly.
I
OIL PUMP
(1) Assemble the oil pump gear to the front case and rotate
it to ensure smooth rotation with no looseness.
(2) Ensure that there is no ridge wear on the contact surface
between the front case and the gear surface of the oil
pump cover.
(3) Check the side clearance.
Standard value:
Drive gear mm
Driven gear mm in.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Connecting 1
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
- 4
Removal steps
1. Nut 7. Piston ring No. 2
Connecting rod cap 8. Oil ring
3. Connecting rod bearing 9. Piston pin
4. Piston and connecting rod assembly 10. Piston
5. Connecting rod bearing 11. Connecting rod
6. Piston ring No. 1 12. Bolt
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Rod
REMOVAL SERVICE
ROD CAP
(1) Mark the cylinder number on the side of connecting
rod big end for correct reassembly.
(2) Keep the removed connecting rods, caps, ‘and bearings
in order according to the cylinder number.
(3) Insert the press pin through the piston pin hole. Select
the correct connecting rod guide pin (See above). Thread
Press the guide pin onto the threaded portion of the press pin.
pin (4) Position the piston assembly on the piston support in
the press. With the press pin up as shown in Figure 4,
Piston pin insert the guide pin through the hole in the piston and
through the hole in the piston support.
Front mark
(5) Press the piston pin out of the assembly.
IMPORTANT: To avoid piston damage,
l The piston support must seat squarely against
the piston.
l Verify that the piston pin will slide through the
Connecting rod hole in the piston support.
guide pin
(6) Remove the piston pin from the press pin.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Connecting Rod
INSTALLATION SERVICE
PIN INSTALLATION
(1) Thread the stop screw and lock nut into the
base. Fit the correct piston support on top of the base,
1 the press pin, threaded end up, into hole in
the piston support until the pin touches the stop
Base screw.
(2) Using the markings on the pin, stop
screw to the depth as shown below.
Depth:
Refer to the operating instructions on the tool.
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and
No. 1 ring
No. 2 ring
Identification mark (2) install piston rings with identification mark facing up,
Identification mark Size mark
to the piston crown side.
(3) Size marks on piston rings are as follows..
Size Identification mark
Standard N o n e
0.50 mm oversize 50
1 mm
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL and
Upper side
PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
(1) Liberally coat engine oil on the of the piston,’
piston ring, and oil ring.
Crankshaft (2) Arrange the piston ring and. oil ring gaps rail and
spacer) as shown in the ‘figure.
side (3) Rotate crankshaft so that crank cylinder
bore.
Identification mark:
ring gap
and spacer gap rail (4) Rotate crankshaft so that the is on the center
of the cylinder bore.
(5) Use suitable thread protectors on the connecting
Timing belt side before inserting piston and rod assembly into
the cylinder block.
Care must be taken not to nick the crank
(6) Using a suitable piston tool, the:
piston and connecting rod into the
,
Front mark
I
1 None
(1.7715-1.7717)
2 None None 2 1.491-1.495
(1.7711-1.7715)
Identification mark 3 None White 3
Notch
(2) Make sure that the connecting rod big end side clearance
meets the specification.
Standard value: mm
Limit: 0.4 mm in.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
11300850104
(3) Install the piston ring into the cylinder bore. Force it
down with a piston, its crown being in contact with the
ring, to correctly position it at right angles to the cylinder
wall. Then, measure the end gap with a feeler gauge.
If the ring gap is excessive, replace the piston ring.
Standard value mm (in.)
No. 1 ring
ring
ring
Limit:
No. 1, No. 2 ring 0.8 mm in.)
Oil ring 1.0 mm in.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston Rod
1 I
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
Removal steps
1. Flywheel bolt 10. Oil seal
2. Flywheel 11. Bearing cap
3. Drive plate bolt 12. Bearing
4. Adapter plate 13. Crankshaft bearing’ (lower)
5. Drive plate 14. Crankshaft
6. Crankshaft bushing (upper)
7. Rear plate
8. Bell housing cover
9. Oil seal case 18. block
TSB Revision
Crankshaft,
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Drive Plate .
REMOVAL POINT
JET
Use an appropriate metal bar to press the out.
CRANKSHAFT BEARING
When the bearing needs replacing, select and install a proper
bearing by the following procedure.
(1) Measure the crankshaft journal diameter and confirm its
classification from the following table. In the case of
a crankshaft supplied as a service part, identification colors
of its journals are painted at the positions shown in the
illustration.
(2) The cylinder block bearing bore diameter identification
marks are stamped at the position shown in the illustration
from the front of engine, beginning at 1.
Crankshaft journal block
Crankshaft
bearing
bore
diameter
Outer
tion mark diameter mm mark tion
(for color (in.)
production (for service
1 None Yellow 1
2
2 3
2 None None (2.2436-2.2439)
0 2
Timing belt side 1
Cylinder block bearing
bore identification mark 2 4
3 None White 3
1’ 4
5
(3) Select a proper bearing from the above, table on the basis
of the identification data confirmed under (1) and
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
ed [Example]
(1) If the measured value of a crankshaft
diameter is between 56.994 mm (2.2439
2.2441 in.), the journal is in the’
case the is also replaced by a
(for No. tion mark spare part, check the identification colors of the
journals painted on the crankshaft. If the color’
is yellow, for example,. journal is classified as
Identification
mark
Upper and lower (2) check the cylinder block bearing hole
(for No. 3) 1 mark stamped on the cylinder block.
If it is “O”, read the “Bearing identification column
to find the identification mark of the bearing to be
used. In this case, it is “1”.
(4) the bearings oil groove to the cylinder
block.
(5) Install the bearings having no oil to the bearing
caps.
TSB Revision
Crankshaft,
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL and
SEALANT TO
sealant:
Mitsubishi Genuine No.
lent
NOTE
(1) Be sure to install the case the
is wet (within, 15 minutes).
(2) After installation, keep the sealed area away from
oil and coolant for approx. 1 hour.
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL and
INSPECTION
OIL CLEARANCE
(1) Remove oil from the crankshaft journal ‘and crankshaft
bearing.
(2) Install the crankshaft.
(3) Cut the Plastigage to the same length as the width of
bearing and place it on journal in parallel with its axis.
CYLINDER BLOCK
(1) Visually check for scratches, rust, and corrosion.
Use also a flaw detecting agent for the check. If defects
are evident, correct, or replace.
(2) Using a straightedge and feeler gauge, check the block
top surface for Make sure that the surface
is free from gasket chips and other foreign matter.
Standard value: 0.05 mm in.)
Limit: 0.1 mm in.)
(3) If the distortion is excessive, correct within the allowable
limit or replace.
Grinding limit: 0.2 mm in.)
Includes/combined with cylinder head grinding
Cylinder block height (when new):
283.9-284.1 mm (11.177-11.185 in.)
(4) Check cylinder walls for scratches and seizure. If defects
are evident, correct (bored to oversize) or replace.
(5) Using cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore and
cylindricity. If worn badly, correct cylinder to an oversize
and replace piston and piston rings. Measure at the
points shown in illustration.
Standard value:
Cylinder I.D.
mm in.)
A Cylindricity 0.01 mm in.)
TSB Revision
, Flywheel
ENGINE OVERHAUL and Drive Plate
BORING CYLINDER
(1) Oversize pistons to be used should be determined
the basis of the largest bore cylinder.
Piston size identification
NOTE
Size mark is stamped on piston top,
(2) Measure outside diameter of piston to be used. Measure
it in thrust direction as shown.
(3) Based on measured piston O.D. calculate boring
dimension.
Boring finish dimension Piston O.D.
(clearance between piston O.D. and cylinder)
0.02 mm in.) (honing margin)
(4) Bore all cylinders to calculated boring finish dimension.
Caution
To prevent distortion that may result from temperature
rise during honing, bore cylinders, working
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Bracket
BRACKET
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
65
47
Removal steps
1. Roll stopper bracket, front
2. Engine support bracket, front
3. Exhaust pipe support bracket
4. Roll stopper bracket, rear
TSB Revision
11
NOTES .
,
CONTENTS
GENERAL
items Specifications
OHV, DOHC
Number of cylinder 4
Bore mm (in.) 87.5 (3.445)
Stroke mm (in.) 83.0 (3.287)
Piston displacement 1,996 (121.8)
Compression ratio 9.6
Firing order
Valve timing Intake Opens 1.3” BTDC
[Measured at 0.5
mm Closes 39.7” ABDC .
Exhaust Opens 36” BBDC
Closes 1.1” ATDC
Lubrication system Pressure feed-full flow filtration
Oil pump type Trochoid type
a
TSB Revision I
ENGINE ‘Service
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value Limit
Drive belt Tension When checked
(For (Ibs.) When a new belt is installed
generator) When a used belt is installed 110)
Deflection Whenchecked 9.0
mm (in.) When a new belt is installed 7.5 10.5
<Reference When a used belt is installed 9.0 12.0
value>
Drive belt Tension Whenchecked 110)
(For power When a new belt is installed
steering oil When a used belt is installed 110)
<Vehicles Deflection When checked
without mm (in.) When a new belt is installed 6.5 9.5
When a used belt is installed
Drive belt Tension Whenchecked 114.6)
(For power When a new belt is installed 608 706 (136.7
steering oil When a used belt is installed 412 510 (92.8 114.6)
and A/C
Deflection Whenchecked
mm (in.) When a new belt is installed 8.0 9.0
When a used belt is installed
Curb idle speed 100
mixture CO contents 0.5 or less
HC contents ppm 100 or less
pressure (at 250 400 (psi) 1,551
pressure difference of all cylinder max. 25%
ntake manifold vacuum min. 60 (18)
SEALANTS
Items Specified sealant
Oil pump to
Outside camshaft bearing cap Loctite 518 or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE Special
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number Supersession Application
and name
502 502 speed inspection
Scan tool
(MUT-II)
ROM Pack
544
MUT-II
Interface
cartridge
545 545
Adapter
harness
Remover
crankshaft
damper/sprocket
1026
Remover
puller damper
Remover
crankshaft
sprocket
TSB Revision
Special Took
seal
SERVICE TOOL
Revision
ENGINE Tools
seal installation
6926-2
Crankshaft oil
seal installer
R e v i s i o n
ENGINE Troubleshooting,
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
TSB Revision
BELT
ADJUSTMENT
Check the belt tension with the tension gauge, or check the
belt deflection by pressing the middle point of the belt by
a force of 98 (22 ibs.).
Standard value:
Tension: 400 490 (90 110
Deflection <Reference
9.0 12.0 mm
Crankshaft
GENERATOR BELT
1. Remove the under cover side panel (R.H.).
2. Loosen the generator pivot nut.
3. Loosen the lock nut.
4. Turn the adjusting screw to adjust belt tension or
deflection to the standard
NOTE
When installing a new belt, apply 310 (70 ibs.) of tension’
for 5 minutes or more, and then apply the final tension.
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
44
Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service’
5. Cover the spark plug hole with a shop towel etc., and
after the engine has been cranked, check that no foreign
material is adhering to the shop towel.
. Caution
1. Keep away from the spark plug hole when crank-
ing.
2. If compression is measured with water, oil, fuel,
etc., that has come from cracks inside the cylinder,
these materials will become heated and will gush
out from the spark plug hole, which is dangerous.
6. Set compression gauge to one of the spark plug holes.
7. Crank the engine with the throttle valve fully open and
measure the compression pressure.
Standard value (at engine speed of
psi)
Limit (at engine speed of
min. 689 (100 psi)
8. Measure the compression pressure for all the cylinders,
and check that the pressure differences of the cylinders
are below the limit.
Limit:
NOTE
The limit value can be derived by calculating the difference
between the maximum and minimum values for the
compression pressure and dividing this value by the
maximum value.
9. If there is a cylinder with compression or a compression
difference that is outside the limit, pour a small amount
of engine oil through the spark plug hole, and repeat
the operations in steps 7 and 8.
(1) If the compression increases after oil is added, the
cause of the malfunction is a worn or damaged piston
ring and/or cylinder inner surface.
(2) If the compression does not rise after oil is added,
the cause is a burnt or defective valve seat, or pressure
is leaking from the gasket.
10. Connect the relay (ASD relay) connector.
11. Install the spark plug and spark plug cable.
12. Use the scan tool to erase the diagnostic trouble codes.
NOTE
This will erase the diagnostic trouble code resulting
the relay (ASD relay) being disconnected.
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle.’
MANIFOLD VACUUM
1. Before inspection, set vehicles. in the condition:
Engine coolant
l Lights, electric cooling and
l Transaxle: Neutral (P
2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector.
LASH CHECK
A tappet-like may be produced from several items.
Check the following items.
1. Engine oil level too high or too low.
This may cause, aerated oil to enter, the adjusters and
cause them to be spongy.
2. Insufficient running time after rebuilding the cylinder head.
Low speed running up to 1 hour may be required.
3. Low oil pressure.
4. The oil restrictor pressed in to the vertical oil passage
to the cylinder head is plugged with debris.
5. Air ingested in to oil due to broken or cracked oil pump
pick up.
6. Worn valve guide.
7. Faulty hydraulic lash adjuster.
(1) Check for sponginess while still installed in engine.
Depress part of the cam follower just over the adjuster.
Normal adjusters should be free and very firm.
Spongy adjusters can be depressed to the bottomed
position easily.
(2) Remove a suspected hydraulic lash adjuster assem-
bly.
(3) Clean out dirt and varnish with solvent.
(4) Reassemble with engine oil.
(5) Check for sponginess.
(6) If still spongy, replace new adjuster
assembly. .
TSB Revision I
ENGINE Engine
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pm-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
l Fuel Line Pressure Releasing l Radiator Installation (Refer to GROUP 14
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) Radiator.)
l Hood Removal l Transaxle Assembly Installation
l Engine Coolant Draining Refer to GROUP Transaxle Assembly.)
(Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.) Refer to GROUP Assembly.)
l Transaxle Assembly Removal l Engine Coolant Supplying
Refer to GROUP Transaxle Assembly.) (Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.)
Refer to GROUP Transaxle Assembly.) l Hood Installation
l Radiator Removal (Refer to GROUP 14 Radiator.) l Accelerator Cable Adjustment
l Under Cover Removal (Refer to GROUP 17 On-vehicle
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under-Cover.)
l Drive Belt Tension Adjustment
<Power Steering
39 Nm
29
39 Nm
29
Removal steps
1. compressor connector 6. MAP sensor connector
2. Power steering pressure switch 7. Intake air temperature sensor
connector connector
3. Heated oxygen sensor connector 8. Power steering pump connection
4. Engine coolant temperature gauge 9. A/C compressor connection
unit connector
5. Engine coolant temperature sensor
connector
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Fuel rail
Engine oil
2.5 Nm
TSB Revision
E N G I N E ,
66 Nm
64
Nm
72-67
TSB Revision 1
ENGINE Engine
A/C COMPRESSOR REMOVAL
the A/C compressor connector and remove the
compressor from the compressor bracket with the
attached.
NOTE
Place the removed A/C compressor in a place where it will
not be a hindrance when removing and installing the engine
assembly, and tie it with a cord.
Caution
Do not bend the joint between the A/C hose and the A/C
pipe by force.
MOUNT BRACKET
REMOVAL
(1) Support the engine with a garage jack.
(2) Remove the special tool which was attached when the’
transaxle assembly was removed.
(3) Hold the engine assembly with a chain block or similar
TSB Revision
ENGINE Enaine
bracket Notch
TSB Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Operation Post-installation
l Under Cover Removal l Drive Belt Tension
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.),
Removal steps
1. Drive belt (Power steering and 3. Crankshaft bolt
4. Crankshaft pulley
2. Drive belt (Generator)
I
CRANKSHAFT BOLT
TSB Revision
ENGINE Camshaft and Camshaft Seal
8.9 Mm 28 Nm
8.9
4.5
3.3
101
75
12 9.8
7.1
TSB Revision
ENGINE Camshaft and
CAMSHAFT BEARING
Loosen the camshaft bearing cap attaching fasteners in
sequence shown in the figure (one at a time).
TSB Revision
ENGINE Camshaft and
EXHAUST CAMSHAFT
CAMSHAFT
Use the special tool to the camshaft turning, and
then install the intake camshaft, sprockets.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Oil Pan and Oil Screen
108 Nm
8.9
Removal steps
1. Drain plug
2. Gasket
3. Front plate
4. Oil pan
5. Oil pan gasket
6. Oil screen
7. O-ring
TSB Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft Front
.
CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post-installation Operatidn
l Timing Belt Removal and Installation
(Refer to
Removal steps
1. Crankshaft sprocket
2. Crankshaft front oil seal
TSB Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
INSTALLATION SERVICE
I CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
Use the special tool to align the oil seal witti the’
..
TSB
ENGINE Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Removal steps
1. Flywheel
2. Crankshaft rear oil seal
TSB Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft Rear Oil
TSB Revision
Cylinder Head
Removal steps
1. NC compressor connector
2. Power steering pressure switch connector
connector 6. MAP
3. Heated oxygen sensor connector
4. Engine coolant temperature gauge
unit connector
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head
4.9 Nm
10
Engine oil
15
TSB Revision
ENGINE Head Gasket
<Long
<Short bolts>
(20 20 20
23
l Intake and exhaust camshafts
(Refer to
23. Front exhaust pipe connection
24. Gasket
25. Cylinder head bolt
26. Cylinder head
27. Cylinder head gasket
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head Gasket
Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt .
TIMING BELT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Operation Post-installation Operation
l Pulley Removal l Crankshaft Pulley Installation (Refer to
(Refer to l Engine Adjustment
88 Nm
84
Nm
8.9
Removal steps
1. Power steering oil pump 5. Front timing belt cover
tion 6. Timing belt
2. Power steering oil pump bracket 7. Timing belt tensioner
3. Engine mount bracket assembly 8. Tensioner pulley
4. Engine mount bracket 9. pulley
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt
I BELT REMOVAL .
sprocket Align timing marks. Loosen the timing belt remove
timing belt.
Caution
Do not rotate the camshaft or crankshaft after removing
the timing belt, or valve components may be
Always align timing marks before removing timing ‘belt.
pulley
TSB Revision
ENGINE Belt
mount
bracket
TSB Revision
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Descriptions Specifications
In-line DOHC
Number of cylinders 4
Cylinder bore mm (in.) 87.5 (3.445)
Piston stroke mm (in.) 83.0 (3.267)
Compression ratio
Valve timing Intake valve Opens (BTDC) 1.3”
[Measured at 0.5
mm in.) lift] Closes (ABDC) 39.7”
Exhaust valve Opens (BBDC)
Closes (ATDC) 1.1
Lubrication system Pressure feed, full-flow filtration,
Water pump type Centrifugal impeller type
EGR type Single type
Injector type and number Electromagnetic, 4
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS ,
Standard value Limit
Ignition coil system
Spark plug cable 12000
Ignition coil Primary
Secondary
Camshaft and cam follower
Cam wear amount mm (in.) 0.0254 0.254
Camshaft bearing bore diameter mm (in.)
Exhaust
TSB Revision 1
. . . . .-- -----
ENGINE OVERHAUL ----
Exhaust
(4.314-4.334)
Valve stem tip height mm (in.) Intake 48.04 (1.891)
Exhaust 47.99 (1.889)
Valve stem diameter mm (in.) Intake 5.934-5.952 ,
Exhaust
Exhaust 0.101
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Specifications
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Items
Generator
Pivot
Lock nut 61
Ignition system
Spark plug 28 20
Camshaft position sensor 3
Timing belt
Crankshaft damper bolt 62 45
Engine mount bracket 41 30
Timing belt inspection cover
Tensioner pulley 28 20
Timing belt tensioner 31 22
Tensioner arm bracket 31 22
Camshaft sprocket 101 73
Rear timing belt cover 9.6
Cooling system components
Water pump
Thermostat housing 22 16
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
Items
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Fuel and emission control parts
EGR tube 11 8
EGR valve
Intake manifold
Intake manifold air temperature sensor 7
Manifold absolute pressure sensor 2 1 . 4
Intake manifold 23 1 7 :
Exhaust manifold
Exhaust manifold 23 17
Camshaft and cam follower
Cvlinder head cover
Bearing head cover No. 5 12
No. 1, 6 28 20
Cvlinder head and valve .
Cylinder head bolt Long bolt 87
Short bolt 28 20
Oil pan and oil pump
Oil filter 21 ,
Adapter
Oil 12
Oil pick-up tube 2 8
Oil pump 23
Oil pump
Relief valve retaining cap 54
Oil pump cover 12
Piston, connecting rod and cylinder block
Connecting rod cap bolt 27 20
Knock sensor 10 I
SEALANTS
Specified sealant
Engine coolant temperature sensor Loctite 24200 or equivalent
switch Loctite 24200 or equivalent
Camshaft bearing cap Loctite 51817 or equivalent
Oil pump Loctite 51817 or equivalent
Bed plate to oil pan gasket Loctite 18718 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch Loctite 24200 or equivalent
Bed plate to cylinder block Loctite 19614 or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
FORM-IN-PLACE GASKETS
There are numerous places where form-in-place gaskets are used on the engine. Care must be
when applying form-in-place gaskets to assure obtaining the desired results. size, continuity, ‘and
location are of great importance. Too thin a bead can result in leakage too much can result’ in
spill-over which can break off and obstruct fluid feed lines. A continuous bead of the proper width
essential to obtain a leak-free joint.
GASKET DISASSEMBLY
Parts assembled with form-in-place gaskets may be disassembled without unusual effort’
it may be necessary to lightly tap the part with a mallet or other suitable tool to break the seal between
the mating surfaces. A flat gasket scraper may also be lightly tapped into the joint but care be
taken not to damage the mating surfaces.
SURFACE PREPARATION
Scrape clean or wire brush all gasket surfaces removing all loose material. Inspect
assure gasket rails are flat. Flatten rails with a hammer on a flat plate if
must be free of oil and dirt. Make sure old gasket material is removed from blind
FORM-IN-PLACE GASKET APPLICATION
Assembling parts using a form-in-place gasket requires care but it’s easier than using precut gaskets.
Gasket material should be applied sparingly 1 mm inch.) diameter or less to one
surface, Be certain the material surrounds each mounting hole. Excess material can easily be
‘off. Components should be torqued in place within 15 minutes. The use of a locating dowel is recommended
during assembly, to prevent smearing the material off location.
Loctite 18718 gasket material or equivalent should be applied in a continuous bead 3
mm inch.) in diameter. All mounting holes must be circled. For corner sealing, 3.17 or 6.35
mm or inch.) drop is placed in the center of the gasket contact area. Uncured may
be removed with a shop towels. Components should be torqued in place while the sealant wet
to the touch (within 10 minutes). The usage of a locating dowel is recommended during assembly to
prevent smearing of material off location.
MOPAR TORQUE CURE GASKET MAKER
Mopar torque cure gasket maker is a unique anaerobic type gasket material to be used ONLY
the and engine block. The material cures in the absence of air when. two
metallic surfaces. It will not cure if left in the uncovered tube. This anaerobic material specially made
to seal the area between the and cylinder block without disturbing the bearing’ or
alignment of these components. . .
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Application
Removal
Removal and
crankshaft
damper/sprocket
8995057
damper/sprocket
9
Pin (2)
6793
1
Installer
crankshaft seal
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Special
crankshaft seal
6926-2
8995060
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Generator
GENERATOR
REMOVAL
(1) Remove drive belt.
(2) Remove generator.
(3) Remove generator
(4) Remove bracket.
INSTALLATION
(1) Install bracket.
(2) Install generator brace.
(3) Install generator.
(4) Install drive belt.
(5) Loosen the generator pivot nut.
(6) Loosen the lock nut.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
Ignition coil
SYSTEM 11301840018
fasteners
REMOVAL
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches to the cylinder head
cover.
(1) Disconnect electrical connector from coil pack.
(2) Remove coil pack mounting nuts.
(3) Remove coil.
cylinder
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Ignition
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
.
INSTALLATION
(1) Install crankshaft position sensor.
Target (2) The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into off-set
machined locating holes in end of the camshaft. install
target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting
screw to 3 Nm (2.2 torque.
(3) Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting
screws to 9 Nm (6.5 torque.
alignment
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Ignition
INSPECTION
SPARK PLUG CABLE
(1) must be between 3,000 to 12,000 ohms per
foot of cable. Replace any cable not within tolerance.
IGNITION COIL
(1) Measure the primary of each ‘At the coil,
connect an ohmmeter between the and the pin
corresponding to the in Resistance
on the primary side of 0.51
ohm. Replace the coil if resistance is
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
REMOVAL
Caution
Camshaft or crankshaft should not be rotate after timing
belt is removed. Damage to valve components may occur.
Always align timing marks before removing timlng belt.
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
camshaft seal.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing
INSTALLATION 11301870017
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
belt. Starting at the crankshaft, go around
the water pump sprocket, ‘idler pulley,
and then around the tensioner pulley.
crankshaft sprocket to up belt slack.
Install tensioner to block but do not tighten fasteners.
a torque wrench on the tensioner pulley, apply
28 Nm (20 of torque to tensioner.
TDC
Install belt in
‘this
here
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
engine mount
Tighten bolts to 41 Nm (30
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cooling System
REMOVAL
(1) Remove water pump attaching screws to engine.
Thermostat
Thermostat Gasket
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Cooling System
Pressure cap (3) Place a new gasket (dipped in clean water) on water
Overflow
nipple box surface, center thermostat in water gasket.
Place housing over gasket and thermostat; making sure
thermostat is in the thermostat housing. Bolt housing
to water box. Tighten bolts to 22 Nm
INSPECTION
Replace water pump body assembly if it has any of these
defects:
(1) Cracks or damage on the body.
(2) Coolant leaks from the shaft seal, evident by coolant
traces on the pump body.
(3) Loose or rough turning bearing.
(4) Impeller rubs either the pump body or the engine block.
(5) Impeller loose or damaged.
(6) Sprocket or sprocket flange loose or damaged.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Fuel and
REMOVAL
(1) Remove screws attaching EGR tube to intake manifold.
(8) Lift rail off of intake manifold. Cover the fuel injector
Retainer Fuel openings in the intake manifold.
(9) Remove fuel injector retainer.
injector out of fuel rail. Replace fuel injector O-rings.
ENGINE, OVERHAUL Fuel and Emission Control,,
INSTALLATION
(1) Apply a light coating of clean engine,, oil to the upper
O-ring.
(2) Install injector in cup on fuel
(3) Install retaining clip.
(4) Apply a light coating of clean engine oil to ‘the -O-ring
on the nozzle end of each
Insert fuel injector nozzle into openings in manifold.
Seat the injectors in place. rail
screws.
(6) Connect fuel supply tube to fuel rail.
(7) Install throttle body and new gasket on intake manifold.
Tighten mounting bolts.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Manifold
INTAKE MANIFOLD
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Exhaust
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
REMOVAL
(1) Remove oil level gauge.
(2) Remove exhaust manifold. heat shield,
(3) Remove 8 exhaust manifold retaining and
move exhaust manifold.
TSB Revision
OVERHAUL Camshaft and Cam
REMOVAL
(1) Remove the cylinder head cover fasteners.
(2) Remove cylinder head cover from cylinder head.
, ,
askets
,
(5) Identify the before removing
The cams are not
(6) Remove cam follower assemblies cylinder head.
Keep the cam followers in the order they have been
removed from the head for
(7) Mark hydraulic lash adjusters for reassembly in their
positions.
Lash adjusters are serviced as an assembly.
CLEANING
Before installation, clean cylinder head and cover mating sur-
faces. Make certain the rails are flat.
.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Camshaft Cam
INSTALLATION
(1) Install hydraulic lash adjuster making. that
adjusters are at least of is
by little or no plunger travel the lash adjuster is
depressed. . .
(2) Lubricate with clean oil and install cam follower assemblies
in their original position on the hydraulic adjuster and
valve stem.
Caution
Piston should NOT be at top dead center when
ling the camshaft.
(3) Lubricate bearing journals and cams with clean oil and
install the camshafts. Install right and left camshaft bearing
caps No. 2 thru No. 5 and right Tighten fasteners
to 12 Nm (9 in sequence shown in the figure.
I
TSB Revision I
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Camshaft and Cam Follower
INSPECTION
CAMSHAFT
(1) Inspect camshaft bearing journals for damage and bind-
ing.
If journals are binding, also check the cylinder head bear-
ing surface for damage, and check the camshaft bearing
oil feed holes in the cylinder head for clogging.
(2) Check the cam surface for abnormal wear and damage.
Replace if defective. Also measure the cam height and
replace if out of limit.
Standard value: 0.0254 mm in.)
Limit: 0.254 mm in.)
To measure cam lobe lobe in
two places at the largest diameter Take
first reading with micrometer area ‘at edge
of the lobe. Take second reading in where
cam follower contacts the
from the first. The is ‘wear.
CAM
(1) Inspect the cam follower assembly for wear damage.
adjuster Replace as necessary.
ket
Roller
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
CYLINDER A N D
REMOVAL
(1) Remove cylinder head bolts.
CLEANING
CYLINDER HEAD
Caution
Be careful not to gouge or scratch the aluminum head
sealing surface.
(1) Remove all gasket material from cylinder head and block.
VALVE ASSEMBLY ,
(1) Clean all valve guides, valves and valve assemblies
thoroughly with suitable reassem-
bling. ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder and Valve
INSTALLATION
(1) Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and
in cylinder head:
(2) If valves or seats have been reground,! valve tip
Valve retaining locks height (A).
Make sure of measurements from cylinder head
to the top of valve stem.
(3) Install valve seal/spring seat assembly over valve guides
on all valve stems. Ensure garter intact
around the top of the rubber seal. Install valve springs,
valve retainers.
Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder
INSPECTION 11390790119
CYLINDER HEAD
(1) Check the cylinder head gasket surface for flatness by
using a straightedge and feeler gauge.
Limit: 0.1 mm in.)
VALVE
(1) Clean valves thoroughly and discard burned, warped and
cracked valves.
(2) Measure valve stems for wear.
(3) If valve stems are worn more than 0.05 mm in.),
replace valve.
Standard value:
Intake mm in.)
Exhaust mm
VALVE GUIDES
(1) Remove carbon and varnish deposits from inside of valve
guides with a reliable guide cleaner.
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Head and
Intake valve
Standard value:
Angle
Intake and Exhaust
Head Diameter
Intake 34.67-34.93 mm in.)
Exhaust mm
Revision
(Overall)
Intake 111.49-111.99 mm (4.389-4.499 in.)
Exhaust mm in.)
Stem Diameter
Intake 5.934-5.952 mm in.)
Exhaust mm in.)
Valve Margin
Intake 1.285-1.615 mm in.)
Exhaust mm in.)
Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head
Revision I
ENGINE OVERHAUL Oil Pan ,
REMOVAL
(1) Remove flywheel or drive plate:
(2) Remove rear plate.
‘Remove oil filter.
(4) Remove adapter.
..
Caution
Do not nick shaft seal surface or seal
Special tool
oil pump.
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Oil Pan and Oil’
(4) Place seal into opening with seal spring toward the inside
engine. Install seal until flush with cover.
(5) Install crankshaft sprocket using
bolt, washer and thrust bearing, from Special ‘Tool Kii
and Tool
,
.
0057
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Oil ‘Pan and Oil Pump
Locating
(lO)Ensure O-ring is in the groove on adapter. Align roll
pin into engine block and tighten assembly to 55 Nm
I (40
adapter
Caution
When servicing the oil filter avoid deforming the filter
can by installing the remove/install tool band strap
against the can-to-base lockseam. The join-
ing the can to the base is reinforced by the base
plate.
Locate wrench
at base of filter
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Oil Pump
Gasket
PUMP
DISASSEMBLY
Sprin (1) To remove the relief valve,’ proceed as
(a) Remove the threaded and gasket from the oil
Caution
Install oil pump pressure relief valve as shown
in the figure, or serious damage may occur.
(b) Remove spring and relief valve.
Remove oil pump cover screws, and lift off cover.
Oil pump body Remove pump rotors.
Outer
REASSEMBLY
(1) Assemble pump, using new parts as required.
Install the inner rotor with chamfer. cast,
oil pump cover.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
INSPECTION
(1) Wash all parts in a suitable solvent and
for damage or wear.
(2) Mating surface of the oil pump should be smooth. Replace
pump cover if scratched or
(6) Slide outer rotor into pump housing, press to one side
with fingers and measure clearance between rotor and
housing. If measurement exceeds the limit, replace hous-
ing only if outer rotor is in specification.
Limit: 0.39 mm in.)
1 ENGINE -‘Oil
Outer 0
rotor
TSB Revision
Piston,
ENGINE and Cylinder
Rear
crankshaft seal
Engine block PISTON, CONNECTING ROD
metal case Engine crankshaft seal CYLINDER BLOCK
REMOVAL
(1) insert a flat ‘screwdriver between the dust
lip and the metal case of the seal.
Angle the screwdriver through the dust lip metal
case of the seal. Pry out seal.
crankshaft seal Caution
dust lip
Do not permit the blade contact
crankshaft seal surface. Contact of the screwdriver
blade crankshaft edge (chamfer) is permitted.
(2) Remove top ridge of cylinder bores with a reliable ridge
reamer before removing pistons from cylinder block.
Be sure to keep tops of pistons covered during this opera-
tion. Mark piston with matching cylinder number.
TSB Revision
Piston, Rod
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL and
DISASSEMBLY
(1) Separate piston from rod by removing piston
pin.
(2) a suitable ring expander,, remove and inter-
mediate piston rings.
(3) Remove the upper oil ring side rail, lower oil ring side
rail and then oil ring expander from piston.
(4) ring grooves of any carbon deposits.
TSB Revision
Rod
ENGINE and Cylinder
REASSEMBLY
(1) Install rings with manufacturer’s mark facing up, to-
ward the top of the piston.
Caution
Install piston rings in the following order:
(a) Oil ring expander.
(b) Upper oil ring side rail.
(c) Lower oil ring side rail.
I (d) No. 2 intermediate piston ring.
(e) No. 1 upper piston ring.
(2) Install the side rail by placing one end between the piston
ring groove and the expander. Hold end firmly and press
down the portion to be installed until side rail is in position.
Do not use a piston ring expander.
(3) Install upper side rail first and then the lower side rail.
(4) Install No. 2 piston ring and then No. 1 piston ring.
Front of engine
TSB Revision
Piston,
ENGINE OVERHAUL and Cylinder
TSB Revision
piston,
ENGINE
Front of engine
(3) Immerse the piston head and rings in clean engine oil,
slide the ring compressor, over the piston. Be sure that
position of rings does not change during this operation.
(4) The arrow should face toward the front of the engine.
Install the pistons.
TSB Revision
Piston, Connecting
ENGINE OVERHAUL and
TSB Revision
Rod
and
(8) Install each bolt finger tight then alternately torque each
nut to. assemble the cap properly.
(9) Tighten the bolts to 27.0 Nm PLUS turn (20
PLUS turn). Do not use a torque wrench for last
step.
Caution
If burr’or scratch is present on the edge
(chamfer), cleanup with 400 grit paper to prevent
seal damage during’ new’
NOTE
When installing seal, no lube on seal is needed.
(11) Place Special Tool on crankshaft. This is a
pilot tool with a magnetic base.
seal over pilot tool. Make sure you can read
Oil seal the words THIS SIDE OUT on seal. Pilot tool should
remain on crankshaft during of seal.
the seal into the block using Special Tool
and handle until the tool bottoms out against
95059
the block.
seal Caution
If the seal is driven into the past flush,
may cause an oil leak.
8995060
I
Piston, Connecting Rod
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL and
INSPECTION
BLOCK
(1) Clean cylinder block thoroughly and check all core hole
plugs for evidence of leaking.
(2) Examine block and cylinder bores for cracks or fractures.
CYLINDER BORE
(1) The cylinder walls should be checked for out-of-round
and taper with Tool or equivalent cylinder
bore out-of-round is 0.051 mm in.) maximum, and
Front cylinder bore taper is 0.051 mm in.)
If the cylinder walls are badly scuffed or’scored, the cylin-
A der block should be rebored and pistons
and rings fitted. Whatever type is
used, boring and honing should be closely
with the fitting of pistons and rings so that specified clear-
ances may be maintained.
(2) the cylinder bore at three levels in directions
A and B. Top measurement should be 10 mm in.)
down and bottom measurement should mm
in.) up from bottom of bore.
Standard value: 87.5 mm (3.445 in.)
PISTONS
(1) Piston and cylinder wall must be clean and dry. Piston
diameter should be measured 90 degrees to piston pin
at size location shown in the figure. Cylinder bores should
be measured halfway down the cylinder bore and trans-
verse to the engine crankshaft center Correct piston
to bore clearance must be established in order to assure
quiet and economical operation.
Standard value: mm 7 in.)
(2) Pistons and cylinder bores should be measured at normal
room temperature, 21
TSB Revision
Piston,
ENGINE
PISTON RING
(1) Wipe cylinder bore clean. Insert ring and push down
with piston to ensure it is square in bore. The ring gap
measurement must be made with the ring positioning
at least 12 mm in.) from bottom of bore.
Check gap with feeler gauge.
Standard value:
Upper ring mm
Intermediate ring mm in.)
Oil ring mm
Limit:
Upper ring 0.8 mm in.)
Intermediate ring 1.0 mm in.)
Oil control ring 1.0 mm in.)
TSB Revision
piston,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Block
CONNECTING BEARING
(1) Place a piece of Plastigage across the, width of
bearing in the cap 6.35
mm off center and away -from the hole.
suspect areas can be checked, by placing in
the suspect area.
(2) Before assembling the rod with in place;
‘the crankshaft must be rotated the connecting rod
being checked starts moving toward the top of the engine.,
Only then should the cap be and torqued
to the specification.
Do not rotate the crankshaft while assembling the cap
or the Plastigage may be smeared, giving inaccurate re-
sults.
(3) Remove the bearing cap and compare the width of the
flattened Plastigage with the metric scale provided on
the package.
Standard value: mm in.)
Limit: 0.075 mm in.)
TSB Revision I
OVERHAUL
CRANKSHAFT
REMOVAL
Procedures after removing crankshaft sprocket, oil pan, pis-
tons and connecting rods.
(1) Using Tool remove front crankshaft oil seal.
Be careful not to damage the seal surface of cover.
(2) out rear seal with screwdriver. Be careful not to nick
or damage crankshaft flange seal surface or retainer bore.
Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft
INSTALLATION
(1) Install oil level gauge (dipstick).
(2) Install oil pressure switch.
,
,
NOTE
Upper and lower No. 3 bearing halves are flanged to
carry the crankshaft thrust loads and are NOT interchange-
able with any other bearing halves in the engine. Bearing
shells are available in standard and the following under-
sized:
0.016 mm, 0.032 mm, 0.250 mm.
Never install an undersize bearing that will reduce clear-
ance below specifications.
(5) Install the main bearing shells with the lubrication groove
in the cylinder block.
Oil holes
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
NOTE
All upper bearing in the crankcase have oil grooves.
All lower bearing shells installed in the (bedplate) main
bearing caps are plain. Crankshaft end play is controlled
by a flanged bearing on the number three main bearing
journal.
(6) Make certain oil holes in block line up with oil hole in
bearings and bearing tabs seat in the tab slots.
(7) Oil the bearings and, journals and install crankshaft.
Caution
Do get oil on
If may effect the sealer ability the
to cylinder block.
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE .
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
new front seal into opening with seal spring towards
the inside of engine. seal by using Tool
until flush with oil pump cover.
Caution
if burr or scratch is present on the crankshaft edge
(chamfer), with 400 grit sand paper to prevent
seal damage during of new seal.
NOTE
When installing seal, no lube on seal is needed.
Tool on crankshaft. This is a
pilot tool with a magnetic base.
seal over pilot tool. Make sure you can read
Oil seal the words THIS SIDE OUT on seal. Pilot tool should
remain on crankshaft during installation of seal.
the seal into the block using Special Tool
95059 and handle until the tool bottoms out against
the block.
seal Caution
If the seal is driven into the block past flush, this
may cause an oil leak.
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE ..
INSPECTION
CRANKSHAFT MAIN JOURNALS
The crankshaft journals should be checked for excessive
wear, taper and scoring. Limits of taper or
on any crankshaft journals should be held. to mm.
in.). Journal grinding should not exceed 0.305 mm
in.) under the standard Do NOT
grind thrust faces of 3 journal. Do NOT
nick crank pin or journal fillets. After grinding, remove
rough edges from crankshaft oil holes and clean out all
passages. ,
Caution .
With the nodular cast iron
tant that the final paper or journal
regrind be in the same direction as normal rotation’
in the engine.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
BEARING CLEARANCE
(1) The. total: clearance of the main bearings can only be
determined by removing the weight of the crankshaft.
This is accomplished by having the engine turned upside
down on the engine stand. This will remove all the crank-
weight off the bearing surface.
(2) Place, a piece of Plastigage across the entire width of
the bearing shell in the approximately 6.35 mm
in.) off center and away from the oil holes. In addition,
suspect areas can be checked by placing the Plastigage
in the suspect area.
Torque the bolts of the bearing being checked
to the proper specifications.
Caution
Do not rotate crankshaft, or the Plastigage may be
smeared.
(3) Remove the and compare the width of the flat-
tened Plastigage with the metric scale provided on the
package.
Standard value: mm in.)
Revision
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
Specifications
Number of cylinders 4
Bore
Stroke 1
Piston displacement
Firing order
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
Rocker arm
Oil filter
Oil
pressure , Camshaft
screen
TSB Revision
ENGINE Service
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Limit
Drive belt Tension (Ibs.) When checked ,
(For When a new belt is installed 490 686 (110.2 154.3)
tor) When a used belt is installed
Deflection Whenchecked
mm (in.) When a new belt is installed 7.5 9.0
When a used belt is installed 10.0
value>
Drive belt Tension (Ibs.)
When checked 245 490 (55.1 110.2)
(For power When a new belt is installed 154.3)
steering When a used belt is installed 343 441 (77.2 99.2)
Deflection Whenchecked 5.5 8.0
mm (in.) When a new belt is installed 4.5
When a used belt is installed 6.0
Drive belt Tension (Ibs.) When checked 255 333 (57.3 75.0)
A/C When a new belt is installed 382 441 (86.0 99.2)
When a used belt is installed 255 333 (57.3 75.0)
Deflection Whenchecked 6.5 7.5
mm (in.) When a new belt is installed 5.5 6.0
When a used belt is installed 6.5 7.5
ignition timing at idle 3”
ignition timing at idle Approx. BTDC
idle speed
contents 0.5 or less
contents ppm 100 or less
pressure (at 250 400 (psi) 1,350 (192) ,020 (145)
pressure difference of all cylinder (psi) 100 (14)
ntake manifold vacuum (in. Hg) min. 60 (18)
head bolt length mm (in.) 99.4 (3.91)
tensioner push rod movement mm (in.) Within 1
belt tension torque Nm 3.5 (2.6)
tensioner rod protrusion mm (in.) 3.8-4.5
belt tension mm (in.) 5 7
S E A L A N T S
Items Specified sealant
Oil pan, cylinder block and thermostat case assembly MITSUBISHI GENUINE PART or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE Special Tools , ,
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Supersession Application
502 Idle
tool
(MUT-II)
ROM pack
8991325
TSB Revision I
Tools
Handle
I
General service tool Crankshaft sprocket removal
Crankshaft sprocket
TSB Revision
ENGINE Troubleshooting .
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Valve seat worn or damaged Repair or replace valve and/or seat ring
Oil pressure drop Engine oil level too low Check engine oil level
Oil pressure too high Oil relief valve stuck (closed) Repair relief valve
Noisy valves Incorrect lash adjuster Bleed air or replace lash adjuster
Thin or diluted engine oil (low oil pressure) Change engine oil
Valve stem or valve guide worn or damaged Replace valve and/or guide
Connecting rod noise/ Insufficient oil supply Check engine oil level
main bearing noise
Low oil pressure Refer to “Oil pressure drop”
,
Thin or diluted engine oil Change engine oil
Timing belt noise Incorrect belt tension Adjust belt tension replace tim-
ing belt
Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
Generator
pulley
Tension 392
(88.2)
Deflection 10.0
mm
<Reference
value>
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
Deflection
mm (in.)
Use the belt tension gauge to check belt tension at the shown
point (a) or (b), or check deflection by applying 98 (22
Ibs.) to the shown point.
Cranksh Standard value:
pulley
Tension: 255 333 (57.3 75.0 Ibs.)
Deflection: 6.5 7.5 mm
TSB Revision
On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
TSB Revision
On-vehicle
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
5. Cover the spark plug hole with a shop towel etc., and
after the engine has been cranked, check that no foreign
material is adhering to the shop towel.
Caution
1. Keep away from the spark plug hole when crank-
ing.
2. If compression is measured with water, fuel,
etc., that has come from cracks inside the
these materials will become heated and gush
out from the spark plug hole, which is dangerous.
Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle Service’
If the air which has mixed in the oil due to the above
causes enters the high-pressure chamber in the lash
adjusters, the air in the high-pressure chamber will be
pressurized during opening of the valve, which causes
High
pressure the lash adjusters to shrink excessively, and an abnormal
chamber noise will be generated when the valve is closed. This
is the same phenomenon as the one when the valve
clearance has been excessively adjusted by mistake. In
this case, if the air which has entered the lash adjusters
is bled, things will be normalized.
TSB Revision
ENGINE On-vehicle
NOTE
l If the vehicle is parked on a slope for long, oil
in the lash adjusters will and ‘air may
enter the high-pressure’ chamber when the vehicle
is started.
l After the vehicle is parked for long, air may enter
the high-pressure because, the oil in the
oil passage will be gone it take a time before
the oil is supplied to the
TSB Revision
Engine Assembly 11
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pm-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
l Fuel Line Pressure Releasing l Radiator Installation
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) (Refer to GROUP 14 Radiator.)
l Hood Removal l Transaxle Assembly Installation
l Engine Coolant Draining Refer to GROUP Transaxle Assembly.)
(Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Refer to GROUP -Transaxle Assembly.)
l Transaxle Assembly Removal l Engine Coolant Supplying
Refer to GROUP Assembly.) (Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.)
Refer to GROUP Transaxle Assembly.) l Hood Installation
l Radiator Removal (Refer to GROUP 14 -Radiator.) l Accelerator Cable Adjustment
l Under Cover Removal (Refer to GROUP 17 On-vehicle Service.)
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
l Drive Belt Tension Adjustment
<Power Steering,
6 28 Nm
21
22 Nm
16
28 Nm
21 Nm
Removal steps
1. Power steering pressure switch 5. Generator
connector (Refer GROUP 16 Generator.)
2. Generator connectors 6. Power pump Connection
3. Oil pressure switch connector 7. A/C compressor connection
4. Oil pressure gauge unit connector
TSB Revision
.
4.9 Nm
\ / X L - - 3.6
. .
TSB Revision
Engine
67 Nm
49
Nm
28
ENGINE A SS EM B LY
REMOVAL ,
(1) Support the a garage
(2) Remove the special tool which was attached when the
transaxle assembly removed.
(3) Hold the engine with a chain block or similar
(4) Place a garage jack against the engine oil pan with a
piece of wood in, between, jack up the engine so that
the weight of is no longer being applied to
the engine mount bracket assembly, and then remove
the engine mount bracket assembly.
ENGINE ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
After checking that all cables, hoses and harness connectors,
etc., are disconnected from the engine, lift the chain block
slowly to remove the engine assembly upward from the engine
compartment.
,
TSB
Engine Assembly
INSTALLATION
ENGINE INSTALLATION
Install the engine while checking
hoses, and harness connectors are not clamped.
MOUNT BRACKET ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
(1) Place a garage jack against the engine oil pan a
piece of wood in between, and install the engine mount
bracket assembly while adjusting the position of the en-
gine.
(2) Support the engine with the garage jack.
(3) Remove the chain block and support the engine assembly
with the special tool.
Engine side Engine (4) Align the notches on the stopper with the engine mount
bracket with the arrow facing toward the shown
direction. Then install the stopper.
Arro
Engine
mount
bracket
assembly
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE Crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal’ Operation
l Under Cover Removal
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
Removal steps
1. Drive belt (Generator)
2. Drive belt (Power steering)
3. Drive belt (NC)
4. Crankshaft pulley
TSB Revision
and Camshaft Seal
22
16
2.9
00005324
7-9
,
Sealant: 01
MITSUBISHI GENUINE PART
or equivalent Engine oil
Removal steps
1. . Accelerator
. . . . . cable connection 9. Timing belt upper cover
2. Air Intake nose 10. Camshaft
3. Connection for breather hose 11. Camshaft oil seal
4. Connection for PCV hose 12. and shaft
5. Spark plug cable side)
6. Rocker cover Rocker and
7. Camshaft position sensor support (Exhaust ‘side)
8. Camshaft position sensing cylinder 14. Camshaft
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE and Camshaft Oil ‘Seat
REMOVAL SERVICE
SPROCKET ,
(1) Rotate the crankshaft (right) direction and
align the timing marks. cylinder the compression
stroke top dead center position.)
Caution
The crankshaft must always be rotated in the forward
sprocket direction only.
(2) Tie the camshaft sprocket and timing belt with a cord
so that the position of the camshaft sprocket will not move
with respect to the timing belt.
Camshaft
sprocket
,
INSTALLATION SERVICE
ARM AND SHAFT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
(1) Temporarily tighten the rocker shaft with the bolt so that
all rocker arms on the inlet valve ‘bide do not push the
valves.
(2) Fit the rocker shaft spring from the and position
it so that it is right angles to the guide.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Camshaft
INSTALLATION
Revision
11 ENGINE Pan and Oil Screen
Specified sealant:
MITSUBISHI PART
or equivalent
7
39 Nm
29
2 00000245
Removal steps
1. Bell housing cover
2. Drain plug
3. G a s k e t
4. Oil p a n
5. Oil screen
TSB Revision
ENGINE Oil Pan and Oil
GASKET INSTALLATION
Replace the gasket and install, it in the in
the illustration.
Oil pan side
Drain
gasket
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Engine oil
00003917
Removal steps
1. Crankshaft sprocket
front oil seal
TSB Revision
ENGINE Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
127-137 Nm
-101
Crankshaft
Specified sealant:
Stud locking 4170 or equiv-
Engine oil alent
Removal steps
Revision
INSTALLATION SERVICE POINTS
CRANKSHAFT REAR OIL SEAL INSTALLATION
(1) Apply a small amount of engine oil to the entire inside
diameter of the oil seal lip.
(2) Tap in the oil seal as shown in the illustration.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cvlinder Head
21
Removal steps
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head Gasket
30 78
3.4
2.5 24 Nm
18
Nm
7-9
00004208
32
34
25
Specified
PART
25.
26.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head
(2) Tie the camshaft sprocket and timing belt with a cord
so that the position of the camshaft sprocket not
with respect to the timing belt.
Camshaft
sprocket
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head Gasket
Exhaust side
INSTALLATION SERVICE
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET INSTALLATION
(1) Wipe off all oil and grease from the gasket mounting
surface.
(2) the gasket to the cylinder block with the identification
mark facing upwards.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Cylinder Head Gasket
Caution
Do not let engine oil or other greases contact with the
-ring
O-ring.
I I (2) Align the mating marks on the radiator hose and hose
clamp, and then connect the radiator hose.
FUEL
When connecting the high-pressure fuel hose to the fuel rail,
apply a small amount of clean engine oil to the hose union’
and then insert, being careful not to damage the O-ring.
Caution
Do not let engine oil get into the fuel rail.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt
8.8
25
7.2-8.7
Removal steps
l Drive
8. Timing belt front upper cover
9. T i m i n g b e l t f r o n t l o w e r
l liming
TSB Revision
ENGINE
marks
TIMING BELT, REMOVAL
(1) Turn the crankshaft in the forward direction (to the
to align the camshaft sprocket timing marks.
Caution
Always turn the crankshaft in the
only.
(4) Once the holes are aligned, insert the set pin.
NOTE
When replacing the auto tensioner with part, the
pin will be in the auto tensioner.
(5) Install the auto tensioner to the
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing Belt
BELT INSTALLATION
Timing marks
(1) Align the timing marks on the camshaft sprocket; crank-
shaft sprocket and oil pump sprocket.
,
. . .
sprocket
mm (2) After aligning the timing mark on the oil pump sprocket,’
(2.36 in.) remove the cylinder block plug and insert a Phillips screw-
or more .
driver with a diameter of 8 mm in.), and check
be sure that the screwdriver goes mm (2.36 in.)
or more. If the screwdriver will only go in 20 25 mm
in,) before striking the counterbalance shaft,
turn the sprocket once, realign the timing mark and check
that the screwdriver goes in 60 mm (2.36 in.) or more.
Do not take out the screwdriver until the timing ‘belt is
installed.
(5) Screw the tool into the engine left support until
its end makes contact with the tensioner At that
point, screw the tool in and then remove
the set wire attached to the tensioner.
(6) Remove the tool.
(7) Tighten the center bolt to the specified torque.
Specified torque: 48 (35
TSB Revision
ENGINE Belt
48
BELT TENSION ADJUSTMENT
(1) After turning the crankshaft of a revolution counter-
clockwise, turn it clockwise until the timing marks are
aligned.
(2) Loosen the tension pulley fixing bolt, and then use the
special tool and a torque wrench to the fixing
bolt to the specified torque while applying tension to the
timing belt. ,
Standard value:
3.5 Nm (2.6
belt tension torque> ,
Caution
When tightening the fixing bolt, do not let the tension
pulley turn with the bolt.
A Flange bolt
(7.2-8.7)
Washer
assembled bolt
8 50 Flange bolt
1.97)
1.10)
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing belt
Nm
Removal steps
2 .
REMOVAL SERVICE
SPROCKET
(1) Use the special tool to remove bolt.
.,
TSB Revision
ENGINE Timing
Crankshaft
sprocket
Crankshaft
blade I
Revision
ENGINE
OVERHAUL.
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
TIMING BELT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
GENERATOR AND IGNITION SYSTEM . . 11
ENGINE OVERHAUL General Information
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
TSB Revision
OVERHAUL Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Timing belt
.
Rocker arms and camshaft
36.97 (1.4555)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
Cylinder block
REWORK DIMENSIONS
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
I‘
TSB Revision
__
3 1 ’
Fuel and emission parts
Intake manifold .
13 9
31
10
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
.
Cylinder head and valves
14.5
14
case
1
,
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
SEALANTS
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Special Tools,
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Tools
bolt
6991654
TSB Revision
ENGINE Generator and Ignition System
25 Nm ...
18
q
23 Nm
17
5
14 Nm
10
10
22 Nm
18
5 Nm
3.8
24 Nm
17
11 Nm
Removal steps
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Generator and
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing Belt
45
33 I
45 Nm
33
I
14 Nm 9 Nm
10 7
8 55 Nm
24’ Nm 40
17 35
25 120 Nm
Removal steps
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing Belt , ,
BELT “B”
(1) Make a mark on the back of the timing belt indicating
the direction of rotation so it may be reassembled in the
same direction if it is to be reused.
NOTE
(1) Water or oil on the belt shortens life drastically,
so the removed timing belt, sprocket, and tensioner
must be free from oil and should
not be washed. Replace parts if seriously contami-
nated.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing Belt
TSB Revision I
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing,
SPACER INSTALLATION
Spacer
Install the spacer with the chamfered end oil seal.
SPROCKET
INSTALLATION , .
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing Belt
AUTO TENSIONER .
(1) If the auto tensioner rod is ‘in its fully extended
reset it as follows.
(2) Clamp the auto-tensioner in vise with, soft ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
(3) Push in the rod little by little with the until the set
hole A in the rod is the hole in cylinder.
(4) a wire mm’ in.) the set
holes.
Unclamp the auto tensioner vise.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Belt
(4) Align the timing mark on oil pump sprocket with its mating
mark.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL .
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Timing
INSPECTION
TIMING BELT
Replace belt if any of the following exist.
(1) Hardening of back
Back side is glossy without resilience, and leaves no indent
when pressed fingernail.:’
Abnormal wear
(Fluffy strand)
AUTO TENSIONER
(1) Check the auto tensioner for possible leaks and replace
in.) as necessary.
(2) Check the rod end for wear or damage and replace as
necessary.
(3) Measure the rod protrusion. If it is out of specification,
replace the auto tensioner.
Standard value: 12 mm in.)
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE
TSB Revision
Fuel and Emission Parts
Removal steps
TSB Revision I
, . .
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Fuel and ..
INJECTORS
(1) Before installing an injector, the rubber O-ring must be
lubricated with a drop of clean engine oil to aid in installa-
tion.
(2) Install injector top end into fuel rail. Be careful not to
damage O-ring during installation.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Intake Manifold
13
30 24
IA I
18 Nm
13
13
10
31 Nm
22
Removal steps
7.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL intake Manifold
INSTALLATION SERVICE ,
SEALANT TO
HOUSING
Specified sealant:
Mitsubishi Genuine Part No. or equivalent
NOTE
(1) Be sure to install the housing quickly while sealant
is wet (within 15 minutes).
sealant (2) After installation, keep the sealed area away from the
oil and coolant for approx. one hour.
SEALANT APPLICATION TO WATER
FITTING
Specified sealant:
Mitsubishi Genuine Part No.’ or equivalent
NOTE
(1) Be sure to install the housing quickly while the sealant
is wet (within 15 minutes).
(2) After installation, keep the sealed area away from the
3 mm
oil and coolant for approx. one hour.
bead sealant
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Exhaust Manifold
30
22 14
14
10
28
Removal steps
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Exhaust Manifold and.
WATER ,
(1) Wet the O-ring (with
Caution
Keep the O-ring free of oil or grease.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker Arms
3.3 2
2.4
Removal steps
2.
4.
6.
7.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker Arms and Camshaft
REMOVAL SERVICE
ARMS AND ARM
REMOVAL .
Before removing rocker arms and shafts assembly, install
the special tool as illustrated to prevent adjuster from dropping.
ARMS AND
ROCKER ARM SHAFT
(1) Temporarily tighten the rocker the bolt so that
all rocker arms on the inlet valve side do not push the
valves.
(2) Fit the rocker shaft spring from the above and position
it so that it is right angles to the plug
NOTE
Install the rocker shaft spring before installing the exhaust
side rocker arms and ‘rocker arm shaft.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker Arms
CAMSHAFT OIL .
. .
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker Arms Camshaft
INSPECTION .
CAMSHAFT
(1) Measure the cam height.
Standard
Intake 37.39 mm (1.4720
Exhaust 37.47 mm (1.4752
Limit:
Intake 36.69 mm (1.4524 in.)
Exhaust 36.97 mm (1.4655 in.)
NOTE
The camshaft identification mark is stamped on the
opposite end of the camshaft sprocket side.
ROCKER ARM
(1) Check the roller surface. If any dents, damage or seizure
is evident, replace the rocker arm.
(2) Check rotation of the roller. If it does not rotate smoothly
or if looseness is evident, replace the rocker arm.
(3) Check the inside diameter. If damage or seizure is evident,
replace the rocker arm.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Rocker and Camshaft
Caution
Upon completion of air bleeding’
upright to prevent inside’ diesel
(4) After air bleeding, set lash adjuster on the special tool
(Leak down tester).
(5) After plunger has gone down somewhat mm),
measure time taken for it to go down 1. Replace
if measured time is out of
Standard value: seconds 1 mm in.)
[Diesel fuel at
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head
10
2 -
Removal steps
1. Cylinder head bolt ii. Exhaust valve
2. Cylinder head assembly 12. Valve stem seal
3. Cylinder head gasket 13. Valve spring seat
4. Retainer lock 14. Valve stem Seal
5. Valve spring retainer 15. Valve spring seat
6. Valve spring 16. Intake valve guide
7. Intake valve 17. Exhaust valve guide
8. Retainer lock 18. Intake valve seat
9. Valve spring retainer 19. Exhaust valve seat
10. Valve spring 20. Cylinder head
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and Valves
REMOVAL SERVICE
PRECAUTION FOR PARTS
Keep removed parts in order according to cylinder
and intake/exhaust.
CYLINDER HEAD BOLTS
Using the special tool, loosen head bolts. Loosen
evenly, little by little.
LOCK REMOVAL
Store removed valves, springs and other parts, tagged to
indicate their cylinder No. and location for reassembly.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head . .
HEAD INSTALLATION
(1) When installing the cylinder head bolts, check that the’
shank length of each bolt meets the limit. If the is’
exceeded, replace the bolt.
Limit: Max. 99.4 mm (3.91 in.)
(2) Apply engine oil to the threaded of bolts
to the washers.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and
INSPECTION
CYLINDER HEAD
(1) Check the cylinder head gasket surface for flatness by
using a straightedge and thickness gauge.
Standard value: 0.05 mm in.)
Limit: 0.2 mm in.)
(2) If the service limit is exceeded, correct to meet specifica-
tion.
Grinding limit: l 0.2 mm in.)
Includes combined with cylinder block grinding.
Cylinder head height (Specification when, new):
mm in.)
VALVE
(1) Check the valve face for correct contact. If incorrect, reface
using valve Valve seat contact be main-
tained uniform at the center of valve face.
Valve seat (2) If the margin exceeds the service limit, valve.
contact Standard value:
Intake 1.0 mm (0.39 in.)
Exhaust 1.2 mm
I
Limit:
Intake 0.5 mm in.)
Exhaust 0.7 mm in.)
(3) Measure the valve’s total length. If the measurement is
less than specified, replace the valve.
VALVE SPRING
(1) Measure the free height of spring and, if it is smaller
than the limit, replace.
Standard value: 51.0 mm (2.008
Free Limit: 50.0 mm (1.969 in.) ,
height
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and
VALVE GUIDE
(1) Measure the clearance between the valve guide and valve
stem. If the limit is exceeded, replace the valve guide
or valve, or both.
Standard value:
Intake mm in.)
Exhaust mm in.)
Limit:
Intake 0.10 mm in.)
Stem O.D. Exhaust 0.15 mm in.)
mm
in.)
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Cylinder Head and Valves
(3) Before fitting the valve seat, either heat the cylinder head
up to approximately or cool the valve seat
in liquid nitrogen, to prevent the cylinder head bore from
galling.
(4) Using a valve seat cutter, correct the valve seat to the
specified width and angle.
See SEAT RECONDITIONING PROCEDURE”.
NOTE
Do not install a valve guide of the same size
(3) Using the special tool, press-fit the guide, working
from the cylinder head top surface.
(4) After installing valve guides, insert new valves in them
to check for sliding condition.
(5) When valve guides have been, replaced, check for valve
contact and correct valve seats as
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
q 27
during reassembly. I
q 24
24
17
23
10
7
16
I I
lb
7
I
19
14
24
. . 17
19
14
7
5
Removal steps
1. Oil filter 17. Oil pump cover
2. Drain plug 18. Oil pump driven gear
3. Drain plug gasket 19. Oil drive gear
4. Oil pan 20. Crankshaft front oil seal
5. Oil screen 21. Oil pump oil seal
6. Oil screen gasket 22. Counterbalance shaft oil seal
7. P l u g 23. Front case
8. O-ring 24. Front case gasket
9. Flange bolt 25. Counterbalance shaft, left
10. Oil pressure switch 26. Counterbalance shaft, right
11. Relief plug 27. Counterbalance shaft, front bearing
12. Gasket 28. shaft, rear
13. Relief spring
14. Relief plunger 29. shaft, rear bearing,
15. Oil filter bracket
16. Oil filter bracket gasket
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE Shaft
PLUG REMOVAL
If the plug is too tight, hit the plug head with a hammer two
to three times, and the plug will be easily loosened.
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
INSTALLATION
R I G H T C O U N T E R B A L A NC E RE A R
BEARING INSTALLATION
(1) Apply engine oil to the outer surface of bearing.
(2) Using special tools, install right rear bearing. Make sure
that oil hole of bearing is aligned with oil hole of cylinder
block.
Rear (3) Using the special tool, install the rear bearing..
NOTE
The left rear bearing has no oil holes.
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
SH AFT
INSTALLATION
Using special tools, front bearing,
FRONT CASE
(1) Set the special tool on the front end of crankshaft and
apply a thin coat of engine oil to the outer circumference
of the special tool to install the front case.
TSB Revision
Front Case, Counterbalance
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
- -
TSB Revision
Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and Can
(2) Secure the oil pump driven gear onto the left counterbal-
ance shaft by tightening the flange bolt to specified torque.
PLUG INSTALLATION
62
(1) Install a new O-ring to the of front case.
(2) Using the special tool, plug and tighten to speci-
fied torque.
mm bolts
TSB Revision
Front Case,
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft
Drain pi ..
gasket
I. ,
.
OIL INSTALLATION
side
(1) Clean the installation of bracket.
Apply engine oil to the O-ring of, the oil filter.
(3) Screw the oil filter in until the the bracket.
Then tighten torque: 7 Nm (12,
NOTE
For 35737, tighten
14 Nm (10 after the O-ring the
,
TSB Revision
Front
ENGINE OVERHAUL Shaft and
INSPECTION
FRONT CASE
(1) Check oil holes for clogging and -clean if necessary.
(2) Check left counterbalance shaft front bearing
wear, damage and seizure. If there is anything ‘wrong
with the section, replace the front case.
(3) Check the front case for cracks and other ‘damage. Re-
place cracked or damaged front case.
OIL SEAL
(1) Check the oil seal lip for wear and damage. Replace
oil seal if necessary.
(2) Check the seal lip for deterioration. Replace oil seal
if necessary.
COUNTERBALANCE SHAFT
(1) Check oil holes for clogging.
(2) Check journal for seizure, damage and contact with bear-
ing. If there is anything wrong with the journal, replace
counterbalance shaft, bearing or front case assembly.
OIL PUMP
(1) Assemble the-oil pump gear to the front case and rotate
it to ensure smooth rotation with no looseness.
(2) Ensure that there is no ridge wear on the contact surface
between the front case and the gear surface of the oil
pump cover,
(3) Check the side clearance
Standard value:
Drive gear mm in.)
Driven gear mm in.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Connecting Rod
Removal steps
1. Nut 7. Piston ring No. 2
2. Connecting rod cap 8. Oil ring
3. Connecting rod bearing 9. Piston pin
4. Piston and connecting rod assembly 10. Piston
5. Connecting rod bearing 11. Connecting rod
6. Piston ring No. 1 12.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and
1
2
I
Connecting Pin
4
5 Rod
Piston Support
7 Connecting Pin
8 Piston Support
9 43 Press Pin
10 216943 Stop Screw
11
11 10396 Nut
(1) Remove the stop screw from the base.
(2) Select the correct piston support for your application
above). Fit the piston support the base. Place the’
base press support blocks.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Rod
(3) Insert the press pin through the piston! pin Select
the correct connecting rod guide pin Thread
the guide pin onto the threaded portion of the press pin.
(4) Position the piston assembly on the piston., support in
the press. With the press pin up Figure 4,
insert the guide pin through the hole, in the piston and
through the hole in the piston support.
(5) Press the piston pin out of the assembly.
IMPORTANT: To avoid piston damage,
l The piston support must seat against
the piston.
l Verify that the piston pin will slide
hole in the piston support.
(6) Remove the piston pin from the press pin.
,
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and
Size Identification
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Connecting Rod
Identification mark “1 2. Install piston rings with identification mark facing up, to’
Identification mark Size mark the piston crown side.
3. Size marks on piston rings are as follows..
Size Size mark
Standard NONE
0.50 mm oversize 50
1 mm oversize 100
I I
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston Rod
CONNECTING ROD
When the bearing needs replacing, select and a, proper
bearing by the following procedure.
(1) the crankshaft pin diameter and
from the following In a
supplied as a service part, identification of its,
are painted at the the
.. ,
None Yellow 1
Identification mark
3 None ‘White 3
TSB Revision
11 ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston
(2) Make sure that the connecting rod big end side clearance
meets the specification.
Standard value: 0.1 mm
Limit: 0.4 mm in.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Piston and Rod
INSPECTION
PISTON RING
(1) Check the piston ring for excessive and
breakage and replace if defects. If the’ piston
has been replaced with ,a new one, the piston rings must
also be replaced with, new. ones.
(2) Check for the clearance between the piston ring and
ring groove. If the limit is exceeded, replace the ring
or piston, or both.
Standard value: mm
Limit: 0.1 mm in.)
(3) Install the piston ring into the cylinder bore. Force it
down with a piston, its crown being in contact with the
ring, to correctly position it at right angles to the cylinder
wall. Then, measure the end gap with a feeler gauge.
If the ring gap is excessive, replace the piston ring.
Standard value:
ring mm
ring mm in.)
Oil ring mm
Limit:
No. 1, No. 2 ring 0.8 mm in.)
Oil ring 1.0 mm in.)
Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL and
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Crankshaft, Flywheel and Plate
REMOVAL AND
9
7
Removal steps
1. Flywheel bolt 9. Oil seal case
2. Flywheel 10. Oil seal
3. Drive plate bolt 11. Bearing cap bolt
4. Adapter plate 12. Bearing cap
5. Drive plate 13. Crankshaft bearing (lower)
6. Crankshaft bushing 14. Crankshaft
7. Rear plate 15. Crankshaft bearing (upper)
8. Bell housing cover 16. Cylinder block
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Crankshaft,
SERVICE
CRANKSHAFT BEARING
When the bearing needs replacing, select and install a proper
bearing by the following procedure.
(1) Measure the crankshaft journal diameter and confirm its
classification from the following In the case of
a crankshaft supplied as part, identification colors
of its journals are painted at the positions shown in the
illustration.
(2) The cylinder block bearing bore diameter identification
marks are stamped at the position shown in the illustration
from the front of engine, beginning at No. 1.
Crankshaft journal Cylinder
block
Crankshaft
bore
Classi- Identifica- Identifica- O u t e r
fication tion mark diameter mm mark mark
(for tion color (in.) (for service
production (for service
None Yellow 1
2
3
Timing belt side None None 0 2
Cylinder block bearing bore 1 3
identification mark
2 4
None White 0 3
1 4
2 5
(3) Select a proper bearing from above table on the basis
of the identification data confirmed under Items (1) and
[Example]
1. If the measured value of a ‘crankshaft journal outer
diameter is between 56.994 57.000 mm (2.2439
2.2441 in.), the journal is classified as “1” in the
Lower bearing Identification case the is also replaced by a
No. mark spare part, check the identification colors of the
Upper bearing journals painted on the new If the color
(for No.
is yellow, for example, the is classified as
Identification .
mark 2. Next, check the cylinder’ block bearing hole
1 identification mark stamped the cylinder block.
If it is read the ideritification mark” column
to find the identification mark of the bearing to be
used. In this case, it is “1”.
(4) Install the bearings having an oil groove to the cylinder
block.
(5) Install the bearings having no oil to the bearing
cap.
.
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Flywheel
(8) After installing the bearing caps, make sure that the crank-
shaft turns smoothly and the end play is correct. If the
end play exceeds the limit, replacer crankshaft bear-
ings.
Standard value: mm in.)
Limit: 0.25 mm in.)
998776
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Crankshaft. Drive
TSB Revision I
ENGINE OVERHAUL Crankshaft, Flywheel and,
. .
INSPECTION 11300880103
BLOCK
(1) Visually check for scratches, rust, and corrosion.
Use also a flaw detecting agent for the check. If defects
are evident, correct, or replace.
(2) Using a straightedge and feeler gauge, check the block
top for Make sure that the surface
is free from gasket chips and other foreign matter.
Standard value: 0.05 mm in.)
Limit: 0.1 mm in.)
(3) If the distortion is excessive, correct within the allowable
limit or replace.
Grinding limit: 0.2 mm in.)
Includes/combined with cylinder head grinding
Cylinder block height (when new):
mm (11.413-11.421 in.)
(4) Check cylinder walls for scratches and seizure. If defects
are evident, correct (bored to oversize) or replace.
Bottom
TSB Revision
ENGINE OVERHAUL Crankshaft, Flywheel ‘and ‘Drive Plate
BORING CYLINDER
(1) Oversize pistons to be used should determined on
the basis of the largest bore
Piston size identification
Size mark
Thrust
direction 0.50
1
NOTE
Size mark is stamped on piston top.
(2) outside diameter of piston to be used.
it in thrust direction as shown.
(3) Based on measured piston O.D. calculate boring
TSB Revision
ENGINE
.
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
The lubrication method is a fully force-fed, full-flow
filtration type.
ENGINE OILS
Health Warning
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
will result in the removal of natural fats from the Adequate means of skin protection and washing
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. facilities must provided.
In addition, used engine oil potentially
Recommended Precautions
The most effective precaution is to adapt working Where there is a risk of eye contact, eye
practices which prevent, as far as practicable, the protection should be worn, for example,
risk of skin contact with mineral oils, for example chemical goggles or face shields; in addition
by using enclosed systems for handling used engine an eye wash facility should be provided.
oil and by degreasing components, where Obtain First Aid treatment immediately for open
practicable, before handling them. cuts and wounds.
Other precautions: Wash regularly with soap and water to ensure
l Avoid prolonged and repeated contact with oils, all oil is removed, especially before
particularly used engine oils. cleansers and nail brushes will help). After
l Wear protective clothing, including impervious cleaning, the application of
gloves where practicable. containing lanolin to replace the natural. .
l Avoid contaminating clothes, particularly oil is advised.
underpants, with oil. Do not use gasoline, kerosine, diesel fuel,
l Do not put oily rags in packets, the use of oil, thinners or solvents for cleaning skin.
overalls without pockets will avoid this. Use barrier creams, applying them before each
l Do not wear heavily soiled clothing and work period, to help the removal of oil from
oil-impregnated foot-wear. Overalls must be the skin after work.
cleaned regularly and kept separate from If skin disorders develop, obtain medical advice
personal clothing. without delay.
LUBRICANTS
Items Engine oil (API classification) Quantity (qts.)
Oil filter Engine (Non-turbo) SH or higher 0.5
Engine (Turbo) and 0.3
Engine
Oil cooler Engine (Turbo)> 0.1
ENGINE OIL
EOLCS certification mark
Caution
use nondetergent or straight mineral oil.
Oil Identification Symbol
Use only engine oils displaying the EOLCS certification mark
on the container.
..
Revision
ENGINE LUBRICATION Service
ON-VEHICLE
.
ENGINE OIL
Pull out the oil dipstick slowly and check that the oil
is within the marks on the oil dipstick.
2. Check that the oil is dirty, that there is
no coolant or gasoline mixed in, ‘and that it has, sufficient
viscosity.
Engine (Non-turbo)>
12-4 LUBRICATION
OIL REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the engine oil filler cap.
2. Remove the engine oil drain plug, and drain out the engine
o i l .
3. Remove the engine oil filter by using the oil filter wrench.
4. Clean the oil filter mounting, surface of the oil filter bracket.
Engine (Non-turbo)>
lFor 090: turn or 21 Nm (15
7. Add new engine oil through the oil filter.
8. Start and run engine and check for engine oil leaks.
9. After stopping engine, check oil level and replenish as
necessary.
TSB Revision
ENGINE LUBRICATION Oil Cooler
Engine oil
Removal steps
1. Oil filter
2. Water hose connection
3. Oil cooler bolt
4. Engine oil cooler
Stopper
Engine oil cooler
TSB Revision
12-6 ENGINE LUBRICATION Engine Oil Cooler
INSPECTION
l Check the water for cracks, clogging, or
deterioration.
l Check the oil cooler bolt clogging deformation.
Revision
FUEL
CONTENTS
FUEL SUPPLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NOTE
Groups that have been shaded are not contained in this manual.
13-2
FUEL
INJECTION
CONTENTS
FUEL INJECTION
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Fuel Injection System consists The PCM carries activities such fuel
of sensors which detect the engine conditions, injection control, idle air control and ignition
the POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE timing control.
(PCM) which controls the system based on In addition, the
signals from these sensors, and actuators diagnostic test which simplify
which operate under the control of the PCM. troubleshooting when a problem develops.
FUEL INJECTION CONTROL
The injector drive times and injector timing are is called The PCM
controlled so that the optimum air/fuel mixture air/fuel mixture by carrying out “open-loop”
is supplied to the engine to correspond to the control when the engine is cold or operating
continually-changing engine operation condi- under high load conditions in to maintain
tions. engine performance.
A single injector is mounted at the intake port In addition, when the engine warm or
of each cylinder. Fuel is sent under pressure operating under normal the PCM
from the fuel tank by the fuel pump, with the controls the air/fuel mixture by using the heated
pressure regulated by the fuel pressure oxygen sensor signal to carry out “closed-loop”
regulator. The regulated fuel is distributed control in order to obtain the theoretical air/fuel
to each of the injectors. mixture ratio that provides the maximum
Fuel injection is normally carried out once for cleaning from the three way
each cylinder for every two rotations of the catalyst.
crankshaft. The firing order is This
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Specifications
Throttle body Throttle bore mm (in) 52 (2.05)
Throttle position sensor Variable resistor type
Idle air control motor Stepper motor type [Stepper type
bypass air control system]’ ,
Sensors Manifold absolute pressure sensor Semiconductor type
Intake air temperature sensor Thermistor type
Engine coolant temperature sensor Thermistor type .
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Fuel
canister
Air inlet
absolute pressure sensor
Intake air temperature sensor
Positive crankcase
ventilation valve transducer
Injector
sensor
Engine coolant
Knock sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
Heated oxygen
sensor (Rear)
Revision
Service
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Sealants
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Ignition timing BTDC. at curb idle (Nonadjustable)-
Curb idle 800 100
Idle speed when is ON 850 in Neutral
Throttle position sensor resistance, 3 . 5 8 . 5 ,
Idle air control motor coil resistance
Intake air temperature sensor resistance 9 - 1 1
0.6 0.8
Engine coolant temperature sensor 9-11 ,
0.6 0.8
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage 0.6 1.0
Fuel pressure (psi) 330 350 (47 50) at curb idle
Injector coil resistance
Electric EGR transducer solenoid coil resistance 25 35 (68
SEALANTS
,
Items Specified sealants
Engine coolant temperature sensor threaded portion Loctite 24200
. or equivalent
Intake air temperature sensor threaded portion Loctite 24200 or equivalent
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> ,
SPECIAL TOOLS
Scan tool
Interface
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING FLOW
Verify complaint
.
Read the diagnostic trouble code (Refer to Read the diagnostic trouble code (Refer to
I I
Diagnostic trouble trouble
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TEST MODE
CHECK ENGINE/MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
As a functional test, the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
illuminates at key-on before engine cranking.
Whenever the Power-train Control Module (PCM) sets a
diagnostic trouble code that effects vehicle emissions, it
illuminates the The PCM illuminates the for
diagnostic trouble codes that effect vehicle emissions. The
remains on until the diagnostic trouble code is erased.
The either flashes or illuminates continuously when
PCM detects active engine misfire.
During active misfire, the PCM records the
operating conditions. The engine operating conditions
recorded by the PCM.
Items Indicated by the Check Engine/Malfunction Indicator Lamp
DTC No. Items
01 No cam signal at PCM
02 Internal controller failure
EGR solenoid circuit
EVAP solenoid circuit
Injector control circuit
20 Injector control circuit
21 Injector control circuit
25 Idle air control motor circuit
26 Throttle position sensor voltage low
27 Throttle position sensor voltage high
30 Engine coolant temperature voltage too low
31 Engine coolant temperature voltage too high
32 Upstream stays at center
35 No vehicle speed sensor signal
,.
36 07) MAP sensor voltage too low
37 MAP sensor voltage too high
39 No change in MAP from start to run
42 Ignition coil primary circuit
,
43 Ignition coil primary circuit
46 EGR system failure
57 Intake air temperature sensor voltage low
58 Intake air temperature sensor voltage high
61 Injector control circuit
62 Upstream shorted to voltage
68 PCM failure communications
71 temperature volts out of limit
92 (PI 490) Low speed fan control relay circuit
93 High speed fan control relay circuit
101 Fuel pump relay control circuit
33) Upstream response
103 Upstream heater failure
Downstream heater failure
Multiple cylinder misfire
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
NOTE
Following a detected malfunction of the Control Module (PCM), the check engine lamp
up the next time the engine is turned on if the malfunction is still detected. However, for items
with an asterisk in the table above, the check engine lamp goes on’ the first time a malfundin is
detected.
Once the check engine lamp is lit, any one of the following will turn it off.
l When the PCM has found no malfunction after monitoring the power train times time
is from engine start to engine stop).
l A misfire of fuel abnormality when engine speed, coolant temperature, etc. are to those
when the malfunction was first recorded, and the PCM has detected no malfunction.
Caution
If the check engine lamp is turned on by a malfunction of the PCM, the scan tool communicate
with the PCM, and the diagnostic trouble code cannot be read.
,
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
ON-BOARD DIAGNOSTICS
The Control Module (PCM) monitors The first is to cycle the ignition switch
many different circuits in the fuel injection system. On-Off-On-Off-On within 5 Then count
If the PCM senses a problem with a monitored the number of times the malfunction indicator lamp
circuit often enough to indicate an actual problem, (check engine lamp) on the instrument panel flashes
it stores a diagnostic trouble code in the on and off. The number of flashes represents the
memory. diagnostic trouble code. There is a slight pause
After the PCM first detects a malfunction, a between the flashes representing the first and
diagnostic trouble code is recorded when the engine second digits of the code. Longer pauses separate
is restarted and the same malfunction is individual trouble codes. The second method of
re-defected. However, for items marked with a reading diagnostic trouble codes uses scan
a diagnostic trouble code is recorded the Connect the scan tool to the
first detection of the malfunction. (diagnostic) connector in the vehicle.
After that, if the PCM does not re-detect the
FREEZE FRAME DATA
malfunction for 40 drives* (51 engine start for
non-emission related faults), the diagnostic trouble The PCM records the diagnostic trouble code and
code will be erased from the PCM memory. also the engine operating conditions the time
NOTE the malfunction was detected. are called
A drive indicates from engine start to stop and “freeze frame” data.
monitors the power train component. This data indicates the engine operating condition
However, for misfiring or a fuel system rich/lean, from when nothing at all is the initial
the diagnostic trouble codes will be erased under detection of the However, misfiring
the following conditions. or fuel trim malfunction data are always. replaced
l When driving conditions (engine speed, engine with the latest data.
coolant temperature, etc.) are similar, to those This data can be read by using the scan tool, and
when the malfunction was first recorded. can then be used in simulation tests for
l When the PCM does not re-detect the troubleshooting.
malfunction for 80 drives*. Data items are as follows.
Technicians can display stored diagnostic trouble
codes by two different methods.
Data Unit
Engine coolant temperature or
Engine speed or RPM
Vehicle speed km/h or mph
Long-term fuel compensation (Long-term fuel trim)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting .
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting 3
If scan tool not available
1. Cycle the ignition key On-Off-On-Off-On within seconds.
2. Count the number of times the malfunction indicator lamp
(check engine lamp) on the instrument panel flashes on
and off. The number flashes represents the trouble
code. There is a slight pause between the flashes
representing the first and second digits of the’ code.
Longer pauses (approx. 4 seconds) separate individual
,
trouble codes.
3. Repair the malfunction while referring to the inspection
chart for diagnostic trouble codes.
4. After disconnecting the battery cable from the battery
terminal for a few minutes, reconnect the
5. Start the engine and run it at for about minutes
after the engine has warmed up.
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Throttle position sensor The PCM uses the value calculated from the MAP sensor signal instead of the
age low valve opening angle (voltage).
Throttle position sensor The PCM uses the value calculated from the MAP sensor signal instead of the throttle
age high valve opening angle (voltage).
Engine coolant temperature l The PCM uses the default value as the engine
(ECT) sensor voltage too low temperature.
l The PCM operates the radiator fan.
l The PCM carries out open loop control.
Engine coolant temperature l The PCM uses the default value as the engine
(ECT) sensor voltage too temperature.
high l The PCM operates the radiator fan.
l The PCM carries out open loop control.
INo vehicle speed sensor The PCM controls the engine as if the vehicle speed were 0 mph.
signal
IMAP sensor voltage too low The PCM uses the value calculated from the throttle position sensor and the engine
speed signals instead of the MAP value
I sensor voltage too high The PCM uses the value calculated from the throttle position sensor and the engine
speed signals instead of the MAP value
change in MAP from start The PCM uses the value calculated from the throttle position sensor and the engine
0 run speed signals instead of the MAP value
I ntake air temperature sensor The PCM uses the engine coolant temperature instead of the intake air temperature.
roltage low
I ntake air temperature sensor The PCM uses the engine coolant temperature instead of the intake air temperature.
roltage high
sensor The PCM retards ignition timing according to the knock sensor signal.
temperature sensor The PCM uses the default value as the battery temperature.
out of limit
speed fan control relay The PCM turns on the high speed fan control relay instead of the low speed fan
relay
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
TPS voltage does not agree The PCM uses the value calculated from the MAP sensor signal instead of the throttle
with MAP valve opening angle (voltage)>
Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or The PCM uses the crankshaft position sensor signal only to control
more timing, etc. (Accordingly, normal sequential fuel injection may not be carried
out.)
No 5 volts to MAP sensor The PCM uses the value calculated from the throttle position sensor and the engine
speed signals instead of the MAP value
No 5 volts to throttle position The PCM uses the value calculated from the MAP sensor signal instead of the throttle
sensor valve opening angle (voltage).
High speed radiator fan con- The PCM turns on the high speed fan control relay instead of the low speed fan control
trol relay circuit relay
Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
DTC No. DTC No. DTC No. Diagnostic items Check items (Remedy) Memory
tool
(MUT-II) scan tool pulses
mode> mode>
48 62 PCM failure l Replace the PCM Retained
SRI mile not stored
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
DTC No. DTC No. DTC No. Diagnostic items Check items (Remedy) Memory
tool <General
(MUT-II) scan tool pulses
mode> mode>
105 21 Downstream l Harness and connector
heater failure Downstream
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
DTC No. DTC No. DTC No. Diagnostic items Check items (Remedy) Memory
tool <General
(MUT-II) scan tool pulses
mode> mode> mode> .
TSB Revision
ENGINE
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
54
[Comment] l Open supply circuit
Background l Open sensor ground
l The PCM uses information from both the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position l Open or shorted signal circuit
sensor to determine ignition timing. l Damaged camshaft target magnet
l When the camshaft position sensor signal is lost, the PCM relies on the position l Sensor failed,
sensor signal to allow engine operation. l PCM failed
l This could result in fuel injection being out of phase, which would result in deterioration
of engine performance and emissions.
Range of Check ,
l Ignition switch: ON
l Crankshaft position sensor signal (High or low) is input (Engine: Cranking).
Set Condition
l Camshaft position sensor signal (High or low) isn’t input for 2 seconds.
NG
Check that the camshaft position Repair
NG NG
Measure at the camshaft sensor connector Check the Repair
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side. connectors:
l Voltage between 1 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK:
l Voltage between 3 and ground Check trouble
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: NG
l Continuity between 2 and ground
OK: Continuity Check the harness wire between the PCM and camshaft position
sensor connector.
OK NG
OK
Replace the PCM. Repair
the PCM. I’
Scan tool 02
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Charging T o o
47
[Comment] l Defects in generator or adjustment
Background l High resistance
The PCM tries to maintain charging system voltage of between and 15 volts. generator
l This code indicates: l High between battery and
The battery voltage input is below the target charging voltage during engine generator ground
and l PCM
No significant change in voltage has been detected during active testing of the generator
output circuit.
Range of Check
l Engine speed: or more for approx. one minute
l Battery positive voltage is at least 1 lower than the target charging voltage for approx.
60 seconds.
Set Condition
l Battery positive voltage does not change even if the generator field current is cut off.
NG
Measure the voltage between the generator terminal and the Check the harness wire and terminal
battery positive terminal. generator terminal and battery
Engine: 1600 necessary.
Headlight: High beam ON)
OK: Less than
NG
Measure the voltage between the generator body and battery Check the generator grounded line:
neoative terminal.
Engine: 1600
Headlight: High beam ON)
OK: Less than 0.5
OK
NG
Measure at the generator Check the wire between generator relay
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side. (ASD relay) connector. Repair, if necessary.
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
10 relay (ASD relay)
isturnedonandoff everyapprox.
l Voltage between 1 and ground
[Measure when the relay (ASD relay) is turned on.]
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
NG
Check the harness wire Repair
connector. I
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TEST (Data list) Check the harness wire between the PCM and the battery
10 Battery voltage as the ignition switch. Repair, if necessary.
OK: indicated on the scan tool and actual positive
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Scan tool 06
General scan tool Charging System Voltage Too
. High
46
[Comment] Generator internal shorted
Background l Generator field driver shorted to ‘ground
l The PCM tries to maintain charging system voltage of between 13.2 and 15 volts. l PCM failed
l This code indicates that the battery voltage input is above the target charging voltage
during engine operation and PCM efforts to regulate the generator field do not prevent
the voltage from rising.
Range of Check
l Engine speed: 1500 or more for approx. one minute
Set Condition ,
l Battery positive voltage is at least higher than target charging voltage for approx. 12
seconds.
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TEST (Data list) Replace the PCM.
36 Charging system goal
OK: or more
TSB
Scan tool 10
Code relay relay)
General scan tool
No.
42
[Comment] l Relay coil open or shorted
Background l relay
l The relay (ASD relay) controls the battery voltage supplied to the fuel injectors, ignition shorted
coils, and generator. l circuit in
l The PCM provides a ground path for the relay (ASD relay).
l This DTC indicates an open or short-circuit condition in the control circuit.
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: or more
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l Open or short circuit is detected in the relay (ASD relay) for 3 seconds.
NG
Check the relay (ASD relay) (Refer to Replace
OK
OK .
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Check the harness wi Repair
relay)
OK
Revision
(NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Scan tool 11
General scan tool Generator Field Not Switching
. Properly
41 .
[Comment] l Field driver circuit open or
Background l Generator internal o p en o r
l The PCM receives generator field input. l PCM failed ,
l Battery voltage is supplied to the generator through the relay relay).
Range of Check
l Ignition switch: ON
l relay (ASD relay): ON
Set Condition
l Open or short circuit is detected in the generator field control circuit.
NG
Measure at the generator connector Repair the generator, and replace if necessary
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the component side.
l Continuity between 2 and generator body
OK: No continuity
OK
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the generator Repair
connector.
OK
Check the following connectors: Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
me relay. Replace . . .
(Refer to GROUF 55 On-vehicle Service)
OK
Measure at the PCM connectors and
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 36 and ground, and 64 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive Check trouble symptom.
l Connect a jumper wire between and the ground.
(Ignition switch: ON) NG
(A/C switch: ON) .
OK: compressor clutch is turned on Replace the
,
NG
I ,
Check the system (Refer to GROUP 55 Troubleshooting)
TSB Revision
Scan tool 17
Code General scan
No.
32 I
[Comment] Open short
Background Open output
l The PCM provides a switched ground path to the solenoid. or shorted
l This DTC indicates an open or short-circuit condition in the control circuit.
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: or more
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l Open or short circuit is detected in the electric EGR transducer solenoid for 3 seconds. I .
. . ,
. .
Replace
(Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control System)
OK .
NG
Measure at the electric transducer solenoid connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector and measure a the harness side.
O K
l Voltage between 2 and ground
switch: ON) Check
Battery positive voltage
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the following
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 40 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
the PCM.
Revision
..
Scan tool 18
Code General Circuit
No.
31
[Comment] Open or short control circuit
Background l Open fused output ,
l It is operated as a PCM output providing a switched ground path once the vehicle enters l Open or solenoid
closed loop operation. l ...
l This DTC indicates a short or condition in the circuit.
Range of Check
Battery voltage: or more
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l Open or short circuit is detected in the EVAP purge control solenoid control circuit for
3 seconds.
NG
Check the evaporative emission Replace
(Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control System.)
OK
NG ...
Measure at the evaporative purge solenoid connector Check the following connectors:
NG
Measure at the PCM connector
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 66 and ground
switch: ON)
Battery positive
NG
Repair
Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 19
OK
NG
Measure at the injector connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
10 relay (ASD relay)
relay (ASD relay) is turned on and off every approx.
l Voltaae between 2 and around
with the (ASD relay) on] Check the harness wire between the relay, (ASD and
OK: Battery positive voltage the injector connector. Repair, if necessary.
OK
Check Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Replace the PCM.
Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 20
Injector Circuit
No.
27
[Comment] l Open or shorted injector control
Background l Open injector
l Grounds for the injector circuits are provided by the PCM. l (ASD) supply
l Battery power is provided through the relay (ASD relay). l Driver tailed
l This DTC is set if an open or short-circuit condition is detected in the control circuit
the individual injector.
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: or more
l relay (ASD relay): ON
l Engine: 3000 or less
Set Condition
l force is not detected for 3 seconds immediately after injectors
Revision
(NON-TURBO)>
,
Scan tool 21
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Repair the relay (ASD relay) circuit.
10 relay (ASD relay)
OK: The reiav sound can be heard.
NG
Check the injector. (Refer to Replace
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 25
Code General scan tool Air Control Motor Circuits
No.
25 ,
[Comment] l Driver circuit shorted to ground
Background l Driver circuit shorted to battery
l The idle air stepper motor is used to prevent the engine from at l shorted to together
idle. l PCM failed
With the throttle plate completely placing a load on the engine (A/C or power l Shorted motor
steering operation) might cause the engine to stall or run rough.
l As the PCM anticipates load, it operates the motor, opening the throttle bypass passage
and allowing more air into the intake manifold.
l Malfunction of this system cause rough idle and emissions.
l The PCM cannot detect an open circuit or determine if the stepper motor is stuck in
one position.
Range of Check
l Battery 10 or more . .
l ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l A short or open circuit condition is detected in a motor circuit for 3 seconds.
NG
Check Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
harness wire between PCM and the Repair
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 26
Code scan tool Position Sensor
No.
24
[Comment] l Sensor circuit shorted to
Background l position
l The sensor consists of a resistor that provides a signal to the PCM based l of
on the position of the throffle blade.
l The PCM uses throffle body position information to adjust fuel injector width. ,
Range of Check
l ignition switch: ON
,
Set Condition
l Throttle position sensor output remains less than for 1 second.
NG
Check the position Replace ,
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
Check harness wire between the PCM and the TPS connector. Repair
the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 27
Code scan tool Throttle Position Sensor Voltage
No. High
24
[Comment] Sensor circuit open
Background l position sensor failed
l The sensor consists of a resistor that provides a to the PCM based Sensor ground circuit
on the position of the throttle blade.
l The PCM uses throttle body position information to adjust fuel injector width.
Range of Check
l ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l Throttle position sensor output remains more than for 1 second.
NG
Check the throttle position sensor. (TPS) (Refer to Replace
OK
Measure at the TPS connector
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Continuity between 1 and ground
OK: Continuity
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair ,
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness wire between the PCM and the TPS connector.
NG
Replace
Scan tool 30
Code General scan tool Engine Coolant Temperature
No. Sensor Voltage Too
22
[Comment] l Sensor shorted to
Background l Sensor internally shorted
l Data from the engine temperature sensor is used in most fuel and spark related l PCM failed
control functions.
Range of Check
l Ignition switch: ON ,
Set Condition
Engine temperature sensor output remains less than 0.51 for 3 seconds.
Replace
(Refer to
OK
Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
the Repair
temperature sensor connector.
OK
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 31 .
Code General scan tool Engine Coolant Temperature
No. Sensor Voltage Too High
22
[Comment] l Sensor signal circuit open
Background l Sensor internally open
l Data from the engine coolant temperature sensor is used in most fuel and spark related
control functions. l PCM failed
l When DTC is set, the PCM uses a default value as the engine coolant temperature, and
the vehicle enters the limp-in mode.
Range of Check
,
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition ,
l Engine coolant temperature sensor output voltage remains more than for 3 seconds.
NG
Replace
(Refer to
OK
Measure at the engine coolant temperature sensor
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Continuity between 1 and ground
OK: Continuity
OK
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the engine coolant
temperature sensor connector. Repair, if
NG .
Repair.
OK
NG .
Check the harness wire between the coolant
temperature sensor connector.
OK NG
Upstream Stays
OK . .
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 33
General scan tool is Too Long P r o b a b l e
Replace
Replace
(Refer to .
Repair
NG
Repair
temperature sensor connector.
OK
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
I Scan tool 35
Code General scan tool No Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
No.
15
[Comment] Open or shorted. circuit
Background Speedometer damaged
l The speed sensor serves as a PCM input switching voltage between 0 and 5 Open supply circuit
volts. Open sensor ground circuit
l Once the vehicle is in motion and the throttle is open, information from the sensor is Vehicle speed sensor failed
sampled every 11 milliseconds and compared to a minimum threshold equal to 1 mph. PCM failed
l If the sensors output voltage indicates a speed higher than this threshold, the sensor
is considered to be operating normally.
l Failure of the sensor would be quite noticeable because the speedometer would fail to
operate.
Diagnostic features that depend on the speed sensor may never execute if this component
fails.
of Check
Engine coolant temperature: or more
Transaxle: Other than or range only).
31 seconds after starting engine
Brakes not applied
Throffle valve: Open
Engine: 1600 or more
Difference between the atmospheric pressure and intake manifold pressure:
34 (10 or more
Condition
Vehicle speed: Less than lmph for 11 seconds
N G
Check the following connectors: I Repair
OK
Check trouble
NG
NG
Repair
connector.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Yes
SCAN SENSOR READ TEST list) Replace the PCM.
65 Vehicle speed sensor
l Is vehicle speed displayed during driving?
No
NG
Check the following Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
OK
NG
harness wire Repair
module connector.
OK
Check the automatic transaxle control system.
NG
Check the following Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and MAP sensor Repair
connector.
OK
Replace the MAP sensor.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 37 ,
Code General scan tool MAP Sensor Voltage Too High
No. 08 Probable cause
14
[Comment] Signal circuit open
Background Sensor open
l This code is generated when the MAP sensor voltage exceeds maximum voltage l Sensor ground circuit open
of 4.7 volts. l Sensor circuit shorted to voltage
Range of Check l PCM
l Engine: 1500
l Throttle position sensor output voltage: Less than
.
Set Condition
l MAP sensor output voltage remains less than 4.7 for 2 seconds.
Check the harness wire between the PCM and MAP se&or
connector. Repair, if necessary. ,
N G
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Repair
connector.
OK
Replace the MAP sensor.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Troubleshooting
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the MAP sensor
connector. if
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 40
Code General scan tool No Crank Reference at Probable cause
No. PCM
11
[Comment] l Open or shorted supply circuit
Background l Open sensor ground
l The crankshaft position sensor is a Hall-effect sensor that provides a voltage signal to l Open or shorted signal circuit
the PCM. l Excessive clearance between the sensor and
l Voltage alternates between 0 and 5 volts as the crankshaft turns. rotor
l This DTC would indicate a failure of the sensor or its circuit. Sensor failed
Range of Check l PCM failed
l The test is run at start-up.
l Camshaft position sensor indicates that the camshaft is rotating.
Set Condition
l Crankshaft position sensor signal (High or Low) is not input.
OK
Replace the PCM. Repair
NG
Check the following Repair
OK
TSB Revision 1
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 42
Code General scan tool Ignition Coil Circuit
No. Probable
43
[Comment] l Ignition coil wiring harness or connector
Background failed
l The PCM provides the ground control circuit for the side of ignition coil. Open circuit in coil
l Battery voltage is through the relay (ASD relay). PCM
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: 13 or more (engine is running)
l relay (ASD relay): ON
l Engine: 3000 or less
l Engine speed and ignition timing are always stable.
Set Condition
l The primary circuit is not achieving peak current with maximum dwell for 3 seconds.
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Repair relay (ASD relay) related
10 relay (ASD relay)
OK: ooeratina sound can be heard.
OK
Measure at the ignition coil connector
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
10 relay (ASD relay)
relay (ASD relay) is turned on and off 1.4 seconds.
l Voltage between 2 and ground
[Measure with relay (ASD relay) on.] Check the harness wire the (ASD-relay) and
OK: Battery positive voltage the ignition coil connector. Repair,’ necessary.
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the following connector:
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Disconnect PCM connector and short terminal (67) of
the harness-side connector to ground.
Voltage between 3 and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
Check the harness wire between PCM and the ignition
connector. Repair, if necessary.
OK
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> ,
Scan tool 43
Code General scan tool Ignition Coil Primary Circuit Probable
No.
43
[Comment] l Ignition coil wiring harness or
Background failed
l The PCM provides the ground control circuit for the primary side of ignition coil. Open circuit in ignition
l Battery voltage is supplied through the relay relay). l PCM failed
Range of Check
Battery voltage: 13 or more (engine is running)
l relay (ASD relay): ON
l Engine: 3000 or less
l Engine speed and ignition timing are always stable.
. .
Set Condition
l The primary circuit is not achieving peak current with maximum dwell for 3 seconds.
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Repair relay (ASD relay) related
10 relay (ASD relay)
OK: Relay operating sound can be heard.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Scan tool 44
C o d e General scan tool No relay) output
No. Voltage at PCM
42
[Comment] l relay (ASD output open
Background l Fused circuit open .
l The PCM senses operation of the relay (ASD relay) by measuring relay voltage. l relay (ASD reiay) failed
(If relay turns to ON, voltage is high). l Circuit in faked .
l This DTC indicates that no voltage is being sensed when the relay (ASD relay) is
being energized.
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: or more ,
l switch: ON
l Unless the engine is cranking
Set Condition
l The relay voltage is low for 1 second.
.
NG
Replace
, .
Measure at the relay (ASD relay) connector
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 6 and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
l Voltage. between 6 and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK Check the harness wire the relay relay) and,
the fusible link. Repair,
NG
Check the following connect Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the relay (ASD Repair
relay) connector.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 46
Code General scan tool EGR System Failure
No. cause
32
[Comment] l EGR valve
Background . tube
l Once per vehicle trip the PCM monitors the EGR system fiow rate. l harness and
l If the flow rate is above or below the acceptable limits, the PCM stores a’ diagnostic l Vacuum hoses’ failed
trouble code.
Range of Check
l Engine temperature is greater than
l More than three minutes have passed since start-up.
l Engine is between 1952 and 2400.
l MAP voltage is between and 2.70.
l TPS voltage is between 0.6 and
Vehicle speed exceeds 3 mph.
Short term fuel compensation value is exhibiting less than
During air/fuel ratio closed loop control
Condition
The measured change in the short-term fuel compensation value shift during the test is
less than 7.4% or greater than 20.5%.
NG
Check the idle running. . l Check the EGR valve and replace if
l Idle running after warming up l Check the EGR tube for and clean or it
l Remove the vacuum hose from the EGR valve nipple and plug ..
it.
l Connect a hand vacuum pump to the EGR valve nipple, and
apply a 12 (3.5 of vacuum.
OK: Idle speed becomes unstable or the engine stalls.
OK
Repair
OK
Check the EGR solenoid circuit. (Refer to INSPECTION
PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Scan tool 46
Code General scan tool PCM Failure Probable cause
No. SRI Mile Not Stored
62
[Comment]
l Unsuccessful attempt to update service reminder indicator (SRI or mileage in the
control module EEPROM.
Revision
ENGINE , Troubleshooting
[Comment) l PCM
l Unsuccessful attempt to write to an EEPROM location by the control module.
I
Scan tool 57
Code General scan Intake Air Temperature
No. Voltage Low
23
[Comment] l Sensor to
Background l Sensor internally shorted
l When the fuel system is in the open loop mode, the heated oxygen sensor cannot be l PCM failed
used for injector pulse width calculation.
,
l In this instance, the system uses information on air mass to determine the correct
width necessary to achieve the proper air/fuel ratio.
l Because air mass is related to temperature, information from the intake air temperature
,
sensor is necessary.
Range of Check
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l Intake air temperature sensor output voltage is less than 0.2 for 3 seconds.
NG
Check the intake air temperature sensor. (Refer to Replace
OK
Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Check the harness wire Repair
temperature sensor connector.
OK
TSB Revision
Scan tool 58
Code General scan tool Air Temperature Senspr
No. Voltage High
23
[Comment] Sensor signal circuit open
Background Sensor internally open
l When the fuel system is in the open mode, the heated oxygen sensor cannot be l Sensor ground circuit open
used for injector pulse width calculation. l PCM failed
l In this instance, the system uses on air mass to determine the correct pulse
width necessary to achieve the proper air/fuel ratio.
l Because air mass is related to temperature, information from the intake air temperature
sensor is necessary.
Range of Check
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l air temperature sensor output voltage is more than for 3
NG
Check the following Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the intake air Repair
temperature sensor connector.
NG
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
. .
Scan tool 59 ,
Set Condition .
l Knock sensor signal below minimum acceptable threshold voltage. .
,
Knock sensor output voltage is above 5.0 volts. I
if
.
.
NG
Repair
.
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Repair
connector.
OK
Replace the knock sensor.
.
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Replace the PCM.
.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 61
Code General scan tool
No. Injector Control Circuit c a u s e
27
[Comment] l Open or shorted injector control
Background l Open injector
l Grounds for the injector circuits are provided by the PCM. l Open
l Battery power is provided through the relay. (ASD relay) in PCM
l This DTC is set if an open or short-circuit is detected in the control for
the individual injector.
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: or more
l relay (ASD relay): ON
Engine: 3000 or less
Set Condition
l Counterelectromotive force is not detected for three seconds immediately after injectors
off.
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Disconnect PCM connector and short terminal (67) of
the harness-side connector to ground.
l Voltage between 16 and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
Check the harness between PCM and injector connector;
if necessary.
OK
NG
Check the Repair
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Scan tool 62
Code General scan tool Upstream Shorted to Volt;
No.
21
[Comment] l Heated oxygen sensor failed
Background l Wiring
l Upstream heated oxygen sensor requires a heater circuit for proper operation. l PCM ,
l The heater circuit is supplied with battery voltage through the relay relay):
l A failure in the sensors heater circuit prevents it from providing accurate data to the PCM.
l the PCM monitors more than 1.2 volts, the sensor has shorted to heater circuit voltage.
Range of Check
l Two or more minutes after the engine starts
l Engine coolant temperature: or more
Set Condition
l Heated oxygen sensor output voltage is more than 1.2 for 3 seconds.
NG
Replace
OK
NG
Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the heated oxygen Repair
sensor (front).
OK
Replace the PCM.
Scan tool 68
Code General scan tool PCM Failure Probable cause
No. Communications
53
[Comment] l PCM failed
Set Condition
l There is no communication between in the control module.
the PCM.
Probable cause
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 92
Code General scan tool Low Speed Fan
No. Circuit
,
35 ,
[Comment] l Relay coil open or shorted
Background l Ignition switch output circuit open
l The low speed radiator fan relay controls the low of the radiator fan. l Low speed radiator fan
l One side of the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is o r
turned to the ON position. l .
l The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the PCM.
l The PCM grounds the relay control circuit depending on engine coolant temperature etc. . .
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: 10 or more
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l An open or short-circuit condition is detected in the low speed radiator fan relay control
circuit for 3 seconds.
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the radiator fan relay drcuit.
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 55 and ground
(ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
l Connect a jumper wire between 55 and ground.
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK Radiator fan runs at low speed.
OK
NG
Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool 93
Code General scan tool High Speed Fan
No. Control Relay Circuit
35
[Comment] l Relay, coil open, shorted ..
Background .
l The high speed condenser fan relay controls the high speed operation of the condenser l High speed condenser fan relay control circuit
fan. o p e n
l One side of the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is PCM failed
turned to the ON position.
l The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the PCM.
l The PCM grounds the relay control circuit depending on engine coolant temperature and
other conditions.
Range of Check
l Battery voltage: or more
Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
An open or shorted condition is detected in the high speed condenser fan relay control
circuit for 3 seconds.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
. .
Scan tool 96
, me
l Disconnect the PCM connector.
l Can the scan tool communicate with the TCM?
No ,
Replace PCM.
,
NG
Measure at the data link connector. Check the following .
l Disconnect the PCM connector.
l Voltage between 27 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK:
l Voltage between and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK:
l Resistance between 27 and 28
OK: Check the harness wire between the PCM and the
.
OK OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
NG
Check the fuel pump Replace
OK ,
Measure at the fuel pump relay connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 6 and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
Check the harness wire between the
pump connector. Repair, if necessary.
N G
Check the following connector: Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the Repair
connector.
OK
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
NG
Check the exhaust Repair
l Check for cracks or exhaust leaks.
OK
N G
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Measure at the heated oxygen sensor (front) connector Check the following connector:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
relay (ASD relay)
everyapprox.
1. Voltage between 4 and ground
[Measure with the relay (ASD relay) on] Check the harness wire between the and
OK: Battery positive voltage the heated oxygen sensor connector. if
2. Continuity between 3 and ground
OK: Continuity 2. NG
Check the harness wire between the heated oxygen sensor and
the ground. Repair, if necessary.
OK
NG
Check the following connect Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE
1. NG
Measure at the heated oxygen sensor (rear) connector
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
10 relay (ASD relay)
everyapprox.
1. Voltage between 3 and ground [Measure with the relay
(ASD relay) on] Check the harness wire between (ASP
OK: Battery positive voltage the heated oxygen sensor
2. Continuity between 4 and ground
OK: Continuity 2. NG
Check the harness wire between the heated oxygen sensor and
the ground. Repair, if necessary.
OK
NG
Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the engine coolant temperature circuit.
05 Engine coolant temperature sensor (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 38.)
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the intake air temperature circuit.
27 Intake air temperature sensor (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the MAP sensor circuit.
11 MAP sensor reading (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 40.)
OK
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the following connectors:
66 Oxygen sensor volts (front) (Refer to
OK: Repeat and alternately when
idling.
Check the fuel pressure. (Refer to Check the harness wire between the PCM and the crankshaft
position sensor connector.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Scan tool
Cylinder Misfire
Code General scan tool Cylinder Misfire
No. Probable cause
Cylinder Misfire
Cylinder Misfire
43 ,
[Comment] l Spark plugs or ,
Background l
l Excessive engine misfire results in increased catalyst temperature. l . valves
l Severe misfire could cause catalyst damage. l Head gasket failed
l To prevent catalytic converter damage, the PCM monitors engine’ misfire. , head
l The PCM monitors for misfire during most engine operating conditions. l Injector failed
l When a misfire is detected, the PCM stores a diagnostic trouble code and causes the l Wiring harness and connectors failed
to either flash or illuminate continuously during active misfire. 6
Range of Check
l MAP voltage is less than
l Engine speed is between 2200 and
l Engine coolant temperature is greater than
l Vehicle speed less than
Set Condition
l 1000 Rev Misfire
The PCM detects misfire in more than 1.6% of the engine cycles in a 1000 revolution
period.
200 Rev Misfire
The PCM detects misfire in more than 15% of the engine cycles in a revolution period.
NG
OK
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
64
[Comment] l Catalytic converter
Background l Heated oxygen sensor failed
l During normal closed-loop operation, the PCM monitors the catalytic converter for hydrocar- l Exhaust
bon conversion (HC) efficiency. l . failed
l When HC conversion drops below 60 percent efficiency, the PCM stores a diagnostic l PCM failed
trouble code. .
Range of Check
l Engine coolant temperature greater than
l Vehicle speed greater than for 2 minutes
l Open throttle
l Closed loop operation
l Engine speed between 1248 and 2400
l MAP voltage between 1.50 and 2.60
Set Condition
l The switch (Lean/Rich) rate of the rear heated oxygen sensor reaches 70% of the front
sensors switch rate.
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) circuit
63 Downstream heated oxygen sensor volts (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE
(Refer to
Transaxle: range , ,
l with wide-open throttle .
OK: 600 1000
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (front) circuit (Refer to
02 Upstream heateed oxygen sensor volts INSPECTION PROCEDURE 42).
(Refer to
OK: 600 1000 during sudden racing
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Replace the heated oxygen sensor (front). 1
02 Upstream heated oxygen sensor volts
(Refer to
OK Repeat 0 400 and 600 1000 alternately when
idling.
OK
Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting’
TSB Revision 1
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
,
Check the transaxle range sensor
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.)
Repair
the PCM.
Check the harness wire between the transaxle range sensor and
the ianition switch connector.
OK NG
Repair
Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
65
[Comment] l PSP switch failed
Background l Wiring harness and connectors failed
l Data from the PSP switch allows the PCM to compensate for the additional load put on
the engine during steering maneuvers that require high steering pump pressure.
Range of Check
l Vehicle speed: 90 (56 mph) ,
Set Condition
l PSP switch output voltage: High for 30 seconds
N G
Measure at the the PSP
Disconnect the connector and measure at the component side.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
N G
Check the engine coolant temperature circuit.
05 Engine coolant temperature sensor. (Refer to INSPECTION -PROCEDURE 38.) .. ,, ,
. - -
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ Check the intake air temperature circuit. (Refer to
27 Intake air temperature sensor (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 39.)
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the MAP sensor circuit. (Refer to INSPECTION
11 MAP sensor reading (Refer to PROCEDURE
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) heatedoxygen circuit.
63 Oxygen sensor volts (rear) (Refer to PROCEDURE 41.) ,
l Transaxle: gear range
l Drive with wide-open throttle
OK:
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list)
02 Oxygen sensor volts (front) (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 42.) ,
OK: during sudden racing
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ
Oxygen sensor volts (front) (Refer
OK
Check the following items.
l Check the injectors for operation sound.
l Check the injectors for leakage.
l Check the evaporative emission control system.
l Check for contamination (water, kerosene, etc.) in the fuel.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the engine coolant temperature circuit.
05 Engine coolant temperature sensor (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 38.)
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ Check the intake air temperature circuit.
27 Intake air temperature sensor to (Refer to PROCEDURE 39.)
I
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ Check the MAP sensor circuit.
11 MAP sensor reading (Refer to (Refer
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (front) circuit.
02 Oxygen sensor volts (front) (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 42.)
OK: during sudden racing
TSB Revision
(NON-TURBO)>
NG
Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear). (Refer to R e p l a c e
OK
NG
Check the following Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the heated
sensor (rear) connector.
OK
NG
Check the thermostat. (Refer to GROUP 14 Thermostat.) Replace
OK
NG
Replace
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
NG
Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) Replace
OK
NG
Repair
OK
Check trouble svmptom.
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the Repair
sensor (rear) connector.
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the throffle position sensor system. (Refer.
07 Throffle position (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE F O R
CODE (Refer to INSPECTION
OK PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
._-
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the MAP sensor system. (Refer to INSPECTION
69 MAP gauge reading (Refer to t - PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
(Refer to INSPECTION
OK FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision ,
(NON-TURBO)>
NG
Check the following Repair
,
Check the camshaft position sensor.
(Refer to GROUP 16 Ignition System.)
I
OK
NG
Check the crankshaft position se Repair
(Refer to GROUP 16 Ignition System.)
OK
,
Check the timing belt. (Refer to GROUP 11 Timing Belt.)
Caution
When the following parts are replaced with new ones, be sure to use the scan to
the camshaft position sensor with the crankshaft position sensor again or disconnect the negative
battery cable for 10 seconds or more:
camshaft, camshaft sprocket, timing belt, tensioner, cylinder head, head gasket, crankshaft sprocket,
crankshaft, cylinder block, etc.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
No 5 Volts to MAP
No.
14
[Comment] Open circuit ,
Background l Signal circuit grounded
l The of 5 volts is to the MAP sensor. if this is extremely
the MAP sensor output deviates from standard .
Range of Check
Before starting engine and immediately after stopping engine
Set Condition ,
The output of MAP sensor is lower than the specified
OK
TSB Revision ,
ENGINE
Measure at the throttle position sensor connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side
OK
l
Check trouble symptom.
UK
Check the wire between the PCM
Repair, if necessary.
.
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
45 .
[Comment] Sensors related to
Background control
The transaxle control module monitors the malfunctions of sensors and actuators l TCM
regarding the transaxle if any malfunction is detected, the TCM informs the PCM l PCM failed
by sending a
Range of Check, Set Conditions
A malfunction is input from the TCM. ,
Revision
ENGINE Troubleshooting
.
Scan tool 138
Code General scan tool
No. Not
25
[Comment] l Idle air control motor failed
Range of Check l motor related circuit
l Engine: .
l Vehicle at rest and the brake applied
Set Condition
l speed differs from target idle by 200 for 12 seconds.
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the air control motor. (Refer to
12 position (Refer to
OK
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the radiator fan circuit.
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at harness side.
Voltage between 69 and ground
, .
(Ignition switch: ON) . ,
OK: Battery positive voltage
l Connect a jumper wire between 69 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Radiator fan runs at high speed.
OK
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
14
[Comment) l supply circuit grounded
l PCM failed
l The PCM supplies a regulated B-volts to the and MAP sensor.
l This DTC is set when both the and MAP sensors have the sensing
too low of voltage.
Range of Check
l Ignition switch: ON
Set Condition
l feed circuit drops below 4 volts for over four seconds.
N G
Measure at the position sensor connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 3 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON) Repair
OK: 4.8
OK
Check harness wire between the PCM and the TPS
necessary;
.
NG
Check the following Repair
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness wire between the PCM and fuel level sensor
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness wire between the PCM and fuel level sensor
connector.
TSB Revision
ENGINE Troubleshooting
Probable cause
Replace the
TSB Revision
ENGINE
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and upstream heated Repair
oxygen sensor connector.
OK
TSB Revision
,
--
Scan tool 156
, I
Code General scan tool Downstream to
No. Ground
21
[Comment] l Downstream heated oxygen
Background l harness and connectors
l When the heated oxygen sensor temperature is low, the sensor has the same electrical l PCM failed
characteristics as an insulator.
l The heated oxygen sensor output signal line is That is
is approx. when the heated oxygen sensor temperature is low.
l If the heated oxygen sensor output signal line is grounded, will become
Range of check
l Engine coolant temperature when the engine starts: or less
l Within three seconds after the engine starts
Set Conditions
The heated oxygen sensor output signal line is or less.
NG
Check the harness I.
oxygen sensor connector. . , ,
OK
11
[Comment]
Background , connected
l After the engine has been started, the PCM maintains an expected camshaft port l position
value. connected
l At every crankshaft leading edge, this value is updated to reflect the expected . Camshaft position sensor
change in the cam level. l
l At every crankshaft trailing edge, this value is compared to the true port level. sensor improperly
l If there is a disagreement between two values, then the diagnostic code is l sensor
set.
Range of Check
l Engine: running
Set Condition
l Cam and crank signals have been out of sync, than times.
NG
Check the following connectors: .
A-l 06
OK
__
Check no cam sync. signal at PCM. (Refer to
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
CODE.
Check no crank reference signal at PCM. (Refer to
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
NG
Check the evaporative Replace
(Refer to GROUP Emission Control System.)
OK
NG
Check the evaporative emission purge solenoid. Replace
(Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control System.)
OK
NG
Check the evaporative emission purge solenoid. Replace
(Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control System.)
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
NG
Measure at the evaporative emission ventilation solenoid connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 2 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK Check the harness wire between ignition switch and
emission ventilation solenoid connector. Repair, if
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 77 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
Check the harness wire between PCM and emission
ventilation solenoid connector. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> .
..
Scan tool 184
Code General scan tool Evaporative Emission Ventila-
No. tion Switch or Mechanical Fault
31
[Comment] l Evaporative emission
Background failed
l When the solenoid diaphragm moves up and down by activating the evaporative emission l Open or short circuit
the solenoid switch turns on and off. l clogged
l The PCM detects how often the solenoid is activated by counting the ON and OFF conditions l PCM failed
of the solenoid switch.
Range of Check, Set Condition
l The solenoid is activated, but the solenoid switch does not turn on and off.
‘ I
.
NG
Repair
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting’
Trouble symptom
The check engine/malfunction indicator lamp does not illuminate right after the ignition 3
malfunction switch is turned to the ON position.
indicator lamp
and related
parts The check engine/malfunction indicator lamp remains illuminated and never goes 4
Surge 19
Knocking 20
21
Too high CO and HC concentration when idling 22
Revision
I ENGINE
Starting Won’t The starter is used to crank the engine, but there is no combustion
within the cylinders, and the engine
Fires up and dies There is combustion within the cylinders, but then the
stalls. .
Incorrect idle speed The engine doesn’t idle at the usual correct Speed.”
Engine stall (Die out) The engine stalls when the foot is taken ‘from pedal,
regardless of whether vehicle is moving or not.
Engine stall (Pass out) The engine stalls when the accelerator pedal is depressed
is being used.
Hesitation “Hesitation” is the delay in response of the vehicle speed (engine
speed) that occurs accelerator is depressed in order to
accelerate from the speed at which the vehicle is
temporary drop in vehicle speed (engine speed)
sharp sound like a hammer striking the cylinder walls during driving
which adversely affects driving.
on condition in which the engine continues to run after the ignition
is turned to OFF. Also called “Dieseling”.
Normal
Vehicle Vehicle
speed speed
Idling Stumble
I
Time Time
I Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
The cause is probably a defect in the power supply system (including ground) for the on-board
NG .
OK Check trouble Check between
and
..
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
Scan tool communication with PCM is not possible. Probable
[Comment] Malfunction of- power supply
One of the following causes may be suspected. o f
l No power supply to PCM l Open circuit between PCM and data link con-
* Defective ground circuit of PCM
l Defective PCM
l Improper communication line between PCM and scan tool
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
Check the harness wire between PCM and data link connector.
OK
NG
Check the power supply and ignition circuit. Repair
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 23.)
Revision
,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3
The check indicator. lamp not
illuminate right after the ignition switch is turned to the
position. ,
[Comment] l bulb
The PCM causes the check engine/malfunction indicator lamp to illuminate for three seconds, l Defective check engine/malfunction
immediately after the ignition switch is turned to ON. lamp circuit
If the check engine/malfunction indicator lamp does not illuminate immediately after the ignition l of the
switch is turned to ON, one of the malfunctions listed at right probably occurred.
NG
Check the power supply and ignition circuit.
10 Battery voltage (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION
NG
NG Replace the PCM. I
Check a burnt-out bulb. Replace
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4
The check engine/malfunction indicator lamp remains Probable cause
illuminated and never goes out.
[Comment] l Short-circuit between the check
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the PCM is indicator lamp and
detecting a problem in a sensor or actuator, or that one of the malfunctions listed at right has l Malfunction of the PCM
occurred.
Measure at the combination meter connector Check the harness wire between meter and PCM
lDisconnect the connector, and measure at the harness connector. Repair, if necessary.
side.
l Disconnect the PCM connector.
l Continuity between 51 and ground
OK: No continuity
O K
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
Cranks, won’t start Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that a spark plugs are fouled defective, l Malfunction of the fuel pump system
or that the supply of fuel to the combustion chamber is defective. l Malfunction of the injector system
in addition, foreign materials (water, kerosene, etc.) may be mixed with the fuel. l Malfunction of the PCM
l Foreign materials in fuel
,
Can any sound be heard . Check the injector control circuit. Carry out procedures 19, 20, 21,
(Refer to in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
,
Yes FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)=,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
Fires up and dies. Probable
[Comment] l of the ignition system
In such cases as the above, the cause is probably that the spark plugs are generating sparks l Malfunction of the injector system
but the sparks are weak, or the initial mixture for starting is not appropriate. l Foreign fuel
l Poor compression
l of the PCM
Can any sound be heard Check the injector control circuit. Carry out procedures
(Refer to in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Yes FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
Hard starting I Probable cause I
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the spark is weak and ignition is difficult, l Malfunction of the injector system
the initial mixture for starting is not appropriate, or sufficient compression pressure is not being l Inappropriate gasoline use
obtained. l Poor
No
Can any sound be heard fro Check the injector control circuit. Carry out procedures 19, 20, 21,
(Refer to in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Yes FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 8
Unstable idle (Rough idle, hunting) Probable cause
[Comment] Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the ignition system, l Malfunction of air-fuel ratio system
idle air control motor or compression pressure is defective. l Malfunction of the system
Because the range of possible causes is broad, inspection is narrowed down to simple items. l Malfunction of the evaporative emission
purge solenoid system
l Malfunction of the EGR system
l Poor compression
l Drawing air into exhaust system
Check the injector control circuit: (Carry out procedures 19, 20, 21,
OK in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.)
Scan tool: Inspection when idle speed is unstable. (Refer
to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 32.)
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 9
Idle speed is high. (Improper idle speed)
[Comment] l
In such cases as the above, the cause is probably that the intake air volume during idle is’ l Intake manifold vacuum leak
too great. b o d y
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 10
Idle speed is low. (Improper idle speed) Probable cause
,
[Comment] l control motor
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the intake air volume during idling is l Malfunction of the’ throttle body
too small.
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
07 motor. (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
OK
Check trouble
SCAN TOOL INPUT STATE TESTS list) Checktransaxle range sensorcircuit. INSPECTION
position switch (transaxle range switch) PROCEDURE 25.)
(Refer to
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 11
When the engine is cold, it stalls at idle. (Die out)
[Comment] l Malfunction of the idle air control
In such cases as the above, the cause is probably that the air/fuel mixture is inappropriate when l Malfunction of the fhroffle body
the engine is cold, or that the intake air volume is insufficient. . l Malfunction of the injector System
l Malfunction: system
.
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently? After warming-up, let the engine run at idling for 10 minutes.
I
NO ,
SCAN TOOL DTC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output? TROUBLE CODES
I -
N O .
.:
Does the engine stall right after the accelerator pedal is Check the throffle body minimum air (Refer to
released
NO . . .
Is engine-idling stable after the warming-up? NO
Check for unstable idle (Rough hunting)
YES (Refer to INSPECTION 8.)
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the idle air control motor circuit. (Refer to
07 motor (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLE CODE
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE
, .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 12 ..
When the engine is hot, it stalls at idle. (Die out)
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that ignition system, mixture, idle l Malfunction control
air control motor or compression pressure is defective. Malfunction of the system
In addition, if the engine stalls, the cause may also be a defective connector contact. l into intake system
l Improper connector contact
YES
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently After warming-up, let the engine run at idling for 10 minutes.
NO
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output? TROUBLE CODES.
NO
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Checktheidleaircontrolmotorcircuit. INSPECTION
07 motor. (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
OK
Check the injector for operation sound. Check the injector control circuit. Carry out procedures 20,
(Refer to in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.
Does the engine stall right Check the throttle body minimum air flow (Refer to
released
NO.
Does the engine stall easily again While carrying out an intermittent malfunction simulation test (Refer
YES to GROUP 00 How to Cope with Intermittent Malfunctions), check
for sudden changes in the signals shown below.
Scan tool: Inspection when engine stalls when the engine l Crankshaft position sensor and
is warm and idling (Refer to INSPECTION
PROCEDURE 33.) l MAP sensor signal Fuel pump signal
l Injector drive signal l power supply voltage
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 13
The engine stalls when accelerating. (Pass out) Probable cause
[Comment] l Injectors failed
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably misfiring due to a weak spark, or an inappropriate l Malfunction of the ignition system
air/fuel mixture when the accelerator is depressed.
YES
Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
YES
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently? After warming-up, let the engine run at idling for
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 15
Hesitation, sag or stumble Probable cause
[Comment] Malfunction of the ignition
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that ignition system, air/fuel mixture or Malfunction of air-fuel ratio control
compression pressure is defective. l Malfunction of the fuel supply
l of the EGR. solenoid
l P o o r
NG
Check the injectors for op Check the injector control circuit.
out procedures 20, 21,
(Refer to in’ INSPECTION PROCEDURE
FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
. ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 16
Acceleration shock ,
YES
Refer to INSPECTION CHART DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 17
Deceleration shock Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of ‘system
Malfunction of the system is suspected.
I I I
YES
Refer to CHART FOR
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
Check trouble I
NG
NG
SCAN TOOL SENS l Check the throttle position sensor
07 Throttle position (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 43.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 18
Poor acceleration Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition system
Defective ignition system, abnormal air-fuel ratio, poor compression pressure, etc. are suspected. l Malfunction of air-fuel ratio
l of the fuel supply
Poor acceleration
l Clogged exhaust system
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
NG
Check the injector Carry out procedures 19, 20,
in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”. ,
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 19
Surge Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition system
Defective ignition system, abnormal air-fuel are suspected. l Malfunction of air-fuel ratio control system
l Malfunction of the EGR solenoid system
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
NG
Check the injectors for op Check the injector control circuit. Carry out procedures 21,
(Refer to in “INSPECTION PROCEDURE
FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES”.
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 20
Knocking
[Comment] l Defective knock sensor
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the detonation control is defective or l Inappropriate value of the
the heat value of the spark plug is inappropriate.
YES
Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the knock sensor circuit (Refer to INSPECTION
09 Knock sensor volts (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
OK
Dieseling cause
[Comment] l Fuel leakage from injectors
Fuel leakage from injectors is suspected.
Revision
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 22
Too high CO and HC concentration when idling cause
[Comment] of the air-fuel ratio control system.
Abnormal air-fuel ratio is suspected. l Deteriorated catalyst .
NG
Check the intake air temperature sensor circuit.
27 Intake air temperature sensor. (Refer to (Refer to 39.)
.
NG
Check the MAP sensor circuit
11 MAP sensor reading. (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 40.)
I
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) circuit.
83 sensor volts (rear) (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 41.)
l Transaxle gear
range
l Driving with the throttle wide open
OK:
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list)
02 sensor volts (front) (Refer to
OK: 1 when suddenlv
NG
TSB Revisiqn
. . , ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 23 .
Power supply system and ignition ,
[Comment] Malfunction
When an ignition switch turns ON, battery positive voltage is supplied to the PCM. l Improper connector contact, open or
short-circuited harness
l Disconnected ground wire
l Malfunction of the
NG
Measure at the PCM connectors
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness
side
1. Voltage between 6 and ground (Ignition switch: ON) NG
OK: Battery positive voltage (when the terminal 67 is Check trouble symptoms.
grounded)
2. Continuity between 47. 50 and ground NG
OK: Continuity
3. Voltage between 20 and ground Check the’ and
OK: Battery positive voltage connector. Repair, if necessary.
.
the PCM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 24
Fuel pump system
[Comment] , Malfunction of the fuel pump relay
The PCM turns the fuel pump relay ON when the engine is cranking or running, and this supplies Malfunction of the
power to drive the fuel pump. or
short-circuited harness wire
l Malfunction of the PCM
NG
Check the fuel pump operation. Check the
l Disconnect the fuel pump relay connector. (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE
l Use a jumper wire to apply battery positive voltage to
the relay connector (2).
OK: Fuel pump activates.
NG
Check the fuel pump relay. Replace
OK
Check the fuel pump drive control circuit.
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 37.)
TSB
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 25
Transaxle range sensor circuit
[Comment]
The transaxle range sensor inputs the condition of the selector lever, i.e. whether it is in or Improper connector contact, open circuit
range or in some other range, to the PCM.
The PCM controls the idle air control motor based on this input.
NG
Check harness wire between
A-l PCM transaxle range
OK sensor connector.
O K
Check trouble symptom.
OK Replace the PCM.
,
Replace the PCM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 26
A/C switch and A/C compressor clutch relay system Probable cause
l Malfunction of A/C control
l Malfunction of A/C switch
motor, and also operates the A/C compressor magnetic clutch. Improper connector open
short-circuited harness wire
l Malfunction of PCM
NG
Check the A/C compressor clutch relay. Replace
(Refer to GROUP 55 On-vehicle Service.)
OK
Measure at the PCM Check the system. (Refer to GROUP 55
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness
side.
l Voltage between 64 and ground, and 38 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON)
(A/C switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
l Connect a jumper wire between 64 and ground.
(Ignition switch: ON)
(A/C switch: ON)
OK: A/C compressor clutch turns ON.
OK
1
NG
Repair
A-l 06, A-l 07
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 27
Fan motor relay system (Radiator fan, condenser fan)
[Comment] l Malfunction of fan motor relay
The fan motor relay is controlled by the power transistor inside the PCM turning ON and OFF l Malfunction of fan motor .
improper connector contact, open or
short-circuited wire
l Malfunction of the PCM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 28
Ignition circuit system 1
[Comment] Malfunction of relay
The PCM interrupts the ignition coil primary current by turning the ignition power transistor inside Improper connector contact, circuit Or
the PCM ON and OFF. short-circuited
l Malfunction of the PCM
NG
Measure at the ignition coil connector Check the following Repair
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness
side. OK
SCAN TOOL Actuator test
Check trouble
relay relay) is turned on and off every 1
TSB
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 29
Scan tool: Inspection when no initial combustion occurs.
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS list) Check the power supply system and circuit.
10 Battery voltage (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 23.)
OK
Does the camshaft rotate, while cranking the engine Check fming belt for breakage.’
(When oil filler cap is removed.)
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check no crank reference signal at’ (Refer to
17 Engine speed INSPECTION TROUBLE CODES
Cranking speed is displayed.
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator te Check the fuel pump system:
51 Fuel pump relay (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION 24.)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 30
Scan tool: Inspection when incomplete combustion occurs.
.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 31
Inspection when hunting occurs.
,
Check the body minimum air flow.
(Refer to
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 32
Scan tool: Inspection when idle speed is unstable.
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check MAP sensor circuit.
11 MAP sensor reading (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the engine coolant temperature sensor
(Refer to PROCEDURE-%)
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear)
63 sensor volts (rear) (Refer to (Refer to P. INSPECTION
l Transaxle gear ..
range
l Drive with wide open throttle
OK: 1,000
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the fuel pressure.
02 sensor volts (front) (Refer to (Refer to
OK: Changes between and ,000
during idling
TSB Revision
(NON-TURBO)> .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 33
Scan tool: Inspection when engine. stalls when, engine warm
.
N G ’
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the MAP sensor circuit
11 MAP sensor reading (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit.
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 38.)
.
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) circuit.
63 sensor volts (rear) (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION
l Transaxle gear ,
range
l with wide open throttle
OK: 1,000
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the fuel pressure.
02 sensor volts (front) (Refer to (Refer to
OK: Changes between and
1,000 during idling
,
SCAN TOOL INPUT STATE TESTS (Data list) Check the power steering switch (Refer
Al Power steering switch (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
.
NG
SCAN TOOL OUTPUT Check the switch and
A/C clutch relay (Refer to (Refer to
.
OK
TSB
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 34
Scan tool: Inspection when hesitation, sag, stumble or poor acceleration occurs.’
NG
Check the intake air
27 Intake air temperature (Refer to (Refer to PROCEDURE 39.)
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the MAP sensor ..
11 MAP sensor reading. (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 40.)
.
NG
Check the engine
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE
OK
NG
Check the position sensor
07 Throttle position sensor (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION 43.)’
I
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the EGR solenoid circuit. (Refer to INSPECTION
16 EGR solenoid (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) circuit.
63 sensor (rear) (Refer to
Transaxle gear
range
l Drive with wide open . --
OK: ,000 .
,
, ,
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the heated oxygeri sensor (front) circuit.
02 sensor volts (front) (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 42.)
OK: Changes between 1,000 during sudden
racing
TSB Revision
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 35
Scan tool: Inspection when surge occurs.
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the intake air’
27 Intake air temperature sensor (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION. PROCEDURE 39.)
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the MAP sensor it.
11 MAP sensor reading (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 40.)
OK
N G
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ Check the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit.
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 38.)
NG
SCAN TOOL SENSOR Check the position circuit.
07 Throttle position sensor (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 43.)
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the EGR solenoid circuit- (Refer to INSPECTION
16 EGR solenoid (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
OK
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) NG
63 sensor volts (rear) (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 41.)
l Transaxle gear
range
l with wide open throttle
OK:
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Check the heated oxygen sensor (front)
02 sensor volts (front) (Refer to (Refer to PROCEDURE 42.)
OK: Changes between 1,000 during sudden
racing
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 36
Check the fuel pump circuit.
Measure at the fuel pump connector Check the harness wire between fuel pump-and
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness necessary.
side.
l Continuity between 2 and ground
OK:
OK
NG
Check the following connect Repair
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 37
Check the fuel pump drive control circuit.
. .
Check the ignition switch. to
Check the harness wire between the battery fuel ‘pump relay
connector. Repair, if necessary
NG
Measure at the PCM connector Check the following con- & p a i r
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness
side. O K
l Voltage between 74 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: positive voltage Check trouble symptom.
OK NG
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
Replace the PCM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 38
, ,
Check the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit. I
NG
Checktheenginecool Replace
OK
Measure at the engine coolant temperature sensor connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 2 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: 4.7-5.2 Repair
Continuity between 1 and ground
OK: Continuity
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the engine coolant
temperature sensor connector. I
OK NG
Replace the PCM.
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
OK
NG
Measure at the intake air temperature sensor connector Check the following connectors:
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side:
l Voltage between 2 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: 4.7-5.2
l Continuity between 1 and ground
OK: Continuity
OK Check the harness wire between the PCM and the intake
temperature sensor connector.
OK
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
TSB Revision
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 40 ,
NG
Measure at the MAP sensor connector the following
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side. . .
OK
l Voltage between 2 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: 4.7-5.2
l Continuity between 1 and ground
OK: Continuity
OK Check the harness between the PCM the MAP sensor
connector.
Replace
OK
R e p a i r
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 41
Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) circuit.
NG . .
Check the heated oxygen sensor (rear) (Refer to Replace
OK
NG
Measure at the heated oxygen sensor (rear) connector Check the following
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
Ok
l Continuity between 2 and around
Check the harness wire between the PCM and heated oxygen
sensor (rear) connector. Repair, if necessary.
Repair
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 42
Check the heated oxygen sensor (front) circuit.
NG
Replace
NG
Measure at the heated (front) connector Check the following connector:
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
OK
l Continuity between 2 and ground
OK: Continuity Check trouble symptom.
OK
Check the harness wire between the PCM and heated oxygen
sensor (front) connector. Repair, if
NG
Check the following connector:
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 43
Check the throttle position sensor circuit.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 44
Check the vehicle-speed sensor and speedometer.
NG
Check the followina connector: Repair
OK
Yes
SCAN TOOL SENSOR READ TESTS (Data list) Replace the PCM.
65 Vehicle speed
l Is actual vehicle speed indicated during driving?
. .
.
No I):
NG ..
Repair
. -
,
Check trouble symptom. .
NG
Check the harness wire between the PCM and the transaxle control Repair
module connector.
OK
INSPECTION
PROCEDURE 45.)
OK
Check the automatic transaxle control system.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 45
Check the speedometer.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
sensor
volts l Transaxle:
gear Engine: 3,500 or 000
(Heated range
oxygen l Drive with more
sensor open throttle
rear)
Actual vehicle
Vehicle speed the
Drive at a constant speed. speedometer are .
speed
the same.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
,
inspection
Inspection Normal condition
Inspection contents page
No. item No.
Engine: Warm When at 4,000
Air/fuel mixture engine is suddenly Lean
made leaner decelerated.
when
decelerating, and
is made richer When engine is Rich
sensor suddenly raced.
state when racing.
(Heated Engine: Warm Procedure
66 oxygen
The heated Engine: Idle
sensor
oxygensensor
-front) Lean Center
signal is used to
check the air/fuel
mixture ratio. and (Changes)
control condition Engine: 2,000
is also checked
by the PCM.
MAP l Engine: Warm, idle The same
Procedure
39 l Use a vacuum gauge to measure the indication as the
reading plenum vacuum. vacuum gauge
Total spark Approx.
71 Engine: Warm, idle
advance
sensor
state l Transaxle:
(Heated gear Engine: 3,500 or Procedure
‘4 range more
oxygen l Drive with
sensor open throttle
rear)
Code No.
Fuel level
‘8 sensor
Idle
Calculated Engine: Warm
load value M/T 6-12
2,500
9-14
TSB Revision
ENGINE
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> , ,
Item Inspection ,
Inspection contents Normal condition
No. item No.
TSB Revision
ACTUATOR TEST REFERENCE TABLE
Inspection
Item Inspection
Drive contents Inspection contents
No. item
Code
04 Injector
,
05 Injector
Injects every 1.4 Operating sound
Ignition switch: ON
seconds can be heard. Code
06 Injector
Code
Injector
I operating Code
fluctuates gnition switch: ON can be
motor 2.8 seconds.
energized,
fan and
Radiator off, low Procedure
gnition switch: ON fan
fan relay high every 2.8
at low
high speeds
WC clutch Procedure
A/C clutch on and off Ignition switch: I sound can
relay 1.4 seconds. A/C switch: ON
heard.
relay Code
on and off sound
(ASD gnition switch: ON
1.4 seconds be heard. No. 1
relay).
Evapora- Code
on and off sound
tive purge gnition switch: ON
1.4 seconds be heard
solenoid.
Engine
Tachome- 45.5 Hz display reads Procedure
gnition switch: ON
ter output 2300
nin.
Code
EGR on and off sound
switch: ON
1.4 seconds. be heard.
No.
speed off and low switch: ON
6
relay 0.7 seconds. 0 35
TSB Revision .
ENGINE
Inspection
Drive contents Inspection contents Normal condition procedure
item
NOTE
If an injector operates properly, it releases fuel when activated by the PCM. Prolonged injector actuation; particularly
on vehicles equipped with multi-port systems may cause excessive amounts of fuel to be deposited in
manifold. Hydrostatic lock may result.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
THROTTLE BODY MINIMUM AIR FLOW
CHECK
1. Start the engine and warm it up until the engine coolant
is heated to or higher and then stop the
engine.
PCV valve hose 2. Disconnect the PCV valve hose from the intake manifold
nipple.
3. Attach Air Metering Fitting (0.125 in. orifice)
to the intake manifold nipple.
4. Disconnect the inch idle purge line from the throttle
body nipple. Cap the inch nipple.
5. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector.
6. Restart the engine. Allow engine to idle for at least one
minute. All accessories should be off.
TSB Revision I
(NON-TURBO)> . .
(c) Using a soft scuff pad, clean the top and bottom
of throttle body bore and the edges and manifold
side of, ‘the throttle blade. The edges of the throttle
blade and portions of the throttle bore that are closest
to the throttle blade when closed, must be free of
deposits.
(d) Use compressed air to dry the throttle body.
(e) Inspect throttle body for foreign material.
(f) Install throttle body on manifold.
(g) Repeat steps 1 through 14. If the minimum air flow
is still not within specifications, the problem is not
caused by the throttle body.
11. Shut off engine.
12. Remove Air Metering Fitting from, the intake
manifold PCV nipple. Reinstall the
13. Uncap the throttle body idle and connect
the idle purge line.
14. Remove the scan tool. . .
. ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE
l Fuel pressure too low Clogged fuel filter Replace fuel filter
l No fuel pressure in fuel return
hose Fuel leaking return side due to poor Replace fuel pressure regulator
fuel regulator valve seating or settled
spring
Fuel pressure drops sharply Checkvalve in fuel pump is held open Replace fuel pump
ately after engine is stopped
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle
FUEL PUMP
(HOW TO REDUCE FUEL LINE PRESSURE)
Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> .
13100210139
COMPONENT LOCATION
NOTE
The “Name” column is in alphabetical order.
TSB Revision
On-vehicle Inspection of
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
of
ENGINE, , ,
Evaporative
TSB Revision
TSB Revision
28 (NON-TURBO)>
of
RELAY RELAY)
RELAY CHE .
1. Remove the relay.
2. Check that there is (4) , and (6)
terminals. .
Standard value:
.
,
Bottom view
of relay
I Connected Continuity
Disconnected No continuity
I 25 (77) 9-11 I
I
INSTALLATION
1. Apply sealant to threaded portion.
Specified sealant: Loctite 24200 or equivalent
2. Install intake air temperature sensor and tighten it to
specified torque.
Sensor tightening torque: 7 (5
3. Fasten harness connectors securely.
TSB Revision
On-vehicle Inspection of
ENGINE
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CHECK
1. Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
2. Measure the resistance between the sensor terminals.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply sealant to threaded
Specified sealant: Loctite 24200 or equivalent
2. engine coolant sensor tighten
it to specified torque.
Sensor tightening torque: 7 (5
3. Fasten harness connectors securely.
TSB Revision
On-vehicle of
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
oxygen sensor
1. Disconnect the heated oxygen
Engine
If-you make
ratio rich by racing the
engine repeatedly, a
normal heated oxygen
sensor will output a
voltaae of
8. If the sensor is defective, replace the heated
sensor.
NOTE
For removal and installation of the heated sensor,
refer to GROUP 15 Exhaust Pipe, Main Muffler.
TSB Revision
On-vehicle Inspection of
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> 1
2. removal and installation of the oxygen sensor,
refer to GROUP 15 Exhaust Pipe, Main
TSB Revision
32 (NON-TURBO)>
On-vehicle, Inspection of
INJECTOR CHECK
Measurement of Resistance between Terminals
1. Remove the injector connector.
2. Measure the resistance between terminals.
Standard value: [at
3. Install the injector connector
TSB Revision
On-vehicle Inspection of
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-Installation Operation
l Fuel Line Pressure Reduction (Refer to P. l Battery and Air Intake Hose Installation
Battery and Air Hose Removal l Fuel Leakage Inspection
2.5 Nm
I
Engine oil I 6
00003911
Removal steps
1. High-pressure fuel hose connection 6. Retainers
2. O-ring
3. Injector harness connector
4. Fuel rail
5. Injector connectors
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
THROTTLE BODY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pm-removal
l Battery Removal
3.9 Nm 5
2.9
Removal steps
1. Air intake hose 5. motor connector
2. Accelerator cable connection 6. Throttle
3. Vacuum hose connection 7. Throttle body body gasket
4. TPS connector
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Throttle Body
2.2
2 I
..
. .
steps
1. motor assembly
2. Throttle body
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> General
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Fuel Injection System consists The ECM carries out activities such as fuel
of sensors which detect the engine conditions, injection control, idle air control and ignition
the ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) which timing control.
controls the system based on signals from these In addition, the ECM is equipped with several
sensors, and actuators which operate under diagnostic test modes which simplify trouble-
the control of the ECM. shooting when a problem develops.
..
FUEL INJECTION CONTROL
The injector drive times and injector timing are crankshaft. The firing is This
controlled so that the optimum air/fuel mixture is called The provides a richer
is supplied to the engine to correspond to the air/fuel mixture by carrying out “open-loop” con-
continually-changing engine operation condi- trol when the engine is cold or operating under
tions. high load in order to maintain engine
A single injector is mounted at the intake port performance.
of each cylinder. Fuel is sent under pressure In addition, when the engine is warm or operat-
from the fuel tank by the fuel pump, with the ing under normal conditions, the ECM controls
pressure regulated by the fuel pressure regula- the air/fuel mixture by using the heated oxygen
tor. The regulated fuel is distributed to each sensor signal to carry out “closed-loop” control
of the injectors. in order to obtain the theoretical air/fuel mixture
Fuel injection is normally carried out once for ratio that provides the maximum cleaning per-
each cylinder for every two rotations of the formance from the three way catalyst.
IDLE AIR CONTROL
The idle speed is kept at the optimum speed coolant temperature and air conditioning load.
by controlling the amount of air that bypasses In addition, when the air’ conditioning switch
the throttle valve in accordance with changes is turned off and on while the is
in idling conditions and engine load during id- the motor operates to adjust the throttle
ling. valve bypass air amount in accordance with
The ECM drives the idle air control (IAC) motor the engine load conditions in order to avoid
to keep the engine running at the pre-set idle fluctuations in the engine speed.
target speed in accordance with the engine
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
ENGINE>
, ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND
Engine (Turbo)>
Item
Throttle body Throttle bore mm (in.) 5 4
Throttle position sensor Variable resistor type
Idle air control motor Stepper motor type [Stepper. type ‘by-pass’ air
control system the air
Closed throttle position switch Rotary contact type,
Engine control model No.
module (ECM) ,
Sensors Volume air flow sensor Karman vortex type
,
Barometric pressure sensor ,
Intake air temperature sensor Thermistor type
Engine coolant temperature sensor Thermistor type
Heated oxygen sensor Zircon type
Vehicle speed sensor Electromagnetic resistance element ‘type
.
Park/neutral position switch Contact switch type
Camshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor Hall element type
Knock sensor Piezoelectric type
Power steering pressure switch Contact switch type
Manifold differential pressure sensor Semiconductor type
fuel injection (MFI) relay Contact switch type
Fuel pump relay Contact switch type
Injector type and number Electromagnetic type, 4
Injector identification mark
solenoid Duty cycle type solenoid valve
Evaporative emission purge solenoid Duty cycle type solenoid valve
Fuel pressure solenoid ON/OFF type solenoid valve
Turbocharger waste gate solenoid Duty cycle type solenoid valve
pressure Regulator (psi) 294 (43)
egulator
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> General
Engine>
Item Specifications
Throttle body Throttle bore mm (in.) 54 (2.13)
Throttle position sensor Variable resistor type
Idle air control motor DC motor type [DC by-pass air control system
with the fast idle air
Closed throttle position switch Rotary contact type, within throttle position sensor
Idle air control valve position sensor Hall element type
Engine control Identification model No.
module (ECM)
Sensors Volume air flow sensor Karman vortex type
Barometric pressure sensor Semiconductor type .
TSB Revision
E N G I N E ( T U R B O )
AND ENGINE> General ..
Evaporative
emission
canister
Manifold differential
sensor
II
ion ..
Intake air
temperature
sensor
Volume air flow
sensor .
in
pres: sure sensor) II
Engine coolant
temperature sensor
Knock sensor
Turbocharger waste TC waste
gate solenoid gate actuator
Heated oxygen
sensor (rear)
Heated oxygen
sensor (front)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> General lnformaiton
,
Engine>
Heated oxygen sensor Power supply Engine control Injector l Fuel pump relay
(front) l Vehicle speed sensor Evaporative emission l Fuel pump relay
Volume air flow sensor l switch purge solenoid
Intake air temperature Park/neutral position air control motor injection
sensor switch EGR solenoid relay
Throttle position sensor Power steering pressure Evaporative emission l
Closed throttle position switch ventilation solenoid clutch relay
switch l Ignition switch ST l Check
Camshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sen-
sor output
Barometric pressure sen- coil, ignition
sor
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor
valve position sensor
Heated oxygen sensor
(rear)
Manifold differential pres-
sure sensor
tank differential pres-
sure sensor
Fuel tank
pressure
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Service
Standard value
,
Basic at curb idle
Curb idle
speed when A/C is ON 850 100 in Neutral
Basic idle speed 750 50
Throttle position sensor adjusting voltage 400 1,000
Throttle position sensor resistance 3.5 6.5
Idle air control motor coil resistance 28 33 [at
Intake air temperature sensor 2.3 3.0 ,
resistance
0.30 0.42
Engine coolant temperature sensor 2.1 2.7
resistance
0.26 0.36
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage 0.6 1
Fuel pressure (psi) Vacuum hose 289 309 (42 45) at curb idle Engine (Turbo)>
disconnected 330 350 (47 50) at curb idle Engine>
Vacuum hose Approx. 230 (33) at curb idle Engine (Turbo)>
connected Approx. 270 (38) at curb idle Engine>
Injector coil resistance 2 3 [at Engine (Turbo)>
13 16 [at
solenoid coil resistance 36 44 [at
Ivaporative emission purge solenoid coil resistance
pressure solenoid 36 44 [at Engine (Turbo)>
waste gate solenoid 36 44 [at
SEALANT
Item Specified sealant
coolant temperature sensor threaded portion Nut Locking Part No. 4171 or equivalent
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Scan tool
Revision I
(TURBO)
TROUBLESHOOTING .?’
DIAGNOSTIC FLOW CHART I:--
Verify complaint.
Read the diagnostic trouble code (Refer to Read the diagnostic trouble code (Refer to
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
DTC No.
Closed throttle position switch malfunction
Power steering pressure sensorcircuit range/performance
Transaxle range sensor circuit malfunction (RPNDL Input)
Transaxle fluid temperature sensor circuit malfunction
Turbocharger waste gate actuator malfunction Engine (Turbo)>
Turbocharger waste gate solenoid malfunction Engine
Fuel pressure solenoid malfunction Engine (Turbo)>
Manifold differential sensor circuit malfunction
Serial communication link malfunction
PG malfunction
Solenoid assy malfunction
Enaine coolant temoerature level circuit (to malfunction
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE>
ON-BOARD DIAGNOSTICS
The engine control module monitors the input/out- Caution
put signals (some signals at all times and the others If the sensor connector ‘is disconnected wlth
under specified conditions) of the engine control the’ ignition switch turned on, the diagnostic
module. trouble code is In send
When a malfunction has continued for a specified the diagnostic trouble code erase to the
time or longer since the irregular signal is initially engine control module in order to erase the
monitored, the engine control module judges that diagnostic memory.
a malfunction has occurred. The 45 diagnostic items are as follows,
After the ECM first detects a malfunction, a diagnos- and if plural items are activated, they are all indi-
tic trouble code is recorded when the engine is cated sequentially from the smallest code number.
restarted and the same malfunction is re-detected.
Caution
However, for items marked with a a diagnostic
The diagnostic trouble code of ignition
trouble code is recorded on the first detection of
adjustment signal is output whenever
the malfunction.
for ignition timing adjustment Is grounded.
There are 45 diagnostic items, and the diagnostic
Therefore, it is not a malfunction that the code
results can be read out with a scan tool.
is output when adjusting
Moreover, since memorization of the diagnostic
trouble codes is backed up directly by the battery, The ECM records the diagnostic, trouble code and
the diagnostic results are memorized even if the the engine operating conditions at the time the
ignition key is turned off. The diagnostic trouble malfunction was detected.’ These are called
codes will, however, be erased when the battery “freeze frame” data.
terminal or the engine control module connector This data indicates the engine operafing condition
is disconnected. from when nothing at all is detected to the initial
In addition, the diagnostic trouble code can also detection of malfunction.
be erased by turning the ignition switch to ON and This data can be read by using the scan tool, and
sending the diagnostic trouble code erase signal can then be used in simulation tests trouble-
from the scan tool to the engine control module. shooting. Data items are as follows.,,
Data Unit
Engine coolant temperature
.
Engine speed
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
.
OBD-II DRIVE CYCLE
All kinds of diagnostic trouble code can be monitored by carrying out a drive test in
with the following six drive cycle patterns. In other words, carrying out such a drive test
to reproduce any kind of which involves causing the check indicator
to illuminate and to check that the repair procedure has eliminated the trouble that the check
engine/malfunction indicator lamp no longer illuminates). In other words, doing such a drive allows
regenerate any kind of trouble which involves illuminating the check engine/malfunction indicator lamp
and to check the repair procedure has eliminated the trouble (the check indicator
lamp is no more illuminated).
Caution
Make sure that there are two people in the vehicle when
1. Catalytic converter monitor
Test conditions/procedure
1. All of the following conditions should be when the drive test is carried out.
(1) Outside air temperature: or higher
(2) condition:
Selector lever position: range
l Overdrive switch: ON
,
l Power/economy changeover switch: Power
(3) switch: OFF
2. Carry out one trip monitoring according to the following drive pattern (from’ starting
until ignition is turned off). (Takes approximately 20 minutes.)
the engine and quickly accelerate to a speed of 72 km/h (45 mph) or
Monitor pre-preparation period: drive for seconds or more the vehicle Speed,
at between 72 97 (45 60 mph). Braking (lasting several seconds)
.. ,
during this period.
Decelerate until the vehicle speed is between 56 64 km/h (35 40 mph).
Monitoring period: drive for 90 seconds or more on a level while maintaining the throttle.
opening angle at a constant angle (keeping throttle variations as small as absolutely possible)
and the vehicle speed at between 56 64 km/h (35 40 mph).
Fully close the throttle to make the vehicle decelerate. (Braking is allowed at this time.)
After the vehicle has been decelerating continuously for seconds, quickly
to a speed of between 56 64 km/h (35 40 mph).
Repeat steps l 4 and six times. (The procedure in steps and should be
total of six times.)
Decelerate to a stop. After the vehicle has stopped, turn the ignition
Drive cycle pattern
300 seconds or more
72 97 km/h (45 60 mph)
Vehicle speed
Engine starts I I
itch: OFF
NOTE:
Throttle open-
ing angle
0
Fully Fully Fully
decelerating decelerating decelerating
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
150 seconds
or more __ or more .
(55 60 mph)
Vehicle speed
NOTE:
Throttle opening 50 ,
angle
Caution
The shaded areas in the raph indicate times when the vehicle
speed should not go of the specified range.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
97 (60)
64 (40)
Vehicle speed
km/h (mph) 32 (20)
Monitoring period
Engine starts I ..
OFF
100
NOTE:
Throttle opening
angle
Caution
The shaded areas in the graph indicate times when
vehicle speed should not go outside of the specified range.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
60 (40)
Vehicle
speed
32 (20)
NOTE:
Throttle
Fully closed/ Fully closed/ Fully closed/ Fully closed/ Fully Fully closed/
decelerating decelerating decelerating decelerating decelerating decelerating
Caution
The shaded areas in the graph indicate times when the vehicle
speed should not go outside of the specified range.
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
30 or more
(55 60 mph)
97 (60)
64 (40)
Vehicle speed
(mph)
32 (20)
Ignition
Engine starts switch: OFF
NOTE:
Throttle opening
angle
Caution
The shaded areas in the graph indicate times when the vehicle
speed should not go outside of the specified range.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting .
6. Other monitoring
l Misfire l Engine coolant temperature sensor
l Evaporative emission control system l Closed throttle position switch
l Idle air control system l Generator terminal circuit
l Manifold differential pressure sensor l sensor circuit
l Excessive time to enter closed loop fuel control l sensor heater circuit
Turbocharger waste gate solenoid
l Throttle position sensor l EGR solenoid
l Barometric pressure sensor l Evaporative emission purge solenoid
Intake air temperature sensor l Evaporative emission ventilation
l Serial communication link solenoid Engine>
l Crankshaft position sensor l Fuel pressure solenoid
l Camshaft position sensor l Injector circuit
Volume air flow sensor
Test conditions/procedure
1. All of the following conditions should be satisfied when the drive test is carried out.
(1) Engine coolant temperature: or higher (when engine is fully warmed up)
(2) Outside air temperature: or higher
(3) condition:
l Selector lever position: range
l Overdrive switch: ON
l Power/economy changeover switch: Power
2. Carry out one trip monitoring according to the following drive pattern (from starting of the engine
until ignition is turned off). (Takes approximately 10 minutes.)
the engine is fully warmed up, turn the ignition switch to OFF.
the engine, accelerate to between 56 64 km/h (35 40 mph) and drive at this speed
for 300 seconds or more. Then stop the vehicle. Braking and throttle operations can be carried
out during this time.
stopping the vehicle, let the engine run at idle for 300 seconds or more, and then turn
the ignition to OFF.
The vehicle should be set to the following condition for idling.
l A/C switch: OFF
l Lights, electric cooling fan and all accessories: OFF
l Transmission: Neutral (A/T for range)
l Steering wheel: position
Drive cycle pattern
64 (40)
Idling
Vehicle speed km/h (mph) transmission: Neutral
32 (20) 300 seo.
NOTE:
Throttle opening angle 50
Caution
The shaded areas in the graph indicate times when the vehicle
speed should not go outside of the specified range.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
,
1. Connect the scan tool to the data and
read the diagnostic trouble. codes.
2. Repair the malfunction while the
CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC ‘CODES.
3. Turn the ignition switch to OFF and then back to ON
again.
4. Erase the diagnostic trouble codes using the scan tool.
5. ‘Check that the diagnostic trouble code is normal.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
DIAGNOSTIC BY TEST
(INCREASED SENSITIVITY)
When mode II is selected using the MUT-II, the check
engine/malfunction indicator lamp illuminates at the point when
the ECM detects a problem (except if the related
to emissions), and at the same time the corresponding
diagnostic trouble codes are stored.
Furthermore, in the case of comprehensive component
electrical faults (opens/shorts), the time from the occurrence
of the fault to the storing of the DTC is compressed (4 seconds
1 second).
As a result of this, checking of the trouble symptoms
checking after have been completed are both made
easier.
Once mode II has been selected, it is necessary
ignition switch to OFF or to use the MUT-II to
I once more before mode I operation can resumed.
However, all readiness test and frame
data will be erased after returning to mode so this
should be recorded beforehand if necessary.
(1) Using the scan tool, changeover the diagnostic test mode
of the engine control module to DIAGNOSTIC TEST
MODE II. (INCREASED SENSITIVITY)
(2) Road test the vehicle.
(3) Read the diagnostic trouble code in the same manner
as “READ OUT OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE” and
repair the malfunctioning part.
(4) Turn off the ignition
NOTE
Turning OFF the ignition switch will cause the engine
control module to changeover the ECM from the diagnostic
test mode II to the diagnostic test
Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> .
Heated oxygen sensor Performs the closed loop control of the air/fuel ratio by using only the signal of the heated
oxygen sensor (front) installed on the front side of the catalytic converter.
Misfire detection The ECM stops supplying fuel to the cylinder with the highest misfiring rate if a misfiring that
could damage the catalytic converter is detected.
Turbocharger waste Shuts off fuel in case of overcharge.
gate actuator
Engine
terminal Does not restrict the generator output with respect to electrical load.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
,
00 Volume air flow circuit malfunction l Harness and connector Retained
(If harness and connector are not
defective, replace volume air flow
sensor assembly.)
Barometric pressure l Harness and connector ‘Retained
circuit malfunction (If harness and connector are not
defective, replace volume air ,
sensor assembly.)
Intake air temperature circuit l Harness and connector Retained
function l Intake air temperature sensor
Engine coolant temperature circuit l Harness and connector Retained
malfunction l Engine coolant
20 Throttle position circuit malfunction l Harness and connector Retained
l Throttle position sensor
l Closed throttle posit& switch
25 Excessive time to enter closed sensor (front) Retained
Loop Fuel Control* l sensor harness and connector
Injector
30 sensor circuit malfunction (Bank l Harness and connector Retained
1 Sensor 1) (If harness and connector are not
defective, replace sensor
(front).)
sensor heater circuit malfunction l Harness and connector Retained
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) sensor (front)
‘0136 sensor circuit malfunction (Bank l Harness and connector Retained
1 Sensor 2) sensor (rear)
‘0141 sensor heater circuit malfunction l Harness and connector Retained
(Bank 1 Sensor 2) l sensor (rear) heater
‘0170 Fuel trim malfunction l Volume air flow sensor output Retained
(Bank 1) frequency
Injector
l Fuel pressure
l Intake air leaks
l Engine coolant temperature sensor
l Intake air temperature sensor
l Barometric pressure sensor
Sensor
l Exhaust manifold
‘0201 Injector circuit malfunction Cylinder l Harness and connector Retained
1 Injector
‘0202 Injector circuit malfunction Cylinder
2
.
‘0203 Injector circuit malfunction Cylinder
3
‘0204 Injector circuit malfunction Cylinder l Harness and connector Retained
4 Injector
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
page
Random misfire l Ignition coil Retained 74
detected* Ignition power transistor
l Spark plug
Cylinder 1 misfire Ignition circuit Retained
detected* Injector
Sensor
Cylinder 2 misfire Compression pressure I,
detected* l Timing belt
Cylinder 3 misfire l Crankshaft position sensor
detected* l Air intake
Fuel pressure
Cylinder 4 misfire l Crankshaft position sensor circuit
detected* and connector
Knock sensor 1 circuit malfunction l Harness and connector Retained
Engine (Turbo)> (If harness and connector are not
defective, replace knock sensor.) ,
Crankshaft position sensor circuit l Harness and connector Retained
malfunction (If harness and connector are not
defective, replace crankshaft
tion sensor.)
Camshaft position sensor circuit l Harness and connector Retained
function (If harness and connector are not
defective, replace camshaft position ,
sensor.)
‘0400 Exhaust gas recirculation flow l Harness and connector Retained
function l EGR valve
l EGR solenoid ,
valve control vacuum
l Manifold differential, pressure sen-
sor
Exhaust gas recirculation solenoid l Harness and connector
malfunction l EGR solenoid
‘0420 Catalyst system efficiency below l Exhaust manifold (Replace the Retained
threshold (Bankl) catalytic converter if there is no
cracks)
‘0440 Evaporative emission control l Harness and connector Retained
malfunction Engine (Turbo)> l Evaporative emission purge Sole-
noid
l Purge control valve
l Vacuum hoses routing
‘0442 Evaporative emission control l Harness and connector Retained
leak detected l Evaporative emission purge
solenoid
l Evaporative emission ventilation
solenoid
l Vacuum hoses routing
‘0443 Evaporative emission control system l Harness and connector Retained
purge control valve circuit malfunc- l Evaporative emission purge
tion solenoid .
‘0446 Evaporative emission control system l Harness and connector Retained
vent control malfunction l Evaporative emission ventilation..
solenoid
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
1. Do not replace the engine control module (ECM) until a thorough terminal check reveals there are
no short/open circuits.
2. After the ECM detects a malfunction, a diagnostic trouble code is recorded when the engine is next
started and the same malfunction is re-detected. However, for items marked with a the diagnostic
trouble code is recorded on the first detection of the malfunction.
3. Heated oxygen sensor
4. Sensor 1: indicates sensors which are mounted closest to the engine.
5. Sensor 2: indicates sensors which are mounted next-closest to the engine.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Measure at the volume air flow Check the volume air flow sensor
sensor connector A-l 02. circuit. (Refer to
l Connect the connector. (Use PROCEDURE 47.)
the test harness:
1. Voltage between 3 and ground
(Engine: idling) Repair
OK: 2.2-3.2
2. Voltage between 7 and ground
OK: (Engine: idling)
6-9 (Ignition switch: ON) Check trouble symptom.
OK OK: 6-9
NG
Replace the ECM.
Check the following connector Repair
Replacethevolumeairflowsensor.
, Check trouble
TSB Revision
ENGINE(TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Check Area
l 60 or more have passed since the starting sequence was completed. ,
l Battery voltage is not lower than 8 V.
Judgement Criteria
l Sensor output voltage has continued to be 4.5 or higher [corresponding to a barometric
pressure of 114 (17 psi) or higher] for 4 sec.
or
l Sensor output voltage has continued to be 1.95 or lower a barometric
pressure of 50 (7.4 psi) or lower] for 4 sec.
NG
Measure at the volume air flow
sor connector sensor connector
l Connect the connector. (Use l Disconnect the connector, and
the test harness: measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 2 and ground l Voltage between 1 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON) (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: 3.7-4.3 OK:
[Altitude: 0 (0 ft.)] l Continuity between 5 and
ground
[Altitude: 1,200 (3,937 Continuity the ECM and the barometric
sure sensor connector. I
OK
OK OK
I Check the following connector: Repair
at the ECM A-i
3-56. OK
Connect the connector.
Voltage between 85 and Check trouble symptom. Replace the ECM.
ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: 3.7-4.3 NG
[Altitude: 0 (0 ft.)] NG
Check the harness wire between Repair
[(Altitude: 1,200 (3,937 the ECM and the barometric pres-
ii.)] sure sensor connector.
OK OK
harness wire
the ECM and the barometric pres-
sure sensor connector.
Repair
OK
the ECM.
TSB Revision 1
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting ,
Check the intake air temperature Replace the volume air flow sensor.
sor. (Refer to
l and ground
Check the wire between the Repair
ECM and the intake air temperature
sensor connector.
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Replace the
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Judgement Criteria
l Sensor output voltage is or less for 4 seconds.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Repair
Engine>
OK
NG
Check the harness wire between the ECM and the heated oxygen Repair
sensor connector.
OK
NG
Check me Injector. (Refer to P.l Replace
OK
NG
Repair
OK
NG
Repair
OK
Check the fuel pressure. (Refer to
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Check the heated oxygen sensor Repair
(front). (Refer to
NG OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
(Refer to ,
I ,
OK
NG
Replace the ECM. I
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Check Area
l Coolant temperature sensor: normal
l Heated oxygen sensor signal voltage has continued to be 0.1 or lower for 3 min or ... .
more after the starting sequence was completed.
l Engine coolant temperature is not lower than . .
l Engine speed is higher than 1200
l Volumetric efficiency is not lower than 25%.
l Intake air temperature is or higher
l Barometric pressure is 76 (11 psi.) or higher.
l Monitoring Time:
Judgement Criteria
l Input voltage supplied to the engine control module interface circuit is not lower than 4.5
when 5 is applied to the heated oxygen sensor output line via a resistor.
l Making the air-fuel ratio 15% richer doesn’t result in raising the heated oxygen sensor
output voltage beyond 0.1 V.
TSB Revision .
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
NG
Replace
(Refer to
NG
Measure at the ECM connector Check the following connector: Repair
OK
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the intake air temperature circuit malfunction. (Refer to
13 Intake air temperature sensor (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the engine coolant malfunction (Refer
21 Engine coolant temperature sensor (Refer to to INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TROUBLE CODE
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the barometric pressure circuit
25 Barometric pressure sensor (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
OK
NG
Check the injector (Refer to Replace
OK
N G
Check the following connectors: Repair
NG
Repair
OK
Replace
TSB Revision 1
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> Troubleshootina
Check Area
l Engine speed is between and 1000
l Throttle position sensor output voltage is not higher than 1.16
l Monitoring Time: 4
Judgement Criteria
l Injector coil surge voltage (system voltage V) has not been detected for 4 sec.
Engine (Turbo)>
Check the injector. (Refer to Replace
NG
Check the resister. (Refer to
NG
Measure at the resistor connector Check harness wire between the relay and the
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
tor. Repair, if necessary.
l Voltage between 3 and ground. (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
NG
Measure at the injector connectors Repair
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side. connector:
l Voltage between 1 and ground. (Ignition switch: ON) OK
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK Check trouble I
NG
Check the injector control circuit.
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 49.) Check wire between the the injector connector.
Repair, if
Engine>
N G
Check the injector. (Refer to I Replace
PROCEDURE 49.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO) .
AND ENGINE> ,
NG
Check the injector (Refer to Replace
OK
SCAN TOOL list Check the engine coolant temperature circuit malfunction (Refer
21 Engine coolant temperature sensor to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
(Refer to TROUBLE CODE 5.)
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
ENGINE>
Revision
ENGINE
AND
Check the harness wire between the ECM and the Repair
sensor connector.
OK
Replace the knock sensor. I
Check trouble I
NG
Revision
OK
Measure at the crankshaft poition sensor connector Replace the ECM.
l Connect the connector. (Use the test harness:
OK:
l Voltage between 2 (black clip) and ground (Engine:
idling)
OK: 1.5-2.5
NG
1. NG
Measure at the crankshaft poition sensor connector Check the harness wire between the crankshaft poition sensor and
Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness the relay connector. Repair, if necessary.
side.
1. Voltage between 3 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
2. Voltage between 2 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: 4.6-5.2
3. Continuity between 1 and ground
O K : I
Check trouble symptom.
Repair
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
OK
Measure at the camshaft position sensor connector Replace the ECM.
l Connect the connector.
Voltage between 2 and ground (Engine: cranking)
OK:
l Voltage between 2 and ground (Engine: idling)
OK:
NG
1. NG
Measure at the camshaft position sensor connector Check the harness wire the camshaft position’
l Disconnect the connector. and measure at the harness the relay connector. Repair, if necessary.
side.
1. Voltage between 3 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK:
Repair
2. Voltage between 2 and (Ignition switch: ON)
OK:
3. Continuity between 1 and ground
OK: Continuity
Check trouble symptom.
OK
Repair
I tor.
Check trouble I
OK
NG
Replace the ECM.
the camshaft oosition sensor.
Check the harness wire between the camshaft position sensor and
the ground. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Check the EGR system (Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control EGR solenoid
(Refer to GROUP 17 Emission System) Engine
OK
Replace,
Check for EGR valve and EGR line blockages, and clean if
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Check the EGR solenoid. (Refer to GROUP Emission Replace
Control System) Engine (Turbo)> (Refer to GROUP
17 Emission Control System) Engine>
I
NG
Measure at the EGR solenoid connector
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness Repair, if necessary.
,
l Voltage between 1 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
positive
Check the harness wire between ECM and solenoid valve connector.
Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting. ,
NG
Replace
OK
Check the oxygen sensor malfunction (bank 1 sensor 2)
SCAN TOOL Data list INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOS-
59 Heated oxvaen senosr (rear) (Refer to TIC TROUBLE CODE
l gear range
l Drive with wide open throttle I
.
TOOL Data list N G
11 Refer to Check the oxygen sensor circuit (bank 1 sensor
. -raced
--- INSPECTION
OK: 600 . 1000 TIC TROUBLE CODE
.
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Replace the heated oxygen sensor (front) .
11 Heated oxygen sensor (front) (Refer to
l Engine: 2000
OK: Switches between 0 400 600 1,000 15 or
more times in 10 seconds
Check trouble
NG
Replace the ECM.
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Check the vapor hose between the fuel tank and the evaporative
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Check if the fuel tank filler tube cap is attached correctly. Attach correctly.
OK
NG
Repair or replace
OK
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the evaporative emission control system purge control valve
06 Evaporative emission purge solenoid (Refer to circuit malfunction (Refer to INSPECTION
OK DURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the evaporative emission control system vent control
29 Evaporative emission ventilation solenoid (Refer to function (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR
OK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the evaporative emission control system pressure sensor
73 Fuel tank differential pressure sensor (Refer to
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit malfunction
21 Engine coolant temperature sensor (Refer to
OK TIC TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL list Check the intake air temperature sensor circuit malfunction (Refer
13 Intake air temperature sensor (Refer to to INSPECTION PROCEDURE DIAGNOSTIC
OK TROUBLE CODE
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
. .
Measure at the ECM Check the following con- ? Repair
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness
side.
l Voltage between 9 and ground (Ignition switch: ON) OK
OK: oositive Check trouble symptom.
NG
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG NG
Measure at the ECM connector Check
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 55 and ground
(Ignition switch: ON) O K
OK: Batten/ positive
Check trouble symptom.
OK NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Judgement Criteria
l The sensor output voltage is 4.5 or higher for 10 seconds even though the intake
air temperature is between 5” and the evaporative emission
purge solenoid is being driven at 100% duty.
or
l The sensor output voltage is 0.5 or lower for 10 seconds even though the intake
air temperature is (41 or higher and the evaporative emission purge solenoid
is not being driven.
2. Check Area
l The pressure fluctuates 20 times or more at 0.2 or higher.
l Closed position switch: ON
Judgement Criteria
l The pressure fluctuates 20 times or more (0.2 or higher) for 15 consecutive idle
operations.
NG
Check the following Repair
/ Check
NG
NG
Check the harness Repair
between fuel tank differ-
ential sensor
and
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
. .
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND. ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Engine> , ,
NG
Cantheoperation sound be heard Check the idle air control motor
system. (Refer to
after the ignition switch is turned INSPECTION PROCEDURE 35.)
to the ON position?
OK Check the
NG
Measure at the idle air control mo- Measure at the idle air control mo-
tor connector tor connector
l Use the test harness l Disconnect the connector, and Check trouble symptom.
to connector the measure at the harness side.
connector. l Voltage between 1, 2, 4 and
l Voltage between 2 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
ground after the ignition OK: 4.8 5.2
switch is turned to the ON Continuity between 3 and
position.) ground
OK: changes from 1.5 4.0 OK: Continuity
(momentary) to 0
1 or 4.5 5.5
l Voltage between 4 and
ground (right ignition OK Replace the ECM. I
switch is turned to the ON NG
position.) Checkthefollowingconnectors: Repair
OK: changes from 1.5 4.0
(momentary) to 0
1 or 4.5 5.5
OK t r o u b l e ,
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Check the closed throttle position switch. Replace the throttle position sensor
(Refer to
OK
Measure at the throttle position sensor connector
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness
side.
l Voltaae between 3 and around switch: ON) .
OK: or higher Check trouble symptom.
l between 4 and
OK: NG
NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Check the power steering press Replace
On-vehicle Service)
Repair
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
NG
Repair
between ECM and power
pressure switch
NG
Replace the ECM.
the ECM.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND
NG
Check the turbocharger Replace
(Refer to GROUP 15 On-vehicle Service.)
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ,
Check trouble
NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE
A N D ,
TSB Revision.
ENGINE (TURBO),
AND ENGINE>
NG NG
Measure at the MDP sensor con- Measure at the MDP sensor con- Check the Repair
nector nector
l Disconnect the connector, and
test harness: measure at the harness side.
Voltage between 1 and ground Voltage between 3 and ground Check trouble symptom.
(Engine: Idle) (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: OK:
Voltage between 1 and ground
OK:
when the
at idle.
OK Check the following connector:
OK:
TSB Revision
(TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
,
Measure at the generator connector Replace the ECM.
l Connect the connector.
l Voltage between 4 and ground . ,
Engine: Idle
Radiator fan: stopped
Headlight: off on
Stop Lamp: off on
Rear defogger switch: off on
OK: voltage drops
NG
Judgement Criteria
l Abnormality in communication line (TCM to ECM) with transaxle control module
l Problem with transaxle control module (TCM).
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
OK
l When the pulse generators “A” and the transaxle control module inputs the pulse
generator failure signal to the engine control module.
Check Area, Judgement Criteria
l Pulse generator fail signal is input to the engine control module from the transaxle control
module.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Repair
module connector.
OK
__
Replace the
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Acceleration shock 16
Deceleration shock 17
Poor acceleration 18
Surge 19
Knocking 20
.
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND Troubleshooting
Items Symptom
Starting The starter is used to crank the engine, but there is no combustion within the
Won’t start
cylinders, and the engine won’t start.
Fires up and dies There is combustion within the cylinders, but then the engine
Idling stability Hunting Engine speed doesn’t remain constant; changes at idle.
Incorrect idle The engine doesn’t idle at the usual correct speed.
speed
Engine stall The engine stalls when the foot is taken from the pedal, regardless
(Die out) of whether the vehicle is moving or not.
Engine stall The engine stalls when the accelerator pedal is depressed or being
(Pass out) used.
“Hesitation” is the delay in response of the vehicle speed (engine speed) that
occurs when the accelerator is depressed in order to, accelerate from the
Hesitation speed at which the vehicle is now traveling, or a drop in
speed (engine speed) during such acceleration.
Serious hesitation is called to
A sharp sound like a hammer striking the cylinder walls during driving
Knocking
which adversely affects driving.
The condition in which the engine continues to run after ignition switch
Run on
turned to OFF. Also called “Dieseling”.
Hesitation
Vehicle Vehicle
speed speed
Idling Stumble
Time
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 1
,
Communication with scan tool is not possible.
tion with all systems is not possible.)
[Comment] Malfunction connector
The cause is probably defect in the power supply system [including ground) for the on-board l
diagnostic test mode line.
OK
Measure at the data link connector Check the harness wire between
data link connector and
l between 4 and ground ground. Repair, if necessary.
l 5 and ground
.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
Scan tool communication with ECM is not possible. P r o b a b l e
[Comment] l of power
One of the following causes may be suspected. of the ECM
l No power supply to ECM
l Open circuit between ECM data link con-
l Defective ground circuit of ECM
nector
l Defective ECM
l Improper communication line between ECM and scan tool
NG
Check the Repair
OK
Check the harness wire between ECM and data link connector.
NG
Repair
(Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 27.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE ( T U R B O )
AND ENGINE>
.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3 ,
SCAN TOOL Date list Check the power supply ignitiori system.,
16 ECM power supply voltage (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 27.) ,
OK
Measure at the ECM Check the con-
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4 ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
Cranks, won’t start Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the spark plugs are fouled defective, or l Malfunction of the fuel pump system
that the supply of fuel to the combustion chamber is defective. Malfunction of the injector system
In addition, foreign materials (water, kerosene, etc.) may be mixed with the fuel. l Malfunction of the ECM
l Foreign materials in fuel
Check battery positive voltage when cranking. Check the battery. (Refer to GROUP 54 -Battery.)
OK: 8 or hiaher
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
Fires up and dies. Probable cause
.
[Comment] Malfunction of system
In such cases as the above, the cause is probably that the spark plugs are generating sparks l Malfunction of the injector system
but the sparks are weak, or the initial mixture for starting is not appropriate. Foreign materials in fuel
Poor .
Malfunction of the ECM
INSPECTION
PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
Yes
,
Yes
Is starting good if the engine . Check idle air control motor Check the idle control
pedal depressed? for operation sound. malfunction (Refer to
No Engine (Refer to INSPECTION
(Refer to
l Check and adjust the
,
Check the ignition timing when cranking. Check that the crankshaft position sensor and belt cover are
OK: installed property.
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
Probable cause .
Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the spark is weak and ignition is difficult, l Malfunction of the system
the initial mixture for starting is not appropriate, or sufficient compression pressure is not being Inappropriate gasoline use
Poor
Check the ignition timing when cranking. Check that the crankshaft position sensor and belt cover are
OK: installed
OK
TSB Revision
E N G I N E ( T U R B O )
AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 8
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently After warming-up, let the for minutes.’
NO ,
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
Checktheinjectorforoperation .
I PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE-CODES
Check the ignition timing. Engine (Turbo)> Check that the crankshaft position sensor and timing belt cover are
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) installed properly.
Check the ignition timing. Engine>
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle
OK
NG .
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the exhaust gas recirculation solenoid malfunction.
10 EGR solenoid (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 9
speed is high. (Improper idle speed)
[Comment]
In such cases as the above, the cause is probably that the intake air volume during idle is too
great.
YES
Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound Check the idle control system malfunction (Refer
Engine (Turbo)>. (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound
Engine>. (Refer to
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the closed throttle position
26 Closed throttle position switch (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR
TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the engine coolant’ temperature
21 I N S P E C T I O N P R O C E D U RE
OK TROUBLE CODES
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the A/C switch and clutch
28 A/C switch (Refer to to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 32.)
OK
.
Check and the fixed SAS. (Refer to
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 10
Idle speed is low. (Improper idle speed) “Probable cause ,.
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound Check the idle control system to
Engine (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound
(Refer to ,
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the closed position switch system.
26 Closed position switch (Refer to (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR
TROUBLE CODE
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the engine coolant temperature circuit malfunction. (Refer
21 INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TROUBLE CODES 15.)
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the ignition switch-ST and park/neutral position system.
29 Park/neutral position switch (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE ,
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 11
.
When the engine is cold, it stalls at idle. (Die out) Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of the system
In such cases as the above, the cause is probably that the mixture is inappropriate when l the body
the engine is cold, or that the intake air volume is insufficient. l Malfunction of the injector system
Malfunction of the system
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently After warming-up, let the engine run at idling for 10 minutes.
NO
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR
Are diagnostic trouble codes output? TROUBLE CODES.
NG
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound Check the idle control system malfunction to .
Engine (Turbo)>. (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound
(Refer to
Checktheinjectorforope
PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the closed position switch system.
26 Closed throttle position switch (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR
OK TROUBLE CODES
Check the ignition timing. Engine Check that the position sensor and belt cover are
(Refer to GROUP
Check the ignition timing. Engine>
(Refer to GROUP
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 12
.
When the engine is hot, it stalls at idle. (Die out) Probable cause
l Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that ignition system, air/fuel mixture, idle air l Malfunction control system
control motor or compression pressure is defective. l Malfunction of system
In addition, if the engine suddenly stalls, the cause may also be a defective connector contact. l Drawing air into intake system
l Improper connector contact
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently After warming-up, let the engine run at idling for minutes.
NO
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART
Are diagnostic trouble codes output? TROUBLE CODES.
Check the idle air control Check the idle control system malfunction (Refer to
Engine (Refer INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound
(Refer to
Checktheinjectorforoperati
PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC ,
OK
I
NO
Does the engine stall While carrying out an intermittent malfunction simulation test (Refer
YES to GROUP 00 How to Cope with Intermittent Malfunctions, check
for sudden changes in the signals shown below.
Scan tool: Inspection when engine stalls when the engine l Crankshaft position sensor Primary
is warm and idling INSPECTION signal signal
CEDURE 41.) Volumeairflowsensorsignal l Fuel pump drive signal
l Injector drive signal l ECM power supply voltage
OK
Check the ignition timing. Engine (Turbo)> Check that the crankshaft position sensor and timing belt cover are
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) installed properly.
Check the ignition timing. Engine>
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 13 ,
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
N O
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 14
The engine stalls when decelerating. Probable
[Comment] l Malfunction of the system .
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the intake air volume is insufficient due
to a defective idle air control motor system.
Were the battery terminals disconnected recently After warming-up, let the engine at-idling for 10
NO
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the closed throttle position switch system.
26 Closed throttle position switch (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR
TROUBLE CODE
YES
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the vehicle speed sensor malfunction (Refer to
45 Idle air control motor position Engine (Turbo)> PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
55 Idle air control valve position sensor Engine>
l Is the idle speed control motor position drops to
steps when decelerating (engine rpm less than 1
NO
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 15
Hesitation, sag or stumble Probable
[Comment] Malfunction of the ignition system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that ignition system, air/fuel or l of
pressure is defective. of the fuel
l Malfunction of the system
Poor compression
Malfunction of the turbocharger,
Check the injectors for operation sound. Check the injector circuit malfunction
(Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
OK
Check the ignition timing. Engine (Turbo)> Check that the crankshaft position and cover
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) installed properly.
Check the ignition timing.
(Refer to GROUP 11 On-vehicle Service.)
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 16
Acceleration shock Probable cause
[Comment] Malfunction system
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that there is an ignition leak accompanying
the increase in the spark plug demand voltage during acceleration.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 17
Probable cause I
[Comment] l Malfunction of the system
Malfunction of the system is suspected.
YES
Refer to INSPECTION FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound Check the idle control system malfunction (Refer to
Engine (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
Check the idle air control motor for operation sound
Engine>. (Refer to
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the throttle position circuit malfunction (Refer to
14 Throttle position sensor (Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
20.)
OK
,
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check closed position switch system.
26 Closed throttle position switch (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE .
. .
Clean the throttle valve area. (Refer to
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 18
Poor acceleration Probable cause I
[Comment] l Malfunction of the Ignition system
Defective ignition system, abnormal air-fuel ratio, poor compression pressure, etc. are Malfunction of air-fuel ratio control
l Malfunction of the fuel supply system
Poor acceleration
l Clogged exhaust system
l Malfunction ‘of turbocharger system .
YES
SCAN TOOL DTC Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NG
Check the injectors for op
(Refer to PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
OK
Check the ignition timing. Engine (Turbo)> Check that the crankshaft position sensor and timing belt cover are
(Refer to GROUP A On-vehicle Service.) installed
Check the ignition timing. Engine>
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.)
OK
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshootina
, .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 19
Surge
l Malfunction of ignition system
Defective ignition system, abnormal air-fuel are suspected. l Malfunction of’ ‘ratio ‘control system
l Malfunction of the EGR solenoid system
,
YES
Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
.
NG
Check the injectors for op
(Refer to PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLE
OK
Check the ignition timing. Engine (Turbo)> Check that the crankshaft position sensor and are
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) properly.
Check the Engine>
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 20
Knocking Probable cause
[Comment] l Defective knock sensor ,
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably that the detonation control is defective or the l heat the
heat value of the spark plug is inappropriate.
. .
YES
Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR’ ‘DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
NO
Does knocking occur when driving with the sensor Check the knock sensor 1 circuit malfunction (Refer
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR CODE’
At this time, use the scan tool to check if the timing is
retarded compared to when the knock sensor connector
is connected.
YES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 21
Dieseling Probable I
[Comment] l Fuel leakage from injectors
Fuel leakage from injectors is suspected.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 22
Too high CO and HC concentration when idling
[Comment] Malfunction of the ratio
Abnormal air-fuel ratio is suspected.
YES
SCAN TOOL Refer to INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble codes output TROUBLE CODES.
NO
NG
Check the ignition timing. Engine (Turbo)> Check that the crankshaft position sensor and belt
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.) installed
Check the ignition timing. Engine>
(Refer to GROUP 11 On-vehicle Service.)
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the oxygen sensor circuit malfunction (bank sensor 2). (Refer
59 Heated oxygen sensor (rear) (Refer to to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
l Transaxle gear TROUBLE CODE
ranae
l Driving with the throttle wide open
OK:
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the oxygen sensor circuit malfunction (bank 1 sensor 1).
Heated oxygen sensor (front) (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
OK: 1,000 when racing suddenly TROUBLE CODE
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (‘TURBO)
AND ENGINE> ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 23
Generator output voltage is low (approx. 1
[Comment] l Malfunction of charging system.
The cause may be a malfunction of the generator or one of the problems listed at right. l Short harness between
t e r m i n a l
l Malfunction of the ECM.
OK
Measure at the generator connector Check the generator.
l Connect the connector.
l Voltage between and ground ,
Engine: idle
Radiator fan: stopped ,
Headlight: off on .. ,
Stop lamp: off on
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshoot&j
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 24
Transient, mass emission tailpipe test test failed Probable cause 1
[Comment]
The test is failed if the air/fuel ratio is not controlled to the theoretical air/fuel ratio by means of
the feedback control from the oxygen sensor signal, if the EGR flow volume is insufficient, or if
the catalyst has deteriorated.
NOTE
If the temperature of the three-way catalyst is low when the exhaust gas is tested, the three-way
cannot effectively clean the exhaust. Accordingly, the engine needs to be sufficiently warmed
the exhaust gas is tested, and the gas should then be tested immediately.
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Has the engine warmed up sufficiently when the exhaust gas is Let the engine warm up sufficiently before testing the exhaust gas.
tested? (Check with owner.) ,
SCAN TOOL list Check the engine coolant temperature sensor circuit malfunction.
21 Engine coolant temperature sensor
(Refer to P.
NG
Check the intake air temperature sensor circuit malfunction. (Refer
to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
OK
NG
Check the barometric pressure sensor circuit (Refer
25 Barometric pressure sensor (Refer to to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
I OK
, N G
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the oxygen sensor circuit malfunction (bank 1 sensor 2).
59 Heated oxygen sensor (rear)’ (Refer to
l Transaxle: gear range TIC TROUBLE CODE
l Drive with wide open throttle
OK: 600 1 0 0 0
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the oxygen sensor circuit malfunction (bank 1 sensor 1).
11 Heated oxygen sensor (front) (Refer to
OK: 600 1000 when racing suddenly TIC TROUBLE CODE
OK
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the EGR system. (Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control
11 Heated oxygen sensor (front) (Refer to System)
OK: 0 400 and 600 1000 alternately when idling OK
and 2500 NG
Measure the CO
sensor
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 25
Purge flow test of the evaporative canister test failed
[Comment] l Blocked purge line or purge port
The test is failed if there is a blockage in the purge line or purge port, or a malfunction of the emission
evaporative emission purge solenoid. solenoid
Blocked emission
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 26
Pressure test of the evaporative system failed Probable
[Comment] l Improper of
The test is if there is a leak in the fuel tank or vapor line. l Broken seal in fuel tank,
emission canister
...
N G
Check the evaporati Replace,
(Refer to GROUP 17 Emission Control System)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 27
Power supply system and ignition system Probable
[Comment] l Malfunction of the ignition switch
When an ignition switch ON signal is input to the ECM, the ECM turns the relay ON. This l Malfunction of the relay
causes battery positive voltage to be supplied to the injectors and volume air flow sensor. Improper connector contact, open or
short-circuited harness wire
l .-Disconnected wire
l Malfunction of the ECM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 28
Fuel pump system Engine (Turbo)> Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of the fuel pump relay ,
The ECM turns the fuel pump relay ON when the engine is cranking or running, and this Malfunction of
plies power to drive the fuel pump. Improper connector open
short-circuited harness wire
l Malfunction of the
Replace
OK .
Check the fuel pump drive control circuit.
Connect the connector. (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 46.)
l Voltage between 1 and ground
l SCAN TOOL Actuator test: Fuel pump drive
OK: oositive voltaae
OK
Check the harness wire between fuel pump relay connector
and fuel pump drive terminal. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 29 ,
NG
Repair
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side. connector. ..
1. Voltage between 1 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK
OK: Battery positive voltage
2. Continuity between 5 and ground Check trouble ,
OK: Continuity
3. 2 and ground (Engine: Cranking)
4. the terminal to the terminal 3 Check the harness wire between the fuel pump relay module con-
negative the terminal 4. nector and fuel pump relay connector and repair if necessary.
OK: Fuel pump operates.
U K
NG Check the harness wire between the fuel pump relay con-
Check the following Repair nector and around and if
connector.
OK
Check the following Repair
Check trouble symptom connector.
NG
NG
Replace the ECM I
- - -
Check the following Repair
connectors.
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 30
Ignition switch-ST system
,
[Comment] l Malfunction, of ignition switch
The ignition switch ST inputs a HIGH signal to the while the engine is cranking. Improper connector
The ECM controls fuel injection, etc. during starting based on this input. .
l the
.
1. NG
Measure at the ECM connector
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness
side. 2. NG
1. Voltage between 71 and ground (Ignition switch: START)
OK: or more
2. Continuity between 91 and ground
OK: Continuity
OK
R e p a i r
... ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 31
Ignition switch-ST and park/neutral position system
1. NG
Measure at the position switch connector
TSB Revision
E N G I N E
AND ‘ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 32
switch and compressor clutch relay system
, ..
(Comment] l Malfunction of control
When an A/C ON signal is input to the the ECM carries out control of the idle air control Malfunction of
motor, and also operates the compressor magnetic clutch. l Improper connector open circuit or
harness
.
NG
Replace
(Refer to GROUP 55 On-vehicle Service.)
OK
NG
Measure at the ECM connectors
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness
OK
the
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 33
Fan motor relay system (Radiator fan, A/C condenser fan) Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of fan motor relay
The fan motor relay is controlled by the power transistor inside the ECM turning ON and OFF. l Malfunction of fan motor
Improper connector open
shortclrcuited
l Malfunction of the ECM
TSB Revision I
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 34
Ignition circuit system cause’
[Comment] l Malfunction of ignition
The interrupts the ignition coil current by turning the transistor in- of
side the ECM ON and OFF. l Improper connector contact, open circuit or,
shortcircuited harness wire
l Malfunction the ECM
Engine (Turbo)>
Measure at the ignition coil connector
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness
side.
l Voltage between 3 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage Check trouble symptom.
Engine>
Measure at the ignition coil connectors 0,
l Disconnect the connectors and measure at the harness
side.
l Voltage between 1 and ground (Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
Check the ignition switch. (Refer to Ignition Switch.)
NG
Check the harness wire between ignition connector
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness and ground. Repair, if necessary.
side.
l Continuity between 3 and ground
OK: Continuitv
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Engine Repair
(Turbo)>, Engine>, A-l 11
OK
NG
Replace
(Refer to GROUP 16 Ignition System.)
NG
Check the ignition power tran Replace
(Refer to GROUP 16 Ignition
OK NG
Check the following con- Repair
I
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 35
Idle air control motor (DC motor) Engine> Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of idle air control motor
The ECM controls the intake air volume during idling by opening and closing the Improper connector open “circuit’
servo valve located in the bypass passage.
l Malfunction of the
Replace
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 36
Scan tool: Inspection when no initial combustion occurs
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the power and ignition
16 Voltage of ECM power source (Refer to (Refer to I PROCEDURE 27.)
NG
SCAN TOOL list Check the crankshaft position sensor circuit malfunction. (Refer to
22 Crankshaft position sensor INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
OK: Cranking speed is displayed. TROUBLE CODES
OK
SCAN TOOL Actuator test Check the fuel pump system Engine
07 Fuel pump (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 28.)
Check the fuel pump system
OK (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 29)
.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 37
,
Ignition system: Inspection when no initial occurs
Engine (Turbo)>
NG
Measure at the ignition coil connector Check ignition circuit system.
l Connect the connector. (Use the test harness: (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 34.)
Engine>
NG
Measure at the ignition coil connectors Check the ignition circuit system.
lConnect the connector. (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 34.)
(Use the test harness:
l To inspect, connect the primary voltage detection-type
tachometer to the terminal 2.
OK: Each terminal displays a speed on the engine
tachometer that is of the cranking speed.
OK
NG
Check that the crankshaft position sensor
OK: are properly installed.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 38
Scan tool: Inspection when incomplete combustion occurs.
YES
INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC
Are diagnostic trouble code output (Refer to
NG ,
SCAN TOOL Actuator te Check the fuel pump system Engine (Turbo)>.
07 Fuel pump (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 28.)
Check the fuel pump system Engine>. (Refer-to IN-
SPECTION PROCEDURE 29.)
./I,’
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 39 ,
when huntina occurs.
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list
26 Closed throttle position switch (Refer to
TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the intake air temperature circuit (Refer
13 Intake air temperature sensor (Refer to INSPECTION’ PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE 10.)
SCAN TOOL Date list Check the barometric pressure circuit malfunction. (Refer to
25 Barometric pressure sensor (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
.
SCAN TOOL list Check the engine coolant temperature circuit
21 INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR
TROUBLE CODE 15.)
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the oxygen sensor circuit malfunction (bank ‘(Refer
59 Heated oxygen sensor (rear) (Refer to to P. INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR DIAGNOSTIC
l Transaxle gear TROUBLE CODE
range
l Drive with wide open throttle
OK: 1,000
OK
SCAN TOOL Date list Check the oxygen sensor circuit malfunction (bank 1) (Refer
11 Heated oxygen sensor (front) (Refer to to INSPECTION PROCEDURE’ DIAGNOSTIC
OK: during sudden racing TROUBLE CODE
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the switch and relay system. (Refer to
28 switch (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 32.)
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list NG
Check the ignition switch-ST and
29 Park/neutral position switch (Refer to (Refer to INSPECTION PROCEDURE 31.)
OK
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Adjust the basic idle speed. (Refer to
45 Idle air control motor position Engine (Turbo)>
(Refer to
55 Idle air control valve position sensor Engine>
(Refer to
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 50
Check the ignition signal circuit.
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 51
Check the boost meter circuit Engine (Turbo)>
I
OK
Measure at the ECM connector Repair
l Disconnect the connector, and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 16 and ground.
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: oositive
NG Replace the ECM.
N G
Check the boost meter (Refer to Replace
GROUP 54 Meters and Gauges)
NG
Measure at the combination meter con- Check the
nector
l Disconnect the connector,
OK
sure at the harness side.
l Voltage between 10 and ground. Check trouble symptom.
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage NG
NG Check harness wire between the ECM
and the combination meter connector.
Check the boost meter power supply Repair, if necessary.
circuit. Repair. if
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Caution
1. Always apply the brakes when shifting the selector lever to ran&, or vehicle will
forward.
2. Driving tests always need another personnel.
NOTE
In a new vehicle [driven approximately 500 km (300 mile) or less], the volume air sensor output
is sometimes 10 higher than the standard frequency.
The injector drive time represents the time when the cranking speed is at 250 or below when the
supply voltage is 11 V.
In a new vehicle [driven approximately 500 km (300 mile) or less], the injector drive time is sometimes
longer than the standard time.
Fuel is injected into all cylinders simultaneously.
In a new vehicle [driven approximately km (300 mile) or less], the step of the stepper motor is sometimes
30 steps greater than the standard value.
If the throttle position sensor voltage rises 100 from the voltage when the engine is at idle and the
closed throttle position switch turns from on to off at this time, the sensors are normal. If the throttle position
sensor voltage rises 100 from the voltage when the engine is at idle, the throttle valve opens, and the
closed throttle position switch turns from on to off at this, time, the sensors should be adjusted.
2,500 Hz
(9.8-12.1
Engine ,
Hz ,
Engine>
Engine is raced Frequency (or air
flow volume) in ,
creases re-
sponse to racing.
TSB Revision
ENGINE .
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
At
At
A t ,
At
At
At
I Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
(3,937 ft.)
At 1800 81
(5,906 ft.)
26 Closed l Ignition switch: ON Throttle valve: Set ON Code No.
throttle l Depress accelera- to idle position
tion switch tor pedal
Throttle valve:
Slightly open
Power steer- Engine: Idle Steering wheel OFF Code No.
ing pressure
switch
Steering wheel turn- ON
ing
A/C switch Engine: Idle A/C switch: OFF OFF
(When A/C switch dure No.
is ON, 32
should be A/C switch: ON ON
operating)
Park/Neutral Ignition switch: ON or
position dure No..
switch
2, or
1 5 - 2 2
Engine>
Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE> . . .
Engine>
When engine cool-
ant temperature is Engine
(Turbo)? .
7.2-11
Engine>
,
l Engine coolant Engine is idling
temperature: Engine
(Turbo)>
2.2-3.4
l Lights, electric Engine>
cooling fan and all
accessories: OFF 1.75
l Transaxle: Neutral Engine
range)
Engine l Lights,
(Turbo)> cooling fan and all A/C switch: OFF Increases by
accessories: OFF 1 steps
l Transaxle:
tral range)
l Closed throttle .
position switch:
l A/C switch: OFF Increases by
l Idle Select lever: steps
(When A/C switch range
is ON, A/C com-
pressor should be
operating)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO) .
AND ENGINE>
,
Engine
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND Troubleshooting ,
TSB Revision
ENGINE
AND ENGINE>
Engine Engine>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Engine Engine>
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Engine Engine>
switch ON (A/C
compressor is
operating)
46 Engine/transaxle general Engine: Idle at the coolant b-l
control torque execution ture of or lower
signal
Engine: Warm, idle
Heated oxygen Engine: Warm, idle
heater (Rear)
Engine: 5,000
55 Evaporative emission
ventilation solenoid
the at a constant speed
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Engine Engine>
When engine
coolant tempera-
ture is
Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Engine Engine> ..
Engine: Idle
89 89 Crankshaft position Engine: Cranking
sor
Engine: Idle
90 90 Volume air flow sensor Engine: Idle 2.2-3.2
Engine: 2,500 __
91 91 Park/Neutral position Ignition switch: selector
switch ON to or
Set-selector lever. 8-14
.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
TERMINAL RESISTANCE
1. Turn the ignition switch off.
2. Disconnect the ECM connector.
3. Measure the resistance and check for continuity between
the terminals of the ECM
referring to the check
NOTE
1. When measuring resistance and checking continuity’
a harness for checking contact pin pressure should’
be used instead of inserting a test probe.
2. Checks do not have to be carried in the
given in this chart. ,
Caution
If resistance or continuity performed on
the wrong terminals, damage to the vehicle wiring,
sensors, and/or ohmmeter may occur.
Use care to prevent this!
4. If the ohmmeter shows from the normal
condition, check the corresponding sensor, actuator and
related electrical wiring, and then repair or replace.
5. After repair or replacement, recheck with the ohmmeter
to confirm that the repair or replacement corrected
the problem.
Harness Side Connector Terminal Arrangement
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
E C M g r o u n d Continuity
ground
ECM ground
ground
intake is
.
Engine coolant temperature sensor [When temperature is
coolant temperature is
17-92 Closed throttle position switch Continuity (when throttle valve is at idle position)
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Time
0
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting ..
0 Time
TSB Revision 1
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Crankshaft
position sensor
output wave
pattern
Camshaft position
sensor output
wave pattern
I
TDC: Top dead center No. TDC No. TDC No. TDC No. TDC
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
l Example 2
Cause of problem
Loose timing belt
Abnormality in sensor disk
Wave pattern characteristics
Wave pattern jumps to the left or right.
Analyzer INJECTOR
Measurement method
1. Disconnect the injector connector and connect the special
tool (test harness: 348) in between. (Both
on the engine control module side and the terminal
on the power supply side should be connected.)
2. Connect the analyzer special patterns pickup to the test
harness clip on the engine control module side.
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
.
5 .
27 FU 1202
TSB Revision
STEPPER MOTOR Engine (Turbo)>
Analyzer Measurement method
1. Disconnect the stepper motor connector, and connect
the special tool (test harness: in between.
2. Connect the analyzer special patterns pickup to the step-
per motor-side connector terminal (red clip on the special
tool), terminal 3 (blue clip), terminal 4 (black clip) and
terminal 6 (yellow clip) respectively.
10
Stepper motor
control signal
wave pattern
Time
Revision
Wave pattern observation points
Check that the standard wave pattern appears when the stepper operating.
Point A: Presence or absence of induced voltage from the motor turning. (Refer to the
pattern.)
Contrast with standard wave pattern Probable cause
Induced voltage does not appear or is extremely small. Motor is malfunctioning
Point Height of coil reverse voltage
Contrast with standard wave pattern -Probable cause
Coil reverse voltage does not appear or is extremely small. Short in the coil
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO)
AND ENGINE>
Measurement method
1. Disconnect the ignition power transistor connector,
connect the special tool (test harness:.
tween. (All terminals should be connected.)
2. Connect the analyzer special patterns pickup to
tion power transistor connector terminal 2 No.
3) and terminal 7 (No. 1 No. 4)
Alternate method (Test
1. Connect the analyzer special pickup to ECM
terminal and connection terminal 23 respectively.
Standard Wave
Observation conditions
Special patterns
Pattern height
Pattern selector Display
Engine Approx. 1,200
Standard wave pattern
wave pattern
6: Spark advance
6 angle Wave build-up section
Ignition power
transistor con-
trol signal wave
OFF ON
Dwell section Time
TSB Revision
Wave pattern observation points
Point: Condition of wave pattern build-up section and maximum voltage (Refer to abnormal wave pattern
examples 1 and 2.)
Condition of wave pattern build-up section and maximum voltage Probable cause
Rises from approx. to approx. at the top-right Normal
rectangular wave Open-circuit in ignition primary circuit
Rectangular wave at power voltage Ignition power transistor malfunction
l Example 2
-- Normal wave pattern Wave pattern during engine cranking
Cause of problem
Malfunction in ignition power transistor
Wave pattern characteristics
Power voltage results when the ignition power transistor
is ON.
Revision
THROTTLE BODY
CLEANING
1. Start the engine and warm it up the coolant is
to higher and then stop the
2. Remove the air intake hose from the
NOTE
When using the scan tool, service item 26
and observe the ON/OFF changes posi-
tion switch instead of performing If the scan
tool is not available, follow the steps bellow.
1. Disconnect the connector the throttle position sensor.
10. Turn the ignition switch ON (but do not start the engine).:
11. Check the throttle position sensor voltage.
__
value:
12. If there is a deviation from the’ standard value, check
the throttle position sensor and the
13. Remove the feeler gauge.
14. Switch OFF the ignition switch.
.
. .
FIXED SAS ADJUSTMENT
NOTE
1. The fixed SAS should not be moved unnecessarily;
it has been precisely adjusted by the manufacturer.
2 . If the adjustment is disturbed for any reason, readjust
as follows.
1. Loosen the tension of the accelerator cable sufficiently.
2. Back out the fixed SAS lock nut.
3. Turn the fixed SAS counterclockwise until it is sufficiently
backed out, and fully close the throttle valve.
4. Turn the fixed SAS clockwise until the throttle lever is
touched (i.e., the point at which the throttle valve begins
to open).
From that point, turn the fixed SAS clockwise another
turn.
5. While holding the fixed SAS so that it doesn’t move, tighten
the lock nut securely.
6. Adjust the tension of the accelerator cable.
7. Adjust the basic idle speed.
8. Adjust the closed throttle position switch and the throttle
position sensor. (Refer to
SPEED
NOTE
1. The standard idle speed by,
engine speed the
and there should usually for readjustment.
2. The adjustment, after first:
confirming that the spark plugs; the
air control servo, the compression pressure,
all normal.
1.. The vehicle should be prepared as follows before the
inspection and adjustment.
l Engine coolant temperature:
l Lights, cooling fan and accessories: OFF
l Transaxle: Neutral (A/T for range)
‘2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector
N O T E
When the scan tool is connected, the diagnostic test mode
control terminal should be grounded.
3. Start the engine and run at idle.
4. Select the item No. 30 of the SCAN TOOL (MUT-II)
Actuator test.
NOTE
This holds the motor at the basic step to adjust the
basic idle speed.
5. Check the idle speed.
Standard value: 750 50
NOTE
1. The engine speed may be 20 to 100 lower
than indicated above for a new vehicle [driven approxi-
mately 500 km (300 mile) or less], but no adjustment
is necessary.
2. If the engine stalls or the is low even though
the vehicle has been driven approximately 500 km
(300 mile) or more, it is probable that deposits are
adhered to the throttle valve, so clean it.
(Refer to
If not within the standard value range, turn the engine
speed adjusting screw to make the necessary adjustment.
NOTE
If the idling speed is higher standard value
even when the engine speed adjusting screw’ fully
closed, check whether or not there is any indication that
the fixed SAS has been moved. If there indication
that it ‘has been moved, the fixed SAS. If there;
are no indications that it has been moved, it possible
that there is leakage as a result of the
fast idle air valve (FIAV), and, if so, the throttle body
should be replaced.
7. Press the scan tool clear key, and release the motor
from the Actuator test‘ mode.
NOTE
Unless the motor is the Actuator test mode.
will continue 27 minutes.
8. Switch the ignition switch.
9. Disconnect the scan tool.
10. Start the engine again and let it run at idle speed for
about 10 minutes; check to be the condition
is normal.
..
.
FUEL PRESSURE TEST
1. Release residual the fuel line.
(Refer to
2. Disconnect the high-pressure,, fuel. hose -at the fuel rail’
side.
Caution
Cover the hose with a shop to let
fuel gush out.
3. Remove the union joint and bolt from the special tool
Fuel pressure (adapter hose and instead attach the special
tool (hose adapter to the adapter hose.
4. Install a fuel pressure gauge on the adapter hose that
O-ring or gasket was set up in step 3.
Use a suitable O-ring or gasket between the fuel pressure
gauge and the special tool so as to seal in order to prevent
fuel leakage at this time.
10. Disconnect and plug the vacuum hose from the fuel
sure regulator and measure fuel pressure with the hose
end closed by a finger.
Standard value:
(42-45 at curb ,
(Turbo)> .
idle
11. Check to see that fuel pressure at idle drop
even after the engine has been raced
12. Racing the engine repeatedly, hold the,, fuel return hose
lightly with fingers to that fuel pressure
in the return hose.
NOTE
If the fuel flow rate is low, there will be no fuel pressure
in the return hose.
13. any of fuel pressure measured in steps 9 to 12 is out
of specification, troubleshoot and repair according to the
table below.
‘Apply
drive drive the fuel pump.
(2) Check fuel for leaks, repair as needed.
.
FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR”
(HOW TO REDUCE FUEL
Fuel
check
. Inject@
Turbocharger waste
solenoid
Data
Name Symbol Name
Air conditioning compressor clutch relay air control motor
Air conditioning switch coil power transistor)
Camshaft position sensor Ignition power transistor
Check engine/Malfunction indicator lamp
Crankshaft position sensor injector
Data link connector Manifold differential pressure sensor
EGR solenoid fuel relav I I
Engine control module (ECM) Park/Neutral position switch
Engine coolant temperature sensor Power steering pressure switch
Evaporative emission purge solenoid Throttle position sensor (with
Fuel check terminal throttle position switch)
Fuel pump relay Vehicle speed sensor .
Fuel pump relay module
Heated oxygen sensor (Front) Vehicle speed sensor
Heated oxygen sensor (Rear) Volume air flow sensor (with
temperature sensor and barometric pressure
sensor)
NOTE
The “Name” column is in alphabetical order.
.
on coil
temperature sensor
neutral position switch
Check engine/malfunction
indicator lamp
Data
connector
, o x v aen
(front)
.
FUEL INJECTION
AND FUEL PUMP RELAY
1. Remove the relay.
2. Check the continuity between the
Inspection terminals Continuity
2-4 70
Intake air temper- 3. Measure resistance while heating the sensor using a hair
ature sensor drier.
Temperature
Higher
4. If resistance does not decrease as heat the
resistance remains unchanged, replace the volume air
flow sensor assembly.
COOLANT SENSOR
Caution
Be careful not to touch the tool against the
(resin section) when and
1. Remove engine coolant temperature sensor from the in-,
take manifold.
wnen ,
engine ing the engine.@-
..
age of
INJECTOR CHECK
Measurement of Resistance between Terminals
1. Remove the injector connector.
2. Measure the resistance between terminals.
Standard value: 2-3 [at
Engine (Turbo)>
13-16 [at
Engine>
3. Install the injector connector
Terminals
1. Disconnect the resistor connector.
2. Measure the resistance between terminals.
Measuring terminals Resistance
4-3
5-3
6-3
3. If the resistance is out of specification, replace the resistor.
IDLE AIR MO T O R )
ai r CHECK Engine (Turbo
Operational Check
1. Remove the throttle body.
2. Remove the stepper motor.
3. Connect the special tool (test harness) to the idle air
control motor connector.
4. Connect the positive a power supply
(approx. to the white clip and the green clip.
5. With the idle air control motor as shown’in
connect the negative terminal. of the power supply
to each clip as described in the following steps, and check
whether or not a vibrating’feeling (a-feeling of very slight
vibration of the stepper motor) is generated as a result
of the activation of the stepper motor.
(1) Connect the negative terminal of the power supply
to the red and black clip.
(2) Connect the negative terminal of the power supply
to the blue and black clip.
(3) Connect the negative terminal of the power supply
to the blue and yellow clip.
(4) Connect the negative terminal of the power supply
to the red and yellow clip.
(5) Connect the negative terminal of the power supply
to the red and black clip.
(6) Repeat the tests in sequence from (5) to’ (1).
6. If, as a result of these tests, vibration is detected, the
stepper motor can be considered to be normal.
IDLE AIR CONTROL (DC: MOTOR)
CHECK Engine>
Use a stethoscope or long blade screwdriver to check if the
operating sound of the idle air control’ motor can
immediately after the ignition switch is turned to
NOTE
If the motor operation cannot be heard, check the motor
drive circuit and the idle air control motor.
Engine>
I:
Engine (Turbo)>
Engine
Engine>
,
ENGINE ( T U R B O )
AND ENGINE>
(Refer to 17 Service.)
Engine (Turbo)>
2 A ..
4.9
3.6
Removal steps
1. Accelerator cable connection 7. Heater hose connection
2. Air hose 8. Charge air cooler
fitting
Engine (Turbo)> Engine
3. Air intake hose Engine> Gasket Engine
4. TPS connector 10. Throttle body
5. motor connector 11. Throttle body gasket
6. Vacuum hose connection
4
,
I
1.4
steps
1. Throttle position sensor (with
in closed throttle position switch)
2. Idle air control motor
3. Gasket
4. Throttle body
NOTE
Resin clip position
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel Tank
13500010032
(1) The fuel tank is located under the floor of the The fuel tank AWD from a high
rear seats to provide increased safety. density: polyethylene material and
(2) A fuel cut-off valve has been’adopted to prevent blow-formed an ‘tank.
fuel from leaking out in the event of a collision.
Specifications
Fuel tank capacity (gals.) 64 (16.9)
pressure sensor
Test harness set
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY -‘Fuel Tank
Water in fuel filter Replace the fuel filter or clean the fuel
tank and fuel line
Dirty or rusted fuel tank interior Clean or replace
Malfunctioning fuel pump Replace
(Clogged filter in the pump)
Evaporative emission Mispiping of vapor line . Correct
control system mal-
functions Disconnected vapor line piping joint Correct
(When tank filler tube
cap is removed, pres- Folded, bent, cracked or clogged vapor line
sure releasing noise is
heard) Faulty fuel tank filler tube cap Replace
Revision I
FUEL SUPPLY Tank
FUEL TANK
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Engine (Non-turbo)>
2.5 Nm
34 1.8
25
2.5 Nm
Removal steps
1. Fuel tank 11. Fuel tank filler tube protector
2. High-pressure fuel hose 12. Reinforcement
3. Return hose 13. Fuel tank filler tube assembly
4. Fuel pump assembly 14. Packing
5. Fuel gauge unit
6. Fuel cut-off valve assembly NOTE
7. Vapor hose When replacing the fuel pump assembly or the fuel gauge
8. Fuel tank filler tube cap unit only, it is possible to work from the service hales
9. Filler hose underneath the rear seat cushion without having to
10. Vapor hose remove the fuel tank. (Refer to
TSB Revision
SUPPLY ‘Fuel Tank
Enaine
2.5 Nm
1.8
Removal steps
1. Fuel tank 12. Fuel tank filler protector
2. Vapor hose
3. High-pressure fuel hose 14. Fuel tank’ assembly
4. Return hose ,, Packing
5. Fuel pump
6. Fuel gauge unit NOTE
7. Fuel cut-off valve assembly When replacing the fuel or the gauge
6. Vapor hose unit only, it is possible to work from the holes
underneath the rear seat without having to
.
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel
Engine>
2.5 Nm
1.8
25 Nm
Removal steps
1. Fuel tank
2. Vapor hose 13. Fuel tank filler tube protector
3. High-pressure fuel hose 14. Reinforcement
4. Return hose 15. tank tube assembly
5. Fuel tank differential pressure 16. Packing
sensor
6. Fuel pump assembly
7. Fuel gauge unit When replacing pump fuel gauge
8. Fuel cut-off valve assembly unit only, it is possible to work from the service holes
9. Vapor hose underneath the rear seat, without having to
lo. Fuel tank filler cap remove the fuel tank. (Refer
11. Filler hose
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel Tank
13 Nm
25
49 13 .
36
Removal Steps
1. Heated oxygen sensor connection 15. Fuel cut-off valve assembly
2. Center exhaust pipe 16. Fuel tank filler tube cap
3. Protector 17. Filler hose
4. Band 18. Vapor hose
5. Fuel tank 19. Fuel tank filler tube protector
6. High-pressure fuel hose 20. Reinforcement
7. Return hose 21. Fuel tank filler tube assembly
8. Suction hose 22. Packing
9. Pipe
10. Cap NOTE
11. Fuel gauge unit and pump When replacing the fuel gauge unit and pump
assembly or the fuel gauge unit and pipe assembly only, it is
gauge unit and pipe assembly to work from the service holes rear seat
cushion without having to remove the fuel tank. (Refer to
14. hose
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel Tank
Mating marks
Fuel gauge unit and
pump assembly
Mating marks
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel Tank
INSPECTION
FUEL TANK FILLER TUBE
Engine (Non-turbo)
(1) Connect a clean rubber hose to the port
tank filler tube assembly.
(2) Blow air into the hose. Check that the air flows out of
the port B.
(3) Use a screwdriver or similar tool to close the valve. Blow
Valve closed air into the hose in this condition. Check that the
not flow out of the port B.
,
Valve opened
To port A To
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel Tank
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel
Mating marks
Fuel gauge unit and
pump assembly
Mating marks
00005330
Caution
The packing should be as in the
illustration.
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Filter
29 Mm
22
‘36.
27
Engine (Non-turbo)>
29 Nm
22
36 Nm
27
Removal steps
1. Eye bolt 7. Gasket
2. Gasket 8. Connector
3. High-pressure fuel hose connection 9. Gasket
4. Gasket 10. Pressure regulator
5. Fuel main pipe connection 11. Fuel filter
6. Eye bolt 12. Fuel filter bracket
TSB Revision
FUEL SUPPLY Fuel Filter .
TSB Revision
NOTES
CONTENTS
LUBRICANT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 THERMOSTAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Radiator
Radi
Engine (Turbo)>
Radiator fan assembly
tank
TSB Revision
General
ENGINE COOLING
Engine>
Radiator fan assembly
Reserve tank
oil cooler
(Air cooled) oil cooler hose and pipe
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value Limit
Thermostat Valve opening temperature of Engine (Non-turbo) 90.5 (195)
thermostat
Engine (Turbo) and Engine 82 (180)
Full-opening temperature of Engine (Non-turbo) 102 (216)
thermostat ,
Engine (Turbo) and Engine 95 (203)
Radiator cap valve opening pressure (psi) Engine (Non-turbo) 94-122 (14-18)
LUBRICANT
Item Quantity
Engine coolant HIGH QUALITY ETHYLENE GLYCOL ANTIFREEZE COOLANT 7.0 (7.4)
SEALANT
Item Specified sealant ,
Thermostat case Engine (Turbo) and Engine> Mitsubishi Genuine Parts No. or equivalent:
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING
TROUBLESHOOTING
OVERHEAT
Probable cause Remedy
Inoperative electric cooling fan Faulty electrical motor , Replace
Faulty radiator fan Replace
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING HINTS
Engine (Non-turbo)>
1. Only the radiator fan does not operate. 4. The radiator fan and condenser fan do not
l Check fusible link No. 7. operate in the high speed mode, ‘but
2. Only the condenser fan does not operate. otherwise.
l Check dedicated fuse No. 9. l Check the radiator fan motor relay and
3. The radiator fan and condenser fan do’ not condenser fan motor relay (HI).
operate in the low speed mode, but operate l Check the power-train control module.
otherwise. .
l Check the radiator fan motor relay (LO)
and condenser fan motor relay (LO).
l Check the powertrain control module.
TSB Revision
14-6 ENGINE COOLING
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
ON
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING On-vehicle Service
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
ENGINE COOLANT LEAK CHECK
1. Confirm that the coolant level is. up to the filter
Install a radiator cap tester and apply 160 (23 psi)
pressure, and then check for leakage from radiator
hose or connections.
Caution
1. After testing, clean up all coolant seepage from
areas of leakage.
2. When the tester is removed, be careful not to spill
Engine (Turbo) and any coolant.
3. During tester usage, do not deform the filler neck
of the radiator.
2. If leakage is present, repair or replace the appropriate
part.
ENGINE COOLANT
Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance
TSB Revision
14-8 ENGINE COOLING, Radiator
RADIATOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Operation
l Engine Coolant Draining (Refer to GROUP 00
Maintenance Service.)
12 Nm
6.7
TSB Revision
ENGINE
Engine (Turbo)>
Pre-removal Operation Post-installation .
l Engine Coolant Draining (Refer to GROUP 00 l Engine Coolant Supplying and
Maintenance Service.) GROUP 00
l A/T Fluid Checking and Refilling if
with
(Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance
8.7
10
TSB
ENGINE Radiator
12 Nm
8.7
12
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING Radiator
Engine (Turbo)>
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING
THERMOSTAT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
Engine Coolant Draining and Supplying (Refer to
GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.)
l Air Hose(C) Removal and Installation Engine
(Turbo)> (Refer to GROUP 15 -Charge Cooler.)
I I
Ermine
16
Engine (Turbo)>
Engine> - -
9.4
00004042
Removal steps
1. Radiator upper hose connection 3. Gasket Engine (Non-turbo)>
Engine (Non-turbo)> or 4. Thermostat
radiator lower hose connection
Engine
- and En-
2. outlet fitting Engine
(Non-turbo)> or
water inlet fitting Engine
(Turbo) and Engine>
Revision
ENGINE Thermostat
Engine
Jiggle valve
Rubber
ring
Revision
ENGINE COOLING Thermostat” .
INSPECTION
THERMOSTAT , . . .
Check that the valve closes ‘tightly-at temperature.
l Check for defects or damage.
Check for rust or other
Remove, if any.
Immerse thermostat in container of Stir to raise
water temperature and check that the thermostat valve
opening temperature and the water temperature with valve
fully open [valve lift: 8 mm in.)] are at the standard value.
Standard value:
Engine (Non-turbo)> Valve opening temperature:
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
Full-opening temperature:
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
NOTE
Measure valve height when fully closed. Calculate lift by mea-
suring the height when fully open.
Engine (Turbo) and Engine> Replace the thermostat if it does not open properly, or does
not have the correct valve lift.
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING Water Pump Engine (Non-turbo)>
12 Nm
8.7
Removal steps
1. Water pump
2. O-ring
TSB Revision
ENGINE COOLING Water Pump Engine
POINT
O-RING INSTALLATION ,
Insert the O-ring to the and
of the O-ring with water or coolant. By with
water or engine coolant, the insertion the will become
easier.
Caution
1. Do not allow engine oil or othei grease to to the
O-ring.
2. When inserting the water pump, check that there is no
sand, dirt, etc. on its inner surface’.
Revision
Water Pump Engine (Turbo) and.
ENGINE COOLING
12-15
12-15 24
17
12-15
Removal steps
1. Generator brace
2. Water pump
3. Water pump gasket
4. O-ring
TSB Revision
Water Pump Engine (Turbo)
ENGINE COOLING
TSB Revision
Water: Hose and Water Pipe Engine
ENGINE COOLING (Non-turbo)>
3.9
2.9
33
Removal steps
1. Air intake hose 7. Radiator fan motor assembly
2. Air hose connection 8. Radiator lower hose connection
3. Control wiring harness connection 9. Water hose
4. Water pipe assembly 10. Front exhaust pipe connection
5. Water hose Water inlet pipe assembly
6. Heater hose connection 12. O-ring
TSB Revision
Water Hose and Water Pipe Engine
ENGINE COOLING (Non-turbo)>
REMOVAL POINTS.
HEATER HOSE
Caution
For cover the a
before a heater hose, the-
below the hoses.
INSPECTION
WATER PIPE AND CHECK’
Check the water pipe and hose’ for cracks, damage,’
and replace them if necessary.
TSB
Water Hose and
ENGINE COOLING and Engine>
11 Specified Sealant:
24 or equivalent
17
24 Nm 3
17
48 Nm
35
58
Removal steps
1. Radiator upper hose connection 11. Heater hose connection
2. Radiator lower hose connection 12. inlet pipe assembly
3. Water hose
4. Heater hose connection hose
5. Water hose Water hose
6. Thermostat case assembly 16. Water pipe assembly (A)
17. Water pipe assembly (B)
8. Water pipe assembly 18. Water
9. Water hose 19. Water pipe (C)
10. Water hose 20. Joint
TSB Revision
Water Hose and Water Pipe
ENGINE COOLING and Engine>
Engine>
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation“
(1) Engine Coolant Draining and Supplying (Refer to
GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.)
(2) Air Cleaner Removal and Installation
(3) Exhaust Manifold Removal and
(Refer to GROUP 15 Exhaust Manifold.)
Specified Sealant:
Mitsubishi Genuine Part No.
or equivalent
Removal steps
1. Radiator upper hose connection 6. Water hose
2. Radiator lower hose 7. Heater hose connection
3. Thermostat case assembly 8. Water inlet pipe assembly
4. O-ring 9. o-ring
5. Water hose
TSB Revision
Water Hose and Water Engine (Turbo)
ENGINE and Engine>
in.)
INSPECTION
WATER PIPE AND HOSE CHECK
Check the water pipe and hose for cracks, damage, clogs
and replace them if necessary.
TSB Revision
INTAKE
EXHAUST,
CONTENTS 15166666676
GENERAL
The intake manifold is made of an alloy, The exhaust pipe is divided into three parts: the
and the shape provides an increased intake inertia front pipe, the center pipe, and the main muffler.
effect and has a good volumetric efficiency.
‘I
Items .
Identification
Supercharging pressure control Turbocharger waste gate actuator and solenoid valve
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS ,
Items Standard value Limit
Intake manifold and Distortion of the installation surface mm (in.) 0.15 or less
air intake plenum
Turbocharger waste gate solenoid terminal 36-44
resistance [at
.
Turbocharger Supercharging pressure (psi) (6.4-14.7)
SPECIAL TOOLS
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Exhaust gas leakage Loose joints Retighten
Broken pipe or muffler Repair or replace
Abnormal noise Broken baffle in muffler Replace
Broken rubber hangers Replace
Interference of pipe or muffler with vehicle body Correct
Broken pipe or muffler
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Service
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
INTAKE MANIFOLD VACUUM
.
Engine (Turbo)>
Refer to GROUP 11 A On-vehicle
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Refer to GROUP 11 On-vehicle Service.
Engine>’
Refer to GROUP 11 On-vehicle Service.
TURBOCHARGER SUPERCHARGING
PRESSURE CHECK <Turbo>
Caution
Do a test drive with two passengers in the and
where full throttle acceleration can be safely made.
A driver should not read the pressure gauge, but a front
passenger should.
TSB Revision
INTAKE CHARGE PRESSURE CONTROL
CHECK <Turbo>
(1) After the diagnostic trouble code of system is com-
pletely read, turn off the ignition switch.
(2) Disconnect the hose (black) from the turbocharger waste
gate solenoid and plug this hose.
(3) Connect a hand vacuum pump to the turbocharger waste
gate solenoid nipple to which the hose (black) was con-
nected.
CHECK ,
OPERATION CHECK .
(1) Connect a-hand
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST On-vehicle
TURBOCHARGER
<Turbo>
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST ..
CHARGE AIR COOLER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post-installation Operation
l Front Bumper Removal and Installation
(Refer to GROUP Bumper.)
Hose
7 A
7.2-9.4
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner assembly 9. Charge air cooler duct
2. Air duct assembly (B) 10. Charge air cooler
3. Relay box 11. Air hose (A)
4. Air bypass hose
5. Air intake hose NOTE
6. Air hose (C) Align the mating marks on the hoses and pipes, and
7. Turbocharger bypass valve move them.
8. Air hose (B)
INSPECTION
l Check the charge air cooler fins for bending, damage,
or foreign matter.
l Check the charge air cooler hoses for cracking, damage,
or wear.
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold Engine
2.9
3.9
2 . 9
O-ring
Engine oil
Removal steps
1. Air intake hose 10. wiring harness
2. Breather hose 11. connection
3. Accelerator cable connection 12. PCV hose assembly
4. Clip 13. Vacuum hose connection
5. MAP sensor connector 14. Brake booster hose
6. Charge temperature sensor connector connection
7. Vacuum hose connection 15. pipe connection
8. TPS connector 16. fuel hose connection
9. motor connector
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold Engine.
19.
23
17
23
17
oil
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold Engine ,
TSB Revision
0 INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold
...
INSPECTION 15100310123
Check the following points; replace the part if a problem is
found.
INTAKE MANIFOLD CHECK
1. Check for damage or cracking of any part.
Check for of the negative pressure (vacuum)
outlet port, and for obstruction of the water passage or
gas passage.
3. Using a straight edge and a feeler gauge, check for distor-
tion of the cylinder head installation surface.
Standard mm in.) or less
0.2 mm in.)
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold Engine
3.9 Nm
2.9
26
9.8 Nm
7.2
23 IEngine oil
Removal steps
Accelerator cable connection 14. Air conditioning compressor con-
2. Air hose nector
3. Injector connector 15. Control wiring harness
4. Ignition coil connector 16. Hose connection .
5. Ignition power transistor connector 17. PCV hose connection
6. Manifold pressure sen- 18. Vacuum hose connection
sor connector 19. Spark plug cable connection
7. Capacitor connector 20. Fuel return hose connection
TPS connector 21. Vacuum hose connection
9. Knock sensor connector 22. Vacuum pipe
10. Engine coolant temperature sensor 23. Brake booster hose con-
connector nection
11. motor connector 24. Heater hose
12. Camshaft position sensor connector 25. Heater hose
13. Crankshaft position sensor connector 26. High-pressure fuet hose connection
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold, Engine
, ,
Nm
Nm
38
12-15
27-34 Nm
27. Fuel rail, fuel injector and pressure 33. Intake manifold
regulator assembly Engine hanger
28. Insulator 35. Intake
29. Insulator 38. Intake manifold gasket
30. Ignition power transistor 37. Manifold sensor
31. Ignition coil 39. Charge air
32. EGR valve assembly 39. Throttle
TSB Revision
AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold
FUEL HOSE
Relieve pressure in line to prevent fuel outflow.
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.)
,
Cautlon
Cover fuel pipe line with shop after
sure as certain pressure may still
INSTALLATION
HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL HOSE
When connecting the high-pressure hose to the fuel rail,
apply a small amount of new engine oil to the hose union,
and then insert, beihg careful not to O-ring.
Caution
Do not let engine oil get into the rail.
INSPECTION 15100310123
Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold
INTAKE MANIFOLD
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
2.9
4.9 Nm
3.6’ 15
18
O-ring 10 Nm
7
Engine oil I
Removal
1. Accelerator cable connection 13. Evaporative emission purge
2. Air intake hose solenoid valve connector .
3. Injector connector 14. Control wiring harness
4. Ignition coil connector 15. PCV hose connection
5. Ignition power transistor connector 16. Vacuum hose
6. Manifold differential pressure sen- 17. Fuel return hose connection
sor connector 18. Vacuum hose connection
7. Capacitor connector 19. Vacuum pipe
8. TPS connector 20. Evaporative emission purge
9. motor connector solenoid valve assembly
10. Heated oxygen sensor connector 21. Brake booster vacuum hose
11. Crankshaft position sensor connector connection
12. Air conditioning compressor 22. Heater hose connection
connector 23. High-pressure fuel hose connection
TSB Revision
12 Nm
8.7
q 26
3.6
3 . 6
9.8 Nm
7.2
24. Fuel rail, fuel injector and pressure 30. Ignition coil
regulator assembly 31. Intake manifold stay
25. Insulator 32. Intake manifold
26. Insulator 33. Intake manifold gasket
27. Manifold erential pressure sensor 34. Throttle body
26. Ignition power transistor 35. EGR valve assembly
29. Spark plug cable connection
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Intake Manifold
INSTALLATION POINT,
HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL HOSE
When connecting the hose to the fuel rail,
apply a, small amount of new engine the hose union,
and then insert, being careful not to damage the O-ring.
C a u t i o n
Do not let engine oil get into fuel rail.
.
I N S P E C T I O N 15100310123
Check the following points; the part if is
found. .
INTAKE MANIFOLD CHECK
1. Check for damage or cracking of any part.
2. Check for obstruction of the negative pressure (vacuum)
outlet port, and for obstruction of the water passage or
gas passage.
3. Using a straight edge and a feeler gauge, check for distor-
tion of the cylinder head installation surface.
Standard value: 0.15 mm in.) or less
Limit: 0.2 mm in.)
TSB Revision
INTAKE, AND EXHAUST Exhaust Manifold Engine
3.9 Nm
2.9
Nm
44 Nm
33
Removal steps
1. Air intake hose 7. Heat protector
2. Radiator upper hose connection 6. Engine hanger
3. Air hose connection 9. Front exhaust connection
4. Control wiring harness connection 10. Heat protector
5. Water pipe assembly 11. Exhaust
6. Engine oil level gauge 12. Exhaust manifold gasket
TSB Revision I
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Manifold
Nm
12-15 Nm
8.8-11 -- 16’
3
.
.
Removal steps
1. Condenser fan motor assembly 9. Heat protector A)
with air conditioning> 10. Heat protector B)
2. Heated oxygen sensor <front> 11. Engine hanger
3. Engine oil level gauge guide 12. Front exhaust pipe connection
4. Air cleaner and air intake hose 13. Flange bolts
assembly 14. Flange
5. Air hose (A) connection 15. Coned disc spring .
6. Water hose connection 16. Exhaust -manifold
7. Water hose connection 17. Exhaust manifold gasket
8. Oil pipe (A) connection Ring
19. Gasket (A)
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Manifold
24
,
54-64 Nm
REMOVAL SERVICE
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR <FRONT> REMOVAL
TURBOCHARGER ASSEMBLY
Remove the turbocharger assembly with the exhaust fitting,
water pipe assembly (A), water pipe assembly (B) and the
oil pipe assembly attached to it.
OIL PIPE ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
Caution
After disconnecting the oil pipe, take care that foreign
material does not enter the oil passage hole of the turbo-
charger assembly.
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Manifold ENGINE (Turbo)>
Exhaust
manifold
INSPECTION
TURBOCHARGER ASSEMBLY CHECK ..
1. Visually check the turbine wheel and
wheel for cracking or other damage.
2. Check whether the turbine wheel and compressor
wheel can be easily turned by
3. Check for oil leakage from the turbocharger assembly.
4. Check if the turbocharger waste gate valve remains open.
If any problem is found, replace the part
.
Check the oil pipe assembly and oil-return pipe for clogging,
bending, or other damage. If there is clogging, clean it.
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Manifold
,
EXHAUST MANIFOLD ENGINE>
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
,
.
12-15 Nm 29 Nm
21
49 Nm
36
Removal steps
1. Front exhaust connection
2. Gasket
3. Heat protector
4. Engine hanger
5. Exhaust manifold
6. Exhaust manifold gasket
I
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Pipe and Main Muffler
18
9.4
9.4 ,
49
36 8
, I
9.4
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Pipe and Main
Engine
and Post-installation Operation
13
9.4
49
1
25
33 9.4
44 9.4
33 36
16
--
9.4
TSB Revision ,
15-24 INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Pipe Main
Engine
Pre-removal and Post-installation
l Under Cover Removal and Installation
(Refer to GROUP Cover.)
16
9.4
13
13
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND EXHAUST Exhaust Pipe . .
Engine>
Post-installation Operation ,
l Under Cover Removal and Installation
(Refer to GROUP Cover.)
9.4
3.4
13
9.4
9.4 49 Nm
36 bs.
-59 Nm
1
q 2
I 33 9.4 9.4
44 N m I
33 49
36
9.4
TSB Revision
INTAKE AND Pipe and Main
INSTALLATION SERVICE
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OXYGEN SENSER <REAR;
If reusing the original sensor, with
an antiseize compound such as
New sensors have compound on do not
require an additional coating.
TSB Revision
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
A cable-type accelerator mechanism and a
suspended-type pedal have been adopted.
SERVICE SPECIFICATION
I Item Standard value I
Accelerator cable play mm (in.)
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Engine Control
ADJUSTMENT
For models equipped with the auto-cruise
refer to
1. Turn and lights OFF.
Inspect and adjust” no load.
2. Warm engine until stabilized at
3. Confirm idle at
4. Stop engine (ignition switch OFF).
5. Confirm there are no in
6. Check cable for correct slack:
7. If there is too much
the following procedures.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to ON position (without
starting the in that condition
motor.’ ,,
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
4.9 Nm
11
13 Nm
9.4
4.9 Nm
TSB Revision
17-6 ENGINE ‘AND EMISSION Engine
ACCELERATOR
TSB Revision
AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
GENERAL INFORMATION
By using the auto-cruise control, the driver can (Non-turbo)>, km/h (25-124 mph)
drive at the speed he/she likes [in a range of Engine (Turbo) and Engine>] without
mately km/h (25-84 mph) Engine ing the accelerator pedal.
Engine Powertrain
(Non-turbo)>
assemblv
Control switch
Engine (Turbo)
and Engine> Control switch ,
.
Main switch
Actuator
Park/Neutral
switch
sensor
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL .
SERVICE
,
Items .
SPECIAL TOOLS
MUT-II
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control
NOTE
Before carrying out trouble diagnosis, check all the following items.
Is the vacuum hose correctly installed and undamaged?
2. Are the auto-cruise, accelerator, and throttle cables routed correctly?
3. Do the link assembly and cables move smoothly?
4. Is the play of each cable within its standard value?
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
HOW TO READ THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
When using the scan tool
Connect the scan tool to the data link connector, and then
read the diagnostic trouble codes.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise
.
ERASING DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
the scan tool
Connect the scan tool to the data link connector, then, erase the diagnostic trouble codes according
to scan tool instruction.
the scan tool
1. Remove the battery cable from the battery terminal for 10 seconds or more, then, reconnect
the cable.
2. After the engine has warmed up, run it at idle for about 15 minutes.
INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Code No.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-Cruise
Scan tool 86
I
Code General scan control switch Probable cause .
No.
Scan tool
Code General scan
control switch Probable
No.
.
34
[Comment] l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control
Speed control switch input below minimum acceptable voltage.
Scan tool 15
Code General scan Speed control servo solenoid
No. system
I , . I
[Comment] l Malfunction of the speed control
An open or shorted condition is detected in either the speed control vacuum or vent solenoid l Malfunction of the connector.
control circuits. l Malfunction of the
l Malfunction of ‘the PCM.
(Refer to
7
connector: Check trouble symptom.
7
Replace the PCM.
Repair
TSB Revision
17-12 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control
I Scan tool 0 2
control module
the control
OK
Check the following connector: Check trouble symptom.
NG
l Voltage between the terminal Replace the PCM.
l Voltage between terminal and
ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
A u t o - c r u i s e c o n t r o l - Check trouble symptom.
(Refer to 52 and 107
NG NG
auto-cruise control relay and the speed
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise
Auto-cruise control indicator light inside combination meter does not illuminate. 1 7 - 1 6
[However, auto-cruise control is normal.)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
When engine speed rises suddenly, auto-cruise control
does not cancel.
[Comment] l Malfunction of the
A malfunction of powertrain control module may exist.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3
When brake pedal is depressed,, auto-cruise control does not Probable cause
cancel.
[Comment] l Malfunction of the stop light switch.
A malfunction of the stop light switch or stop light circuit may exist. l Malfunction of the connector.
l Malfunction of the
l Malfunction of the PCM.
OK
following connectors: Check trouble symptom.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4
When selector lever is set to range, auto-cruise control does
not cancel.
[Comment]
An open-circuit in the output signal circuit in IN range may be present.
OK
and
.
NG
Inspect the between the
transaxle range switch and PCM.
OK
the PCM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
When auto-cruise control CANCEL switch is set to ON, Probable cause
auto-cruise control does not cancel.
[Comment] l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control switch.
An open-circuit inside the CANCEL switch may be present.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
Auto-cruise control cannot be set. cause
,
[Comment] l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control switch
A malfunction of the auto-cruise control switch circuit may exist. l Malfunction of spring.
l Malfunction of the connector.
l of
NG
Auto-cruise control switch check
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
Hunting (repeated acceleration and deceleration) occurs at the
set vehicle speed. Probable cause
NG
Speed control servo check
OK
NG
Vacuum supply check (Refer
the PCM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 8
When the auto-cruise control main switch is ON, the switch
indicator on the instrument panel does not illuminate. Probable cause
(However, auto-cruise control is normal.)
[Comment] l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control main
Blown bulb in auto-cruise control main switch. switch.
TSB Revision
17-16 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 9
Auto-cruise control main switch illumination light does not
illuminate. Probable cause
I I
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 10
Auto-cruise control indicator inside combination meter does Probable cause
not illuminate. (However, auto-cruise control is normal.)
l Malfunction of the bulb.
l Malfunction of the
l Malfunction of the connector.
l Malfunction of the PCM.
(Refer to
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise System
Does not
(Refer to (Refer to
No diagnostic trouble Diagnostic trouble No diagnostic
code or can’t code displayed trouble code
with scan tool
(Refer to
NOTE
Before carrying out trouble diagnosis, check to be sure that all of the following items are normal.
1. Is the vacuum hose correctly installed and undamaged?
2. Are the auto-cruise, accelerator, and throttle cables routed correctly?
3. Do the link assembly and cables move smoothly?
4. Is the play of each cable within its standard value?
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
HOW TO READ DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
When using the scan tool
1. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector.
Caution
Turn the ignition switch off before or
connecting the scan tool.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control
NOTE
Other on-board diagnostic items are also output as voltage waveforms corresponding to diagnostic trouble code
numbers.
HOW TO ERASE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
The diagnostic trouble codes can erased by disconnecting the cable from the battery for 10 seconds
or more and then reconnecting it, or by the following procedure.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
2. With the SET switch at the ON position, turn the main switch to ON, and within 1 second after this,
turn the RESUME switch to ON.
3. With the SET switch once more at the ON position, turn the stop light switch ON for a continuous
period of 5 seconds or more.
TSB Revision
AND CONTROL
Stop light switch Auto-cruise control-ECU judges that stop light switch is ON
23
(ON when brake pedal depressed)
16 Auto-cruise control-ECU
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise
(Refer to
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control’
1. NG NG
Measure at the vehicle speed sensor connector Check the following connector.
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the
harness side. O K
1. Voltage between 1 and ground Check trouble symptom.
(Ignition switch: ON)
System voltage NG
2. Voltage between 3 and ground 2. NG
(Ignition switch: ON) Check the harness between the speed sensor
OK: 4.6 5.2 and ignition switch connector
3. Continuity between 2 and ground 3. NG
OK
OK: Continuity
OK Check the ignition switch.
(Refer to GROUP 54 ,,
Check the following
OK NG
OK NG
Check the harness between the
cruise vacuum pump and the
cruise control-ECU.
and
TSB Revision
17-22 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
OK
NG
Check trouble symp l Inspect the harness between the
position sensor and
cruise control-ECU
OK
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control
Input switch inspection using the scan tool is not possible. (However,
diagnostic inspection is possible.) 3 .
TSB Revision
17-24 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
Refer to GROUP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
Communication with scan tool is not possible.
(Communication with auto-cruise control-ECU only is not Probable cause
possible.)
[Comment] l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control
mainswitch switch.
ground circuit may be present. l Malfunction of the connector.
l Malfunction of the harness.
l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control-ECU.
NG
Auto-cruise control main switch check Repair
to
OK
NG
Measure at auto-cruise control main
switch connector
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Voltage between the terminal (1) Check trouble symptom. Check the harness between the
and around auto-cruise control main switch and
OK: Battery positive voltage power supply. Repair, if necessary.
. Repair
24, and
OK
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION System
. ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3
Input switch inspection using the scan tool is pdssible.
(However, diagnostic inspection is possible.) I
[Comment] l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control
A malfunction of auto-cruise control switch circuit system may be present. l Malfunction of the clock spring .
l of the connector.
l Malfunction of the harness.
.
NG
(Refer to
l
sure at the harness side
l Voltage between terminal (2) and Check trouble symptom.
ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
Check trouble
spring and auto-cruise
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4
When brake pedal is depressed, auto-cruise control does not
Probable ,
cancel. ,
[Comment] l Malfunction of the stop light switch.
A malfunction of stop light switch or a malfunction of stop light circuit may be present. l Malfunction of the connector.
l Malfunction of. the
l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control-ECU.
TSB Revision
17-26 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
When clutch pedal is depressed, auto-cruise control does not Probable cause
cancel.
l Malfunction of the clutch pedal position switch.
or clutch circuit may be present. l Malfunction of the connector.
l Malfunction of the
l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control-ECU.
Check trouble symptom. Inspectthe harness between theclutch Replace the auto-cruise control-ECU.
pedal position switch and ground.
NG
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
When select lever is set to range, auto-cruise control does Probable cause
not cancel.
[Comment] l Malfunction of the position switch
The cause is probably an open-circuit in the output signal circuit in range. l Malfunction of the connector.
l Malfunction of the harness.
l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control-ECU.
check(Refer
Measure at park/neutral position switch -- Starter relay continuity check (Refer to
to
connector A-l 01. GROUP 16 Starting ing System.)
l Disconnect the connector and
OK
measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between terminal (6) and
NG
ground Engine> and
l Voltage between terminal (5) and
ground Engine> OK
OK: Battery positive voltage
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness between-the
neutral position switch
control-ECU. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Control. System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
When auto-cruise control CANCEL switch is set to ON,
auto-cruise control does not cancel.
[Comment] l the
An open-circuit in the circuit inside the CANCEL switch may be present.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 8
The diagnostic result displayed on the scan tool is normal
even though auto-cruise control cannot be set. Probable cause
TSB Revision
17-28 ENGINE AND CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 9
Auto-cruise control cannot be set. cause
[Comment] Malfunction of the auto-cruise control main
A malfunction of switches or that the fail-safe function auto-cruise control may be switch.
present. l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control
l Malfunction of the clock
l Malfunction of the harnesses or connectors.
l of the clutch pedal position switch
l Malfunction of control-EC@
No
Can the auto-cruise control communicate with the scan Inspection for each trouble symptom.
(Refer to inspection procedure No. 2 on
Yes
Is input switch inspection possible with the scan tool? Inspection for trouble symptom.
Yes (Refer to inspection procedure No. 3 on
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 10
Hunting (repeated acceleration deceleration) occurs at the
set vehicle speed.
l Malfunction of the vehicle speed sensor.
A malfunction of vehicle speed sensor or incorrect vacuum in the auto-cruise vacuum pump l Malfunction of the auto-cruise
l Malfunction
l Malfunction of the auto-cruise control-ECU.
NG
Auto-cruise vacuum pump check (Refer to Replace
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 11
When the auto-cruise control main switch is ON, the switch
indicator on the instrument panel does not illuminate.
(However, auto-cruise control is normal.) Probable cause
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 12
Auto-cruise control main switch illumination light does not
illuminate. Probable cause
(Refer to
NG
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 13
Auto-cruise control indicator inside combination meter does
not illuminate. (However, auto-cruise control is normal.) Probable cause
to
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 14
Stop light switch input circuit system check (Code No. 23)
I I
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 15
Clutch pedal position switch or position switch input circuit system check
(Code No. 26)
<M/T>
OK
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness between clutch pedal position switch and
auto-cruise control-ECU. Repair, if necessary.
NG
Park/neutral position switch check (Refer to
57
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness between auto-cruise control-ECU and power
TSB Revision
,
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
TSB Revision
ENGINE EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control
Normal
Check item Check conditions condition
No.
14 Ground A? all times Continuity
When brake pedal is
When stop light switch ON
Stop light switch depressed voltage
15
input When brake pedal is not When stop light switch is
depressed OFF
ECU backup Al all times Battery
16 voltage
power supply
When SET switch is pressed When SET switch is ON
When SET switch is not When SET switch is OFF
pressed
When RESUME switch is When RESUME switch is
pressed ON
Auto-cruise control
18 When RESUME switch is not When RESUME switch is
switch input ov
pressed OFF
When CANCEL switch is Battery positive
When CANCEL switch is ON
voltage
When CANCEL switch is not When CANCEL switch is
pressed OFF
When vehicle is moved When sensor is ON
Vehicle speed and backwards,
19 sensor turns ON and OFF
sensor input
repeatedly. When sensor is OFF 4.5 or more
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL CABLE CHECK AND ADJUSTMENT
Accelerator cable
Adjusting bolts
To intake manifold
assembly
Engine (Turbo)
and Engine>
Actuator
Link assembly
Accelerator cable
Auto-cruise vacuum
Revision
Auto-cruise Control System
Engine (Non-turbo)>
CABLE
Link (A)
1. Adjust with the adjusting nut A so when the hits
the stopper, the accelerator cable play (inner cable play
reaches the standard value.
Standard value:
O-l mm in.)
2-3 mm in.)
2. Fix the accelerator cable with the lock nut.
nut
Accelerator cable
Link(A)
Engine (Non-turbo)>
THROTTLE CABLE
1. Adjust with the adjusting nut so when the lever hits
the link A, the throttle cable play (inner cable play) reaches
the standard value.
Standard value: mm in.)
2. Fix the throttle cable with the lock nut.
cable .
Engine (Turbo) and Engine> 3. Tighten the throttle lever-side adjusting bolt to the specified
torque.
Throttle cable
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL
1. Switch ON the main switch.
2. Drive at the desired speed within the range of
approximately km/h mph) Engine
(Non-turbo)>, km/h (25-124 mph) Engine
(Turbo) and Engine>.
3. Switch ON the SET switch.
4. Check to be sure that when the switch is released the
speed is the desired constant. speed,
ON
NOTE
‘If the vehicles speed decreases to approximately 15 km/h
(9 mph) below the set speed because of climbing a hill
for example, the auto-cruise-‘control will be canceled.
TSB Revision
17-36 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
SPEED-INCREASE
RESUME switch: ON
1. Set to the desired speed.
2. Switch ON the RESUME switch.
3. Check to be sure that acceleration continues while the
switch is hold, and that when it is released the constant
speed at the time when it was becomes the
driving speed.
SPEED REDUCTION
1. Set to the desired speed.
2. Switch ON the SET switch.
3. Check to be sure that deceleration -continues while the
switch is pressed, and that when it is released the constant
speed at the time when it was released becomes the
driving speed.
NOTE
SET switch: ON When the vehicle speed reaches the low limit
6 [approximately 40 km/h (25 mph)] during deceleration,
the auto-cruise control will be canceled.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
CONTROL COMPONENT
TSB Revision
17-38 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise’ Control
<Release valve closed, control valve 3. Connect terminal (1) to the battery terminal, and
closed> connect terminals (2) and (3) to the battery terminal.
4. Check to be sure that the vacuum gauge shows a reading
of 53 (15.7 or more when (4) is
connected to the battery terminal.
<Release valve open> 5. In this condition, check to be sure that the vacuum gauge
shows a 20 (6 or less when terminals (2)
and (3) are disconnected from the battery.
I I
<Control valve
I
Battery
00000264
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Engine
(Non-turbo)>
Engine (Turbo)
and Engine>
7 6
4
17
00003900
TSB Revision
17-42 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise Control System
CAUTION:
Before removal of air bag module and clock spring, refer to the following sections:
GROUP SRS Service Precautions.
GROUP Air Bag Modules Clock Spring.
41 Nm 5.9 Nm
30 4.3
28
38
Auto-cruise control switch and Sensor removal steps
clock spring steps 33. Throttle position sensor
27. Air bag module Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
(Refer to GROUP Bag 34. Transaxle range switch
Modules and Clock Spring.) Engine (Non-turbo)
28. Auto-cruise control 35. Park/neutral position switch
29. Steering wheel Engine AA and
30. Steering column upper cover Engine
31. Steering column lower cover 36. Stop light switch
l under cover (Refer to 37. Clutch pedal position switch
GROUP Panel.) Engine (Turbo) M/T and
32. Clock spring Engine
(Refer to GROUP Bag 38. Vehicle speed sensor <Except
Modules and Clock Spring.) Engine (Non-turbo)
39. Input speed sensor
Engine (Non-turbo)
40. Output speed sensor
Engine (Non-turbo)
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Control
..
INSPECTION
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH CHECK
Switch Terminal No.
ON 0
0 0
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Auto-cruise System’,
TSB Revision
Emission
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
GENERAL INFORMATION
The emission control system consists of the following sub-systems:
l Positive crankcase ventilation system
l Evaporative emission control system
l Exhaust emission control system
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Evaporative emission purge solenoid coil resistance 25-35
[at
Electric EGR transducer solenoid coil resistance .
[at 25-35
TROUBLESHOOTING 17300070052
TSB Revision
17-46 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
VACUUM HOSES
VACUUM HOSE
I I
To heater and
control
Two way
valve
Vent
EVAP
solenoid
EVAP
canister
To engine block
EVAP Back pressure EGR and
emission electric EGR transducer
sole assembly
Revision
Emission
ENGINE AND EMISSION
.
VACUUM CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
To combustion
Electric EGR
transducer
EGR valve
EVAP
canister
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Ventilation hose
COMPONENT LOCATION
Positive crankcase ventilation valve
Valve
Revision
Emission
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL (Non-turbo)>
CRANKCASE, CHECK’
Positive crankcase
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VALVE
ventilation CHECK
1. Insert a thin rod into the positive
valve from the side shown in the illustration (rocker cover
installation side), and move the rod back forth to
confirm that the plunger moves.
2. If the plunger does not move, the valve is clogged. In
this case, clean or replace, the valve.
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
GENERAL INFORMATION
The evaporative emission control system prevents purge solenoid, the power-train control module
the emission of fuel tank vapors into the atmo- (PCM) allows intake manifold vacuum to draw va-
sphere. When fuel evaporates in the fuel tank, pors into the combustion chambers during certain
the vapors pass through vent hoses or tubes to engine operating conditions. The plunger solenoid
the charcoal filled EVAP canister. The EVAP canis- regulates vapor flow from the canister to the engine.
ter temporarily holds the vapors. Through the EVAP
OPERATION
The EVAP purge solenoid regulates the rate of grammed time delay ends. During closed loop
vapor flow from the EVAP canister to the throttle operation, the PCM energizes and de-energizes
body. The PCM controls solenoid operation. the solenoid approximately 5 to 10 times per se-
During the cold start warm-up period and the hot cond, depending on operating conditions. The PCM
start time delay, the PCM does not energize the varies the vapor flow rate by changing solenoid
solenoid. When de-energized, no vapors are pulse width. Pulse width is the amount of time
purged. The PCM de-energizes the solenoid during the solenoid de-energizes.
open loop operation.
The engine enters closed loop operation after it
reaches a specified temperature and the
COMPONENT LOCATION
Evaporative emission purge solenoid
Revision
Emission
ENGINE AND CONTROL
PURGE PORT VACUUM CHECK
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle body purge
vacuum nipple and connect a hand vacuum pump to
the nipple.
Vacuum
2. Start the engine and raise the speed. Vacuum should
be kept constant regardless of the increased engine
speed.
NOTE
If no vacuum is generated, the throttle body purge port
may be clogged.
Engine speed
AFUOO
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
TSB Revision
Emission
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER/AIR
VENTILATION SOLENOID
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
Splash Shield (R.H.) Removal and Installation
fer to GROUP
Removal steps
1. Suction hose fixing bolts 6. Vapor hose
2. Pressure tube fixing bolt 9. Evaporative emission ventilation
3. Air filter solenoid bracket
4. Air filter bracket 10. Evaporative emission ventilation
Evaporative emission canister and solenoid
evaporative emission ventilation 11. Evaporative emission canister
solenoid assembly holder assemblv
6. Vent hose 12. Evaporative emission canister
7. Vapor hose assembly
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
GENERAL INFORMATION
The EGR system reduces oxides in engine The EGR system contents:
exhaust and helps prevent detonation (engine l EGR tube
knock). The system allows a predetermined amount l EGR valve
of hot exhaust gas to recirculate and dilute the l Electronic EGR Transducer
incoming air/fuel mixture. The diluted air/fuel mix- l Connecting hoses
ture reduces peak flame during com-
bustion.
OPERATION
The electronic EGR transducer an electri- closes the transducer bleed valve. This causes
cally operated solenoid and a back-pressure trans- vacuum to flow through the transducer to operate
ducer. The Control Module (PCM) con- the EGR valve.
trols operation of the solenoid. Exhaust system Energizing the but not fully closing the
back-pressure controls the transducer. transducer bleed. hole (because of low back-pres-
When the PCM de-energizes the vacuum sure), varies the strength of vacuum to
does not reach the transducer. the EGR valve.
Vacuum only flows to the transducer when the PCM Varying the strength of the vacuum changes the
energizes the solenoid. amount of EGR supplied to the engine.
When exhaust system back-pressure becomes high This provides the correct amount of exhaust gas
enough, a bleed valve in the transducer closes. for different operating conditions.-
The PCM energizes the solenoid and back-pressure
COMPONENT LOCATION
Electric EGR transducer solenoid EGR valve
Revision
Emission Control
Engine
..
C H E C K
To ensure proper operation of system, all
and moving parts must be free of
plugging or sticking.
Ensure that the system’ hoses do not leak.
Replace leaking components.
1. Check the EGR and valve with
engine fully warmed up and running coolant
perature over
2. With the transaxle in neutral and the allow.
the engine to idle seconds.
3. Abruptly accelerate the engine approximately
but not over 3000
4, The valve ‘stem should move when accelerating
the engine. Repeat the test several- times-to
movement.
5. If the EGR valve stem moves, the control system is
ing normally.
6 . Remove the vacuum hose from the EGR valve and plug
the hose end.
7. Connect a hand vacuum pump directly to the EGR valve.
8. Check whether the engine stalls or if the idle is unstable
when a vacuum of 12 (3.5 or higher is applied
while idling.
EGR CHECK
1. Remove the EGR valve and inspect for
deposits, etc. If the
with a suitable solvent so’ it will seat
2. Connect a hand vacuum pump to the
3. Apply 67 (20 of vacuum, and check that the
vacuum is maintained.
4. vacuum according to and check
the passage of air by either side of the
EG passages.
5. Replace the gasket, and tighten the valve to the specified
torque.
torque: 22 Nm (16
Vacuum Passage of air
5.3 (1.6 or less Air blows out of opposite
passage.
29 (8.7 or more Air does not blow out of
posite passage.
TSB Revision
Emission Control System
ENGINE AND
Vacuum 2. Start the engine and gradually raise the speed. The vacu-
um reading on the pump should remain constant.
Engine speed
TSB Revision
Emission Control
AND EMISSION CONTROL
8. Measure the resistance between the solenoid terminals.
Standard value: [at
CATALYTIC CONVERTER
GENERAL INFORMATION
The three-way catalytic converter, together with When the mixture is controlled at stoichiometric
the closed loop air-fuel ratio control (based on the air-fuel ratio, the three-way catalytic converter pro-
oxygen sensor signal) oxidizes carbon monoxides vides the highest purification against CO, HC, and
(CO) and hydrocarbons (HC), and reduces nitrogen
oxides
9.4
36
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
INSPECTION
Check for damage, cracking or deterioration. Replace if faulty.
Caution
1. Stop the engine immediately if engine misfiring
occurs, otherwise an abnormally hot exhaust system
will damage the catalytic converter or other underbody
parts.
2. Correct and repair the ignition or fuel system if there
are malfunctions, otherwise engine misfiring may
occur which will damage the catalytic converter.
3. Observe manufacturer’s specifications when doing
service work.
TSB Revision
(Turbo) 2.41 Engines
GENERAL INFORMATION
The emission control system consists of the following sub-systems:
l Positive crankcase ventilation system
l Evaporative emission control system
l Exhaust emission control system
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Evaporative emission purge solenoid coil resistance 36-44
[at
EGR solenoid coil resistance [at 36-44
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name Supersession Application
700 Checking the purge control
system
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Engine will not start or Vacuum hose disconnected or damaged. Repair or
is hard to start.
The EGR valve is not closed. Repair or replace
Rough idle or engine The EGR valve is not closed. Repair or replace
stalls.
Vacuum hose disconnected or damaged. Repair or replace
Excessive oil Positive crankcase ventilation line clogged. Check positive crankcase ventilation
sumption. system.
Poor fuel mileage. Malfunction of the exhaust gas recirculation Check the system: if there is a
system. check its component parts.
TSB Revision
(Turbo) and Engine>
VACUUM HOSES
VACUUM HOSE ROUTING
Engine (Turbo)>
To evaporative emission
(EVAP) canister EGR solenoid Evaporative emission Fuel pressure
(EVAP) purge solenoid solenoid
I
Turbocharger waste
gate solenoid gate actuator
Front
L: Light Blue
Red
Black
G: Green
Yellow
W: White
Revision
(Turbo) and
Engine> ,
,
Evaporative emission solenoid
(EVAP) canister
Vacuum control
valve
EGR
Evaporative
(EVAP) purge
Front
Blue
B: Black
G: Green
Y: Yellow
White
Revision
Engine and
Check
EVAP canister
EVAP
(ON: open)
Air
Turbocharger waste
gate Turbochargerwaste
ate solenoid
ON: open)
TSB Revision
Engine
Engine>
G: Green
Yellow
White
intake air
Throttle body
To combustion
chamber
Red
paint
mark
EGR
(ON: closed)
EVAP purge
(ON: open)
Fuel pressure
regulator
EVAP canister
EGR
TSB Revision
(Turbo) and Engine>
GENERAL INFORMATION
The positive crankcase ventilation system (PCV) The plunger inside the positive crankcase
prevents the escape of blow-by from inside tion valve is designed to lift according to intake
the crankcase into the atmosphere. manifold vacuum, regulating the flow of blow-by.
Fresh air is sent from the air cleaner into the The blow-by gas flow is decreased during low load
case through the breather hose, be mixed with engine operation to maintain engine stability, and
the blow-by gases inside the crankcase. is increased during high load operation to improve
The blow-by gas inside the is drawn the ventilation performance.
into the intake manifold through the positive crank-
case ventilation valve.
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Engine (Turbo)>
Breather hose
Positive crankcase
Revision
Emission Control
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL and
__
Ventilation hose
Breather hose
COMPONENT LOCATION
Positive crankcase ventilation valve
TSB Revision
17-66 AND (Turbo) and
Revision
(Turbo) and
Thin stick
PCV valve
TSB Revision
17-68 ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL (Turbo) and
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Check valve EVAP canister
To air intake
hose
EVAP purge
s o l e n o i d
Engine control
module
I 1
Barometric pressure sensor
COMPONENT LOCATION
Evaporative emission purge solenoid
Revision
(Turbo) and
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Engine control
module
Barometric pressure
sensor
Intake air temperature
sensor
Engine coolant
temperature sensor EVAP ventilation
Volume air flow
sensor
COMPONENT LOCATION
Evaporative emission ventilation
Evaporative emission purge solenoid solenoid
TSB Revision
17-70 CONTROL (Turbo) and Engine>
EVAP purge
solenoid
(ON: OPEN)
Nipple
Purge
control
valve
Air cleaner
Check valve
Purge flow
indicator
700)
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL
4. Check the purge when
carried out several times. .
Standard value: Momentarily 20 (2.5 SCFH)
or more
5. If the purge flow volume is less thah the standard value,
check it again with the vacuum hose disconnected from
the EVAP canister.
If the purge flow volume is below the standard values,
check for blockages in the vacuum port and vacuum hose,
and also check the evaporative emission purge solenoid
and the purge control valve.
If the purge flow volume is at the standard value, replace
the EVAP canister.
TSB Revision
(Turbo) and Engine>
OFF
ON
EVAP purge
solenoid
(ON: OPEN)
Purge flow
hose I indicator
EVAP canister
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION
4. Check the purge when sudden is
carried out several’
value: (2.5 SCFH)
more , __
5. If the purge flow, volume ‘is than the value,
check it again with the hose from
the EVAP canister.
If the purge flow volume the
check for blockages in the vacuum
and also check the evaporative
and the purge control
If the purge flow volume is at the value, replace
the EVAP canister.
Revision
Engine (Turbo) Engine>
Enginespeed
Engine (Turbo)>
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the intake manifold
purge vacuum nipple and connect a hand vacuum pump
to the nipple.
Engine speed
TSB Revision
.
Engine (Turbo)> EVAPORATIVE EMISSION PURGE --SOLENOID
CHECK
NOTE
When disconnecting the vacuum hose, place an
mark on it proper reconnection.
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the valve.
2. Disconnect the harness connector.
3. Connect a hand vacuum pump to nipple (A) of the solenoid’
valve (refer to the at left).
4. Check air-tightness by applying a vacuum with voltage
applied directly from the battery to the purge control sole-
noid. valve.
Battery voltage
Applied Vacuum leaks
Not applied Vacuum
, .
Engine>
TSB Revision
AND CONTROL (Turbo) and Engine>
Valve
3. Apply a vacuum of 53 (16 and check
ness.
4. Blow in air lightly from the evaporative emission canister
side nipple and check conditions as follows.
Hand vacuum pump vacu- Normal condition
um
0 (0 (No vacuum Air does not blow through
is applied)
27 (8.0 or more Air blow through
Revision
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER/FUEL TANK PRESSURE
RELIEF VALVE/PURGE CONTROL VALVE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Engine (Turbo)>
Removal steps
1. Battery bracket 8. Vapor hose
2. Shift and con- 9. Check valve
nection 10. Clamp’
3. Vapor hose hose
4. Connector 12. Purge control
5. Vapor hose 13. Evaporative canister
6. Fuel tank pressure relief 14. Evaporative emission canister
7. Vapor hose er assembly
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
Engine>
Removal steps
1. Evaporative emission 10. Vent hose
2. Vent hose 11. Filter bracket
3. Vent hose 12. Air filter
4. Connector 13. Evaporative emission canister up-
5. Vent hose per bracket
6. Vapor hose 14. Evaporative
7. Connector 15. emission
8. Evaporative emission purge hose
9. Vapor hose
TSB Revision
FUEL TANK ,
INSTALLATION
Install the fuel relief
Evaporative
emission on the left. ,
canister side
,
I..-
,
INSPECTION
FUEL TANK PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE SIMPLE .
,
WARNING
To avoid bodily injury, do not breathe fuel
Attach a clean hose and tank
TSB Revision
(Turbo) and Engine>
GENERAL INFORMATION
The exhaust gas recirculation (EG system lowers chamber through the intake manifold to decrease
the nitrogen oxide emission level. When the the mixture combustion temperature, result-
air/fuel mixture combustion temperature is high, ing in reduction of
a large quantity of nitrogen oxides is gener- The EGR flow rate is controlled by the EGR valve
ated in the combustion Therefore, this so as not to decrease the
system recirculates part of emission gas from the
exhaust port of the cylinder head to the combustion
OPERATION
When the engine coolant is low, when In normal vehicle operation performed after warm-
the engine is at idle or when a wide open throttle ing up of the engine, the EGR valve is opened
operation is performed, the EGR valve is kept to carry out EGR.
closed, achieving no EGR.
The manifold differential pressure sensor is located The ECM uses this to check the operation of the,
in the intake manifold plenum. This sensor detects EGR system. If a problem is found, the check en-’
variations in the manifold pressure when indicator light illuminates to warn
the EGR solenoid is momentarily operated. If the the driver that a problem has occurred.
manifold negative pressure the EGR sys-
tem is normal.
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Engine (Turbo)>
EGR solenoid
EGR valve
Engine control
module
relay I
sensor
Engine coolant
temperature sensor
sensor
Manifold differential
pressure sensor,
TSB Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Engine (Turbo) end
Engine>
Engine
module
relay
COMPONENT LOCATION
Engine (Turbo)>
EGR solenoid EGR valve
Engine>
EGR solenoid EGR valve
TSB Revision
Emission Control
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Engine
TSB Revision
(Turbo) and Engine>
TSB Revision
and
Engine>
Vacuum
2. Start the engine and gradually raise the speed.’ The vacu-
um reading on the pump should remain
NOTE
If no vacuum is generated, the throttle body purge port
may be clogged.
Enginespeed
Revision
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL (Turbo)
NOTE
When disconnecting the vacuum’ hose, identification
mark on it for p r o p e r r e c o n n e c t i o n .
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose (yellow stripe, stripe,
green stripe) from the solenoid valve.
2. Disconnect the harness connector.
Revision
Emission
AND EMISSION CONTROL Engine
SOLENOID CHECK
NOTE ,
When disconnecting the vacuum
mark on it for proper re-connection.
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose (yellow stripe; stripe)
from the solenoid valve;
2. Disconnect the harness connector.
27
.
TSB Revision
Emission Control System
ENGINE AND EMISSION CONTROL Engine (Turbo) and
GENERAL INFORMATION
The three-way catalytic converter, together with When the mixture is controlled at stoichiometric
the closed loop air-fuel ratio control (based on the air-fuel ratio, the three-way catalytic converter pro-
oxygen sensor signal) oxidizes carbon monoxides vides the highest purification against CO, HC, and
(CO) and hydrocarbons (HC), and reduces nitrogen
oxides
13 Nm
9.4 13 Nm
I
36
. .
36
Removal steps
1. Front exhaust pipe
2. Gasket
3. Catalytic converter
4. Gasket
INSPECTION
Check for damage, cracking or deterioration. Replace if faulty.
Caution
1. Stop the engine immediately if engine misfiring oc-
curs, otherwise an abnormally hot exhaust system
will damage the catalytic converter or other under-
body parts.
2. Correct and repair the ignition or fuel system if there
are malfunctions, otherwise engine misfiring may oc-
cur which will damage the catalytic converter.
3. Observe manufacturer’s specifications when doing
service work.
Revision
CLUTCH
CONTENTS
CLUTCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CLUTCHOVERHAUL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NOTES
CONTENTS
LUBRICANTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
21 CLUTCH General Information
GENERAL INFORMATION
The clutch is a dry single-disc, diaphragm type;
hydraulic pressure is used for the clutch control.
Clutch hose
NOTE
This figure shows Engine (Turbo).
Revision
CLUTCH Service Specifications/Lubricants
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Clutch pedal height mm (in.)
Clutch pedal pin play mm (in.)
Clutch pedal free play mm (in.) 6-13
Distance between the clutch pedal and
the when the clutch is disengaged mm (in.) 70 (2.76) or more
LUBRICANTS
Items Specified lubricants Quantity
Clutch fluid Brake Fluid DOT 3 or DOT 4 As required
Push rod assembly Rubber grease As required
Boot
Release cylinder push rod MITSUBISHI genuine grease As required
Part No. 0101011 or equivalent
Clutch pedal shaft, bushings and end of the Brake grease SAE No. 1 As required
pedal
Clutch master cylinder push rod, pin
and washer
Clutch release cylinder pin
Revision
CLUTCH
21199979939
Revision
CLUTCH -On-vehicle Service
Clutch pedal free Distance between the 6. After completing the adjustments, confirm that the clutch
clutch pedal and the pedal free play (measured at the face of the pedal pad)
when the
clutch is disengaged and the distance between. the pedal (the face of
the pedal pad) and the when the clutch is disen-
gaged are within the standard value ranges...
Clutch pedal free play (including the pin play)
Standard value (C): 6-13 mm in.)
Distance between the clutch pedal and
when the clutch is disengaged
00000089 Standard value (D): mm (2.76 in.) or more
7. If the clutch pedal free play and the distance between
the clutch pedal and the when the clutch is disen-
gaged do not agree with the standard values, it is probably
the result of either air in the hydraulic system or a faulty
master cylinder or clutch. Bleed the air, or disassemble
and inspect the master cylinder or clutch.
8. Turn back the carpet, etc.
TSB Revision
CLUTCH On-vehicle Service
1. Lock the front wheels, apply the parking brake and put
the shift lever in the gear.
2. After normally adjusting the clutch pedal, check the inter-
lock switch operation as follows:
(1) The engine should not start even if the ignition switch
is turned to “START” position with the clutch pedal
not depressed. If the engine should start, check the
interlock switch harness.
(2) The engine should start after the clutch has been
disconnected while the clutch pedal is depressed with
the ignition switch turned to “START” position.
If the engine should start before the clutch pedal
is disconnected or the engine does not start even
if the clutch pedal is depressed, adjust the interlock
switch.
Revision
CLUTCH On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
21 CLUTCH Clutch Pedal
CLUTCH PEDAL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
l Scuff Plate Removal GROUP l Clutch Pedal Adjustment (Refer to
Cowl Side Trim Removal l Junction Block Installation
(Refer to GROUP Trims.) l Cowl Side Trim Installation
l Junction Block Installation Boll: Removal (Refer to GROUP Trims.)
Scuff Plate Installation
(Refer to GROUP Trims.)
I
Nm 29 Nm
7-9 21
5 00003519
Removal steps
1. Instrument under Engine (Turbo)>
(Refer to GROUP
Panel.) Clutch pedal
2. Master cylinder installation nuts 13. Bushing
3. Clutch pedal return spring 14. Spacer
gine (Non-turbo) Engine> 15. Pedal pad
4. Clevis pin 16. Adjusting bolt <Vehicles without
5. Clutch pedal assembly clutch pedal position
6. Clevis pin (Turbo)> 17. Clutch pedal position switch
7. Rod A Engine (Turbo)> <Vehicles with clutch pedal position
8. Turnover spring Engine
18. Interlock switch
9. Rod Engine (Turbo)> 19. Clutch pedal bracket assembly
Revision
CLUTCH Clutch
INSPECTION
l Check the pedal shaft for, wear.
l Check the clutch ‘for
l Check the return spring for or
l Check the turnover spring for
l Check the pedal pad for damage or wear.
TSB Revision
CLUTCH Clutch Control
CLUTCH CONTROL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Operation
l Clutch Fluid Draining
Specified grease:
MITSUBISHI genuine grease
Part No. 0101011 or equivalent I
Engine (Non-turbo)> Nm
4 9
11
00003520
11
Clutch master removal Clutch release cylinder removal
steps steps
1. Clevis pin 6. Clutch pipe connection
2. Clutch pipe 7. Clutch release cylinder
3. Clutch master cylinder
4. Sealer Clutch line removal steps
5. Reservoir bracket
8. Clutch pipe
11. Clutch pipe
12. Clutch hose
13. Clutch hose bracket
TSB Revision
CLUTCH Clutch
Nm
7-9
Engine (Turbo)>
11
TSB Revision
CLUTCH Clutch Control
INSPECTION
l Check the pedal shaft bushing for wear.
l Check the pedal arm for bend or torsion.
l Check the turnover spring for deterioration.
l Check the master cylinder or clutch hose for fluid leakage.
l Check the clutch hose or pipe for cracks or clogging.
Revision
CLUTCH Clutch Master Cylinder
. .
.
(Non-turbo)
Engine (Turbo)>
Disassembly steps
1. Piston stopper ring 7. Reservoir cap
rod assembly 8. Reservoir tank
9. Reservoir band
Piston assembly 10. Nipple
5. Return spring 11. Clutch master cylinder body
6. Reservoir hose
0820004
INSPECTION
l Check the inside cylinder body for rust or scars.
l Check the piston cup for wear or deformation.
l Check the piston rust or scars.
l Check the clutch pipe connection for clogging.
TSB Revision
NOTES
OVERHAUL
CONTENTS
SPECIFICATIONS 21200030047
0.3
Diaphragm spring end height difference
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
Nm ft.
Clutch cover bolt 19 14
Release cylinder mounting bolt 19 14
Release cylinder union bolt 23 17
Release cylinder bleeder plug 11 8.0
Release fork fulcrum 36 24
Clutch chamber bracket mounting bolt 19 14
Clutch line tube flare nut 15 11
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Revision
CLUTCH OVERHAUL Specifications
LUBRICANTS
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
I Specified lubricants
Clutch release cylinder inner surface Brake Fluid or
Piston and cup of surface
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Items Specified lubricants
Clutch flywheel assembly spline Mitsubishi genuine grease Part As required
No. or equivalent
Clutch release release cylinder contact surface
Clutch release lever to release bearing contact surface
TSB Revision
21 CLUTCH OVERHAUL Clutch
CLUTCH
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION Engine
Removal steps
1. Oil tube 5. Clutch release lever
2. Clutch release cylinder 6. Clutch control equip stud
3. Clutch flywheel 7. Boot
4. Clutch release bearing
NOTE
The modular clutch assembly flywheel assembly) used in this vehicle consists of a single,
dry-type clutch disc and a diaphragm style clutch cover. The clutch unit is serviced as an assembly.
No disassembly is possible.
Revision
CLUTCH OVERHAUL Clutch
15 Nm
11
23
17
19 Nm
14
19 Nm
14
Removal steps
1. Clutch oil tube (A) 10. Clutch cover
2. Clutch tube 11. Clutch disc
3. Clutch oil fluid chamber 12. Return clip
4. Union bolt 13. Clutch release bearing
5. Gasket ä 14. Release fork
6. Union 15. Release fork boot
7. Valve plate 16. Fulcrum
8. Valve plate spring 17. Transmission
9. Clutch release cylinder
TSB Revision
21 CLUTCH OVERHAUL Clutch
Revision
- -
CLUTCH OVERHAUL Clutch
CLUTCH DISC/CLUTCH COVER ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
(1) Apply specified grease to clutch disc splines and squeeze
it in place with a brush.
Specified grease:
Clutch disc MITSUBISHI genuine grease No. 0101011 or
equivalent
(2) Using clutch disc guide to position clutch disc on flywheel.
Clutch cover
assembly
TSB Revision
21 CLUTCH OVERHAUL Clutch
INSPECTION 21200110043
TSB Revision
CLUTCH OVERHAUL Clutch
CLUTCH RELEASE
Caution
Release bearing is packed with grease. do
wash it in cleaning solvent the like.
l Check bearing for seizure, damage, noise, or improper
rotation. Check also diaphragm spring contact surface
for wear.
l Replace bearing if its release fork contact surface is abnor-
mally worn.
RELEASE FORK
l Replace release fork if its bearing contact surface is abnor-
mally worn.
Engine (Non-turbo)>
CLUTCH FLYWHEEL ASSEMBLY
l Check clutch assembly for contamination (dirt, oil).
Replace clutch assembly, if required.
l Check to see if the clutch disc hub are damaged.
Replace with new clutch assembly, if necessary.
l Check for uneven wear on clutch fingers.
l Check for broken clutch cover diaphragm spring fingers.
Replace with new clutch assembly, if necessary.
CLUTCH RELEASE BEARING
l Check to see if the release bearing is sticky or binding.
Replace bearing, if needed.
CLUTCH RELEASE LEVER/CLUTCH CONTROL EQUIP
STUD
l Check linkage for excessive wear on the pivot stud and
fork fingers.
Replace all worn parts.
TSB Revision
(Turbo)
Brake fluid or
4
q3
1
2
5
Piston
8.0
I Brake fluid or
Disassembly steps
1. Push rod 5. Conical spring
2. Boot 6. Cap
3. Piston cup 7. Bleeder plug
4. Piston 8. Release cylinder
TSB Revision
Clutch Release Cylinder
CLUTCH Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
INSPECTION
Check the inner of the release cylinder for
scratches or irregular wear.
l Check the piston cup for scratch or deformation, and
the lip for wear.
TSB Revision
NOTES
CONTENTS
GENERAL
The manual transaxles come in three models, axles are essentially the same as the previous
namely, and These els.
FWD
Engine Engine (Turbo)
Model
Applicable engine
floor shift floor shift
Gear ratio 3.166 3.090
1.833 1.833
1.240 1.217
0.896 0.888
0.731 0.741
Reverse 3.166 3.166
Final gear ratio 3.625 4.153
gear
Specifications
Model
Applicable engine
floor shift
Gear ratio 3.083
1.684
1.115
0.833
0.666
Reverse 3.166
Reduction ratio Primary 1.275
Front differential 3.800
Transfer 1.074
Speedometer gear ratio (driven/drive)
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
SECTIONAL VIEW
Bearing retainer
‘peed gear
Input shaft
3 peed ,
1 st speed gear
synchronizer
speed
Intermediate
shaft
Transaxle case
. Drain plug
TSB Revision
MANUAL
ENGINE
Bearing retainer
speed
speed
speed gear
speed gear
I .
, ,
Rear cover
brake device
Spacer
Spacer
Drain plug
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) Information
hh ousing
, .
speed synchronizer
gear assembly
speed gear
Sub gear
speed gear .
speed synchronizer
gear
I I
Input shaft
gear
- -
Center shaft
Driven
bevel
gear coupling
differential
Front output shaft
Front differential
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Service Specifications/
ENGINE AND ENGINE> Lubricants
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
of front roll stopper bracket 43 3 (1.69
LUBRICANTS
1
Items lubricant Quantity
Transaxle oil API classification SAE or 2.3 (2.4
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Special Tools
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Application
l Tie rod end ball joint
Steering linkage puller knuckle
l Lateral lower arm ball join
and knuckle disconnection
l Compression lower arm ba
joint and knuckle
tion
GENERAL SERVICE Supporting the engine assembly
TOOL during removal and installation
Engine lifter of the transaxle
of hub
yoke holder
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Troubleshooting!
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable Remedy
Vibration, noise Loose or damaged transaxle and engine mounts Tighten or replace mounts
Oil leakage Broken or damaged, oil seal or O-ring Replace the oil seal or O-ring
Jumps out of gear Worn gear shift fork or broken poppet spring Replace the shift fork or poppet
spring
Synchronizer hub to sleeve clearance too Replace the synchronizer hub and
large sleeve
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
22100090053
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
TRANSAXLE CONTROL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Caution: SRS
Be careful not to subject the SRS-ECU to any
shocks during removal and installation of the
transaxle control cable and shift lever assembly.
Engine>
3.9 Nm
2.9
Engine (Turbo)>
9 bs.
9
NOTE
Resin clip position
Transaxle control cable assembly Shift lever assembly removal steps
removal steps 2. Shift
1. Air cleaner and air intake hose 3. Center.
assembly 4. assembly
2. lever knob 5. Floor console assembly
3. Center panel 6. Shift lever panel
4. Cupholder assembly 7. Console side cover
5. Floor console assembly 9. Clip
6. Shift lever cover (passenger compartment side)
7. Console side cover 11. Shift cable and select cable con-
8. Nut nection (passenger compartment
9. Clip (passenger compartment side) side)
10. Clip (transaxle side 14. Shift lever
11. Shift cable and select cable con- 15. Distance piece
nection (passenger compartment 16. Bushing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle
INSTALLATION SERVICE
CABLE AND SELECT
CONNECTION (TRANSAXLE SIDE)
SELECT CABLE
(1) Connect the select cable to the transaxle side select lever.
(2) Set the shift lever of the transaxle side at the neutral
position.
NOTE
Neutral position When the shift lever of the transaxle side is set at the
neutral position, the select lever of the transaxle side
is also set at the neutral position.
SHIFT CABLE
(1) Connect the shift cable to the transaxle shift lever.
(2) While leaving the select lever at the transaxle side in
the neutral position, move the shift lever at the transaxle
side in the direction of the arrow in the illustration to
set it to gear.
NOTE
If the shift lever does not move easily, depress and hold
the clutch pedal.
SHIFT CABLE
Shift lever (1) Pull the shift lever at the passenger compartment side
fully in the direction shown in the illustration gear
position), and install the shift cable to the shift lever at
the passenger compartment side.
Install so that the slit section of the bushing is facing
either up or down.
(2) Put the shift lever to all the positions and make sure
that the operation is smooth.
Shift lever
Bushing Bushing A
Slit
Down
‘TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
15
14
00000099
Disassembly steps
1. Nut 12. Bolt
2. Spring washer 13. Lever A
3. Plain washer 14. Bushing
4. Shift lever 15. Collar
16. Bushing
17. Snap ring
Spring washer 18. Washer
8. Plain washer 19.
9. Return spring 20. Bustiing
10. Bushing 21. Bracket assembly
11. Pipe
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> Transaxle
TRANSAXLE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
l Transaxle Oil Draining (Refer to GROUP 00 l Supplying Transaxle Oil (Refer to GROUP 00
Maintenance Service.) Maintenance Service.)
l Removal l Shift Lever Operation Check
l Under Cover Removal l Speedometer Operation Check
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
l Battery installation
Engine>
56
69 42
Engine (Turbo)> 51
32
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake 9. Shift cable cable
hose assembly connection
2. Air cleaner element 10. Backup light switch connector
3. Air hose (Turbo)> 11. Vehicle speed sensor connector
4. Air hose A Eingine (Turbo)> 12. Starter motor
5. Battery tray 13. Transaxle assembly mounting
6. Evaporative emission canister 14. roll stopper bracket
Engine (Turbo)>
7. Evaporative emission canister 15. Transaxle mounting bracket
holder (Turbo)> ing nuts
8. Battery tray stay l Supporting engine assembly
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
-ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle
Engine>
27
13 Engine> 26 22-25
18
13
78
I
85
Nm
51-58
20
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
DRIVE DISCONNECTION
(1) Insert a pry bar between the transaxle case and the drive
shaft to remove the drive shaft.
NOTE
Do not remove the hub and knuckle from the drive shaft.
Caution
1. Use a pry bar to remove the drive shaft from the
I
Transaxle B.J. assembly, or the assembly may be
damaged.
2. Do not insert the bar too far, or the oil seal may
be damaged.
(2) Suspend the removed drive shaft with wire so that there
are no sharp bends in any of the joints.
(3) Use the special tool as a cover not to let foreign objects
get into the transaxle case.
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
CLUTCH.
Remove the clutch release cylinder without disconnecting
the oil line, and suspend a nearby “a
etc.
CENTER MEMBER
If the dimension shown in the outside the standard
value when the weight of the engine is on the body;, replace
,
Front roll the front roll stopper bracket assembly.
Standard value (A): 43 3 mm (1.69 in.)
member
DRIVE SHAFT
Temporarily install the drive shaft so that the T.J. case of
the drive shaft is perpendicular to the transaxle.
Caution
Do not damage the oil seal lip by the serrated part of
the drive shaft.
TSB Revision . .
,
MANUAL
ENGINE AND Transaxle Assembly
.
REMOVAL INSTALLATION
Pre-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
Transaxle Oil Draining to GROUP 00 l Supplying Transaxle Oil (Refer to GROUP 00
Maintenance Service.) Maintenance Service.)
l Battery Removal l Shift Lever Operation Check
l Under Cover Removal l Speedometer Operation Check
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) Transfer Assembly Installation (Refer to
l Transfer Assembly Removal (Refer to l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
l Installation
56 Nm
42
69 Nm
51
3.9 Nm
2.9 15
51
Removal steps
Air cleaner cover and air intake 9. Shift cable and select cable
hose assembly connection
2. Air cleaner 10. Backup light switch connector
3. Air hose 11. Vehicle speed sensor connector
4. Air hose A 12. Starter motor
5. Battery tray 13. Transaxle assembly mounting bolts
6. Evaporative emission canister 14. Rear roll stopper bracket mounting
7. Evaporative emission canister bolts
holder 15. Transaxle mounting bracket
8. Battery tray stay mounting nuts
l Supporting engine assembly
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
34 Nm
. .
24’
59-71 Nm 8.8 Nm
44-52 8.5
26
7 8
85
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
I-
SUPPORTING ENGINE ASSEMBLY
Set the special tool to the vehicle to support the engine
assembly.
Cord Caution
1. Using the special tool, loosen the tie rod end mounting
nut. Only loosen the nut; do not remove it from the
I’ -- ball joint.
2. Support the special tool with a cord, etc. to prevent
Nut it from coming off.
SHAFT NUT
Caution
Do not apply the vehicle weight to the wheel bearing
while loosening the drive shaft nut. the vehicle
weight must be applied to the bearing (because of moving
the vehicle), temporarily use the special tool
etc. to secure the wheel bearing.
I
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
(2) Use the special tool to cover the transaxle case not to’
let foreign materials get into the transaxle case.
11
,
(2) Suspend the removed drive shaft with inner shaft with
wire so that there are no sharp bends in any of the joints.
(3) Use the special tool to cover the transaxle case not to
let foreign materials get into the transaxle case.
R E L E A S E
Remove the clutch release cylinder without disconnecting
the line, and suspend to a nearby parts with a wire,
etc.
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND Assembly
TRANSFER ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
54-59 Nm
Gear oil:
API classification SAE
or
1. Transfer assembly
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
(NON-TURBO)> General Information
22110010022
GENERAL
The manual transaxle comes in one model, namely
Items Specifications
Model
Applicable engine
floor shift
Gear ratio 3.54
2.13
1.36
1.03
0.81
Reverse 3.42
Final gear ratio 3.94
Speedmeter gear ratio (driven/drive)
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
(NON-TURBO)> General
SECTIONAL VIEW
speed gear
synchronizer
1 st synchronizer
1 st speed clear
Differential
TSB Revision I
MANUAL Service Specifications/Lubricants/
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Special Tools/Troubleshooting/On-vehicle Service
LUBRICANTS 22110020025
Engine hanger
TROUBLESHOOTING 22110040021
Refer to
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle
TRANSAXLE CONTROL
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
, I
Pre-removal and Post-installation Caution: SRS ,
Operation Be careful not to the any
l Removal and Installation shocks during removal and of the
transaxle control cable and assembly.
3.9 Nm
2.9
12
11 l
,
NOTE
Resin clip
. .
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle Control
(1) Connect the select cable to the transaxle side select lever.
(2) Set the select lever of the transaxle side at the neutral
position.
(1) Connect the shift cable to the transaxle side shift lever.
(2) Set the shift lever of the transaxle side at the neutral
position.
Shift lever
Neutral position 1
(1) While leaving the shift lever inside the passenger
compartment in the neutral position, install the select cable
Select cable end to the passenger compartment side of the shift lever.
(2) Install the select cable so that the flange side of resin
bushing is positioned at the edge of lever side.
Shift lever
Bushing Bushing A
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE .
ENGINE Transaxle
00000098
Disassembly steps
1. Nut 12. Bolt
2. Spring washer 13. Lever A
3. Plain washer 14. Bushing
4. Shift lever 15. Collar
5. Bushing 16. Bushing
6. Nut 17. Snap ring
7. Spring washer 18. Washer
8. Plain washer 19. Lever
9. Return spring 20. Bushing
10. Bushing 21. B r a c k e t
11. Pipe
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle Control
TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
l Transaxle Oil Draining (Refer to GROUP 00 l Supplying Transaxle Oil (Refer to GROUP 00
Maintenance Service.)
l Shift Lever Check
l Speedometer ‘Operation Check
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
Installation
8
54 Nm
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake 7. Vehicle speed sensor connector
hose assembly 8. Starter motor
2. Air cleaner element 9. roll stopper bracket mounting
3. Battery tray
4. Battery tray stay 10. Transaxle mounting bracket
5. Shift cable and select cable mounting nuts
connection l b l Supporting engine assembly
6. Backup light connector
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle
75 Nm
55
13
59-71 Nm I
24
18
16
Nm
65
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
(3) Chalk mating marks on the flex plate and clutch pressure
plate for easier installation.
(4) Press the clutch pressure plate into the transaxle for easier
removal.
(5) Remove the transaxle assembly mounting bolt and lower
the transaxle assembly.
TSB Revision
MANUAL. TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle Control
ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
If the dimension shown in the illustration is outside the standard
value when the’ weight of the engine is on the body, replace
Front the front roll stopper bracket assembly.
stopper
bracket Standard value (A): 43 3 mm (1.69 in.)
member
SHAFT CONNECTION
Temporarily install the drive shaft so that the T.J. case of
the drive shaft is perpendicular to the transaxle.
Caution
Do not damage the oil seal lip by the serrated part of
the drive shaft.
Transaxle case
Revision
TRANSAXLE
CONTENTS
GENERAL 22200010055
ed gear
Input shaft
speed gear
1 speed gear
I
speed
synchro-
nizer speed gear
Rear cover
Reverse
brake device
speed
intermediate gear
Intermediate gear
spacer
Output shaft
Spacer
Drain plug
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Information
SECTIONAL VIEW
Clutch housing
Bearing retainer speed gear
speed gear
Input shaft
1
I
Rear cover
Reverse
brake
gear
gear
Spacer
Output
Spacer
case
Spacer
Drain plug
Differential
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Information
speed gear
Clutch housing speed synchronizer assembly
speed gear
I
Bearing retainer Sub gear
I speed gear
speed synchronizer assembly
speed gear
speed gear
speed
synchronizer
Intermediate gear
coupling
Center differential
Front differential
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
SPECIFICATIONS
Transaxle model Gear ratio Speedometer Final gear ratio Vehicle model model”
gear ratio
..
A 3.625
4.153
Items
3.166 3.090
1.833 1.833 .
1.240 1.217 , ,
0.896 0.888
TSB Revision
MANUAL, TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Standard value
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Snap ring (For adjustment of input shaft front bearing end play)
Thickness mm (in.) identification symbol Part No. Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part No.
2.24 None 2.38 Brown
2.31 Blue
Snap ring (For adjustment of input shaft rear bearing end play)
Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part No. Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol No.
1.40 Blue 1.60 Yellow
1.45 Purple 1.65 Brown
1.50 Red 1.70 Green
1.55 White 1.75 Orange
Snap ring: (For adjustment of intermediate rear front bearing end play)
Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part No. Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part
Snap ring: (For adjustment of intermediate gear front bearing end play)
Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part No. Thickness mm (in.) symbol No.
1.40 Blue 1.60 Yellow
1.50 Red 1.70 Green
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
0.62 62 1.01 01 49
0.65 65 1.04 04
0.68 68 1.07 07 51
0.71 71 1.10 10
0.74 74 1.13 13
0.77 77 1.16 16
0.80 80 1.19 19 55
0.83 83 43 1.22 22
0.86 86 44 1.25 25
0.89 89 45 1.28 28 58
0.92 92 1.31 31 59
0.95 95 1.34 34 60
0.98 98 48 1.37 37
0.80 80 1.13 13
0.83 83 1.16 16
0.86
0.89 86
89 1.19
1.22 19
22
0.92 92 1.25 25 2346’
0.95 95 1.28 28 2347
0.98 98 1.31 31 2348
1 01 1.34 34
1.04 04 1.37 37
1.07 07 1.40 40
1.10 10 1.43 43
0.83 83 1 0454
0.86 86 1
0.89 89 1.16 0455
0.92 92
0.95 95 1.22
0.98 98 1.25 0457
1 01 1.28 0456
1.04 04 1.31
1.07 07 1.34 0 0459
Revision
MANUALTRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
0.56 56 1 01
0.65 65 1.10
0.74 74 1
0.83 83 1.28 0458
0.92 92 1.37 0460
80862 80675
80861
80860
1.28 67 1.61
1.31 68 1.64
1.34 69 1.67
1.37 1.70
1.73
1.43 1.76
1.46 1.79
1.49 1.82
1.52 1.85
1.55 1.88
1.58 1.91
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Snap ring: [For adjustment of viscous coupling end play (with VCU)]
Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part No. Thickness mm (in.) Identification symbol Part No.
408
2.25-2.32 2.67-2.74 3
409
74 1 78
50 1 1.08 76
80 77
79 49
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
1.34 34 1.52 52
1.37 37 1.55 55
1.40 40 1.58 58
1.43 43 1.61 61
I 0575) 46 I 64
1.49 49 I 67 71
I 67 1.58
I 68 I
69 I
1.37 I
I 1.70
1.43 1.73
1.46 1.76
1.49
I
1.55 1.85
0.13 0.34 34
0.16 0.37 37
0.19 19 0.40 40
0.22 22 0.43 43
0.25 25 0.46 46
0.28 IO) 28 0.49 49
0.31 31 0.52 52
1 19 1.58 58
I 22 1.61 61
I 25 I 64
1.28 28 1.67 67
I 31 1.70 70
1.34 34 1.73 73
1.37 37 1.76 76
1.40 40 1.79 79
1.43 43 1.82 82
I 46 I 85 02
1.49 49 1.88 88 03
I 52 1.91 91 04
1.55 55 1.94 94 05
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Items
Transaxle
Backup light switch
Bearing retainer bolt
Bell housing cover mounting bolt
Center differential lock actuator mou
Center differential lock indicator
Center differential shift lever
Differential drive gear bolt
Input shaft lock nut
Interlock plate bolt
Intermediate gear lock nut
33 24
33 24
Output gear mounting bolt
Poppet plug
Rear cover bolt
Rear cover bolt
Restrict ball
Reverse brake cone machine screw
Reverse idler gear shaft bolt
Reverse shift lever assembly
Select lever mounting bolt
Shift cable bracket mounting bolt
Speedometer sleeve bolt
Starter motor mounting bolt
Stopper bracket bolt
Transaxle case tightening bolt
Transaxle mount bracket mounting
Transaxle mounting bolt mm
Transaxle mounting bolt mm diamet
Transaxle mounting bolt mm diamet
Transaxle switch
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Tools
Items Nm
Transfer
,
Cover mounting bolt 9 7
Extension housing
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and Application
Installation of extension
Oil seal installer housing oil seal,
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Special Tools
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
-Special Tools
TSB Revision .
I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
6 Special Tools
Tool Application
Installation of each bearing
Installer adapter (56)
Handle
7 of intermediate
Bearing remover
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
TRANSAXLE
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
19 Nm
33 N m 14
24 I
36 Nm
27
Disassembly steps
1. Bolt 12. Speedometer. driven gear assembly
2. Rear cover 13. Air breather
3. Reverse brake cone 14. Spring
41 Wave spring 15. Lock nut
5. Machine screw 16. Lock nut
6. Backup light switch 17. speed synchronizer assembly
18. speed shift fork .
7. Gasket
8. Poppet plug 19. Synchronizer ring
9. Poppet spring 20. speed gear
10. Poppet ball 21. Needle bearing
11. Bolt 22. speed intermediate gear
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
8 Transaxle
39 Nm
33 Nm 29
24
26
q 48 I
2 5
23
49 Nm
36
2210010
Disassembly steps
23. Reverse idler gear shaft bolt 36. Bearing outer race
24. Gasket 37. Spacer
25. Bolt 38. Bearing outer race
26. Transaxle case
27. Oil guide
28. Bolt Reverse shift lever
29. Spring washer 42. Reverse shift lever shoe
30. Stopper bracket 43. Reverse idler gear shaft
31. Restrict ball assembly 44. Reverse idler gear
32. Gasket 45. Spring pin
33. Oil seal 46. Spring pin
34. Bearing outer race 47. Shift rail assembly
35. Spacer
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
19 Nm
19
54
58
Disassembly steps
56. Oil guide
57. Bearing outer race
Bearing retainer 58. Bearing outer race’
51. Intermediate gear assembly 59. Oil seal
52. Input shaft assembly 60. Oil seal
53. Output shaft assembly 61. Clutch housing assembly
54. Differential gear assembly 62. Magnet
55. Bearing outer race 63. Magnet holder
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
..
33 N m 19 Nm
24 14
36
27
4 5
Disassembly steps
1. Bolt 12. Speedometer driven gear assembly
2. Rear cover 13. Air breather
3. Reverse brake cone 14. Spring pin
4. Wave spring 15. Lock nut
5. Machine 16. Lock nut
switch 17. synchronizer assembly
1.8. fork
Poppet plug 19.
9. Poppet spring 20. gear
10. Poppet ball bearing,:,
11. Bolt 22. gear
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE. OVERHAUL
Transaxle
39 Nm
33 Nm 29
24
50 25
I
14
Disassembly steps
23. Reverse idler gear shaft bolt 37. Spacer
24. Gasket 38. Filter
25. Bolt 39. Bearing outer race
26. Transaxle case 40. Spacer
27. Oil guide 41. race
28. Bolt
29. Spring washer
30. Stopper bracket 44. Reverse
31. Restrict ball assembly 45. Reverse shift
32. Gasket 46. gear, ,
33. Oil seal 47. gear
34. Bearing outer race p i n
35. Spacer 49. pin
36. Bearing outer race 50. Shift
TSB Revision ,
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
Transaxle
19 N m
14 53
Disassembly steps
60. Oil guide
61. Bearing outer race
Bearing retainer 62. Bearing outer race
54. Intermediate gear assembly 63. Oil seal
55. Input shaft assembly 64. Oil seal
56. Output shaft assembly 65. Magnet
57. Differential gear assembly 66. Magnet holder
58. Bearing outer race 67. Clutch housing assembly
59. Bearing outer race
TSB Revision I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
33 N m
24
33 N m 39 Nm
24 29
I
150 Nm
109
36 N m
2 7
4 Nm
3
Disassembly steps
1. Rear cover 12. Speedometer gear assembly
2. Reverse bracket cone 13. Air breather
3. Wave spring 14. Spring
4. Machine screw . 15. Lock nut
16. Lock nut
17. speed assembly
assembly
19. Synchronizer ring
Poppet plug 20. speed
10. Poppet spring 21. Needle bearing.
11. Poppet ball 22. speed intermediate gear
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
Disassembly steps
Snap ring
24. Viscous coupling
25. Steel ball
26. Center shaft
27. Transaxle case adapter
28. Outer case
29. Spacer
30. Outer race
31. Spacer
32. Outer race
33. Spacer
34. Center differential
35. Outer race
36. Reverse idler gear shaft bolt
37. Gasket
Revision
Disassembly steps
38. Clutch oil line bracket
39. Transaxle case
40. Oil guide
41. Oil guide
42. Outer race
43. Spacer
44. Spacer
45. Stopper bracket
46. Oil seal
47. Reverse shift lever assembly
48. Reverse shift lever shoe .
49. Reverse idler gear
50. Reverse idler gear
51. Front output shaft assembly
52. Needle bearing
53. Front erential
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Disassembly steps
54. Spring pin Oil
55. Spring pin 64. race’
56. Shift rail assembly 65. Oil seal
57. Bolt
58. Bearing retainer O i l ‘ s e a l
59. Intermediate gear assembly 68. Magnet
60. Input shaft assembly Magnet
61. Outer race 70. Clutch housing assembly
62. Outer race
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
(5) Remove the lock nut, while using the bolt as a spinner
handle stopper.
23
RAIL ASSEMBLY
(1) Shift the speed fork to the speed.
(2) Shift the speed fork to the speed.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
SEAL FOR DRIVE SHAFT
SE A L I N P U T
INSTALLATION
G E A R
SHAFT ASSEMBLY .
Lifting up the input shaft assembly, it simultaneously
,
with the intermediate gear assembly.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
APPLICATION TO
RETAINER MOUNTING BOLT
sealant:
STUD Locking or equivalent
(4) the shift rail into the shift fork hole, while turning
so as to prevent the shift lug from interfering with the
stopper plate.
(5) Turn the shift rail to engage shift lug.
PINS S PE E D
FORK SPEED SHIFT FORK
INSTALLATION
IDLER GEAR
Install in the direction as
TSB Revision
MANUAL
Transaxle
SPACERS SELECTION
Solder (1) solder with a length of approximately 10 mm
Solder in.) and a diameter of in.)
in the spacer mounting pasition.
(2) Tighten the case mounting’ bolt to torque.
(3) Remove the case and then take solder. If
solder is not broken, use solder with a larger diameter
to carry out the operations in (1) and (2).
mm
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle .
22210033
APPLICATION TO
Specified sealant:
STUD Locking or equivalent
,
TSB Revision
MANUAL OVERHAUL
Transaxle
,
Oil seal
INSTALLATION
(1) Place two pieces of solder measuring about
in.) in length and 3 mm in.) in at illustrated
locations on the transaxle and install each outer
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle.,
SPACERS INSTALLATION
(1) Place two pieces of solder measuring about 10 mm
in.) in length and 3 mm in.) diameter at illustrated
locations on the transaxle case adapter assembly and
install outer races.
(2) Install the transaxle case adapter assembly and rear cover
and tighten the bolts to the specified torque.
(3) Remove the transaxle case adapter assembly and rear
cover.
(4) Remove outer races and remove the solder. Measure
the thickness of the crushed solder with a micrometer,
and select and install a spacer of thickness that gives
standard end play and preload.
Standard value:
Intermediate gear preload:
mm in.)
Center differential case
mm in.)
Input shaft end
mm in.)
TRANSAXLE CASE
INSTALLATION
Apply the specified sealant (liquid gasket) to the transaxle
case side of the transaxle case adapter, assembly.
Specified sealant:
Mitsubishi genuine sealant Part or
equivalent
Caution
S q u e e z e out sealant from the tube
excess or discontinuity.
22200056
RING INSTALLATION
Choose a snap ring that gives the standard end play.
viscous coupling and install it.
Standard value:
Viscous coupling: mm In.)
0123
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transaxle
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Synchronizer
SYNCHRONIZER
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. Reverse brake ring 4. Synchronizer key
2. Synchronizer spring 5. Synchronizer hub
3. Synchronizer sleeve
72
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Synchronizer
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Input Shaft
INPUT SHAFT
8
Lubricate all internal
9 parts with engine oil
during reassembly.
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring 2.Bearing sleeve
2. Ball bearing 3.Synchronizer ring
3. Bearing sleeve 4.Synchronizer spring
4. Snap ring 5. speed synchronizer sleeve
5. Ball bearing 6.Synchronizer key
6. Spacer 7. speed synchronizer hub
ä Dd 7. Snap ring 8.Synchronizer ring
8. Cone spring 9. speed gear
9. Sub gear Needle bearing
10. speed gear 21. Input shaft
11. Needle bearing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Input Shaft
4
q 5
6
11
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing 11. Synchronizer ring
2. Bearing sleeve 12. Synchronizer spring
3. Snap ring 13. synchronizer
4. Taper roller bearing 14. Synchronizer key
5. Snap ring 15. hub
6. Cone spring 16. Synchronizer ring
7. Sub gear 17. gear
8. speed gear 18. Needle bearing
9. Needle bearing 19. Input shaft
10. Bearing sleeve
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL .
Input Shaft
Disassembly
1. Taper roller bearing 11. Synchronizer
2. Bearing sleeve speed synchronizer
3. Snap ring Synchronizer ring
4. Taper roller bearing speed
5. speed gear S n a p r i n g
6. Needle bearing Cone spring
7. Bearing sleeve Sub gear
8. Synchronizer ring Needle bearing
9. Synchronizer spring Oil seal
10. speed synchronizer sleeve 20. Input shaft
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL:
Input
DISASSEMBLY
BALL BEARING TAPER
ROLLER BEARING, REMOVAL
speed gear
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Input Shaft
gear
Identification
mark
SYNCHRONIZER SPRING
INSTALLATION
When installing the be sure position
each spring with respect to the keys illustrated.
Spring
stepped
SLEEVE FOR
INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE’ OVERHAUL
Input
GEAR CONE
Snap ring
INSTALLATION
Sub
SPACER INSTALLATION
speed
gear side
210019
REAR BALL
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Input Shaft
Caution
l Do not reuse the snap
l The snap ring by pliers,
resulting in improper the
22100024
TSB Revision
M A N U A L
65133, Input Shaft
F R O N T B A LL
BEARING INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE’OVERHAUL
Shaft , ,
INSPECTION . . .
INPUT SHAFT
(1) Check the outer surface of the input shaft where the
needle bearing is mounted for damage, abnormal wear
and seizure [portion A].
(2) Check the for damage and wear.
NEEDLE BEARING
(1) Combine the needle bearing with the shaft or
sleeve and gear and check that it rotates smoothly without’
abnormal noise or play.
(2) Check the needle bearing cage for
201051
SYNCHRONIZER RING
(1) Check the clutch gear teeth for and breakage.
(2) Check the internal surface for damage, and broken
threads.
(3) Force the synchronizer ring toward the clutch gear and
check clearance “A”. Replace if it is out of specification.
Limit: 0.5 mm in.)
I I
Synchronizer ring Gear
2110009
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Da
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Intermediate Gear ,
..
‘I
7
8
7
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring 9. Synchronizer key
2. Taper roller bearing 10. speed synchronizer hub
3. Bearing sleeve 11. Synchronizer ring
4. Needle
5. speed gear
bearing 13.
12. N e espeed
dle gear
6. Synchronizer ring bearing
14. Taper roller bearing
7. Synchronizer spring 15. Intermediate gear
8. speed synchronizer sleeve
TSB Revision I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE.: OVERHAUL
Gear
. ,
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring speed
2. Taper roller bearing 11.
Bearing sleeve 12. Synchronizer cone
4. speed gear 13. Synchronizer inner
5. Needle bearing speed gear
6. Synchronizer ring 15. Needle
7. Synchronizer spring 16. Taper roller bearing
8. speed synchronizer 17.
9. Synchronizer key
7
, ..
___
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Intermediate Gear
. .
2201053
2 REASSEMBLY SERVICE
ROLLER BEARING
Caution
3 When installing the bearing, push the inner race only.
,
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
bear
1 SPEED
Clutch housing
SYNCHRONIZER KEY
SLEEVE
(1) the speed
as
Identification mark
Synchronizer key
..
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Intermediate Gear
.
RING INSTALLATION ,
Select and install the snap that gives
intermediate gear bearing end play.
Standard, value:
Intermediate gear bearing end
mm in.)
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Gear
INSPECTION
INTERMEDIATE GEAR
(1) Check the outer surface of the
the needle bearing is mounted’ abnormal
wear and seizure
(2) Check the splines for and
NEEDLE BEARING
(1) Combine the bearing or bearing’
sleeve and gear and check it rotates Smoothly without
abnormal noise or play.
(2) Check the needle bearing for’
201051
SYNCHRONIZER RING
(1) Check the clutch gear teeth for damage breakage.
(2) Check the internal surface for damage,, broken
threads.
ring Gear
2110009
and wear
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Intermediate Gear
the outer ring, inner ring and cone, and press them
onto the clutch gear. Check clearance and replace
if is below the limit value. .
Limit: 0.5 mm in.)
SPEED GEARS
(1) Check the bevel gear and clutch gear teeth for damage
and wear.
(2) Check the synchronizer cone for damage
and wear.
(3) Check the gear bore and front arid rear ends for
and wear.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Output Shaft
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing
2. shaft
2210025
I I
TSB Revision I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL ...
Front Output , __
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing
2. Taper roller bearing
3. Front output shaft
Press DISASSEMBLY
ROLLER BEARINGS REMOVAL
Remove the taper roller bearings using the special tool.
NOTE
(1) Do not reuse the bearing removed’ ‘the
(2) Replace the inner and outer the taper roller
bearing as a set.
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
ROLLER BEARINGS
Install the taper roller bearing special tool.
.. ,
3
Apply the special tool to the inner race only when ‘installing’
the bearing.
8
ROLLER
Install the taper roller bearing using the special
NOTE
Apply ‘the tool to the inner
the bearing.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Differential
DIFFERENTIAL
DISASSEMBLY REASSEMBLY
2160119
Disassembly steps
2.
1. Bolt
Differential drive gear 6. Pinion shaft’
7.
3. Ball bearing 8. Washer
4. 9. Side gear
10. Spacer,
5. Lock pin 11. Differential
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Differential , , .
Differential case
Lock pin
Differential case REASSEMBLY SERVICE POINTS
Pinion shaft LOCK PIN INSTALLATION
Align the pinion shaft lock pin hole the case lock pin
hole and insert the lock pin.
Caution
1. Do not reuse the lock pin.
2. The lock pin must not protrude more than 3 mm
I in.).
Lock pin end with at three places on
larger chamfering pin outside
3. The lock pin head must be sunk from the flange
surface of the differential case.
9 Bearing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Differential
JNSTALLATION ,
(1) Apply the specified sealant to the bolt threads.
Specified sealant:
Stud Locking or equivalent
160030 I
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Center Differential ,
CENTER DIFFERENTIAL
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
22250015
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing
2. Bolt
3. Taper roller bearing
4. Output gear
5. Spacer
6. Side gear
7. Pinion shaft
8. Washer
9. Pinion
Side gear
11. Spacer
12. Center differential case
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL,
Center
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
ROLLER REMOVAL
Remove-the taper roller bearings ‘using the special
NOTE
(1) Do not reuse the bearing removed from shaft.
(2) Replace the inner and races the taper roller
bearing as a set.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Center Differential
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Shift Fork
SHIFT FORK .
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. speed shift fork 5. Interlock plunger
2. speed shift fork 6. speed shift rail
3. speed shift rail 7. Reverse shift lug
4. speed shift rail
, 0
SPEEDOMETER GEAR
,
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. e-clip
driven gear
Sleeve
SERVICE
SPEEDOMETER DRIVEN GEAR
Apply gear oil sparingly to the speedometer gear shaft
and insert the shaft.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Housing
CLUTCH HOUSING
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
19 Nm
14
24 Nm
16
Disassembly steps
1. Bolt 12. Neutral return spring assembly
2. Select lever assembly 13. Control shaft
3. Select lever shoe 14. Control shaft boot
4. Interlock plate bolt 15. Oil seal
5. Gasket 16. Needle
6. Lock pin 17. Needle,
7. Spring pin
8. Neutral return spring
9. Stopper body Return spring
10. Control finger 21. plate
1 Interlock plate 22. Spring pin
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Clutch Housing
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
,
Caution
When removing the lock pin, turn the control lever to
such position that the lock pin will not contact the clutch
housing.
2200064
Needle bearing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Clutch Housina
socket
bar wrench
Extension bar
SEAL INSTALLATION
socket wrench
TSB Revision I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
.
TRANSFER
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
39 Nm
28
I I
Disassembly steps
1. Cover
2. Cover gasket
3. Extension housing assembly
4. Transfer case sub assembly
5. Spacer
6. O-ring
7. Transfer case adapter sub-assembly
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
REASSEMBLY
BACKLASH ADJUSTMENT,
(1) a light and uniform coat
lead to the driven bevel gear teeth using.
brush.
,
.
(2) install the spacer that has
.
,
,
,
,
.
(4) Align the transfer case adapter and drive bevel gear mating
marks.
(5) Assemble the transfer case and transfer case adapter
and tighten to the specified torque.
(9) Check to see if the drive bevel gear and driven bevel
backlash is as specified.
Standard value: Bevel gear set
mm
O-RING INSTALLATION’
Caution
Apply oil to the Q-ring,
H O U S I N G .
Apply sealant to the adapter flange surface and the
extension housing.
Specified sealant:
Mitsubishi genuine Sealant or
equivalent
NOTE
Squeeze out sealant from the ‘tube uniformly and
continuously in adequate amount.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
(both sides)
Remedy
Use thicker bevel gear mount adjusting spacer to separate
the driven bevel gear more from the drive bevel gear.
Remedy
Use thinner driven bevel gear mount adjusting spacer,
to briiig the driven bevel gear closer to the drive
bevel gear.
. .
NOTE
Drive bevel gear (1) If’ correct tooth contact cannot
mount adjusting change of the driven
spacer Drive bevel gear
preload adjusting spacer, increase or decrease;
bevel gear preload adjusting,
bevel gear mount
and then adjust
l When the driven ‘bevel gear height is too small
if the thinnest driven bevel gear mount adjusting
spacer 0.13 mm in.) is used:
Replace the drive bevel gear mount adjusting spacer
‘Driven that is in use with one rank thicker and
bevel replace the drive bevel preload adjusting spacer that
gear is in use with one that is ‘thinner.
mount
adjusting l When the driven bevel too large even
spacer if the thickest driven
__
Replace the drive. bevel gear mount
Driven that is in use with one that is
bevel gear replace the drive bevel gear preload adjusting spacer
preload
adjusting
spacer
equal or close to the standard pattern
, ,
22210129
TSB Revision I
, ,
, ,
Disassembly steps
1. Air bleeder
2. Dust seal guard
3. Oii seal
4. Extention housing
AIR BLEEDER
Install the air bleeder
Specified sealant:
SUPER WEATHERSTRIP
,
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
TRANSFER CASE
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY ..
Nm
29
Disassembly steps
1. Transfer cover
2. O-ring
3. Spacer
4. Outer race
5. Drive bevel gear assembly
6. Outer race
7. Spacer
6. Oil seal
9. Transfer case
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL,.
Case“ , ,
I , ,
SPACER
(1) Use the existing spacer assemble the transfer case.
(2) Using the special that the rotating
drive torque is within the standard value.
Standard value:
(3) If the rotating drive torque is outside of the standard value,
adjust using adjusting spacers.
NOTE
For adjustment, use two spacers of which thickness is
as close as possible to each other.
O-RING INSTALLATION
.
Caution
Apply transmission oil to
....
.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL ,
Transfer Case Adapter
22210133
Disassembly steps
1. Lock nut 5. Collar
2. Driven bevel gear assembly 6. Outer race
3. Taper roller bearing 7. Outer race
4. Spacer 6. Transfer case assembly
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Transfer Case Adapter
REASSEMBLY POINTS
SPACER
(1) Use the exisfing spacer to assemble the transfer case
adapter.
(2) Using the special tool, check that the bevel gear rotating
drive torque is within standard value.
Standard value: Nm
(3) If the rotating drive torque is outside of the standard value,
adjust using adjusting spacers.
22210142
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing
2. Taper roller bearing
3. Drive bevel gear
4. Drive bevel gear shaft
DRIVE
,
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
TRANSFER DRIVE BEVEL GEAR INSTALLATION
Install the drive bevel gear and drive bevel gear shaft with
the mating marks aligned.
TSB I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Driven
.. Bevel .
Disassembly steps
1. Driven bevel gear
2. Taper roller bearing
DISASSEMBLY
ROLLER BEARING
14
TSB Revision.
CONTENTS
22210010018
The transaxle internal components can only as a unit, no, disassembly and reassembly
be serviced by separating the gear case from the is possible. Damage to the transaxle may results.
case. The transaxle output shaft is
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE General Information
SECTIONAL VIEW
speed gear synchronizer
speed gear
1 synchronizer
Differential
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications
Model -1
Applicable engine
2.13 2.13
1.36 1.36
1 . 0 3
Reverse 3.94 ,
Final gear ratio 3.55
Speedometer gear ratio (driven/drive)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications
,
Differential side gear end play mm (in.)
Items Nm
SEALANTS 22210050010
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
SPECIAL TOOLS .
Tool Tool number and name
Removal of input.
Installer adapter and sleeve.
.
Installer adapter
with
Installer bar
Bearing remover
installer
Bearing remover
installer
Removal of
Puller press
of side
, ,
Dial indicator set
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ,
. .
.
Removal of differential bearing.
Adapter Adjustment of differential side
gear end play.
TSB Revision
Installation and of
tool
Installer 100
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case .
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
(7) Remove reverse idler shaft ,
Selector shaft
spacer (Plastic)
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case
Case
. .
two snap rings retaining the output shaft and’
the input shaft to the bearing.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
bearing fixture
bearings. Verify tool is property and
shaft.
blocker
assembly I
.
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case Disassembly
TSB Revision
.
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
Caged
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Shaft Disassembly
Thrust washer
.
TSB Revision I
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
caged
needle bearing
I Revision I
Output Disassembly/
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
speed
Stop ring gear It is necessary to check the gap. Use
Reverse gear a feeler gauge to measure the gaps the stop rings
and the speed gears.
The correct gaps are. listed below:
m m
mm
mm
mm
1.37-1.93 mm
.
If a stop ring gap does not fall specifications it
must be inspected for wear and and
synchronizer stop ring is worn beyond the
plete output shaft assembly must be
The output shaft incorporates the gears
synchronizers on the assembly.
.
. ..
TSB Revision I
..
,
25
gear bolts
Differential Side
Rotate side gears to opening in differential.
assembly , (7) Remove pinion gears, side gears’ thrust washers
Pinion rotating side gears to case.
Pinion
wash ..
Ring gear
REASSEMBLY
(1) Assemble the differential side gears, gears and
pinion gears with the pinion gears
thrust washer ,
,
gear ..
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
. .
(6) Using the smallest end play record, shim that side gear
to within 0.25 mm in.) to 0.33 mm in.).
Move side (9) The other side gear should be checked using the same
gear up procedure.
and down
Bearing cone
.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Synchronizer
DISASSEMBLY
Place synchronizer in a clean shop,, towel Wrap. Press
on inner hub. Carefully open up shop. towel and remove
springs, balls, keys, hub, and sleeve.
CLEAN
Do not attempt to clean the blocking rings in solvent. The
friction material will become contaminated. Place synchronizer
components in a suitable holder and clean with solvent. Then
let them air, dry.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
Sleeve ASSEMBLY
(1) Position synchronizer hub onto a suitable holding fixture
(input shaft). The synchronizer hubs are directional. The
hubs must be installed with the facing upward.
(2) Install springs into hub slot
(3) Insert key into hub and spring.
(5) Slide sleeve over the hub and depress balls as you careful-
ly slip the sleeve into position.
(6) Line up stop ring tang over the keys in the hub. Install‘
stop rings. Center the keys and balls by pushing on both
stop rings.
.
INSPECT
Proper inspections of components involved:
Teeth, for wear, scuffed, nicked, burred or broken teeth keys,
for wear or distortion.
Balls and springs, for distortion, cracks or wear’
If any of these conditions exists in these replace
as necessary.
TSB Revision
Shifter Rails Overhaul/
MANUAL
SHIFTER
Disassemble the transaxle case using the procedures’
provided in this group.
(2) Remove shifter rails from the
(3) To service the shift rail, remove the retaining
the reverse shift lever arm. Remove the “shift fork
roll pin and remove the shift fork.
Remove the shift lug roll pin and remove the shift lug.’
Replace parts as necessary.
(4) To service the shift rail, remove the roll pin retaining’
the shift fork. Remove the shift fork.,, Remove the
shift lug roll pin and remove shift lug. Replace parts as,
necessary.
(5) To service the shift rail, remove roll pin retaining,
the shift fork. Remove the shift replace parts
as necessary.
GEAR CASE
The sealant used to seal the transaxle case halves is Loctite
51817 or equivalent. The sealant used for the bearing end
plate cover is Loctite or equivalent.
The components that are left in the gear cases when the
gear train is pulled out are the:
Axle shaft seals
Output bearing race and retainer
Input bearing and sleeve
Differential bearing cones ,
Shifter rail bushings
Shifter shafts
Shifter shaft seals
Shifter shaft bushings
Rear bearing oil feed trough
INSTALLATION
Clean axle shaft seal bore of any excess sealant.
(2) Align axle shaft seal with axle shaft seal bore.
(3) Install axle seal on tool and insert
shaft seal bore.
(4) Tap seal into position.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case Overhaul
REMOVAL
(1) Note the position of the output shaft
The bearing is not identical to end.
Remove caged roller bearing from output bearing “race.
output
bearing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case
I\
REMOVAL
tool over input bearing on.
the gear case side of the transaxle clutch housing.
(2) Tap the input bearing out housing.’
INSTALLATION .
(1) Apply coating of Loctite sealant
Position sleeve and bearing
bore.
(2) Install tool input
.
, .
(3) Using the spacer tool and shop press, install input bearing
into bore until it is fully seated.
ing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case
Gear case
REMOVAL
(1) Install into the differential bearing cup.
INSTALLATION
(1) Position the bearing cup into case.
(2) Install the bearing cup onto
(3) Using driver, install differential
bearing cup into the transaxle ,
REMOVAL
(1) Thread tool into shifter rail bushing.
(2) Install onto tool.
(3) Remove bushing using slide hammer and tool assembly.
bearing
INSTALLATION
(1) Line up replacement bushing in bore.
(2) Using tool tap bushing into bore until flush
with the chamfer in the case.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Gear Case
SHAFT SEALS
It is not necessary to remove the shifter the trans-
axle to service the shifter shaft seals.
REMOVAL
(1) Using a pick tool, pry up the shifter seal and
remove seal from bore.
INSTALLATION
(1) Position new shifter shaft seal in bore.
(2) Install shifter shaft seal bore using an
size deep well socket.
REMOVAL
(1) With the transaxle disassembled, remove the selector
shaft by pushing on the shaft from the outside and pulling
shaft out from the inside.
Reverse removal procedure to install selector shaft.
REMOVAL
(1) With the transaxle disassembled, remove the crossover
shaft seal.
(2) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring at the cross-
over shaft bore.
(3) Push the crossover shaft in the case and remove the
crossover assembly.
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Gear Case Overhaul
INSTALLATION
(1) Position replacement over selector shaft bore.
(2) Using an appropriate size deep well socket, install bushing
in selector shaft bore.
SHIFTER CROSSOVER
REMOVAL
(1) Install through the crossover bushing.
(2) Thread nut and washer onto
(3) Using the remove the crossover shaft bush-
ing.
INSTALLATION
(1 Position the replacement crossover shaft bushing over
the crossover shaft bushing bore.
(2) Using an appropriate size deep socket, install the
crossover shaft bushing into the bushing bore.
Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Shaft Reassembly
TSB Revision
(7) split thrust washer pin.
Input shaft
Separation pin
. , .
,
, .
(8) Install split thrust washer onto input shaft.
Input shaft
Input
gear caged needle bearing.
Caged
needle
bearing
TSB Revision
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case
CASE REASSEMBLY
The sealant used to seal the transaxle case halves is Loctite
51617 or equivalent.
The sealant used for the bearing end plate cover is Loctite
18718 or equivalent.
(1) Verify bench fixture shims are removed from bench
Install output and input gear pallet
End
Reverse
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Case-
Reverse idler
Screws (2) A
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE
GENERAL RULES ON
Take extreme care when removing, and installing bearing
cups and cones. Use only arbor for installation,
as a hammer may not properly* align the
or cone.
Burrs or nicks on the bearing give a end
play reading while gauging. for proper shims. Improperly
seated bearing cups and cones are subject to low mileage’
failure.
Bearing cups and ‘cones should be replaced if they
signs of pitting or heat distress., If distress seen on’
either the cup or bearing rollers, both cone must
be replaced.
(3) Bearing preload and drag torque specifications
maintained to avoid premature’
(original) bearing may lose up to drag
torque offer break in. All bearing, adjustments
made with no other component
mesh.
(4) Replace bearings as a pair. For
bearing is defective, replace both differential.
If one input shaft bearing is defective; ‘replace both input
shaft bearings.
Bearing cones must not be reused if
Turning torque readings should be while smooth-
ly rotating in either direction,,
TSB Revision
Differential Bearing
MANUAL TRANSAXLE Preload Adjustment
DIFFERENTIAL BEARING
ADJUSTMENT
True bearing turning torque readings can only be obtained
with the gear train removed from the case.
(1) Remove bearing cup and existing shim from clutch
housing case.
(2) Press in new bearing cup into bell housing case (or use
a cup that has been ground down on the outer edge
for ease of measurement).
(3) Press in new bearing cup into gear case side.
(4) Lubricate differential bearings with SAE engine
oil. Install differential assembly in transaxle gear case.
Install clutch bell housing over gear case. and
torque case bolts to 29 Nm (21
(5) Position transaxle with bell housing facing down on work-
bench with C-clamps. Position dial indicator.
TSB Revision
. . .
, ,
AUTOMATIC
TRANSAXLE
CONTENTS
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. .
,
.
CONTENTS
, .
.
. .
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) ENGINE> General Information’ .
GENERAL INFORMATION
The automatic transaxles come in two models, namely, and These transaxles
are essentially the same as the conventional models.
FWD
0.685 0.685 ,
Reverse 2.176 2.176
Final gear ratio 4.350 4.376
Speedometer gear ratio (driven/drive)
AWD
Specifications
Model
Applicable engine
Electronically controlled full-automatic
Torque converter Type with torque converter clutch
Engine stall speed
Gear ratio 2.551
1.488
1
0.685
Reverse 2.176
Reduction ratio Primary 1.228
Front differential 3.550
Transfer 1.074
Speedometer gear ratio (driven/drive)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> General Information
Selector
Gear Gear Engine Parking Front Rear down
lever drive . . way.
ratio start mechanism clutch clutch clutch clutch
position switch
Neutral OK .
Re- 2.176 l
verse
...
Neutral OK
,
ON 2.551
ON 1.488
I ON 1.000
I ON 0.685
I OFF 2.551 l
OFF 1.488
OFF 1.000 l
2.551
1.488
2.551
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> General tnformation
SECTIONAL VIEW
Torque
converter
End clutch
Transfer
Torque driven gear
clutch
drive gear
Transfer shaft
Differential
TSB Revision I-
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> General
Torque
converter brake Planetary ,
Oil pump
gear
I Transfer
Front clutch Low-reverst idler gear
brak
Rear clutch
I
I
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> General Information
SECTIONAL VIEW
Oil pump
gear
Transfer
Rear reverse drive
brake clutch brake gear
I I
Torque
converter
Rear output
shaft
Transfer
Viscous
differential
output shaft
Differential
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE Service
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>- . .
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Resistance of pulse generators A and [at
Resistance of oil temperature sensor [at
Resistance of oil temperature sensor [at
Resistance of torque converter clutch solenoid coil [at Approx. 13
Resistance of pressure control solenoid valve coil [at Approx. 3
Resistance of shift control solenoid valves A and coils [at Approx. 22
Line pressure Line pressure (psi) (126-129)
Oil pressure change for each turn of adjusting screw (psi) 38 (5.5)
Reducing pressure Reducing pressure (psi)
Oil pressure change for each turn of adjusting screw (psi) 45 (6.5)
Distance between detent pin and detent plate mm (in.)
Installation dimension of front roll stopper bracket assembly mm (in.)
LUBRICANTS
Items Specified lubricant Quantity
Transaxle fluid DIAMOND ATF SP II or equivalent (7.1
Transfer oil API classification 0.5
SAE or ,
Propeller shaft sleeve yoke API classification As required
SAE or
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Special
SPECIAL TOOLS
I
ROM pack
(for scan tool)
Oil pressure
5 servo adjustment
servo wrench
adapter
6
servo wrench
adapter
8
servo wrench
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Special Tools
Hub fixing
yoke holder
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING
Verify complaint
trouble code
trouble
Basic
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
scan
Conditions Operation Judgement value Inspection Inspection proce-
dure page if there is
an abnormality
1 Ignition Overdrive switch Data list No. 35 Overdrive Overdrive switch
switch: ON switch system
Engine: (2) OFF (2) OD OFF
Stopped
Selector Data list No. 37 Park/ Neutral Code Nos.
position Park/ Neutral
switch position switch
system
(3)
(4)
(4)
2
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND Troubleshooting
Engine: Idling switch Data list No. 26 A/C load signal A/C load signal
(vehicle system
stopped) (2) OFF
Selector lever
position: Accelerator pedal Data list No. 45 Pressure Code Nos.
(1) Fully closed (1) 55-75 trol solenoid 85 Pressure
(2) Depressed (2) valve (PCSV) control
(Driving at valve
5 km/h (3.1 mph)
Engine: Idling Accelerator pedal Data list No. 27 Shift control Code Nos.
(vehicle (1) Fully closed solenoid valve 83 Shift control
stopped) (2) Depressed A (SCSV-A) solenoid valve A
Selector lever system
position:
Shift control Code
solenoid valve 84 Shift control
solenoid valve
system
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> , .
NOTE
Tests marked with should be carried out on a road that is as straight and level as possible.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>
A Selector lever Monitor scan tool For (2) and Malfunction Shocks and flare shifts
position: data list Nos. 27 (3) should match when shifting
Overdrive and 32. the specified
ON (1) Accelerate to shaft Displaced All points
gear at speed (vehicle shifting points
TPS output of speed), and Some points
1.5 (opening there should be
angle 30%). no abnormal
not shift No fail-safe codes
(2) Slowly shocks.
erate to a For (5) and
standstill. downshifting
(3) Accelerate to should be made Code Nos.
gear at immediately after Pulse generator A
TPS output of operation. system
2.5 (opening
angle 50%). C o d e
(4) At 50 km/h (31 Pulse generator
mph) in system
gear, turn
overdrive OFF.
(5) At 50 km/h (31 Code Nos.
mph) in Shift control solenoid
gear, move valve A system
selector lever
to 2 range.
Code Nos.
Shift control solenoid
range, move valve system
selector lever
to range.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Tests marked with should be carried out on a road that is as straight and level as possible.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>
,
SHIFT PATTERN
Throttle opening
50 100
,
0 50
DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION
METHOD OF READING THE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
CODES
When Using the Scan Tool
Connect the scan tool to the data link connector at the
lower right of the instrument under cover, and then read the diagnostic
trouble codes.
Caution
Always turn the ignition switch off before connecting or
disconnecting the scan tool.
Example of flashing when a diagnostic trouble code is output Flashing when normal
For diagnostic trouble
code No.
ov
NOTE
Other diagnostic trouble codes also output as the same code numbers as when using the scan tool.
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Torque converter
Revision
.
Code Diagnostic item
63 Torque reduction execution signal lines Short circuit
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>
NG
Check the throttle position sensor Replace
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle
Inspection of Components.)
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
l
OK
NG
Oil temperature sensor check. Replace
(Refer to
OK
Measure at the oil temperature sensor Check the following connector: Repair
connector
l Disconnect the connector, and
,
I .
measure at the connector side.
l Voltage between terminal (1) and
ground (Ignition switch: ON)
Replace the
OK
Repair
l
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshdoting
NG
Replace
(Refer to
OK
Repair
I
l Disconnect the connector and
OK
sure at the harness side.
the TCM.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>
Yes
SCAN TOOL DTC Stop light switch check (Refer to
Is TCL diagnostic trouble code No. 23 GROUP Brake Pedal.)
No
NG
Repair
l
OK
NG
Repair
and stop light switch.
OK
Check trouble
NG
Refer to Automatic
P u l s e g e n e r a t o r - Replace
(Refer to
OK
NG NG
Measure output from pulse R e p a i r
generator connector A-l 04 (using an tion
oscilloscope).
l
sure at PG-A side.
l Engine: 1,000 [approx. 30
19 mph)]
l range
Repair
OK
0
-1
-2
0 10 20
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>
NG
Pulse generator check Replace
(Refer to
OK
Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
NG
between pulse Repair
aenerator and TCM connectors.
OK
I -
I
1 6 2 1 1 2 7
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE>
(Refer to
switch connectors.
OK
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
.
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshootina
NG
Replace
check (Refer to
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
l
NG
Repair
of TCM and SCSV- A.
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshootina
NG
Replace
check (Refer to
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
.
OK
NG
Check the harness wire between con-
of TCM and PCSV. I
OK
Replace
(TCC) solenoid with a new component. Engine Stalling during shifting check
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting .
No
Yes
SCAN TOOL DTC Code Nos. 32, 82 Pulse generator
Is diagnostic trouble code No. 32 system check (Refer to
output?
No
NG
Measure output waveform from pulse generator connector (using an Pulse generator A and
oscilloscope). wire
l Disconnect the connector and measure at PG-A side. OK ,
l Engine: 1,000 [approx. 30 mph)]
l Selector lever position: range gear)
l Voltage between terminals (1) and (2) (PG-A output waveform)
OK: The waveform shown below should be output, and the amplitude should
be 1.0 or more. (Refer to .
There should be no noise in output waveform. Check trouble symptom.
l Voltage between terminals (3) and (4) output waveform)
OK: Thewaveformshownbelowshould NG
be 0.5 or more. (Refer to
There should be no noise in the output waveform. Replace the transfer gear and
end clutch retainer.
OK
I
Replace the rear clutch. I
-1
-2
0 10 20 0 10
1621126
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
,
Code No. gear incorrect ratio cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of pulse generator A or
If the value resulting from dividing the PG-A output (input shaft rotation speed) by the l Malfunction of transfer driven gear
gear ratio does not match the output (output shaft rotation speed) gear is engaged, l Malfunction of end clutch retainer
diagnostic trouble code No. 52 is output. In addition, if diagnostic trouble codes (Nos. l Malfunction of rear clutch
51, 52, 53 and 54) are output 4 times, there is an incorrect gear ratio, fail-safe code No. 86 l
is output and the vehicle is locked in gear (D) or gear (2, L) as a fail-safe measure. l Malfunction of brake’
No
Refer to Automatic
Yes
SCAN TOOL DTC Code Nos. 1 gear incorrect
Is diagnostic trouble code No. 51 ratio check (Refer to
output?
No
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ENGINE’
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Yes
there noise in the pulse generator Eliminate the source Of
A output waveform?
No
Measure at ECM
l Disconnect the connector and
NG
Check the
l
un
OK
Replace the TCM.
Check trouble
Repair
TCM and
.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Poor acceleration 14
while
Vibration 15
switch system 16
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
is communication with other systems Check the diagnosis line with scan tool.
possible using the scan tool? Repair, if necessary.
Yes
NG NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
l
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Voltages between terminals
(25) and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
l Continuity between terminal
Replace the TCM.
.
NG
Check the following connectors; Repair
l
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
l Starting impossible (will not crank) Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of engine system
Starting is not possible when the selector lever is in or range. In such cases, the cause l Malfunction of torque converter
is probably a defective engine system, torque converter or oil pump. l Malfunction of torque converter
l Malfunction of oil pump
thing is normal.
l If there is an repair or
replace the engine
After completion
After completion
Torque converter check Oil pump check
l Check to be sure that the torque l Check to be sure that there are no
converter installation is not defec- abnormalities such as oil pump Sei-
tive (inserted at an angle, etc.). zure, side
l If there is an abnormality, carry out or loosening of
repairs. However, if the are l If there is an abnormality, replace
damaged and repairs are not pos- the oil pump assembly.
sible, replace the torque converter
assembly.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3
l Does not move forward
[Comment] Abnormal line pressure
When the engine is idling, the does not move forward even if the lever is l Malfunction of rear
shifted from to 2 or range. In such cases, the cause is probably abnormal line pressure, l Malfunction of one-way
or a defective rear or one-way clutch. l Malfunction of body
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4
l Does not back-up Probable cause
[Comment] l Abnormal low reverse brake pressure
When the engine is idling, the vehicle does not back-up even if the lever is shifted l Abnormal front pressure
from to range. In such cases, the cause is abnormal pressure in the low reverse l Malfunction of front
brake or front clutch, or a defective low reverse brake or front clutch. l of low reverse
of valve
NG .
Low reverse brake system check Front clutch and low reverse
check
l Remove the oil pan and valve l Check for burning of the facing,
body. defective piston seal rings and
l Pistons operate and interference between the end
pressure should also be and retainer.
maintained when air is blown
through the low reverse brake
oil holes in the transaxle case.
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> ,
.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
l Does not move (forward or reverse) Probable cause‘
[Comment] l Abnormal reducing pressure
When the engine is idling, the vehicle does not move forward or in reverse even if the selector l Malfunction of power train
lever is shifted from to 2, or range. In such cases, the cause is probably abnormal l Malfunction of oil pump
reducing pressure, or a defective oil pump or power train. l ‘of valve body
l If it is considered that the damage or chipping cannot If there is an abnormality, replace the oil pump assembly.
be repaired, replace the valve body assembly.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
l Engine stalling during shifting cause
[Comment] Malfunction of engine system
When the engine is idling, the engine stalls when the selector lever is shifted from to l Malfunction of torque solenoid
2, or range. In such cases, the cause is probably a defective engine system or damper l Malfunction of body
clutch control solenoid valve. l Malfunction of torque converter
After completion
Transaxle cooling system check
l Check for plugged cooler lines.
l Check for plugged oil cooler.
After completion
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
l Shocks when shifting from to and long lag time Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of rear clutch
When the engine is idling, abnormal shocks or a lag time of 2 seconds or more occur when Malfunction of valve body
the selector lever is shifted from to range. In such cases, the cause is probably a defective Malfunction closed switch’
rear clutch or valve body
.
Refer to Automatic Transaxle‘ Overhaul
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ,
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 8
l Shocks when shifting from to and long lag time Probable cause
[Comment] Abnormal front clutch pressure
When the engine is idling, abnormal shocks or a lag time of 2 seconds or more occurs when l Abnormal low reverse brake
the selector lever is shifted from to range. In such cases, the cause is probably abnormal l Malfunction of front clutch
low reverse brake or front clutch pressure, or a defective low reverse brake or front clutch. l Malfunction of low reverse brake
Malfunction of valve
OK
OK
Hydraulic pressure test Front clutch system check ..
(Refer to Remove the transaxle, oil pan and
l Measure the low reverse brake valve body.
pressure in range at 2,500 Pistons should operate and pres-
Standard value: 1,640 sure should also be maintained
when air is blown through the front
clutch oil holes in the transaxle
case.
NG NG
l Remove the transaxle, oil pan and l Check for burning of the facing, de-
fective piston seal rings and interfer-
l Pistons should operate and ence between the end plate and
retainer.
when air is blown throuah the low
reverse brake oil holes trans-
axle case. I Valve body disassembly, cleaning and
OK reassembly
T S B Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 9
l Shocks when shifting from to D, to and long lag ,
time
[Comment] l Abnormal reducing pressure
When the engine is idling, abnormal shocks or a lag time of 2 seconds or more occur when Malfunction of
the selector lever is shifted from to range and also from to range. In such cases, Malfunction
the cause is probably abnormal reducing pressure or a defective oil pump.
. .
Refer to Automatic Transaxle Overhaul
OK
Hydraulic pressure test (Refer to
l Measure the reducing pressure in range while the
engine is idling.
Standard value: psi)
,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 10
.
l Shocks and flare shifts
[Comment] l Malfunction of servo switch
Shocks occur when driving due to upshifting or downshifting. In addition, the engine speed l Abnormal reducing pressure
during shifting increases abnormally in comparison to normal shifting. In such cases, the cause l Malfunction of valve body
is probably abnormal reducing pressure or a defective servo switch. l Malfunction of closed throttle positron switch
Malfunction of pressure control solenoid
l Malfunction of clutches and brakes
SCAN
l 21 servo switch
OK: Turns momentarily from ON to OFF when engine
is in and the accelerator pedal is
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 11
l All points (Early, late shifting points) Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of pulse generator
All shift points occurs early, late while driving. In such cases, the cause is probably a defective l Malfunction of shift control solenoid A or
pulse generator (PG-B) or shift control solenoid valve A or B).
l Malfunction of
l Abnormal reducing pressure or servo
brake application pressure
l Malfunction of clutches and brakes
l Malfunction, of ‘valve body,
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list
l 32 Pulse generator (PG-B)
OK: Increases in proportion to vehicle speed
NG
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURES 12
l Some points (Early, late shifting points) Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of valve body
Some shift points occurs early, late while driving. In such cases, the cause is probably a
defective valve body, or it is a phenomenon related control and is not an abnormality.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 13
l No fail-safe codes (Does not shift) Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of overdrive switch
Shifting does not occur while driving, and no fail-safe codes are output. In such cases, the l Malfunction of Park/ Neutral position switch
cause is probably a defective overdrive switch or Park/Neutral position switch. l Malfunction of power supply circuit
l Malfunction of TCM
No
Yes
Check to be sure that backup power is being supplied to Does overdrive operate?
the TCM.
Yes
Check to be sure that power is being supplied to the TCM SCAN TOOL Data list
l 35 Overdrive switch
OK: When overdrive switch turns from OFF to ON,
scan tool display turns from OFF to ON.
SCAN TOOL Data list
l 37 Park/ Neutral position switch
OK: TCM input signal and selector lever position Check the overdrive switch system according to inspection
should match. , procedure (Refer to ,
NG OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 14
Poor acceleration I
[Comment] l Malfunction of clutches and brakes
While driving, acceleration is poor even if downshifting is performed. In such cases, the cause Malfunction of engine system
is probably a defective clutch or brake, or a defective engine system.
,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 15
l Vibration Probable cause
[Comment] l Abnormal torque converter pressure
Vibration occurs when driving at constant speed or when accelerating in top range. In such l Malfunction of engine system
cases, the cause is probably abnormal torque converter clutch pressure or a defective torque Malfunction of torque converter
converter. of valve body
Refer to Automatic
Yes
sensor connector is disconnected?
No
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
..
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 16
l Overdrive switch system Probable cause .
[Comment] l Malfunction of overdrive switch
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably a defective overdrive switch circuit or defective l Malfunction of
ignition switch circuit. l Malfunction of ignition switch
l Malfunction of TCM
NG
Overdrive switch check Replace
to
NG
Measure at overdrive switch connector Check the Repair
l
OK
l Voltage between terminals (3) and
OK
the TCM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 17
l Closed throttle position switch system Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of closed
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably a defective closed throttle position switch l Malfunction of connector
circuit. l Malfunction of
Check trouble
NG
NG
Check the harness wire between the Repair
closed throttle position switch and TCM
connectors.
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 18
l A/C load signal system Probable
[Comment] l Malfunction of dual pressure
In cases such as the above, the cause is probably a defective Idle position switch circuit. l Malfunction of
l Malfunction of A/C system
l Malfunction of TCM
NG
Dual pressure switch check (Refer to Replace
GROUP 55 On-vehicle Service.)
OK
..
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
l Vehicle speed sensor system Probable ‘cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of vehicle speed
In cases such as the above, the cause, is probably a defective vehicle speed sensor circuit. .
l Malfunction of connector
l of TCM
NG
Replace
(Refer to
. .
..
1. NG NG
Measure at the vehicle speed Check the following con-, Repair
l Disconnect the connector, and measure at the harness side.
1. Voltage between 1 and ground
OK
(Ignition switch: ON)
OK: Battery positive voltage Check trouble symptom. .
2. Voltage between 3 and ground I
2. NG
(Ignition switch: ON) NG
OK:
3. Continuity between 2 and ground
O K :
NG
Check the following con- + Repair
OK
Check trouble symptom.
OK NG
NG
Replace the TCM. Check the harness wire Repair
between the TCM and the
vehicle sensor
connector.’
the TCM. I
Check the harness wire between the vehicle speed sensor and
the ground and repair if necessary.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Item
No. Check item Check conditions Normal condition
Depressed ,
Brake pedal position
28 light switch Ignition switch: ON
Released
Stopped OFF
Driving at 5 km/h (3.1 mph)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Item
Check item Check conditions Normal
No.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> Troubleshootina
82 Open circuit in pulse generator (PG-B) Hold in gear (D) or gear (2, L) 32
85 Open or short circuit in pressure control Hold in gear (D) or gear (2, L)
solenoid valve (PCSV)
86 Incorrect gear ratio Hold in gear (D) or gear (2, L) 54
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Engine: Idling
o v
Torque converter Selector lever position: range
1
clutch solenoid
When clutch solenoid is operating
At all times o v
Oil temperature AWD only
3 Ignition switch: 5 minutes after turning Battery positive
warning light
on
Engine: Idling
servo Selector lever position: range
7
switch Selector lever position: range, Battery positive
Transaxle condition: gear voltage
Battery positive
A/C switch: ON
compressor
8
clutch relay signal
A/C switch: OFF o v
Diagnostic output .
9 When normal
terminal Flashing
Pressure control
Engine: Idling
14 solenoid valve
Selector lever position: range
Battery positive
Transaxle condition: 1 st and gear
Shift control solenoid voltage
15 valve (SCSV-B)
Transaxle condition: and gear. 0
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENG INE AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE. (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Troubleshooting
Check Normal
Check conditions
item
,
WAVEFORM SAMPLE
Waveform A Waveform
.
5
0 ,
Waveform Waveform
2
1
0 0
-1 -10
-2 -20
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.
TRANSAXLE FLUID REPLACEMENT 23100100176
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle Service
Terminal
No.
I I I I
Manual
2
Terminal . I
No.
I I I
2
I I I
10
11
12
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle
SWITCH
23100150072
1. Set the selector lever to the (Neutral)
2. Loosen the’control cable to lever coupling
adjusting nut to free the cable and lever.
Section A-A
Hole in end Manual
control
lever
Hole in Switch
flange body
00004249
Manual control
lever
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC: TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND On-vehicle Service
Name
switch
servo switch
OD-OFF switch
Oil temperature sensor
Revision
‘I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle Service I-
Pulse
gene-
rator
Pulse
gene-
rator A
Vehicle
sensor
CC Solenoid
Revision
TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle Servide
Refer to
OVERDRIVE SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK 23100330032
Refer to
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (TPS) CHECK
Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Inspection of Compo-
nents.
CLOSED THROTTLE POSITION SWITCH CHECK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
8. Torque 23199999949
brake
6. End clutch
pressure
.
,
TSB
TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
l
2 Idling gear
(using
scan tool)
3 Approx. gear
2,500 (64-92)
4 Approx. gear 900 I
2,500 (64-92) I
5 2 Approx. gear I I
2,500 (64-92)
6 Approx. 1 st gear .
1,000 ( 4 3 - 6 4 )
7 Approx.
2,500 2,240 2,240
Reverse (233-319) (233-319) .
Approx. 1,000 1,000 (64-92)
1,000 (145) or (145) or
more more
NOTE
must be (1.5 psi) or less.
SW-ON: Switch ON the overdrive control
SW-OFF: Switch OFF the overdrive control switch
Hydraulic pressure is generated, but not the standard value.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
D-ring I , b r a k e
Seal ring
Seal ring
I
D-ring
O-ring
Seal ring
.
Seal ring
A Seal ring
D-ring
brake
O-ring
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Service
ring
I
D-ring O-ring
Seal
Oil seal
D-ring
A Seal ring
D-ring
brake
O-ring
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC: TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND ENGINE> .
Hole
6 Hole A
1 Hole
2 I 6 hole A
3 Hole
00000394
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
CASE 1 No. 2 and 7 hydraulic pressures (line pressure) are all abnormal.
Refer to Automatic Transaxle Overhaul
Measure No. and 7 hydraulic Check the oil filter (blockage, damage) Replace
sure (line pressure)
All are high
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC: TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND On-vehicle Service
OK
Check the Use Overhaul the valve
the scan tool to check the (Pressurecontrolvalve, pressurecontrolspring,
PCSV control operation shift valve)
sound, and check No. 2 hy-
draulic pressure also.
NG I
down servo spring ring
Check the PCSV
, part.
(Refer to
NG
Replace the PCSV
,
Replace the reaction support rings Retest
and the front clutch (2 rings).*
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
No. 7 condition
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
CASE 9 Hydraulic pressure appears in places where standard hydraulic pressure is 9.8 (1.4 psi) or less
Refer to Automatic Transaxle Overhaul
Check the SCSV-A Replace SCSV-A.
(Refer to
OK
Check the Replace the
(Refer to
TSB Revision
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
25
24
25
Line pressure Oil pump suction pressure Torque
shift valve
15. End valve
16. Converter control
4. Low-reverse brake 17. solenoid valve
5. End 18. Shift
6. Servo 19. N-D valve
7. Transaxle 20.
8. converter control 21. Manual valve
22. Pressure control
9. Rear clutch exhaust valve 23. N-R
valve 24. Oil
11. Torque clutch 25. Oil pan
valve 26. Oil pump
12. valve 27. Line relief valve
13. valve “A” 28. Pressure Control solenoid
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
On-vehicle
Drive (Stop)
To
To
25
Torque
Torque converter pressure pressure
lubrication
pressure
Reducing pressure
(First)
To (front
To (rear)
25
Line Oil pump suction pressure Torque clutch
14 valve
2. Front clutch 15 End clutch
3. Rear clutch 16 Torque Converter control valve
4. brake control solenoid
5. End clutch control valve
6. Servo 19. N-D control
7. Transaxle
8. Torque converter clutch 21. Manual valve
22. Pressure control valve
valve
9. Rear clutch exhaust 23. N-R control
10. valve 24. Oil filter
il. Torque converter clutch 25. Oil pan
26. Oil pump
27. Line valve
12. Reducing control solenoid
Shift control valve
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
Drive
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
Drive (Fourth)
Torque
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
Lock. (First)
To
To
Reverse
To
To
25
Line pressure Oil pump suction pressure press
Torque and
control solenoid pressure
1. Torque converter
2. Front clutch End clutch valve
3. Rear clutch 16. Torque converter valve
4. Low-reverse brake 7. Shift control
5. End clutch 18. control valve
6. 19. N-D control valve
7. Transaxle control module 20. Regurator valve
8. Torque converter clutch control 21. Manual valve
valve 22. Pressure control valve
9. Rear clutch exhaust valve 23. N-R control
valve 24. Oil filter
Torque converter clutch control 25. Oil pan
Valve 26. Oil pump
valve 27.
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND On-vehicle Service
SERVO ADJUSTMENT
1. Completely remove all dirt and other materials adhered
around the servo switch.
2. Remove the snap ring.
3. Remove the servo switch.
Lock nut
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
9. Tighten the lock nut by hand until the lock nut contacts
the piston. Then using the torque wrench, tighten to the
specified torque.
Lock nut: (21
Caution
If it is rapidly tightened with the socket wrench or
torque wrench, the lock nut and adjusting rod may
rotate together.
10. Remove the special tool which fastens the piston.
Attach the plug to the outlet of the low-reverse pressure.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service
23100170047
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle
TSB Revision
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
,
1. Shift selector lever to each, and check lever
moves smoothly and clicks
indicator is
2. Check that the selector lever can be shifted to
(by button dperation as shown in the
3. Start the engine check if the vehicle
when the selector lever is from to moves
backward when shifted
4. When the shift lever adjust control cable’
and selector lever sleeve. Check for
Button pressed sliding parts.
brake pedal is
depressed) NOTE .
Button not pressed To move the selector lever “P” any
Button pressed
other position, first turn. the key to
‘other than “LOCK (OFF)” the pedal.
..
LOCK INTERLOCK
Push button the vehicle and switch OFF before
making the check.
1 Check that, under the the
lever cannot be moved from the position other
position.
Also check, at the same time, that the button
be pressed.
Ignition key position: or
Brake pedal: Depressed
.
00000209
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> On-vehicle Service‘
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>
Engine>
8.8 Nm
6.5
11 Nm
11 Nm
8.3
11 Nm
8.3
11 N m
. .
8.3
l
NOTE
Resin clip position
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND
9 1.5
2 Nm
arrow-located places)
11 Nm
8.3
Disassembly steps
1. Overdrive switch position indicator 12. Position indicator light assembly
light connector case 13. Sleeve
2. Cover 14. Bolt
3. Selector knob 15. Lever assembly
4. Overdrive switch button 16. Detent spring assembly
5. Overdrive switch 17. Bushing
6. Pin 18. Pipe
7. Push button 19. Cotter pin
8. Spring 20. Washer
9. Indicator panel upper 21. Lock cam
10. Slider 22. Bracket assembly
11. Indicator panel lower
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Control
te
TSB Revision
,
(TURBO) AND ENGINE> . .
.
l Check the wear
l Check the spring’ for
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Automatic Transaxle Key Interlock
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> and Shift Lock Mechanisms
23200120045
6 7
5
I
- -
11 Nm
18’
NOTE
(1) clip position
(2) clip position 8.3 00003933
Key interlock cable removal steps Shift lock cable removal steps
1. Plug A 1. Plug A
2. Plug 2. Plug
3. Hood release lever 3. Hood release lever
4. Instrument panel under cover 4. Instrument panel under cover
5. Steering column lower cover 6. Center panel
6. Center panel 7. Cup holder assembly
7. Cup holder assembly 8. Floor console assembly
8. Floor console assembly 9. Console side cover (L.H.)
9. Console side cover (L.H.) 16. Shift lock cable connection
10. Cover 17. Cotter pin
Cam and lever 18. Shift lock cable connection
12. Key interlock cable connection 20. Shift lock cable
13. Slide lever
14. Snap pin
15. Key interlock cable connection
19. Key interlock cable
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Lock
LOCK
INSTALLATION
Secure the section between the metals of the
and key interlock cable with the of the steering cover
assembly.
Caution ,
Do not change the routing of shift lock cable to
. the
lever assembly.
LEVER
INSTALLATION
(1) Install the key interlock cable on the lock cam.
(2) Install the spring and washer of the key interlock cable
as shown.
(3) While lightly pushing the cable coupling portion of the
cam in-the direction A, tighten the nut
. to fasten the
key interlock cable.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
23100570192
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake 13. Oil temperature sensor connector
hose assembly 14. Kick down servo switch connector
2. Air cleaner element 15. Solenoid valve connector
3. Air hose 16. Pulse generator connector
4. Air hose A 17. Speedometer connector
5. Battery tray 18. Transaxle assembly mounting bolts
6. Evaporative emission canister 19. roll stopper bracket mounting
7. Evaporative emission canister holder
8. Battery tray stay 20. Transaxle mounting bracket mount-
9. Transaxle control cable connection ing nuts
10. Oil dipstick and guide assembly 21. Transaxle oil cooler hoses connection
Starter motor l Supporting engine assembly
12. Park/Neutral position switch con-
nector
TSB Revision
, . . ,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
33
45-52 Nm
33-38
69-78 Nm
,
2 5
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
Engine>
Pre-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
l Transaxle Fluid Draining l Battery Installation
(Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.) l Under Cover Installation
l Battery Removal (Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.)
l Under Cover Removal l Transaxle Fluid Supplying
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover.) (Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service.)
I I l Selector Lever Operation Check
I
30 Nm
44 Nm
59 15
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake 10. Kick down servo switch connector
hose assembly 11. Solenoid valve connector
2. Air cleaner element 12. Pulse generator connector
3. Battery tray 13. Speedometer
4. Battery tray stay 14. Transaxle assembly mounting bolts
5. Transaxle control cable connection 15. roll stopper bracket mounting
6. Oil dipstick and guide assembly
7. Starter motor 16. Transaxle mounting bracket mount-
8. Park/Neutral position switch ing nuts
connector 17. Transaxle oil cooler
9. Oil temperature sensor connector l Supporting engine assembly
TSB Revision
, ,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
29-34 Nm
9.8-13 Nm
7.2-9.4
8.8 Nm
6.5
Nm
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Assembly
DRIVE PLATE
SERVICE
TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
After securely inserting the torque converter the transaxle
so that the shown in the becomes the refer-
ence value, install the assembly the engine.
value (A):
mm
12.0
ASSEMBLY
If the dimension shown in the is outside the standard
Front roll value when the weight of the engine the body, replace
stopper the front roll stopper bracket assembly.
bracket
Standard value (A): mm
ber
DRIVE SHAFT
Temporarily install the drive shaft so that T.J. case of
the drive shaft is perpendicular to the
Caution
Do not damage the oil by part of the
drive shaft.
Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
23100570205
69 Nm
51
3.9
2.9
30 Nm
22
Nm
23
17
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake 13. Oil temperature sensor connector
hose assembly 14. Kick down servo switch connector
2. Air cleaner element 15. Solenoid valve connector
3. Air hose 16. Pulse generator connector
4. Air hose A 17. Speedometer connector
5. Battery tray 18. Transaxle assembly mounting bolts
6. Evaporative emission canister 19. roll stopper bracket mounting
7. Evaporative emission canister holder
8. Battery tray stay 20. Transaxle mounting bracket
9. Transaxle control cable connection ing nuts
10. Oil dipstick and guide assembly 21. Transaxle oil cooler hoses connection
11. Starter motor l Supporting engine assembly
12. Park/Neutral position switch con-
nector
TSB Revision
Nm
-188
76
Nm
Revision
.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
Caution
Do not apply the vehicle weight to the wheel bearing
while loosening the drive shaft nut. If, however, the vehicle,
weight must be applied to the bearing (because of moving
the vehicle), temporarily secure the wheel bearing by
using the special tool, etc.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE AND Transaxle
SHAFT REMOVAL
(1) a pry bar between the transaxle case drive
shaft, and then pry the drive shaft from the transaxle.
Caution
1. Use a pry bar to remove the shaft from the
B.J. assembly, or the may be dam-
aged. .
2. Do not insert the pry bar oil
Pry bar Transaxle may be damaged.
CONNECTING’ BOLTS/TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY MOUNTING BOLTS/TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
(1) Use a transmission jack to support the transaxle assembly.
Caution
Support the transaxle case side, not pan.
.
Transmission
jack
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
Washer
DRIVE SHAFT NUT INSTALLATION
(1) Install the drive shaft washer in the specified direction.
TSB Revision I
A U T O M A T I C T R A N S A X L E
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> Transaxle Assembly
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND Transfer Assembly
69 Nm
51
Gear oil:
classification SAE
1. Transfer assembly
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND Transaxle
29199710119
Engine>
Engine (Turbo)>
9.8 Nm
7.2
Engine (Turbo)>
9.8
6 7.2
Nm
2.9
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake Pipe assembly
hose 6. Oil cooler duct
2. Feed hose 7. Bracket
3. Return hose 8. Oil cooler assembly
4. Hose assembly
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> -‘Transaxle Oil Cooler
INSPECTION 231
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE .
ENGINE
22110010012
GENERAL INFORMATION
The automatic transaxle comes in one model, namely,
Items Specifications
Model
Applicable engine
Fully-adaptive, electronically controlled
full-automatic
Torque converter with torque
Engine stall speed
Gear ratio 2.842 I
1 . 5 7 3
‘ 1 . 0 0 0
. 0.689
,
Reverse 2.214
Final gear ratio 3 . 9 0 9
Vehicle upshift and downshift speeds are increased when in these selector positions.
TSB Revision ,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)? General
SECTIONAL VIEW
Case
Overdrive Reverse clutch
Input speed clutch
sensor
2-4 clutch
Underdrive
clutch Low/Reverse
clutch
converter
Torque .
converter sensor
Oil pump
gear
shaft
gear
Differential
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Tools
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Verify complaint
Communication with
scan tool not possible
Record the diagnostic trouble code
and fail-gafe code. (Refer to ,
OK
NG Confirmation test (road test) ‘Completed
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
ROAD TEST
Use scan
Diagnostic
Conditions Operation Judgment value Inspection item
trouble code
1 Ignition switch: ON Check the limp-in Data list Transaxle control
Engine: Stopped mode l No limp-in mode module
Transaxle control 14
relay
15
20
Check the battery Data list Battery 12
positive voltage
2 Warming up Drive for 15 Data list No. 56 Oil temperature 74
minutes or more so Gradually rises to sensor
that the automatic
transmission fluid
temperature
becomes
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Proce-
dure Conditions Operation Judgment value Inspection item
tor lever in 2
(4) Driving in
gear with 2-4: OFF
lever in OD: OFF
range
(Overdrive
switch ON)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Diagnostic
Conditions Operation Judgment value Inspection item trouble
dure
code
57
58
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE . . .
ENGINE
SHIFT PATTERN
Throttle opening
.
. .
100
I
I ,
,
.
de- -
3 .
.
I
20
I
0
0 1000 2000 3000 '4000 6000
Transfer
, drive
, , , , , , , , ,
0
LOCK-UP
Throttle opening
40
I I . I I
20
I
.
I I I I I
0 .
1000 2000 3000 4000 5000
Transfer drive
0
Vehiclespeed (mph)
,
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE Troubleshooting
43 Engine speed
47 Throttle position
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
ACTUATOR RE FE R E NC E TAB L E
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
If a problem which interferes with the continuous safe operation of the transaxle is identified, the TCM
records a diagnostic trouble code in memory, all solenoids are turned off, and the module is switched
to limp-in mode.
When limp-in mode is started, the transaxle is locked in gear if a drive gear had previously been
selected. Meanwhile, if or range was selected, operation is as usual.
If the ignition key is turned to OFF and then back to ON again, limp-in mode is (a record
is retained).
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE ( NON - TURBO )> Troubleshooting
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Relay output (switched battery) has more than 3 volts at TCM and 57 (Connector l Malfunction of relay
when TCM pin 55 (Connector is turned off. Relay should be de-energized whenever l Short to power on of relay
relay and TCM .
ignition switch is OFF.
l Short to power on load side of relay between
relay and TCM
l TCM relay driver circuit stuck ON
NG
EATX relay Check the EATX relay Replace the EATX relay
l Ignition switch: OFF ON l Check the continuity between
.
OK: Operatingsoundcanbeheard terminals (2) (8).
OK: Continuity (0 when system
voltageisapplied
(4) and no
nuity when ‘system
voltage is not applied.
OK
Measure at the EATX relay connector Measure at the EATX relay connector Repair the harness
and the TCM
l Disconnect the connector and Continuity between terminal (6) and .
measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between (4) and
(55). 2. ground.
l Ignition switch: ON
OK: Less than
OK NG
Check trouble
l NG
I Repair
Replace the TCM ,
Measure at the TCM connector Check the harness wire between the
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side. relay, pressure switch assembly
l Voltage between (57) and
ground.
Disconnect solenoid and pressure
switch assembly. Check the harness wire between the
Ignition switch ON
OK: Less than
2. Connect solenoid and pressure
switch assembly.
Ignition switch ON
OK: Less than
OK
Measure at the EATX relay connector Replace the TCM
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting .
Relay output (switched battery) has less than 3 volts at TCM pins 56 and 57 (Connector l Malfunction of relay (open contacts)
when TCM pin 55 (Connector to energize relay. Relay should be energized l Harness or connector between relay coil and
whenever key is ON. TCM open or short-circuited
. Harness or connector between relay output
and TCM open-circuited
. Relay supply lines open-circuited
. Relay ground open-circuited
Malfunction of TCM
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE
Engine speed received at the PCM from the CKP over the CCD bus is less than 384 o f
l Harness or connector between crankshaft
position sensor and TCM open. . or
l of TCM
Abnormality exists
(diagnostic trouble
code present)
Recheckdiagnostictroublecodeswhich
were read before the road test
Diagnostic trouble No diagnostic trouble
code output code displayed
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
No CCD messages received for 10 seconds l CCD bus between PCM and TCM
short-circuited
l Malfunction of PCM
NG
Check the following connect Repair
l
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE .
ENGINE. (NON-TURBO)> ,
NG
Measure at solenoid and pressure Check the wire between the Repair
switch assembly connector TCM and the EATX relay
l Disconnect the connector and (Check short to power)
measure at the harness side. ,
l Voltage between (5) and OK
ground.
l Ignition switch: ON
OK: OV
OK Replace the
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
34 ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
A mismatch has occurred between the shift condition and the pressure switch condition fluid level in transaxle
(ON/OFF) while the vehicle is moving. l Malfunction of pressure switch assembly
l Harness or connector between OD pressure
switch and TCM open or short-circuited
l of TCM
l Internal transaxle problem
NG NG
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the harness wire between the Repair
22 Overdrive pressure switch EATX relay and solenoid and pressure
l Engine: Stopped switch assembly
l Disconnect the EATX relay (Check short to power)
connector and apply system
voltage to harness-side connector
Check the harness wire between sole-
. O N
noid and pressure switch assembly and
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE
A mismatch has occurred between the shift condition and the pressure switch condition
(ON/OFF) while the vehicle is moving. l Malfunction
l Harness or connector between 2-4 pressure
switch and TCM open or short-circuited
l Malfunction of TCM
Internal transaxle problem
NG
TOOL Data Check the harness wire between the
21 2-4 pressure switch
l Engine: Stopped
l Disconnect the EATX relay
connector and apply system
to harness-side connector
. O N
OK
.
. Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 21. (Refer
to 134)
l Carry out inspection procedure for code No. 22. (Refer
to
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
36 ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
A mismatch has occurred between the shift condition and the pressure switch condition l Low/high fluid level transaxle
(ON/OFF) while the vehicle is moving. l Malfunction of switch
l Harness or connector between pressure
switch and TCM open or short-circuited
l Malfunction of TCM
l Internal transaxle problem
NG
SCAN TOOL list Check the harness wire between the
20 pressure switch EATX relay and solenoid and pressure
l Engine: Stopped switch assembly
l Disconnect the EATX relay (Check short to power)
connector and apply system OK
voltage to harness-side connector NG
terminal (8). Check the harness Repait
l Ignition switch: ON
and pressure switch assembly and
OK: OFF TCM (terminal (10))
(Check short to power)
OK
Hydraulic Possible causes: NG
l Raise vehicle on hoist l Incorrect transmission fluid level Check the following connector: Repair
allowsfrontwheelstoturn. l Internal transaxle failure (Refer
.
l Attach oauae to to
OK
l the Replace and pressure Check trouble
l Increase speed to
1 5 0 0
1. Take a reading of the Replace solenoid and pressure switch
clutch pressure.
OK:
psi)
2. SCAN TOOL list Replace the TCM Check trouble symptom.
20 L-R pressure switch
OK: ON NG
OK Replace the TCM
INTERMITTENT MALFUNCTION
l Study the DTC information (back-
ground, range of check, setting
condition).
l Refer to INTRODUCTION How
to Cope with Intermittent Malfunc-
tion.
A mismatch has occurred between the shift condition and the pressure switch condition l Low/high fluid level in transaxle
(ON/OFF) while the vehicle is moving. l Malfunction of pressure switch assembly
l Harness or connector between OD pressure
switch and TCM open or
l Harness or connector between pressure
switch and TCM open or short-circuited
l Malfunction of TCM
Internal transaxle problem
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE .
ENGINE Troubleshooting
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 22. (Refer
to
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 24. (Refer
to
A mismatch has occurred between the shift condition and the pressure switch condition fluid level
(ON/OFF) while the vehicle is moving. Malfunction of pressure switch assembly
Harness or connector between OD pressure
Internal transaxle
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 21. (Refer
to .
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 22. (Refer
to 135) I
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 24. (Refer
to
. ,
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> ‘Troubleshooting,
Case 1 Invalid code timer has expired (100 msec). Malfunction range
Case 2 Third occurrence of setting data error flag since start-up l Harness or connector between transaxle range
sensor and open or short-circuited
l Transaxle range sensor ground open-circuited
l Malfunction of
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list
26 Transaxle range sensor 43
l Ignition switch: ON
OK: Shift lever position
2, L: ON
Otherthan OFF
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list Check the transaxle range sensor Replace the transaxle range sensor
27
. Transaxle range sensor 41 (Refer to
. . . I
OK:
Check the following connector:
l
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
l Throttle angle less than 6 degrees, or Throttle greater than 120.6 degrees. l Malfunction of sensor
l The engine must be running. l Harness or connector between
sensor and TCM open or short-circuited
l or connector
sensor output and TCM open or short-circuited
l Malfunction of
l Malfunction of
..
OK
Check that the engine lamp is on -- Reform PCM diagnostics.
the enaine I
,
OK:
connector
Abnormality exists
trouble code
present)
Measure at TCM connector and Check the harness wire between the ,
throttle position connector TCM and the throttle sensor
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side. .
l
Less than
OK
NG
Repair
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshootihg
Pressure switch falls to respond within specified time for given temperature range. l Low/high fluid level in transaxle
l Malfunction of pressure switch assembly
l Internal transaxle problem
OK NG
Hydraulic pressure check Check the following Repair
l Measure the overdrive clutch pressure l
l engine
l Disconnect the solenoid and pressure switch OK
assembly connector and apply system voltage
Replace the solenoid and pressure switch
between terminals (6) (8).
bly.
WARNING: FRONT WHEELS MUST BE OFF
THE GROUND BEFORE PRO-
CEEDING.
NOTE: Step on the brake pedal so the wheels won’t
rotate.
l Select lever:
Increase the engine speed slightly.
Standard (75-95 psi)
every 3 seconds
Pressure switch falls to respond within specified time for given temperature range. l Low/high fluid level in transaxle
l Malfunction of pressure switch assembly
l Internal transaxle problem
NG
Hydraulic pressure check following connector Repair
l Measure the 2-4 clutch pressure
Start engine OK
WARNING: FRONT WHEELS MUST BE OFF
THE GROUND BEFORE PRO- the solenoid and pressure switch assem-
CEEDING.
on the brake pedal so that wheels
won’t rotate.
l Select lever:
l increase the engine speed slightly.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Pressure switch falls to respond within specified time for given temperature range. l Low/high fluid level in transaxle
Malfunction
Internal transaxle problem
,
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 31. (Refer
to
l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 32. (Refer
to .
Fault happened within 1.3 second of a shift (This code is not stored alone. It if l Internal transaxle problem
a speed error (codes through 58) is detected immediately after a (Refer to Speed errors) I
Electronically Modulated Converter Clutch (EMCC) operation is inhibited l Low/high fluid level in
Internal problem
NG
check I - ..< .
l - Measure the torque converter clutch off control valves.
NG
ROAD TEST Check the transmission fluid level. Repair
OK: Code 38 set.
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
A shift must not be in progress; an selector lever position, pressure switch, or watchdog l of pressure switch assembly
test must not be in progress; no spike must be detected from the solenoid during the first l Harness or connector between solenoid
test, or a pressure switch problem, or a speed problem. The code sets if the solenoid continuity and TCM open or short-circuited
test failed for the second time, or if there is either a pressure switch or speed data problem l TCM ground open-circuited
and the solenoid continuity test failed for the first time. l Malfunction of TCM
Check the
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Troubleshooting
A shift must not be in progress; an selector lever position, or watchdog of pressure switch
test must not be in progress; no must be detected from the solenoid during the first l Harness or connector between
test, or a pressure switch problem, or a speed problem. The code sets if the solenoid continuity open or .
test failed for the second time, or if there is a pressure switch or speed data problem l ground open-circuited
and the solenoid continuity test failed for the first time.
NG
Measure at the TCM connector
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (59) and
ground. l Resistance value between (59) and
OK: Less than
OK
OK: 1
I
NG
the TCM
NG ,
Measure at the TCM connector Check the harness wire between the
and solenoid and pressure switch TCM and solenoid and pressure switch
connector assembly.
l Disconnect the connector and .
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (59)
and (3)
OK: Less than
I
. .
,
Measure at EATX Relay connector . Check the harness wire between the
and solenoid and pressure switch as-
. . , ,
sembly connector
l Disconnect the connector and
,
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (8)
and (6).
OK: Less than
OK
Replace the solenoid and pressure
switch assembly.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE
A shift must not be in progress; an selector lever position, pressure switch, or watchdog l of pressure ‘assembly
test must not be in progress: no spike must be detected from the solenoid during the first l Harness or between OD
test, or a pressure switch problem, or a speed problem. The code sets if the solenoid continuity and TCM open or
test failed for the second time, or if there is either a pressure switch or speed data problem l TCM ground open-circuited
and the solenoid continuity test failed for the first time. l Malfunction of TCM
OK
Check the following connector:
l Disconnect the connector and Disconnect the connector and l
NG
Measure at the TCM connector Measure at the TCM connector Check the harness the
l Disconnect the connector and l Disconnect the connector and TCM and ground.
measure at the harness side. measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between and l Resistance value between
and ground.
OK: 1 OK: Less than
N G OK
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
l
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE , .
ENGINE, (NON-TURBO)>
A shift must not be an selector lever position, pressure switch, or watchdog Malfunction of
test must not be in progress; no spike must be detected from the solenoid during the l or connector between UD
test, or a pressure switch problem, or a speed problem. The code sets if the solenoid continuity and TCM
test failed for the second time, or if there is either a pressure switch or speed data l TCM ground open-circuited
and the solenoid continuity test failed for the first time. l Malfunction of TCM
NG
Measure at the TCM connector . Measure at the TCM connector
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (19) and
around. value between (19) and
Less than
OK Replace the
switch assembly.
NG
Measure at the TCM Measure at the TCM connector the harness wire between
TCM and ground.
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
NG
Measure at the TCM connector Check the harness wire between the
and solenoid and pressure switch TCM and solenoid and pressure stitch
sembly connector assembly.
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
l between (19)
and (7).
OK: Less than
NG
Check the harness wire between the
and solenoid and switch EATX and solenoid pressure
sembly connector switch
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (8)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
A 3-4 shift must be in progress, and the UD flag must be set (temperature must not be l Internal transaxle problem
cold). The code sets concurrently with the third consecutive 3-4 shift abort if the
fault counter is greater than three.
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list
51 clutch volume index .
52 2-4 clutch volume index
53 OD clutch volume index
54 UD clutch volume index Refer to INSPECTION MATRIX FOR
l Ignition switch: ON
Selector lever:
transaxle problem) (Refer to
OK: 51 (LR) 35 85
52 (2-4) 20 77
53 (OD) 75 150
54 (UD) 24 70
NG
NG
Check the following co Repair
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE
. .
Code sets if the ratio of the input to the output does not compare to a l Malfunction of input speed’
particular gear ratio. l Malfunction of output speed sensor
A hard fault is considered to exist when the fault counter has matured to a value of l Harness or connector between
An intermittent fault is considered present when the fault counter is greater than or equal sensor and TCM open or
to and less than 255. l Harness or
No fault is considered to exist when the fault counter is less than 6. sensor and TCM or
l of
l Internal transaxle problem
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
NG
Check the installation condition of the input speed sensor Repair
OK
NG
Check the installation Repair
NG
Repair
l
OK
SCAN TOOL Data list l Carry out the inspection procedure for code No. 56.
44 Transaxle input speed
NG
Check the transmission fluid level. Repair
OK
1. NG
SCAN TOOL Data list The 2-4 clutch or clutch may be slipping.
44 Transaxle input speed
l Raise the vehicle’s drive wheels off the ground
l Start the engine and step on the brake so the wheels won’t
rotate. Caution
1. Selector lever: 2 Do not test any gear range for longer than 5 seconds
l the throttle to 30%
l Use the scan tool ‘to monitor the input RPM.
Allow the engne to return to idle. l The reverse clutch or low/reverse clutch may be slipping.
OK: 0 rpm
2. Select lever:
l Open the throttle to 30%
l Use the scan tool to monitor the input RPM.
Allow the enaine to return to idle.
OK: 0 rpm
Transaxle overhaul
l If code No. 50 is set:
Reverse clutch or clutch may be slipping
l If code No. 51 is set:
UD clutch may be slipping
l If code No. 52 is set:
2-4 clutch or UD clutch may be slipping
l If code No. 53 is set:
OD clutch may be slipping
l If code No. 54 is set:
OD clutch may be slipping
OK
NG
Repair
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting.
There is an excessive change in input shaft speed in any gear. l Malfunction of input speed
A hard fault is considered to exist when the fault counter has matured to a value of 255. l Harness or connector between output speed
An intermittent fault is considered present when the fault counter is greater than or equal sensor and open
to 6 and less than 255. l Malfunction of TCM
No fault is considered to exist when the fault counter is less than 6.
NG
SCAN TOOL Data list l Carry out the inspection procedure
45 Transaxle output speed for code No. 57.
l Start the engine
Selector
OK: More than 0
OK
NG NG
Measure at the TCM connector 1 . Measure at the TCM connector Check the harness wire between the
l Disconnect the connector and l Disconnect the connector and TCM and input speed sensor.
measure at the harness side. and then measure at the
l Resistance value between (12) and side.
ground. l Resistance between (12) and
OK: Less than ground.
OK OK: Less than
OK NG
Measure at the TCM connector Check the following Repair
l Disconnect the connector and l
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (12) and
OK
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
There is an excessive change in output shaft speed in any gear. Malfunction of output speed sensor
A hard fault is considered to exist when the fault counter has matured to a value of 255. l Harness or connector output Speed
An intermittent fault is considered present when the fault counter is greater than or equal sensor and TCM open or short-circuited
to 6 and less than 255. l Malfunction of TCM
No fault is considered to exist when the fault counter is less than 6.
NG NG
Measure at the TCM connector Measure at the TCM conenctor Check the harness’ between
l Disconnect the connector and l Disconnect the connector and TCM and input speed
measure at the harness side. and then measure at the
l Resistance value between (54) and harness side.
around. l Resistance value between (54) and
Less than ground.
OK: Less than
OK
OK
Measure at the TCM connector Check the following connector: Repair
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (53) and
(54). Replace the TCM
OK:
NG
Measure at the TCM connector Repair
and output speed sensor connector
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC .
.
No. ground
General scan tool .
,
,
..
After a reset in Neutral and input shaft speed/output shaft speed of input ground open-circuited
gear teeth to output teeth of 2.50.
A hard fault is considered to exist when the fault counter has matured to a value of 255.
An intermittent fault is considered present when the fault counter is greater than or equal
to 6 and less than 255.
No fault is considered to exist when the fault counter is less than 6.
OK NG
Measure at the TCM connector Check the following Repair
l Disconnect the connector and l
measure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between (12) and OK
(53). Replace the
l Resistance value between (53) and
.
(54). .
OK:
Less than
.
The updated learned volume is below a threshold value.
The volumes of the transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously
monitored and learned for adaptive controls. As the friction material wears, the volume Of code. (Internal transaxle problem
fluid needed to apply the element increases. The following are the typical clutch volumes
beyond which the clutches might be damaged:
LR: 35-83 OD: 2-4: UD:
With the clutch engaged, clutch fully on, partial lock failure counter greater l Degraded fluid
than equal to and the turbine acceleration out of range. l Wheels severely out of alignment
Theory of operation: l Internal transaxle problem
While in gear Fully electronically modulated converter clutch (FEMCC) and just before
the clutch engages, the PCM requests the TCM to momentarily establish Partial
electronically modulated converter clutch (PEMCC) operation. If the turbine acceleration is
out of range during the FEMCC to PEMCC transition, a counter is incremented. When the
count is 20 or more, the trouble code is set. This code does not cause the code is set,
FEMCC to PEMCC operation before the A/C clutch engagement will be disabled.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
This code will set when the Transaxle Thermistor Voltage is below volts or above l Malfunction of oil temperature sensor
4.9412 volts for 15 seconds, for 3 consecutive engine starts. l or connector between transaxle range
sensor and TCM open or short-circuited
l Malfunction of TCM
NG
Oil temperature sensor check. Replace
(Refer to
NG NG
Measure at the transaxle range sensor Check Repair
connector A-l 08 .
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side. OK
1. Voltage between (4) and ground.
NG
Check the harness wire between the Repair
transaxle range sensor and the TCM
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>:
NOTE
Code 36 is not stored alone. It is stored if a speed error (code 50 through 58) is detected immediately after a shift. Look
at the possible causes associated with the speed error code.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE Troubleshooting
PROBABLE CAUSE
No. Probable cause .
1 Low fluid level
2 Aerated fluid (High fluid level)
3 Worn or damaged reaction shaft support sealing
4 worn or damaged input shaft sealing
5 Worn pump
6 Damaged or failed underdrive clutch
7 Damaged or failed ovedrive clutch
8 Damaged or failed reverse clutch
9 Damaged or failed 2-4 clutch
10 Damaged or failed low/reverse clutch
11 Damaged clutch seal
12 Worn or damaged accumulator sealing
13 Plugged filter
14 Stuck/sticky valves
15 Solenoid switch valve
16 Lock-up switch valve
17 Torque converter control valve
18 Regulator valve
19 Valve body leakage ,
20 Pressures too high
21 Internal solenoid leak
22 Torque converter clutch failure
23 Faulty cooling system
24 Damaged speed sensor gear teeth
25 Planetary gear sets broken or seized
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
PROBABLE CAUSE
No. Probable cause ,
Engine performance
2 Worn or faulty underdrive clutch ..
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Troubleshooting
Trouble symptom
PROBABLE CAUSE
No. Probable cause
18 Drive shaft(s) bushing(s) worn or damaged
19 Worn or broken reaction shaft support sealing
20 Worn or damaged input shaft sealing
21 Valve body malfunction or leakage
22 Hydraulic pressure too low
23 Hydraulic pressure too high
24 Faulty oil pump
25 Oil filter clogged
26 Low fluid level
27 High fluid level
28 Aerated fluid
29 Engine idle too low
30 Engine idle too high
31 Normal solenoid operation
32 Solenoid sound cover loose
33 Sticking lockup piston
34 Torque converter failure
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Wire end
--
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE Troubleshootina
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
.
to GROU’P 00
TCM RESETTING
(1) Disconnect the negative battery cable from the
before replacing the transaxle out overhaul.
(2) After work has been completed, check
trouble codes (DTC). If DTC 12 (“Battery power was
disconnected since last power has been
generated, this DTC must be cleared.
Furthermore, select “Special function” on the scan tool
and then set the scan tool to Quick Learn mode (carry
out this operation from the scan tool screen). Then input
the clutch volume index into the
PINION FACTOR WRITING PROCEDURE
REPLACEMENT OR TIRE SIZE
NOTE
With transmissions, the TCM uses the rotation speed
of the transaxle output shaft to calculate the vehicle speed
and cumulative distance Because of this, it is
necessary to input (or update) the tire size coefficient into
the TCM memory after the TCM has been replaced or the
tire size has been changed.
(1) Select “Special function” on the scan and then set
the scan tool to Pinion Factor mode (carry out this
operation from the scan tool screen). Then input (or
update) the tire size coefficient the TCM memory.
Note that new do not a tire size
already input.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>: On-vehicle _ _
AUTOMATIC
COMPONENT CHECK
SPEED SENSOR
(1) Disconnect the input speed sensor connector.
(2) Measure the resistance the input speed
side connector terminals 1 and 2.
Standard value:,
(3) If the resistance is outside the standard value, replace
the input speed sensor.
Refer to
OVERDRIVE SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK
Refer to
POSITION SENSOR (TPS) CHECK
Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Inspection of Compo-
nents.
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR CHECK
.
Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Inspection of
nents.
CRANKSHAFT CHECK
Refer to GROUP Troubleshooting.
ABSOLUTE PRESSURE SENSOR
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
SOLENOID CHECK
(1) Disconnect the solenoid and pressure switch assembly
connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the solenoid and
pressure switch assembly side connector terminals 4
and 6.
Standard value: Approx. 1 [at
(3) If the resistance is outside the standard value, replace
the solenoid and pressure switch assembly.
SOLENOID CHECK
(1) Disconnect the solenoid and pressure switch assembly
connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the solenoid and
TSB Revision
.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
OVERDRIVE CLUTCH
Apply air pressure to the overdrive clutch apply passage and
watch for the push/pull piston to move forward. The piston
should return to its starting position when the air pressure
is removed.
REVERSE CLUTCH
Apply air pressure to the reverse clutch apply passage and
watch for the push/pull piston to move rearward. The piston
should return to its starting position when the air pressure
is removed.
CLUTCH
Apply air pressure to the feed hole located on the clutch
retainer. Look in the area where the piston contacts
the first separator plate and watch carefully for the piston
to move rearward. The piston should return to its original
position after the air pressure is removed.
LOW/REVERSE CLUTCH
Apply air pressure to the low/reverse clutch feed hole (rear
of case, between 2 bolt holes). Then, look in the area where
the low/reverse piston contacts the first separator plate and
watch carefully for the piston to move forward. The piston
should return to its original position after the air pressure
is removed.
CLUTCH
Because this clutch piston cannot be seen, its operation is
checked by function. Air pressure is applied to low/reverse
and the clutches. This locks the output shaft. Use a
piece of rubber hose wrapped around the input shaft and
a pair of clamp-on pliers to turn the input shaft. Next apply
air pressure to the underdrive clutch. The input shaft should
not rotate with hand torque. Release the air pressure and
confirm that the input shaft will rotate.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle .
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
On-vehicle Service
TEST FOUR-SELECTOR IN
(1) Attach pressure to tap.,,;
(2) Move selector lever to the position,
(3) Allow vehicle wheels to turn and increase,
to achieve an indicated vehicle speed of
“mph).
(4) The clutch pressure should read 517 to
(75 to 95 psi).
(5) This test checks the clutch hydraulic circuit.
IN
(1) Attach pressure gauge to the torque
off pressure tap.
(2) Move selector lever to the position.’
(3) Allow vehicle wheels to turn and increase
to achieve an indicated vehicle speed of 80 km/h
mph).
CAUTION
must turn at the ‘speed.
(4) Torque converter clutch off pressure should be
35 (5 psi).
(5) This test checks the torque converter clutch
circuit.
.
,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
SECOND 1,000
48 km/h
48 km/h DRIVE
(30
3-14
80 km/h DRIVE
(50 WITH TCC
l : Engine speed at 1,500
CAUTION; Both front wheels must be turning at same speed.
TSB Revision
.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
<Park/Neutral>
REVERSE 24 CLUTCH
CL.
AC
ITCH
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle
<Reverse>
REVERSE
c c
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
Block>
REVERSE BLOCK
REV. W/SPEED OVER MPH -- .
LR REVERSE
I
AC
PT
OFF ON
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service . ,
<First Gear>
FIRST GEAR
LR REVERSE
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
<Second
SECOND GEAR
PT
OFF II n
SOLENOIDS EM
RPM
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
<Direct Gear>
Electronically Modulated Converter Clutch
DIRECT GEAR
EMCC
LR REVERSE 24 CLUTCH
AC
P T
VENT
RESERVOIR
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> On-vehicle Service
<Direct Gear>
Converter Clutch ON
DIRECT GEAR
CC ON
“ 4
LR REVERSE 24 CLUTCH
SW-SWITCH
I P I
PT
AC
02
RESERVOIR
nl
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
<Overdrive>
OVERDRIVE
REVERSE 24 CLUTCH
CL.
OFF ON
SW
,
, .
CHAIN LUBE
0 2
.
,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Service
<Overdrive>
Electronically Modulated Converter Clutch
OVERDRIVE
REVERSE 24 CLUTCH .............
............
AC CL.
P T
AC
.
II II I II I
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE. On-vehicle Service
<Overdrive>
Converter Clutch ON
OVERDRIVE
--
ON
SW
CHAIN LUBE
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE On-vehicle Service
Refer to
Refer to
Refer to ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC 1
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Control
TRANSAXLE CONTROL
4.9 Nm
9.9 N m
8.3
is--
11 Nm
8.3
NOTE
Resin clip position
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE Transaxle Control
NUT INSTALLATION
al control lever (1) Put the selector lever in the “N” position.
(2) Loosen the adjusting nut, gently pull the transaxle control
cable in the direction of the arrow tighten nut.
TSB Revision
,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle Control
(arrow-located places)
11' Nm 22
8.3
Disassembly steps
1. Overdrive switch position indicator 12. Position indicator light assembly
light connector case 13. Sleeve
2. Cover 14. Bolt
3. Selector knob 15. Lever
4. Overdrive switch button 16. Detent, spring’ assembly
5. Overdrive switch 17. B u s h i n g
6. Pin
7. Push button 19. Cotter pin
8. Spring 20. Washer.
9. Indicator panel upper 21. Lock cam
10. Slider 22. Bracket assembly
11. Indicator panel
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE Transaxle Control
OVERDRIVE SWITCH
SWITCH REMOVAL
(1) Use a flat-tip screwdriver to remove the overdrive switch
button.
(2) Remove the overdrive switch mounting screw.
(3) Pressing the switch, remove the overdrive switch.
SELECTOR KNOB
Sleeve
(1) Put the selector lever in the “N” position, turn the sleeve
and adjust the dimension between the sleeve and the
end of the lever so it reaches 16 mm (1.02 in.)
(2) Install the selector knob.
(3) Check that dimension (A) the detent plate
detent pin reaches the standard value.
Standard value (A): 1.7-2.4 in.)
Selector lever Detent pin (4) If outside the standard value, remove the selector knob
and turn the sleeve again to readjust.
TSB Revision
ENGINE
l
l Check the bushing wear
l
Revision ,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Automatic Transaxle Key Interlock
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> and Shift Lock Mechanisms
Caution: SRS
Be careful not to subject the SRS-ECU to any shocks
during removal and installation of the key interlock
cable and shift lock cable.
6 7
5 I
8 ’
NOTE
clipposition 11 Nm
position 8.3
Key interlock cable removal steps Shift lock cable removal steps
1. Plug A 1. Plug A
2. Plug 2. Plug
3. Hood release lever 3. Hood release lever
4. Instrument panel under cover 4. Instrument panel under cover
5. Steering column lower cover 6. Center panel
6. Center panel 7. Cup holder assembly
7. Cup holder assembly 8. Floor console assembly
8. Floor console assembly 9. Console side cover (L.H.)
9. Console side cover (L.H.) 16. Shift lock cable connection
10. Cover 17. Cotter pin
11. Cam and lever 18. Shift lock cable connection
12. Key interlock cable connection 20. Shift lock cable
13. Slide lever
14. Snap pin
15. Key interlock cable connection
19. Key interlock cable
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Key Interlock
ENGINE and
LOCK CABLE L EV E R
INSTALLATION ..
(1) Place the lever in
(2) Fasten the shift lock cable at the end
of the shift lock is-positioned the
INSPECTION
Check the cable assemblies for function and for damage.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> Transaxle Assembly
TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Post-installation Operation
l Transaxle Fluid Draining l Under Cover Installation
(Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance service) (Refer to GROUP Under Cover)
l Battery Removal l Battery Installation
l Under Cover Removal l Transaxle Fluid Supplying
(Refer to GROUP 42 Under Cover) (Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance Service)
l Selector Lever Operation Check
9.2
69 Nm
51
I
74
54
42
51
51
40
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake 10. Solenoid and pressure switch con-
hose assembly nector
2. Air cleaner element 11. Input speed sensor connector
3. Battery tray 12. Transaxle assembly mounting bolts
4. Battery tray stay 13. roll stopper bracket mounting
5. Transaxle control cable connection
6. Oil dipstick and guide assembly 14. Transaxle mounting bracket mount;
7. Starter motor ing nuts
8. Output speed sensor connector 15. Transaxle oil cooler hoses connec-
9. Transaxle range switch connector tion
l Supporting engine assembly
TSB Revision
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
. .
59-71 Nm
--
102
. .
103
76
39 Nm
2 .
..
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>
TORQUE
ASSEMBLY MOUNTING
Transmission
ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
Front roll If the dimension shown in the illustration is outside the standard
stopper value when the weight of the engine is on the body, replace
bracket
the front roll stopper bracket assembly.
ber Standard value (A) mm in.)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> -Transaxle Oil Cooler
and Post-installation
Transaxle Fluid Draining and
(Refer to GROUP 00 Maintenance
3.9 Nm
2.9
Removal steps
1. Air cleaner cover and air intake
hose
2. Hose
3. Pipe assembly
TSB Revision
.
....
GEAR AND TRANSFER DRIVE SPECIAL . ...... ............. . . . . . ...
GEAR SET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ....... . .
DIFFERENTIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Gear Ratio Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GENERAL INFORMATION
Precautions to be taken when disassembling and the
Because the automatic transaxle is composed of component parts high degree of
precision, these parts should be very carefully handled during disassembly and assembly so as not
to scar or scratch them.
A rubber mat should be placed on the workbench, it should kept clean.
During disassembly, cloth gloves or shop towels should not be used. If items must be used,
either use articles made of nylon, or use paper towels.
All disassembled parts must be thoroughly cleaned.
Metal parts may be cleaned with ordinary detergents, but must be thoroughly air dried.
l Clean the clutch disc, resin thrust plate and rubber parts by using transmission fluid),
being very careful that dust, dirt, etc. do not adhere to them.
Do not reuse gaskets, oil seals, or rubber parts.
Replace such parts with new ones at every reassembly. The’ O-ring of the oil level gauge need not
be replaced.
Do not use grease other than petrolatum jelly.
Apply ATF to friction components, rotating parts, and sliding parts before installation.
A new clutch disc should be immersed in ATF for at least two hours before installation.
Do not apply sealer or adhesive to gaskets.
When a bushing be replaced, replace the assembly in which incorporated.
If the transaxle main unit is damaged, also disassemble and clean the cooler system.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Information
Torque
converter
Front
clutch
Rear
clutch
Oil pump
brake
I
Transfer
drive
Transfer
driven gear
Differential
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL General Information
II II
2.551 1.488 1 0 . 6 8 5
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Specifications
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
Snap ring (For stment of front clutch and rear clutch clearance)
Thickness Identification P a r t N o . Thickness Identification .
mm (in.) symbol mm (in.) symbol , ,
1.6 None 2.4 Blue
1.7 Brown 2.5 None
1 . 8 Blue 2.6 Brown
1.9 None 2.7 Blue
2.0 Brown 2.8 None
2.1 Blue 2.9 Brown
2.2 None 3.0 Blue
2.3 Brown
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Specifications
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Items
Bearing retainer bolts 20 15
Converter housing bolts 16
Detent plate mounting bolt 1 1
Differential drive gear bolts 135
Drain 33 24.
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Special Tools ,
SPECIAL TOOLS
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Special Tools ,
Tool numberand
Tool Super-session ,
name
Alignment of oil ‘pump housing and reaction
Guide pin shaft
Use
Spring
compressor
Disassembly clutch
Spring
compressor
of bearing
puller
of
..
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Tools
Tool
of each bearing
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL __
TSB Revision .. .
AUTOMATIC
4 Transaxle
TRANSAXLE
16
18
16
TSB Revision
Pulse generator 54. Idler gear shaft
Spring washer 55. Bearing inner race’
39. Control lever 56. Idler gear
40. Clamp 57. Bearing inner race
41. Park/neutral position switch 58. Spacer
59. Snap ring .
Oil temperature sensor
End clutch cover 60. servo switch
44: O-ring 61. servo piston
45. Bearing 62. Spring
46. End clutch 63. Anchor rod
47. Thrust washer 64. flange
End clutch hub 65. Transfer shaft
Thrust bearing 66. Outer race
50. End clutch shaft 67. Gasket . . ,
51. Bearing retainer 68. O-ring
52. Snap ring 69. Valve body
53. Lock plate
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
6 OVERHAUL Transaxle
2170046
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
(11) With their catches pressed down, force the harness grom-
met and connector into the transaxle case:,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE’
8 OVERHAUL Transaxle
.
thrust washer from the end.
TSB Revision
end
, , .
, ,
14
the housing and
the six
arrows. ,
the special the bolt
,
the oil’
remove the gasket.
,
, .
the the
case.
.. .
..
.
.
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL Transaxle
.
fiber thrust washer
. .
. .
..
,
,,
. , ,
,
,
race and t h r u s t
,
.
..
, ,
,
--
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL Transaxle , .
the drum.
(29) Remove
,
,
,
.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL ,
,
the idler shaft lock plate.
.
the transfer idler shaft with the
..
..
transfer idler
gear and the two bearing inner races inside the;
case.
.
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE
AUL Transaxle
the spacer.
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
I
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
REASSEMBLY
(1) Before reassembling the transaxle, measure the end play
in the low-reverse brake and select to
obtain the specified end play. Use procedure.
(a) Install the brake reaction plate,
disc in the transaxle. case.
Caution ,
Blow off automatic transmission fluid from the
plates and discs with low-pressure compressed
air.
(b) Install the appropriate pressure and the
Oil pump side
return spring.
Pressure
spring
i .
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL
3
Idler
shaft
hole
Brake
reaction
plate
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
(9) Measure the end play while sliding the transfer shaft ‘in-
and out, and select a spacer. to obtain the specified end
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
Torque converter side outer race and inner races in the transfer
Groove
idler gear.
,
Inner race
Outer race
ransfer idler gear
TSB Revision
OVERHAUL .
the
shaft plate.
and the lock plate should closed iri the
will prevent idler ‘shaft then tighten the
lock plate bolt to the
Tightening torque:
. , ,
, .
.
....
the bearing
the screw to specified torque.
Caution ,
The screw not
Tightening torque;
.
... . ,
,
__
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle ,
thrust race
sun gear. Then, assemble, sun gear.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
I 55.7 (2.193)
I I 38.7 1.6
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision . I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
..
clutch hub, engaging it with sun gear
splines. ,
, ..
,
.
.. ..
petrotatum jelly
it to the clutch hub.
Revision
to thrust washer and thrust bear-
‘: ing. and attach the bearing to the
assembly.
. .
.
,
,
,.. ..
.
.
....
race rear
face of the oil
.
,
,
. .
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL
, ,
end play of the input shaft. If the measure-
ment is out of the standard value, replace thrust race
and thrust washer to meet the standard value.
Standard value: mm in.)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL ..
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
.. . ,
TSB Revision 1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL . .
..
TSB Revision
,
body in
plate pin
the valve,
..
, ..
five the five. depressions
the oil pan.
sure to remove metal from the
. clean the inside the oil pan
TSB Revision ,
AUTOMATIC
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
control lever
I I III
11 Transaxle control
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
pulse
to the. specified torque.
Tightening torque: 11 Nm (8
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
INSPECTION
,
Pulse generator connector PULSE
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 or
3 and 4.
Standard value: 245 at
(2) A too small resistance indicates a short and a
too large resistance indicates an open circuit.
Pulse generator “A” In either case, replace the ‘pulse generator assembly.
3-4: Pulse generator
21750010
SOLENOID VALVES
(1) Measure the resistance the terminals
1: Pressure control ,
solenoid valve body of each solenoid valve.
2: Torque converter Stgndard value: at
clutch solenoid
3: Shift control solenoid Pressure control solenoid valve:
valve “A”
4: Shift control solenoid Shift control solenoid- Approx.
valve Torque converter clutch solenoid: 13
(2) A too small or large resistance indicates, a’ or open
circuit.
In either case, replace the assembly.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC .
OVERHAUL
.
OIL PUMP
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
.
2 Nm
.
. ,
Disassembly steps
1. O-ring
2. Reaction shaft support
3. Steel ball
4. Drive gear
5. Driven gear
6. Seal ring
7. Oil seal
6. Oil pump housing
9. Snap ring
10. Oil seal
Revision
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL , ,
STEEL BALL,
O-RING INSTALLATION
Install a new O-ring in the groove of the pump housing and
apply jelly to the O-ring.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Front Clutch
FRONT CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
.
,
,
__
Disassembly steps
Snap ring
2. Clutch reaction plate
3. Clutch disc
4. Snap ring
5. Return spring
6. Front clutch piston
7. D-ring
6. D-ring
9. Front clutch retainer
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Front Clutch . .
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
SNAP RING
(1) Compress the return spring with special tool. .
(2) Remove the snap ring.
21750264
750264
Plate Plate Plate (2) Install the innermost the reaction plate with their shear
Shear droops directed as shown in the illustration.
droop
Identification of reaction plate
mm (in.)
Plate No. Thickness Identification mark
1 5.0 A
2 3.1
3.1 I
3.7 I
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Front Clutch
RING SELECTION
Check clearance snap ring and
plate. To of
the clutch reaction plate down with (11 Ibs.). force.
If clearance is out of standard value, select a snap ring to
obtain the standard value.
Standard value: mm in.)
NOTE
To install the return spring snap rings, set the rings with their
end gaps
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Rear Clutch
.
REAR CLUTCH .
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
__ 13 9 8
Disassembly steps
1. Seal ring 10. Clutch plate
11. Clutch pressure plate
12. Wave spring
Snap ring 13. Return spring
5. Thrust race 14. Rear clutch piston
6. Seal ring 15. Rear clutch retainer
7. Snap ring 16. D-ring
8. Clutch reaction plate 17. D-ring
9. Clutch disc
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
Rear
DISASSEMBLY
WAVE
(1) Compress the return. spring with
(2) Using a screwdriver, remove
,
,
,
,
I’
750274 ,
Clutch disc (2) Install the clutch reaction plate with its shear droop directed
Shear droop , I as shown in the illustration.
reaction
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL End Clutch
END CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. Seal ring 8. Return Spring
2. Snap ring 9. End clutch piston
3. Clutch reaction plate 10. Oil seal
4. Clutch disc 11. D-ring
5. Clutch plate 12. End clutch retainer
13. Oil seal
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL End Clutch
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Planetary ‘Gear
PLANETARY GEAR
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
29
Disassembly steps
1. Bolt Front thrust washer ,
2. Lock plate Spacer bushing
3. One-way clutch outer race
4. End plate
5. One-way clutch 12. Thrust bearing .
6. End plate 13. Planet carrier
7. Pinion shaft
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Planetary Gear
(3) Line up the holes of the rear thrust washer and front
thrust washer “A” with the shaft the carrier.
(4) Install the short pinion, spacer bushing thrust
washer and align the holes. Use care not to the
rollers to get out of position.
washer
Rear thrust washer
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
,
BOLT INSTALLATION
NOTE
Do not reuse the pre-coated
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Gear
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring 5. Snap ring
2. Bearing 6. Output flange
3. Transfer drive gear 7. gear
4. Bearing
TSB Revision ..
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Gear and Drive Gear Set
, .
TRANSFER
Install the transfer drive gear in, proper
can be identified by the groove provided in the
side surfaces.
Caution
Replace the output flange and transfer drive gear as
set.
INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Differential .
DIFFERENTIAL
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
135 Nm
Disassembly steps
1. Bolt 6. Pinion
2. Differential drive gear 7.
3. Taper roller bearing 6. Side gear
4. Lock pin 9. Spacer
5. Pinion shaft 10. Differential case
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
TAPER ROLLER,
Differential case
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Differential
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Brake
LOW-REVERSE BRAKE ,
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY ... . .
Disassembly steps
1. Low-reverse brake piston
2. D-ring
3. D-ring
4. Center support
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Servo
SERVO
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY 3
Disassembly steps
1. O-ring
2. servo sleeve
3. D-ring
4. Seal ring
5. Lock nut
6. servo rod
7. piston
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE’
OVERHAUL Gear
SPEEDOMETER GEAR
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
driven gear
Sleeve
REASSEMBLY SERVICE ,
(A,
Apply gear oil sparingly to shaft
and insert the shaft.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Drive Shaft
Disassembly steps
1. Converter housing
2. Transaxle case
3. Oil seal
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE
AUL
TRANSFER SHAFT ,
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. Bearing
2. Transfer shaft
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
BEARING REMOVAL
,
,
REASSEMBLY SERVICE .
BEARING INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transfer Driven Gear
Disassembly steps
1. Bearing
2. Transfer driven gear
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
VALVE BODY
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Viewed A
. .
Disassembly steps
1. Manual valve Jet
2. Pressure control solenoid valve Relief spring
3. Shift control solenoid valve “A” 15. ball
4. Shift control 16. Oil filter.
converter clutch 17. Upper valve body sub assembly
18. Steel ball
Valve stopper 19. Teflon
8. N-D control sleeve 20. N/D plate
9. N-D control valve 21.
10. Lower valve body sub assembly 22. Upper plate
11. Lower separating plate 23. Dowel bushing
12. Nut 24. Intermediate plate
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Valve Body
Viewed from
5 Nm
, 4
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Body
TSB Revision
AUTO TRANSAXLE
OVER
2 1 7 5 0 3 3 3
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Valve Body .
(3) Secure the lower valve body with the bolts. Then,
the special tools.
TSB Revision
NOTES
.
GEAR AND TRANSFER DRIVE .......................... 6
GEAR SET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gear Ratio Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
CENTER DIFFERENTIAL . . . . . . . 103 Pressure Plates, Snap Rings and
Spacers for Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
DIFFERENTIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Sealants and Adhesives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Service Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
END CLUTCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Torque Specifications
EXTENSION HOUSING . . . . . . . . . 118 Transaxle Model Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Valve Body Spring Identification Chart . . . . . . . . . 7
FRONT CLUTCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
SPEEDOMETER GEAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
FRONT OUTPUT SHAFT ......
TRANSAXLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
TRANSAXLE ...................
SERVO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
TRANSFER ...................
LOW-REVERSE BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRANSFER CASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
OIL PUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
TRANSFER CASE ADAPTER ..
PLANETARY GEAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
TRANSFER SHAFT .............
REAR CLUTCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
VALVE BODY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL General
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL General
SECTIONAL VIEW
Kick-
Torque converter do\
clutch Oil pump bra
Transfer
drive gear
End
Differential
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL General Information
SECTIONAL VIEW
Planetary Transfer
Torque converter Oil pump gear idler gear
Torque
Transfer
coupling differential
Front
snaft
.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL
TSB
TRANSAXLE
3 4 1.17-1.24
,
32 . . .
4 8 1.32 72 .
.
81
TSB
Spacer (For adjustment of drive bevel gear mount)
Thickness Identification Part No. Thickness
mm (in.) symbol mm (in.) symbol
1.34 34 1.52 52
1.37 37 1.55 55
1.40 40 1.58 58
1.43 43 1.61 61
1.46 46 1.64 64
1.49 49 1.67 67
1.52
1.55 52
55 1.91
1.94 91
94
TSB Revision 1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Specifications
Items
Valve body bolt 5 4
Center bearing retainer stopper bolt 5 4
Center differential drive gear bolt 75 54
Front bearing retainer bolt 49 35
TRANSFER
Items Nm
__
Cover mounting bolt 5 4::
Driven bevel gear lock nut 150
Extension housing mounting bolt 19 1’4
Oil drain plug 33
Oil filler plug 33 , .
Transfer case adapter mounting bolt 39 4 ,
Transfer cover mounting bolt 39 28
TSB Revision
,
__
__
TSB Revision
Oil seal installer
TSB Revision
,
. .
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Special Tools
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
23300100110
TRANSAXLE
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
7 8
during reassembly.
15
14
1. converter 16. Snap ring
assembly 17. Center support
18. Wave spring
Thrust washer 19. Return spring
5. Front clutch assembly 20. Pressure plate
6. Thrust race 21. Brake
7. Thrust bearing 22. Brake plate
8. Thrust washer 23. Reaction ‘plate
9. Rear clutch assembly 24. gear
10. Thrust bearing 25. Thrust bearing
11. Rear clutch hub 26, race
12. Thrust bearing 27. sun
13. Thrust race 28. Planetary
14. band 29. Thrust bearing
15. drum 30. Output
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
32
16
11
70 18
Nm
I I 8
49
38
I 72
59
9 60
7
24
66
70 Nm
51
.....
8 5
11
I 8
42
. .
. . .
(5) Remove the pulse
...
. ... a-
. .
(7) Remove the oil pan, magnets and
,
, ,
.
.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL ,
I- *
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
the spacer.
.
,
thrust washer .
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
thrust bearing
thrust bearing
the drum.
TSB Revision
the .
. .
, ,
, , ,
t h e
TSB
-Transaxle
TSB Revision
the wave spring, return spring, reaction
brake discs, and brake plates.
TSB Revision
-Transaxle
REASSEMBLY
(1) Using the special tool, install the oil seals to the differential
Differential bearing retainer and transaxle case.
bearing
retainer
(2) Use the special tool to press fit the into the’
transaxle case.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
O VER H AUL -Transaxle
(5) Install the output bearing retainer ‘and tighten the bolts
to the specified torque.
Output bearing, retainer mounting ,
24 Nm (18 .
(6) Loosen the bolts and remove the output bearing
68
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
a coating of to bearing
Thrust bearing attach to the planetary carrier.
race
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
the band.
Caution
Install so the arrow mark is facing forward.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle .
race
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
.
,
Revision
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL
I-
..
. ..
the idler cover new
Idler gear cover’ (8
.
,
..
the clutch shaft ‘from
spline.
-- ...
I.
,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
a new to the
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
assembly.
with a length mm
in.) and diameter of 1.6 mm in.) on the
rear bearing retainer at the position shown the diagram
and install the outer race.
the of the
and adjust by selecting a
that will provide the value and
preload. .
Standard value:
, ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
.
the servo by
Fit the claw of the the
piston to prevent. the from use
adapter to secure it at
Caution
1. Do not push with
2. When the
case, do not
, en by hand. .
TSB Revision
-Transaxle
22200100127
COMPONENTS
Lubricate all internal
parts with automatic
I transmission fluid
during reassembly.
8. Thrust bearing
7. washer 22.
23. Brake
Reaction plate:, .
9. Rear clutch assembly 24. Reverse sun gear
10. Thrust bearing 25. Thrust bearing
11. Rear clutch hub 26. Thrust race
12. Thrust bearing 27. sun
13. Thrust race 28. carrier.
14. band 29. Thrust bearing ,
15. drum 30. Output flange..
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
32 18
38
78
Nm
9 Nm
7
41
24 Nm
46
11 Nm --
8
I
42 during reassembly.
TSB Revision
A U T O M A T I C T R A N S A X L E
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
DISASSEMBLY
(1) Clean away any sand, mud,. etc. adhered the
transaxle.
(2) Place the transaxle assembly on the workbench with the
oil pan down.
(3) Remove the torque converter.
(4) Use the special tool to mount the dial gauge on trans-
axle case and the” play the .-
,
.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC .
OVERHAUL
the cover
the differential
differential ,
a
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
the thrust
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
the spacer.
thrust washer
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
thrust bearing
Thrust bearina
thrust bearing
the drum.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
O VERHAUL
the band.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
the assembly.
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
__
49
Revision
OVERHAUL , , . . ,
special tool,
, ,
front
I
REASSEMBLY
(1) Using the special tool, install the oil differential
bearing retainer and transaxle ‘case.
59
I I I
TSB Revision ,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
(3) Using the special tool, press-fit the outer race in the trans-
axle case.
(6) Install the front bearing retainer and tighten the bolt to
the specified torque.
Front bearing retainer mounting bolts:.
49 Nm (35
(7) Loosen the bolts and remove the front bearing retainer.
(8) Remove the outer race from the front bearing
and remove the solder. If the solder does not break, per-
form the work in steps 5-8 with large solder.
Measure the thickness of the crushed solder a ‘mi-
crometer and select a spacer with the correct thickness.
so the preload reaches the standard value.
Standard value:
mm
(9) Install the spacer selected in the previous step and the
outer race in the front bearing retainer.
(lO)First install the front bearing retainer and apply sealant
to the bolts and then tighten to the specified torque.
Specified sealant:
Stud Locking Part No. 4170 or
Front bearing retainer mounting bolts:
49 Nm (35
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
167
I
the outer race from the bearing ‘retainer
and remove the solder. If the solder is repeat
steps using with of 3 mm
in.) ,
Measure the thickness of the crushed ‘with a
micrometer and select a spacer with’ thickness that
will provide the standard. value for ...
Standard value:
‘168
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL ,
..
the
,
retainer (15
_, , i i -
,
I..
,
. ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
2.2
2.4
48.1 (1.906) 34.4 (1.354)
42.6 (1.677) 28.0 (1.102)
.
54.0 (2.126) 38.7 (1.524) 1.6
52.0 (2.047) 36.4 (1.433) 0
45.0 (1.772) 28.0 (1
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
the band.
Caution
Install so the arrow mark facing forward.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
TSB Revision
A U T O M A T I C T R A N S A X L E
OVERHAUL Transaxle
..
__
..
I .
.
. .
.
thrust race and thrust washer
of the oil pump with petrolatum.
.
,
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
...
the spacer, idler and then insert
the idler shaft.
Caution
Assemble so that the groove ‘on
idler gear faces backward.
,
the end clutch shaft from the end with the long
. ,
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL Transaxle
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
the detent ..
Detent plate mounting bolt: 11 Nm (8
Detent plate
evision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
O V E R H AU L .
oil screen.
Oil filter mounting, 8
, ,,
the switch
manual control lever.
Park/neutral position switch, mounting bolts:
Nm (8
Manual control lever 19
the speedometer gear
Speedometer gear
N m ( 4
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
(c) Fit the special tool (outer) to lock nut.‘ Turn the
outer cylinder and the inner
clockwise to lock the lock nut and, the tool
(inner).
..
. .
, ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL -Transaxle
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Oil pump
OIL PUMP
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Lubricate all internal
parts with automatic
transmission fluid 2 N m
during reassembly. 8
I I
- 3
Disassembly steps
1. O-ring 6. Seal ring
2. Reaction shaft support 7. Oil seal
3. Steel ball 8. pump housing
4. Drive gear 9. Snap ring
5. Driven gear 10. Oil seal
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
O-RING
(1) Install a new O-ring the the pump housing
and apply petrolatum jelly to the
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Front
,
FRONT CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
8
7 I
2 6
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring 7. Return spring
2.3.Clutch
Clutchreaction
disc plate 9.
8. Front clutch piston
4. Clutch plate 10. D-ring D-ring
5. Clutch pressure plate 11. Front clutch retainer
8. Snap ring
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC “TRANSAXLE .
SNAP
Compress the return spring with the tool.
(2) Remove the snap ring.
P L A T E
Install the clutch plate with their portions
(A in the illustration) in alignment.
NOTE
This design helps automatic transmission fluid escape
and improve the cooling efficiency of the plate and disc.
Plate No. 4 Plate No. 2 (2) Install the innermost plate droops directed
as shown in the
SNAP RING
Check clearance between the ring and reac-
tion plate. To check the clearance, inside diam-
eter of the clutch reaction plate ‘50 tbs.)
force. If clearance is out of standard a snap
ring to obtain the standard value;,
Standard value:
NOTE
Position the gap of the snap ring approx. away
from that of the return spring mounting snap ring.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Rear
. . . . .
DISASSEMBLY AND
.
Disassembly steps
1. Seal ring 10. Clutch
2. input shaft Clutch.
3. 12.
4. Snap ring 13. Snap
5. Thrust race 14.
6. Seal ring 15. piston
7. Snap ring 16.
8. Clutch plate 1 7 .
disc
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
Rear
(2) Install the clutch reaction plate with its shear droop directed
as shown in the illustration.
Clutch discs
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Rear
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
End Clutch
END CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
11
-8
Disassembly steps
1. Seal ring 8. Return Spring
2. Snap ring 9. End clutch
3. Clutch reaction plate 10. Oil seal
4. Clutch disc 11. D-ring
5. Clutch plate 12. End clutch retainer
13. Oil seal
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
End
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
, ,
(1) Remove the piston. If it hard to remove,’ the
retainer on the workbench with piston side down and
blow air through the oil passage in the back of retainer.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
PLANETARY ‘GEAR
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps . .
1. Thrust bearing
2. Rivet
3. Wave washer End
4. One way clutch outer race Planetary carrier
POINTS’
BEARING
(1) the only one short not
and lose the 17 rollers in the not
the other short pinions.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Planetary Gear
RIVET REMOVAL
(1) Shift the stopper plate to ensure that the rivet head does
not hit it.
NOTE
Make sure that the stopper plate claw is not at
the groove in the one-way clutch outer race.
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
BEARING
(1) Install a new thrust bearing car&r.. sure
that it fits correctly in the spot faced carrier.
.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE ,
washer
Rear thrust
I
(5) Insert the pinion shaft. Make sure that the flattened end
of pinion shaft is correctly fitted in the hole of the rear
thrust plate when the pinion shafts is inserted.
Notch
Arrow
RIVET INSTALLATION
(1) Stake the rivet using a punch and press.
NOTE
(1) Use a punch with a tip angle.
(2) Stake the rivet with a load of 11
Ibs.).
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Gear and Transfer Drive Gear Set
.
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring 5. drive
2. Stopper plate 6. Snap ring
3. Bearing 7. Output flange
4. Bearing 8. gear
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
and Drive Gear Set
(2) Using the special tool, install the transfer drive gear to
the output flange.
2
SNAP SELECTION
(1) Measure the snap ring groove ‘clearance and select the
appropriate spacer to obtain the end
Standard value: m m in.)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Differential
DIFFERENTIAL 23300310063
Disassembly steps
1. Bolt Pinion
2. Differential drive gear 8. Washer
3. Ball bearing 9. Side gear
4. Taper roller bearing 10. Spacer
5. Lock pin 11. Differential case
6. Pinion shaft
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
ROLLER BEARING’
(1) Using the special tool, remove the taper roller bearing.
PIN REMOVAL
(1) Using a pin punch, drive out the lock pin.
. .
The lock pin may be removed with bunch.
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
SPACER
PINION INSTALLATION
(1) Fit the spacer to the back face of gear, then
install the gear into the differential case.
(2) Fit a washer to back of the pinion two pinions
at the same time into position to gear.’
..
.
the pinion’shaft.
.
(4) Measure the backlash between the side gear and pinion.
Standard
mm in.)
(5) If the backlash is out of specification, select the appropriate
spacer and disassemble and reassemble the gears as
necessary.
NOTE
Adjust so that the backlash in both side gears equals.
TSB
AUTOMATIC
-Differential
BEARING INSTALLATION
BOLTS INSTALLATION
(1) Apply ATF to the differential gear bolts;
tighten to the specified the shown order.
Differential drive gear bolt: 135 (98
2160030
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
‘I
SERVO
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY .. ..
Disassembly steps
1. O-ring
2. servo sleeve
3. D-ring
4. Seal ring
5. Lock nut
6. servo rod
7. servo piston
Revision ,
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Low-reverse Brake
LOW-REVERSE BRAKE
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. Low-reverse brake piston
2. D-ring
3. D-ring
4. Center support
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE.
SPEEDOMETER GEAR
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. E-clip
driven gear
Sleeve
I.
. .
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Transfer Shaft
TRANSFER SHAFT
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing
2. Transfer shaft
3. Taper roller bearing
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Transfer
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
,
..
INSTALLATION
I I
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Valve Body
.
B O D Y 29999999999
18
15
14
16
5 Nm
4
Disassembly steps
1. Manual valve 13. Jet
2. Pressure control solenoid valve 14. Relief spring
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid 15. Steel ball
4. control valve 16. Oil filter
control valve 17. Upper valve body sub assembly
18. Steel ball
Valve stopper 19. Teflon ball
8. N-D control sleeve
9. N-D control valve
10. Lower valve body sub assembly Upper separating plate
11. Lower separating plate 23. Dowel bushing
12. Nut 24. Intermediate plate
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
47
Viewed from
I
5 Nm
4
4 2
5 Nm
4
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Body
62
69
Disassembly steps
48. Pin 56. Torque converter clutch control
49. Stopper spring
50. End clutch plug 57. N-R control valve
51. End clutch spring 58. N-R control spring
52. End clutch valve 59. Adjusting’ screw
53. End cover 60. Reducing spring
54. converter clutch control 61. Reducing valve
62. Lower valve body
55. Torque converter clutch control
valve
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
‘Id
0
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Valve Body
(3) Secure the lower valve body with mounting bolts and
then remove the special tool.
SOLENOID VALVE
(1) Install the solenoid valves as shown.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
CENTER DIFFERENTIAL
. ,
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
5
74 Nm
54 I
__
Disassembly
1. Transfer driven gear
2. Taper roller bearing
3. Taper roller bearing 10. Washer
4. Bolt 11. Side gear
5. Center differential flange 12. Clip
6. Spacer 13. Spacer
7. Side gear (front) . Center
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
. .
Using the
from the transfer gear.
BEARING REMOVAL
‘the special tool, remove the taper roller bearing
from the center differential flange.
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
SPACERS SELECTION
(1) install the spacer, side gear
pinion shaft in the center differential case.
(2) While pressing the pinion shaft, select the thickest
to gently rotate the pinion.
(3) Install the side gear (front), spacer and center differential
flange and tighten the bolts to torque.
Center differential
(4) Using the front output side
and select the thickest , gently! rotate side
gear front.
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Cent&
..
(1) Using the special
the center flarige.
INSTALLATION
(1) Using the special the taper roller bearing on
the transfer driven gear.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Front Output Shaft ,
Disassembly steps
1. Taper roller bearing
2. Taper roller bearing
3. Front output shaft
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Transfer
TRANSFER 23300670017
DISASSEMBLY AND
39
Lubricate all
internal parts
with gear oil
during reassembly.
Disassemblv .
1. Cover 6. ,
2. Cover gasket
3. Extension housing assembly case sub
4. Oil guide
5. Transfer case sub assembly
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Transfer .
INSTALLATION,
( I) Install the spacer that has
CASE SUB’
INSTALLATION
(1) With the matching marks in alignment, the transfer
case adapter sub assembly to the sub as-
sembly.
(3) Using the special tool, turn the drive bevel gear shaft
(one turn in normal direction, one turn in reverse direction).
NOTE
Do not give the drive bevel gear shaft more than one
turn in either direction as this causes unclear
p a t t e r n .
Matching mark
(4) Align driven bevel gear and transfer
mark
marks.
.
,
TSB Revision
Check the ‘bevel gear tooth is
page
.
.
--
Mitsubishi ,
or equivalent
NOTE
Squeeze out sealant from the tube uniformly and
ously in adequante
TO .
‘Specified
ATD Part No. 8660 or,
0
0
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Transfer
TOOTH CONTACT
1. Standard tooth contact ‘pattern
A Small end side
Drive side tooth face ,
(Side on which force acts running forward)’
Big end side
Coast side tooth face
(Side on which
,
I
Remedy
Use thicker gear mount to separate,
the driven bevel gear more drive. bevel gear.
, .
3. Tooth produced
gear height is too small
Cause
The driven bevel gear is too from the drive,
bevel gear.
.. .
Remedy
Use thinner driven bevel gear mount adjusting spacer
to bring the driven bevel gear more closer to the drive
bevel gear.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Transfer
.
(1) If correct tooth contact cannot be obtained by
Drive bevel gear
mount adjusting change of the driven gear
Drive bevel gear
spacer preload adjusting spacer, increase or decrease the drive bevel gear
.
spacer preload adjusting spacer and-the drive bevel gear
mount adjusting spacer as described below and then
adjust tooth contact again.
l When the driven bevel, gear height is too small even
if the thinnest driven bevel gear mount adjusting
spacer 0.13 mm is used:
Driven beve Replace the drive bevel gear mount adjusting spacer
that is in use with one that is one rank thicker and
replace the drive bevel preload adjusting spacer that
is in use with one that is one rank thinner.
l When the driven bevel gear height is too large even
if the thickest driven bevel gear mount adjusting
spacer 0.52 in.) is used:
Driven beve
gear preloac Replace the drive bevel gear mount adjusting spacer
adjusting
spacer that is in use with one that is one rank thinner and
replace the drive bevel gear preload adjusting spacer
that is in use with one that is one rank thicker.
Repeat above steps until the tooth contact pattern
equal or close to the standard pattern is obtained.
(2) If the tooth contact pattern cannot be adjusted close
to the standard by above adjustment, replace
the drive bevel gear driven bevel gear as a set
and readjust the tooth’ contact. ,....
I .
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Transfer
internal
9 gear oil
7 8 during
Disassembly steps
1. Lock nut 6. Outer race
2. Driven bevel gear 7. Outer race
3. Taper roller bearing 8. Transfer case adapter
Taper roller bearing
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
-Transfer Case Adapter
Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Transfer Case Adapter
SPACER SELECTION
(1) Use the existing spacer to assemble “the transfer case
adapter.
(2) Using the special tool, check that gear rotating
drive torque is within standard range.
Standard value: Nm
(3) If the rotating drive torque is outside standard range,
adjust using adjusting spacers.
..
LOCK NUT
(1) Holding the driven bevel gear in a workbench and using ,
the special tool, tighten the lock nut specified torque.
Driven bevel gear lock nut: 150 Nm (108
TSB Revision
.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
TRANSFER CASE
DISASSEMBLY AND
39 Nm
2 9
Disassembly steps
1. Transfer cover
2. O-ring
3. Spacer
4. race
5. Drive bevel gear shaft 11. roller
6. Outer race 12.
. .
TSB
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Case
1 II I
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
ROLLER BEARING INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Transfer Case
SEAL
SPACER SELECTION
(1) Use the existing spacer to assemble the transfer case.
(2) Using the special tool, check that the bevel gear rotating
drive torque is within standard range.
Standard value: 1.7-2.5 Nm (1.23-1.81
(3) If the rotating drive torque is outside of the standard range,
adjust using adjusting spacers.
NOTE
For adjustment, use two spacers of is
as close as possible to each other.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Extension Housing
23300760011
Disassembly steps
1. Air breather
2. Dust seal guard
3. Oil seal
4. Extension housing
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE
OVERHAUL
CONTENTS
DIFFERENTIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
General Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
GENERAL INFORMATION ................. 2 .................................... 5
GENERAL INFORMATION
The four-speed FWD transaxle uses fully-adaptive Adaptive are those which
perform their functions based on real-time feedback sensor The t&axle uses hydraulically
applied clutches to shift a planetary gear train.
SECTIONAL VIEW
Case clutch
Reverse
sensor
Torque converter
clutch ,
Output
speed
sensor
gear set
gear
shaft
gear
Differential
Revision
AUTOMATIC ‘TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
. .
HYDRAULIC CONTROL SYSTEM
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
. .
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Items , Specifications
Model .
.
Applicable engine
four-speed automatic
Torque converter with converter
. .
2 . 8 4
1 . 5 7
Gear ratio 1
0 . 6 9
Reverse 2.21
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
pump gear
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Nm
Pump bolts 22 16
SEALANTS 22210056010
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Specifications .
THRUST PLATE, THRUST WASHER, REACTION PLATE,”
ADJUSTMENT
Thrust washer (For adjustment of differential side gear end play)
Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.) Thickness (in.)
0.81 0.93 1.07 1 . 1 9
Shim (For adjustment of output gear bearing preload, transfer shaft bearing end play)
Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.)”
3.22 3.46 3.70
3.26 3.50 3.74 3.98
3.30 3.54 3.78 4 . 0 2
3.34 3.58 3.82 4.06
3.38 3.62 3.86 4.10
3.42 3.66 3.90 4.14
Shim (For adjustment of output gear bearing preload, transfer shaft bearing end play)
Also used as “test” shim. (Output gear)
‘2: Also used as “test” shim. (Transfer shaft)
Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.) Thickness mm (in.)
4.18 4.34 4.50 4.66
4.22 4.38 4.54
4.26 4.42 4.58
4.30 4.46 4.62
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
SPECIAL TOOLS
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Special
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
overdrive clutch.
TSB Revision
gear remover
, ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Took
Tool
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL’ Special
Tool
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
DISASSEMBLY
Caution
Do not intermix clutch discs or plates, or might
fall.
TSB Revision I
(6) Remove valve body.
Seal ring
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
adjustable
.
TSB Revision
the weights of the pullers against the
of the tools to loosen the pump. on input
while loosening pump.
,
.
oil pump.
,
,
,
TSB Revision
cooler
washer
clutch retainer.
clutch spring.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
clutch pack.
NOTE
Tag clutch pack for reassembly identification.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
low/reverse clutch pack. ,
NOTE
Tag low/reverse clutch pack for identification.
rear bolts.
rear cover.
Transfer shaft
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL”-’ Transaxle
gear carrier bearing with-, Rearing
and Button
and
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
out park rod bracket anchor shaft with
hammer and drift.
Drift
Park rod
bracket anchor
shaft
,
-r at c h et
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERRAUL
, , ,
Split sleeve
spring .
I
Stepped
spacer Spacer
Lip seal
Low/reverse , , Screwdriver
screws low/reverse
piston retainer.
retainer
screws
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Remover 1.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
. . .
REASSEMBLY
(1) Install both output bearing Bearing
and wrenches.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Guide bracket
l Guide bracket (disassembled)
I
Split sleeve
ide
bracket anchor
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL .
I
a 4.50 mm in.) “test” shim on the rear carrier
assembly hub, using grease to hold the shim in place.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
0.38 4.10
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL --Transaxle
mm in. mm in..:
,
0.84 3.62
0.86 3.62
3.58
0.91 . 3.54
0.94 3.54 ..
0.97 3.50
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE , ,
_ _. .
.
. .
gear bolt and coned
. .
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
output bolt to 271 Nm (200
holding output gear with ,
Caution
Always use new must
not be reused.
4
New bearing
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Output gear
Transfer shaft
Transfer
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Gauging shim
Wr
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL,
TRANSFER BEARING
0.28
0.30 4.38
0.33 I ,
0.36 4.34
0.38 I
0.41 . .
0.43 4.26
0.46 4.22
0.48 4.22 ,
A I
0.53 4.18
0.58 4.14
0.58 '4.10
0.81 .
0.64
I
0.71 3.98
0.74 -3.94
3.94
3.79 , I I
3.81 .
3.84 3.86 .
I
3.91 3.78
3.94 3.74 ..
3.97 3.74
3.99 3.70
1.02 3.66
1.04 3.66
1.07 3.62
1.08 3.62
1.12 3.58
,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC
End play
installed .
m m -
, ,
1 . 1 7
1.19 3.50
1.22 3.46
1.24 3.46..
1.27
1.30
3.38
tranbfer
and two wrenches
. ,
‘ I
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
,
, .
.
.
. .
a screwdriver, install low/reverse reaction plate flat
snap ring. .
, ,
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
Ho
..
NOTE
View from bell-housing l Do not reuse the old snap. ring.
Snap ring end l When installing a new position the snap
ring ends as shown.
l Follow A sequence for best results.
Sequence
A thru Install
clutch pack.
clutch retainer.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
Spring Compressor
Using a screwdriver, install the retainer snap
ring.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Transaxle
Front sun
assembly
shaft
determine the proper thickness thrust
plate, select the thinnest No. 4 “test” thrust plate; Using,
to hold thrust in position,, install input
clutches assembly. Be sure the ‘input assembly
is completely seated.
Caution
if view through input speed sensor hole is not as
shown above, the input assembly is not
seated
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
shaft end play must be 0.13 to 0.64
to inch). Subtract end play from end
play
. readings. Add the result to “test” shim to select proper
No. 4 thrust.
.
Input input clutches assembly. ,
clutches
washer
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC .
cooler .
‘Caution
cooler must If
has
clean old When
end toward rear
oil
Caution
Be sure oil pump Is
attaching
r e t u r n
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
the snap the low/reverse
plug (cover) in place.
detent as shown.
valve body.
TSB Revision
oil filter. .
oil pan.
NOTE
Apply a inch wide bead of 8718
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Input Clutches
Reverse clutch
(3) Loosen reverse clutch reaction plate by prying at
Screwdriver
locations with screwdrivers as shown.
clutch
(4) Remove reverse clutch reaction plate.
plate
flat side ,
Reverse
(5) Remove clutch plates and discs.
clutch Tie plates and discs together so they go back in ‘the
plate same location.
19
TSB Revision
(7) Remove
pressure
plate (step
side down)
.
shaft
assembly
assembly
.
overdrive clutch
Tie plates and together so they go back ‘in ‘the
same location.
Overdrive shaft
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
No. 3 thrust
shaft
washer (5 tabs) ,
No. 2 needle
(not
.
clutch
reaction
TSB Revision
clutch
Underdrive clutch
reaction plate flat .
snap ring
Screwdriver
Piston return
spring
TSB Revision
hub snap ring input hub ring with snap ring pliers.
Plastic hammer
Overdrive/reverse
overdrive/reverse piston.
Overdrive/
reverse
piston
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Input
Return I.
spring
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Arbor press ram Screwdriver While compressing return spring with Disc
and arbor press ram, install snap ring with a screwdriver.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
shaft
retainer
assembly
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
piston
,
..
TSB Revision ,
AUTOMATIC Input Clutches
clutches
clutches reaction plate tapered snap ring with tapered side
28 .
.
overdrive clutch pack starting
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Clutches
crewdriver
Overdrive/
reverse
pressure
plate
TSB Revision
Reverse
clutch
plate
down)
I I
reaction plate
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Clutches
Thickness
1.56 mm in.) I
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
Underdrive
underdrive shaft assembly.
shaft
Underdrive shaft
No. 3 thrust washer.
No. 3 thrust
washer assembly
(note 5 tabs)
(note 3 tabsj
No. 3
thrust
washer
AUTOMATIC OVERHAUL Input Clutches
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE’
DISASSEMBLY
Oil pan bolts (1) Remove oil pan bolts.
TSB Revision
(4) Remove, valve body attaching bolts (18).
Manual
shaft
seal
TSB Revision
(9) Slide transaxle range sensor up the manual shaft and
remove.
Transaxle
,
range
sensor
thermal valve.
Check ball 75
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Valve Body
retainer plate with
T/C control valve 6.
spring plug Remove torque converter control valve and torque
converter clutch valve.
Regulator
valve spring
76
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Valve Body
Insulator
Rivet
Retainer
-4 accumulator
Manual valve
Retainer
T/C control
valve
Torque
clutch valve
Valves removed
Valves installed
76
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Body
REASSEMBLY
(1) Install regulator valve.
Install retainer plate using 7.’
Check ball
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Body
Manual
shaft
seal
detent as shown.
(11) Install valve body.
I oil filter.
oil pan.
NOTE
Apply a inch bead of 18718 or equivalent.
TSB Revision
oil pan bolts.
NOTE
Use Loctite or equivalent bolt
233101800~6
DISASSEMBLY
(1) Remove oil pump seal with Seal Remover ,
REASSEMBLY
Install new oil pump seal with
3 and Adapter (52)
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Oil Pump
DISASSEMBLY
Remove pump .
(7) Remove the six bolts, and ‘then disassemble the pump
housing and reaction shaft
,
(8). Remove the oil pump outer gear and oil pump inner gear
from the pump housing. If the “gears are to be reused,
place. mark on the ‘to’ ensure that the
mounting direction will be correct;’ gears are
installed.
(Use a felt pen or to place
(9) Remove the four seal rings from the reaction shaft support;
TSB Revision
R E A S S E M B L Y
(1) Install the oil and
to the pump housing.
If reusing the old gears, marks’
that were made
.
,
(5) Place the four seal rings onto the reaction shaft support.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Oil Pump
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
DISASSEMBLY
Remove oil seal from housing.,
Diffe
cove
Differential cover
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
(6) Remove differential bearing
Bearing
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
pinion shaft.
case
Thrust
Pinion
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Differential
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Differential
R E A S S E M B L Y
(1) Install ‘a 0.50 mm in.)
the bearing cup into the press
in using and
Oil is not required when making
selection.
,
(3) extension housing into the and
to 28 Nm (20
Position transaxle assembly with oil facing
Rotate ring gear one revolution to seal differential’
bearings.
I,.
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
.
DIFFERENTIAL BEARING SHIM CHART
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
(8) extension housing with Remover
housing out of transaxle using special tool.
(9) Remove extension housing.
differential bearing
. . retainer.
Lubrication hole Bearing cup 15) Install the proper shim combination under the -bearing
cup.
im
Bearing retainer
TSB Revision
differential bearing retainer into the case torque
bolts to 28 Nm (20
Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Differential
bearing retainer
I
dial indicator and Adapter
check side gear end play at ring gear side and differential
Move side A
case side.
NOTE
Side gear end play each side must be 0.025 to 0.330
mm to inch).
TSB Revision
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL Differential
pinion gears,
by rotating pinion gears to opening in case.
Washer
Pinion
pinion shaft.
case
. ,
ring gear bolts.
Torque wench
NOTE
Always use new ring gear bolts arid to 95 Nm
(70
.
must
properly
tc
TSB Revision
TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
extension.
i n c h w i d e b ead
NOTE
Apply an inch wide bead of Loctite 18718 or equivalent.
TSB Revision I
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE OVERHAUL
.
differential cover.
Differential inch bead
NOTE
Apply an inch wide 1 equivalent:
. . . . ,
..
Differential cove
differential cover
_. . .
new oil seal using Installer arid-
Installer Adapter (56)
...
TSB Revision
PROPELLER
SHAFT
CONTENTS
LUBRICANTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3’
General Information/Service Specifications/
PROPELLER SHAFT Lubricants/Adhesive
..
Specifications
mm (in.) Front:
Center:
Rear:
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value Limit
Journal end play mm (in.)
Propeller shaft Front 0.6 or ‘less
(Dial indicator reading) mm (in.) Center 0.6 or less
Rear 0.6 or less
LUBRICANTS
Items Specified lubricant Quantity
Sleeve yoke surface API classification SAE or As required
joint Outer and inner races ball grooves Repair kit grease As required
assembly Repair kit grease 45-55
joint assembly inner part
oz.)
ADHESIVE 25100050024
TSB Revision
PROPELLER SHAFT Special
25100070020
Revision
PROPELLER Propeller
,
PROPELLER SHAFT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
22 6
22 11 Nm
8
Removal steps
1. Self-locking nut shaft assembly
2. Insulator
3. Spacer Heat protector
TSB Revision
SHAFT Propeller
..
Caution’
joint boot the propeller shaft in a straight and level
manner so as to ensure that the boot is not
through pinching. ,
NOTE
Damage to the boot can be and the Work will
be easier, if a piece of cloth or material is inserted
in the boot.
Center propeller Lbbro’ joint
shaft assembly
SPACER REMOVAL
The number of spacers depends on models. Check the num-
ber of spacers used and write it down for reference during
reassembly.
TSB Revision ..
. . ,
INSPECTION
Check the sleeve yoke, center yoke and flange yoke:
for wear, damage or cracks.
l Check the propeller shaft for damage or
cracks’:
l Check the propeller for or
l the universal joints operation in all’
directions.
l Check the center bearing for movement,
l Check the center bearing mounting rubber for damage
or deterioration.
.
PROPELLER SHAFT CHECK
Limit:
Front propeller shaft 0.6 mm or less
Center propeller shaft 0.6 mm in.) or less
Rear propeller shaft 0.6 in.)
TSB Revision
PROPELLER SHAFT Propeller Shaft
186 Nm
3
n u
- - -
2 0
21
Disassembly steps
1. Snap ring 12. Boot band
2. Journal bearing 13. Lobro joint assembly
3. Journal 14. Rubber packing
4. Flange yoke 15. Lobro joint boot
5. Sleeve yoke assembly 16. Washer
6. Front propeller shaft 17. Center propeller shaft
7. Self-locking nut 18. Self-locking nut
8. Center yoke. 19. Companion flange
assembly 20. Center ‘bearing assembly
21. Rear propeller shaft
Snap ring
TSB Revision
25-8 PROPELLER SHAFT ‘Propeller
Rubber mount
joint assembly
,
Grease: Repair kit grease Grease: Repair kit grease
(1.59-1.94 oz.)] fix adhesive
Part No. equivalent
TSB Revision
PROPELLER SHAFT Propeller, Shaft
\I
BOLTS REMOVAL
Put mating marks on the center propeller shaft, the Lobro
joint and the companion flange before removing
the bolts.
PROPELLER SHAFT Shaft
Mating marks (2) Put mating marks on the outer race, cage and inner race
with a scriber.
(3) Remove the outer race and balls.
NOTE
Note the positions of balls so that they can be
in their original positions.
Inner race
Cage
Cage (4) Remove the inner race with cage from the center propeller
shaft by using a puller (commercially available).
NOTE
When changing the grease on the Lobro joint assembly,
wipe off the grease and clean the outer and inner
cage and balls.
Lbbro ioint (5) If the outer race cannot be removed, remove the complete
joint assembly from the center
using a puller (commercially available).
TSB Revision
SHAFT
F L A N G E R E M O V A L
Put mating marks on the companion ‘flange and rear,
propeller shaft before removing the companion
SERVICE”
CENTER BEARING
FLANGE/SELF-LOCKING
(1) Apply multipurpose grease shown in the ‘figure.
(2) Install the center bearing assembly to the rear
shaft as shown in the illustration.
(3) Align the mating marks on the companion flange
rear propeller shaft.
(4) Press-fit the center bearing assembly with the companion
flange while tightening the self-locking nut.
. --
T S B
PROPELLER
(2) Put the cage on, the inner race with the mating
aligned and install two balls, one in and the
other in the groove opposite to that Both balls
should be placed in the grooves they were before,
disassembly.
(3) Assemble the inner race and cage the, outer with,
their mating marks aligned.
NOTE
Make sure that the recessed end snap ring will
Ball be fitted) of the inner race, the recessed end (where
Mating
marks packing will be fitted) of the outer race, and
end of the cage are all on the same ensure
that the relative positions’ of inner
Recessed end as shown in the illustration.,
of inner race
Chamfered (4) Install the remaining balls in their positibns.
end of cage (5) Check outer race rotates on the inner race smooth-
I,
on outer
race for fitting the Ball
packing
,
. . . .
. ,
TSB Revision
PROPELLER SHAFT Propeller Shaft
CENTER BEARING
Center bearing assembly YOKE/SELF-LOCKING NUT
(1) Apply multipurpose grease as shown in the figure.
(2) Install the center bearing assembly to the center propeller
shaft as shown in the illustration.
(3) Align the mating marks on the center yoke and center
propeller shaft.
(4) Press-fit the center bearing assembly with the yoke
while tightening the self-locking nut.
Journal (2) Press fit the journal bearings to the yoke by using the
special tool according to the following procedures.
1) Install the base to the special tool.
2) Insert both bearings in the yoke, and hold and press
fit them by using the special tool.
TSB Revision
PROPELLER SHAFT Propeller Shaft
SNAP RINGS
(1) Install snap rings of the same thickness onto both sides
of each yoke. .
(2) Press the bearing and journal into one side by using
a brass bar.
(3) Measure the clearance the snap ring and the
groove wall of the yoke with a feeler If the clear-
ance exceeds the standard value, the snap rings should
be replaced.
Standard value (A): mm
Snap ring thickness mm (in.) color
1.28
1 . 3 1 Yellow
1.34 ,
1.37
1 . 4 0 Brown
INSPECTION 25100120026
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
The front axle consists of a knuckle, front hub, has a tripod joint (T.J.) on the transaxle side and
unit bearing and drive shaft, The unit bearing is a joint (B.J.) on the wheel side. A center
press-fitted to the front hub and bolted to the bearing and an inner been adopted
kunckle. Also, the unit utilizes a double in some models.
row angular contact ball bearing. The drive shaft
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM
Knuckle
hub
inner
Drive shaft
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value Limit
Setting of boot length mm (in.)
Opening dimension of the When the band (small) is 2.9
special tool mm crimped
(in.) When the band (big) is 3.2
crimped
Crimped width of the band mm (in.) 2.4 2.8
Clearance between the (larger diameter side) 0.1 1.55
and the stepped phase of the B.J. housing mm (in.) .
Wheel bearing end play mm (in.) 0.05
Wheel bearing breakaway torque Nm 1 (9) or less
LUBRICANTS
Quantity (oz.) Specified lubricant
FWD Engine (Non-turbo)> 105 (3.70) Repair kit grease
FWD Engine (Turbo) and Engine> 120 (4.23)
AWD
Inner
Outer dust seal . grease
FWD Engine (Non-turbo)> 110 (3.88) Repair kit grease
FWD Engine (Turbo) 130 .
AWD 95 (3.35)
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Special , .. .
SPECIAL TOOLS
torque measureme
460
TSB Revision
26-4 FRONT AXLE Special
Shimmy
TSB Revision
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
WHEEL BEARING END PLAY CHECK
1. Remove the disc brake caliper and suspend it with a
wire.
2. Remove the brake disc from the front hub.
3. Attach a dial gauge as shown in the illustration, and then
measure the end play while moving the hub in the axial
direction.
Limit: 0.05 mm in.)
4. If end play exceeds the replace the front hub assem-
bly.
4. Use the wheel nuts to securely install the new hub bolts,
while being careful of the serrations of the hub bolts and
hub;
8990767
TSB Revision
26-6 FRONT AXLE Front
88 Nm
65
88 Nm
85 145-188
5
Removal steps
1. Cotter pin 6. Upper
2. Drive shaft nut
3. Front wheel speed sensor 7. Front hub.
with
4. Caliper assembly Caution
5. Brake disc The front hub assembly not be disassembled.
.
Al
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Front Hub Assembly
I (2) Use the special tool to tighten the drive shaft nut.
Caution
196-255 Nm Before securely tightening the drive shaft nuts, make
145-188
sure there is no load on the wheel bearings.
(3) If the position of the cotter pin holes does not match,
tighten the nut up to 255 Nm (188 in maximum.
(4) Install the cotter pin in the first matching holes and bend
it securely.
INSPECTION
WHEEL BEARING BREAKAWAY TORQUE CHECK
(1) Install the special tool to the front hub assembly and
tighten the nut to the specified torque 196-255 Nm
86
(2) Use the special tool to measure the hub rotation break-
away torque.
Nm Limit: 1.0 Nm (9 or less
00000320
(3) The hub rotation breakaway torque should be within the
limit value range, and there should be no engagement
or feeling of roughness.
WHEEL BEARING END PLAY CHECK
(1) Install the special tool to the front hub assembly and
tighten the nut to the specified torque 196-255 Nm
TSB Revision
26-8 FRONT AXLE
KNUCKLE
REMOVAL AND
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
l Fr o n t Wh eel Sp eed Sen s o r Rem o v al an d
Installation <Vehicles with
l Front Hub Assembly Removal and
(Refer to
All
Removal steps
1. Dust shield 6. Connecting bolt fork and
2. Cotter pin lateral lower
3. Tie rod end ball joint and 7. Knuckle
connection
4. Compression lower arm ball joint Caution
and knuckle connection Indicates parts which tightened,
5. Lateral lower arm ball joint and and then fully tightened with on ground
knuckle connection In the unladen condition.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Knuckle
INSPECTION
l Check the knuckle bending or cracking.
TSB Revision I
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
DRIVE SHAFT
REMOVAL AND .
43-52
196-255 Nm
17-25
103 Nm
76
65
6
Removal steps
1. Cotter pin 7. Compression lower arm ball joint
2. Drive shaft nut and connection
3. Tie rod end ball joint and knuckle Drive shaft
connection
4. Stabilizer link ball joint and damper
fork connection Caution
5. Damper fork l Indicates parts which should be temporarily tightened,
6. Lateral lower arm ball joint and and then fully tightened with on the ground
knuckle connection in the unladen condition.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
REMOVAL SERVICE
SHAFT NUT REMOVAL
‘Caution
Do not apply the vehicle weight to bearing
while loosening the drive shaft If,
weight must be the bearing moving
the temporarily secure wheel by
using the special tool, etc.
1 (2) Use the special tool as a cover not to let foreign objects
461 get into the transaxle case.
I
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
(2) Use the special tool to tighten the drive shaft nut.
Caution
88 Before securely tightening the drive shaft nuts, make
sure there is no load on the wheel bearings.
(3) If the position of the cotter pin holes, not match,
tighten the nut up to 255 Nm ‘in maximum.
(4) Install the cotter pin in the first matching holes and bend
it securely.
INSPECTION
l Check the drive shaft boot for damage or deterioration.
l Check the ball joints for wear or, operating condition.
l Check the spline part for wear or damage.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
Disassembly steps
1. T.J. boot band (large) 10. assembly .
2. T.J. boot band (small) 11. band (small)
3. T.J. case 12. band (large)
4. 13. boot
5. ring
Caution
Do not disassemble the B.J. except
band replacement of the B.J. boot.
9. Dynamic damper
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
LUBRICANT POINTS
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft . .
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE POINTS
CASE
Remove the T.J. case from the B.J. assembly, and off
the grease inside the T.J. case.
.
BOOT REMOVAL
(1) Wipe the grease off of the spline portion.
(2) Remove the boot.
NOTE
If the boot is reused, wrap plastic tape around the
shaft spline so that the boot is not damaged when it
is removed.
TSB Revision
FRONT Drive Shaft
561 (3) the a justing bolt of the special tool to adjust the
opening dimension (W) to the standard value.
Stopper
Standard 2.9 mm in.)
more than 2.9 mm in.)>
Screw in the adjusting bolt.
<When less than 2.9 mm in.)>
Loosen the adjusting bolt.
Adjusting bolt NOTE
00003420 (1) The dimension (W) is adjusted by approx. 0.7 mm
in.) per one turn.
(2) Do not turn the adjusting bolt more one turn.
(4) Place the boot band (small) along the protruding
and install it so that there is some (A)
the other side. . .
protruding portion
00003421
5.5 mm in.)
Example: If is 2.3 is
3.2 m m
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
(9) Install the B.J. boot to adjust the clearance (C) between
the B.J. boot end and the stepped of the B.J.
housing is within the standard
Standard value (C): 0.1 1.55 mm
(lO)Adjust the opening dimension the standard
as mentioned at the step (3).
Standard value (W): 3.2 mm
5.8 mm in.)
Example: If (E) is 2.3 mm in.), is 3.5
mm in.).
that the boot band is secured correctly. If the band
is secured incorrectly, repeat steps (11) to (13) to replace
it.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
DYNAMIC DAMPER
Install the dynamic damper in the position shown in the illustra-
tion.
Items Engine Engine Engine
(Non-turbo) (Non-turbo) ..
<AK>
A mm L.H.
(in.)
B.J. Dynamicbamper R.H.
SPIDER CASE
(1) Install the spider assembly to the shaft
of the spline section.
(2) After applying specified grease insert
the drive shaft and apply grease one
Specified grease: Repair grease
Engine (Non-turbo)> 105
Engine (Turbo) and
(4.23 oz.)
NOTE
The grease in the repair kit be divided in. half
for use, respectively, at the joint and inside the boot.
Caution
The drive shaft joint uses special Do not mix
old and new or different types of
INSPECTION
l ‘Check the drive shaft for damage, bending or corrosion.
l Check the drive shaft spline part for wear or damage.
l Check the spider assembly for roller rotation, wear or
corrosion.
l Check the groove inside T.J. case for wear of corrosion.
l Check the dynamic damper for damage or cracking.
l Check the boots for deterioration, damage or cracking.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
26166366107
59-71 Nm
8
Nm 40
145-188 30
Removal steps
1. pin 8.
2. Dye shaft nut 9. Drive shaft and inner shaft (L.H.)
3. rod end ball joint and knuckle or drive shaft (R.H.)
connection 10.
4. Stabilizer link ball joint and damper
fork connection Caution
5. Damper fork Indicates parts should be tightened,
6. Lateral lower arm ball joint and and then fully tightened with vehicles on the ground
knuckle connection in the unladen
7. Compression lower arm ball joint
and knuckle connection
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
REMOVAL SERVICE
SHAFT REMOVAL
Caution
Do not apply the vehicle weight to the wheel bearing
while loosening the drive shaft nut. If, however, the vehicle
weight must be applied to the bearing (because of moving
the vehicle), temporarily secure the wheel bearing by
using the special tool, etc.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive
SERVICE POINT
DRIVE SHAFT NUT INSTALLATION
(1) Install the drive shaft washer in the specified direction.
,
l Check the drive shaft boot for damage or deterioration.
l Check the ball joints for wear or operating condition.
l Check the part for wear or damage. ,
..
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
.
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
13 15 (L.H. only)
2
I
boot repair kit repair kit Bearing dust seal Bracket assembly
repair kit repair kit
Disassembly steps
1. T.J. boot band (large) 13. ring
2. T.J. boot 14. assembly
shaft assembly 15. T.J. boot
16. B.J. assembly
Seal plate 17. B.J. boot band (small)
6. I n n e r 18. B.J. boot band (large)
7. Bracket assembly 19. B.J. boot
8. Dust seal (outer)
9. Dust seal (inner) Caution
10. Center bearing Do not disassemble the B.J. assembly except replace-
11. Center bearing bracket ment of the B.J. boot.
12.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
LUBRICANT POINTS
Multi-purpose grease:
Dust seal (inner)
oz.)
Dust seal (outer)
oz.)
Grease
Repair kit grease 95 (3.35 oz.)
Caution
The drive shaft joint uses special
grease. Do not mix old and new
or different types of grease.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
CASE REMOVAL
After removing the T.J. case from the B.J. assembly,
off the grease on the. T.J. case
(2) Use the special tools to remove the inner shaft from the
97 bracket.
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
(3) Turn the adjusting bolt of the special tool to adjust the
opening dimension (W) to the standard value.
Stopper
Standard value (W): 2.9 mm in.)
more than mm
Screw in the adjusting bolt.
<When less than mm
Loosen the adjusting bolt.
Adjusting bolt NOTE
(1) The dimension (W) is adjusted by approx. 0.7 mm
in.) per one turn.
(2) Do not turn the adjusting bolt more than one turn.
B.J. (4) Place the boot band (small) along the protruding portion,
and install it so that there is some clearance (A) along
the other side.
Protruding
portion
Revision
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
(5) Use the special tool crimp the B.J. boot band
Caution
(1) Hold the drive and use the
special tool to crimp the B.J.
(2) Crimp the B.J. boot special tool
‘touches the stopper.
00003421
(6) Check that the crimped width (B) within the stand&d
value.
Standard value (B): 2.4 2.8 in.)
than 2.8 mm
Readjust the dimension of the
value calculated by the
and repeat step (5).
5.5 mm in.)
Example: If (B) is 2.9 mm in.), is 2.6
00003422 mm in.).
<When less than 2.4 in.)>
Remove the B.J. boot
dimension (W) of step
calculated by the following
a new B.J. boot band to to
(5).
5.5 mm in.)
Example: If is 2.3 is
3.2 mm in.).
00003423
TSB Revision
FRONT AXLE __ ,
Bearing
FRONT AXLE Drive. Shaft
.
.
..
172
CASE
nner
INSTALLATION
(1) Apply multi-purpose grease then
press fit into the case.
T.J. case
TSB Revision I
FRONT AXLE Drive Shaft
INSPECTION 26100280076
TSB Revision
.
NOTES
,
REAR AXLE
CONTENTS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
General Information/Service Specifications/
REAR AXLE Special Tools
The rear axle consists of a knuckle, rear hub, unit the front axle. On, ABS, a ABS rotor
bearing and axle shaft. The unit bearing is for detecting the speed is located on the
fitted to the rear axle shaft and bolted to the knuckle. and sensor is located on
Also, the unit bearing utilizes the same type of the knuckle.
double row angular contact ball bearing as does
rotor
Rear
Unit
Oil seal
, ,
Items Limit
Wheel bearing end play mm (in.) 0.05
Wheel bearing rotary-sliding resistance (Ibs.) 18 (3.9)
,
Tool Tool number and name Supersession Application
113 Toe’ arm ball and
Steering linkage puller knuckle removal’
.
I
248
Inner shaft remover
. .
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE ..
WHEEL BEARING
1. Release the parking brake: ,
2. Remove the brake drum.
3. For vehicles with rear disc brake, caliper as-
sembly and the brake disc.
4. Check the bearing’s end
Place a dial gauge against the move
the hub in the axial and check ‘whether or not
.
there is end play.
Limit: 0.05 mm . .
5. If the play exceeds the limit value, replace the hub
assembly. .
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE On-vehicle Service
HUB BOLT
1. Remove the caliper assembly and with
so that it does not fall.
2. Remove the brake drum and- brake disc.
3. For vehicles with disc brakes;’
assembly.
.
5. Use the wheel nuts to securely install the new hub bolts,
while being careful of the serrations of the hub bolts and
hub.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Rear Hub Assembly
54-65
54-65
00004045
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Rear Hub
REMOVAL SERVICE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY ,
Remove the caliper assembly it.
ABS ROTOR
Socket
INSPECTION 27100210105
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Knuckle
27100300055
85-99
71 ‘2
Removal steps
1. Trailing arm connection 7. Hub cap without
2. Lower arm connection
3. Toe control arm ball joint and Caution
knuckle connection l : Indicates parts which should be temporarily
4. Shock absorber connection and then fully tightened with the vehicle
5. Upper arm connection on the ground in the unladen condition.
6. Knuckle
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Knuckle
Caution ,
1. Use the special to
nut. Only loosen the do the
ball joint.
2. the special tool with a
it from coming off.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE General Information .
In the rear axle structure, the unit bearing is rotor for detecting the is
fitted to the rear hub and bolted to the knuckle. on the outer ring of the drive shaft B.J., and a
Also, the unit bearing utilizes a double row angular speed sensor is located on the knuckle.
contact ball bearing. The drive shaft has a T.J. The differential carrier provides elastic support by,
on the differential side and a B.J. constant-velocity means of a bushing. In addition, the VCU-type LSD
joint on the wheel side. In vehicles with a has been adopted in some models.
Reduction gear type Hypoid gear Hypoid gear Hypoid gear Hypoid gear
Reduction ratio 3.545 3.307
Differential Side gear Straight bevel Straight bevel Straight bevel Straight bevel
gear type
,
ber of Pinion gear Straight bevel Straight bevel Straight bevel Straight bevel
gears)
Number of Drive gear 39 43 39 43
teeth
Drive pinion 11 I ‘3 I
Side gear 14 14 16 16
Pinion gear 10 10 10 10
Bearing
(outside Side 72 35 (2.83 1.38) 72 35 (2.83 1.38) 72 35 (2.83 1.38) (2.83 ,
Front 62 25 (2.44 62 25 (2.44 62 25 (2.44 62 25
side
ter) mm (in.) 72 35 (2.83 1.38) 72 35 (2.83 72 35 (2.83 1.38) 72 35 (2.83
NOTE
Denotes the gear (L.H.) which is in a single body with the viscous coupling.
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM
rotor with
Differential carrier
Unit bearing
TSB Revision
REAR
SAE
SAE
Preload socket
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Tools
race removal
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Special Tools
eanng
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING
AXLE SHAFT
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Noise while wheels are Brake drag Replace
rotating
Bent axle shaft
NOTE
l l: In addition to a malfunction of the differential carrier components, abnormal noise can also be caused by the
universal joint of the propeller shaft, the axle shafts, the wheel bearings, etc. Before disassembling any parts,
take all possibilities into consideration and confirm the source of the noise.
l 2: Noise from the engine, muffler vibration, transaxle, propeller shaft, wheel bearings, tires, body, etc., is easily
mistaken as being caused by malfunctions in the differential carrier components. Be extremely careful and attentive
when performing the driving test, etc.
Test methods to confirm the source of the abnormal noise include: coasting, acceleration, constant speed driving,
raising the rear wheels on a jack, etc. Use the method most appropriate to the circumstances.
TSB Revision
REAR
Gear oil leakage Worn or damaged front oil seal, OF an improperly Replace,
installed oil seal
Damaged gasket
The limited slip The limited slip device is damaged Disassemble, check the functioning
differential does not and replace the damaged parts
function (on snow,
mud, ice, etc.)
NOTE
Noise from the engine, muffler vibration, transaxle, propeller shaft, wheel bearings, tires, body, etc., is easily
mistaken as being caused by malfunctions in the differential carrier components. Be extremely careful and attentive
when performing the driving test, etc.
Test methods to confirm the source of the abnormal include: coasting, speed
raising the rear wheels on a -jack, etc. Use the method most appropriate to the
In the event of seizure, disassemble and replace the parts involved, and also be sure to check
for any irregularities and repair or replace as
l 4: In addition to disassembling and replacing the failed parts, be sure to check all components for irregularities
and repair or replace as necessary.
TSB Revision
6 REAR AXLE Service
NOTE
Over SAE
Under SAE
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision 1
REAR AXLE Rear Hub Assembly
l
Operation
Drive Shaft Removal (Refer to 1
<Vehicles with drum brakes>
Nm
7
8
11
00004046
Removal steps
1. Rear wheel speed sensor 7. Clip
<Vehicles with 8. Parking brake cable
(Refer to GROUP Wheel 9. Rear hub assembly
Speed Sensor.) 10. Brake pipe connection
2. Brake drum 11. Dust seal
3. Shoe and lever assembly
4. Caliper assembly (Refer to Caution
5. Brake disc The rear hub assembly should not disassembled.
6. Shoe and lining assembly (Refer to
GROUP 36 Parking Brake
<Drum-in-disc brakes>.)
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Rear Assembly
INSPECTION
l Check the oil seal for crack damage.
l Check the rear hub for wear or damage.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Knuckle
98
, 71
98
118-137
85-99
98
71
Removal steps
1. Trailing arm connection
2. Lower arm connection
3. Toe control arm ball joint and
knuckle connection (Refer to
Caution
4. Shock absorber connection Indicates arts which should be tightened,
5. Upper arm connection and then tightened the veh on the ground
6. Knuckle in the unladen condition.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Drive
27100330023
98
71
10
I I
,
19
44 118-137
33 85-99
11
with drum brakes>
98
71 ..
,
11
Removal steps
1. Rear wheel speed sensor 13. Toe control arm ball joint and
<Vehicles with knuckle connection
2. Caliper assembly (Refer to (Refer to
3. Brake disc 14. pin
4. Brake drum 15. Drive shaft nut
5. Shoe and lining assembly (Refer to 16. Washer
GROUP 36 Parking Brake 17. Differential mount support
<Drum-in-disc brakes>.) 18. Drive shaft
6. Shoe and lever assembly 19.
7. Clip
8. Parking brake cable Caution
9. Brake pipe connection 1. For vehicles with ABS, careful not to damage
10. Shock absorber connection drive shaft rotor.
Trailing arm connection 2. l : Indicates parts should be temporarily
12. Lower arm connection and then fully tightened the on the
ground in the unladen condition.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Shaft
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Shaft
INSPECTION 27100340026
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Shaft
6
2
10 . 00003847
repair kit
repair kit
Disassembly steps
1. T.J. boot band (large) 8. B.J. boot band (small)
2. T.J. boot band (small) 9. B.J. boot
__ 3. T.J. case 10. B.J. assembly
4. Snap ring 11.
5. Spider assembly
6. T.J. boot Caution
7. B.J. boot band (large) Do not disassemble the B.J. assembly.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Drive Shaft
LUBRICATION POINTS
Grease:
Repair kit grease 75 (2.66 oz.)
Caution
The drive shaft uses special
grease. Do not mix old and new or
different types of grease.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
B.J. BOOT INSTALLATION
(1) Wrap plastic tape around the drive shaft spline.
(2) the drive shaft in’
... ,
(3) the inside of the B.J. and B.J. boot with the specified
grease.
grease: Repair kit grease (2.66
NOTE
The grease in the repair kit should be divided in half
for use, respectively, at the joint and inside the boot.
Caution
The drive shaft joint uses grease. DO not mix
old and new or different types of grease.
TSB Revision I
REAR AXLE Drive Shaft
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Drive __
BOOT B AND
(LARGE)
INSTALLATION
Set the T.J. boot bands at the specified distance in order
to adjust the amount of air inside the T.J. and then
tighten the, T.J. boot bands securely.
Standard value (A):
<Conventional differential> 79 3
<Limited slip differential> 84 3 mm in.)
Caution
Always check the identification numbers on the
band levers. Never confuse the bands.
Items Identification number I
T.J. boot band (large) I
T.J. boot band (small)
INSPECTION
l Check the drive Shaft for corrosion.
l drive shaft part for wear or damage.
l Check for entry of water and/or foreign
l Check the spider assembly
corrosion.
l Check the groove inside T.J. case for
l Check the boots for deterioration, or
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential Carrier
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal Operation Post-installation Operation
l Brake Fluid Draining with drum brakes> l Differential Gear Oil Filling (Refer to
l Differential Gear Oil Draining l Brake Line Bleeding with drum
(Refer to GROUP Service.)
l Parking Brake Adjustment (Refer to GROUP
Service.)
98 Nm
98
5
22-25
118-137
85-99
11
11
Removal steps
1. Rear wheel speed sensor 12. Lower arm connection
with 13. Toe control arm ball joint and
2. Caliper assembly (Refer to connection (Refer to
3. Brake disc
4. Brake drum 14. Differential mount support
5. Shoe and lining assembly (Refer to 15. Propeller shaft connection
GROUP 36 Parking Brake 16. shaft
<Drum-in-disc brakes>.) 17.
6. Shoe and lever assembly Differential mount bracket assembly
7. Clip
8. Parking brake cable
9. Brake pipe connection parts which should be tightened,
10. Shock absorber connection and then fully tightened wlth the vehicle on the ground
11. Trailing arm connection in the unladen condition.
Revision
REAR AXLE Differential
DIFFERENTIAL REMOVAL
Support the differential carrier with a jack. Then remove the
connecting bolt between it and the rear crossmember and
remove the differential carrier.
INSTALLATION SERVICE
DRIVE SHAFT CONNECTION
Caution
Do not damage the differential carrier ‘oil seal.
PROPELLER SHAFT
Connect the propeller shaft so‘ that the marks on the
differential companion flange and the are aligned.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential Carrier
INSPECTION BEFORE
Hold the special tool in a vice, and attach the differential
carrier to the special tool.
TSB Revision
27-32 REAR AXLE Differential Carrier .
NOTE
(1) Tooth contact pattern is a method for judging the result of the adjustment of drive pinion height and drive gear
backlash. The adjustment of drive pinion height and drive gear backlash should be repeated until tooth contact
patterns bear a similarity to the standard tooth contact
(2) When adjustment is not able to obtain a correct pattern, it may be judged that the drive gear and pinion
have exceed their usage limits and both gears should be replaced as a set.
Revision
27-34 REAR AXLE. Differential
DISASSEMBLY
1820 27 28 31
<Limited slip differential>
Disassembly steps
l Inspection before disassembly Differential case
(Refer to <Conventional differential>
Differential cover assembly 16. Limited slip differential case assem-
2. Vent plug bly (Refer to
3. Bearing cap 17. Self-locking nut
4. Differential case assembly 18. Washer
5. Side bearing spacer 19. Drive pinion assembly
6. Side bearing outer race 20. Companion flange
7. Side bearing inner race 21. Drive pinion front shim (for preload
Drive gear adjustment)
9. Lock pin 22. Drive pinion spacer
<Conventional differential> 23. Drive pinion rear bearing inner race
10. Pinion shaft 24. Drive pinion rear shim (for pinion
<Conventional differential> height adjustment)
11. Pinion gear 25. Drive pinion
<Conventional differential> 26. Oil seal
12. Pinion washer 27. Drive pinion front bearing inner race
<Conventional differential> 28. Drive pinion front bearing outer race
13. Side gear 29. Drive pinion rear bearing outer race
differentials 30. Oil seal
14. Side gear spacer 31. Gear carrier
<Conventional differential>
.
REAR AXLE Differential ‘Carrier
NUT REMOVAL
Revision
REAR AXLE Differential Carrier
Mating marks (1) Make the mating marks to the drive pinion and companion
.
Caution
Mating marks should not be sur-
faces of companion shaft.“‘
(2) Drive out the drive pinion
spacer and drive pinion ,
I . .
OIL
RACE/DRIVE PINION FRONT
OUTER RACE REMOVAL
REAR BEARING
REMOVAL
INSPECTION
l Check the companion flange for wear or damage.
l Check the bearings for wear discoloration.
l Check the gear carrier for cracks.
l Check the drive pinion and drive gear or
l Check the side gears, pinion gears and shaft for
wear or damage.
l Check the side gear for damage
TSB Revision
AXLE Differential’
REASSEMBLY
<Conventional differential>
Reassembly steps
1. Gear carrier 18. Side spacer
2. Oil seal differential>
3. Drive pinion rear bearing outer race 19. Side
4. Drive pinion front bearing outer race differential>
l Pinion height adjustment 20. Pinion washer
5. Drive pinion <Conventional differential>
6. Drive pinion rear shim (for pinion 21. Pinion gear
height adjustment) differential>
7. Drive pinion rear bearing inner race 22. Pinion shaft
6. Drive pinion spacer <Conventional differential>
l Drive pinion preload adjustment 23. Lock pin <Conventional differential>
9. Drive pinion front shim (for preload 24. Drive gear
adjustment) 25. Side bearing race
10. Drive pinion assembly 26. Side bearing outer race
11. Drive pinion front bearing inner race l Drive gear backlash adjustment
12. Oil 27. Side bearing
13. Companion flange 28. Differential case assembly
14. Washer 29. Bearing cap
15. Self-locking nut 30. Vent plug
16. Differential case 31. Differential cover assembly
17. Limited slip differential case assem-
bly (Refer to NOTE
l Differential gear backlash adjustment l : Tightening torque with gear oil applied
differential>
TSB Revision
2-3 mm in.)
<Conventional differential>
Adhesive:
Locking No.
or equivalent ,
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential
SERVICE POINTS
(1) With the special fit the oil seal is. flush
with the end of carrier.
(2) grease to the lip.
PINION
Adjust the drive pinion height by the following procedures:
(1) Apply a thin coat of the grease to the mating
face of the washer of special tool.
(2) ‘Install special tools and drive front and rear bearing,
inner. races on the gear carrier in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
NOTE
Apply a thin coat of the multipurpose grease to the mating
face of the washer of the special tool.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential Carrier
Bearing cap
(9) Install. the. bearing cap, and then use a gage
and the micrometer to measure the
of the bearing cap as shown in the
the thickness (E) of the drive rear shim
from the following equation, and select the shim that is’
closest to this value.
A mm
Al
(11) Fit the selected drive pinion rear shim(s) the drive
and press-fit the drive pinion rear bearing inner
race by using the special tool.
(4) If the drive pinion turning torque is not within the range
of the standard value, adjust the turning torque by replac-
ing the drive pinion front shim(s) or the drive pinion spacer.
NOTE
When selecting the drive pinion front shims, if the number
of shims is large, reduce the number of shims to a minimum
by selecting the drive pinion spacers.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential Carrier
(8) Measure the drive pinion turning torque (with oil seal)
by using the special tools to verify that the drive pinion
turning torque complies with the standard value.
Standard value:
Bearing Bearing lubrication Rotation torque
classification (starting friction
torque)
New None (with
oil)
New/reused Gear oil application 0.5 0.8 (4-5)
DIFFERENTIAL GEAR
differential>
Adjust the differential gear backlash by the following proce-
dures:
(1) Assemble the side gears, side gear spacers, pinion gears,
and pinion washers into the differential case.
(2) Temporarily install the pinion shaft.
NOTE ,
Do not drive in the lock pin yet. ,
(3) While locking the side gear with the wedge,. measure
the differential gear backlash with a on the’
pinion gear.
NOTE
(1) The measurement should be made for both pinion
gears individually.
(2) Refer to for measurement of slip
differential gear backlash.
Standard value: 0 0.076 mm in.)
Limit: 0.2 mm in.)
(4) If the differential gear backlash exceeds the limit, adjust
the backlash by installing thicker side gear spacers.
(5) Measure the differential gear backlash once again, and
confirm that it is within the limit.
NOTE
1. After adjustment, check that is less than
the limit and differential “gear rotates smoothly.
2. When adjustment is impossible,’ replace the side gear
and the pinion gear as a set.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential Carrier
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential
0.05 mm
2 in.)
Thickness of the spacer on
one side
(5) Tap the side bearing spacers with a brass bar to fit them
to the side bearing outer race.
(6) Align the mating marks on the gear carrier and the bearing’:
cap, and then tighten the bearing cap.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE Differential
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE <AWL)> Assembly
, . . .
Feeler
INSPECTION BEFORE
DIFFERENTIAL
(1) Hold the limited a
the differential side
Caution
When the limited slip in
vice, do not tighten
(2) Install two 0.03 ih.)
between the differential case
Feeler
gauge
Caution
Do not insert the feeler
in the differential
.
washer .
gear (R.H.) . .
A
I
the special in the splined of the
tial’ side gear (R.H.) and make the side gear
(R.H.) turns.
the feeler gauges with in.) feeler:
“gauges. .
the special tool in the
gear (R.H.) and make , gear’
,
(R.H.) does not turn.
Standard value:
mm in.)
NOTE
The differential gear backlash is normal if the side gear
clearance in the direction of thrust is within the standard
value.
(6) If the side gear clearance in the direction of thrust
not within the standard value, remove the differential case
(A) and adjust by means of thrust washer (L.H.).
Thrust washer (L.H.)
Part No. Thickness mm (in.)
0.8
0.9
1
1.1
1.15
1.2
1.25
1.3
I 1.35
1.4
1.5
Revision
REAR AXLE LSD Case Assembly
Disassembly steps
l Inspection before disassembly 6. Differential pinion mate
, to 7. Differential pinion shaft
8. Differential side gear
Differential case (A) 9. Thrust washer (R.H.)
3. Thrust washer (L.H.) 10. Differential case (B)
4. Viscous coupling (with differential
side gear: L.H.) NOTE
5. Pinion mate washer LSD: Limited slip differential
The thrust washer (L.H.) differs from the thrust washer (R.H.)
in thickness.
Keep them separately from each other for reference in assem-
bly.
TSB Revision
REAR AXLE LSD Case Assembly
l-
REASSEMBLY SERVICE POINTS
- c a s e ( B ) DIFFERENTIAL CASE CASE
(A) INSTALLATION
Install the differential cases (A) and (B) with their mating
marks in alignment.
TSB
REAR AXLE LSD Case
Differential side
INSPECTION
Differential
(1) Check each gear and the differential pinion shaft for wear
and damage.
(2) Check the portion of the differential side gear
(R.H.) for damage and shoulder.
pinion mate
(3) Check the sliding surfaces of the thrust washer and pinion
mate washer for wear, seizure and damage.
(5) Check the spline of VCU for damage and shoulder and
in sliding check the surface in sliding contact with the differential
contact with case (B).
differential case
(6) Check the side gear (L.H.) of VCU for wear and damage.
Splined portion
TSB Revision
NOTES
CONTENTS
GENERAL’
Both steel type and aluminum type wheels have A compact spare tire has been adopted as the
been adopted. The type of wheel used depends spare tire in all models.
on the vehicle model.
<ECLIPSE>
Item Medium price High price
Wheel Type I Steel I Steel I Steel
Tire
Spare
wheel
NOTE
l : optional items
wheel Size
. . . .mm
... 46 (1.8) 46 (1.8) 46 (1.8)
circle diameter mm (in.) (4.5) 114.3 (4.5) 114.3 (4.5)
Spare Size
<ECLIPSE
Item Medium price Premium price
Wheel Aluminum type Aluminum type
Size
Amount of wheel offset mm (in.) 46 (1.8) 46 (1.8)
Pitch circle diameter mm (in.) 114.3 , 114.3 (4.5)
Tire Size . ..
Spare Type Steel type Steel type
wheel Size
Amount of wheel offset mm (in.) 46 (1.8) 46 (1.8)
circle diameter mm (in.) 114.3 (4.5) 114.3 (4.5)
Spare Size
l .
optional items
TSB Revision
WHEEL AND TIRE Service Specifications
Limit
Tread depth of tire 1.6 ,
Wheel Radial Steel wheel 1.2 or less
Aluminum wheel or less
Lateral Steel wheel 1.2 or less,
Aluminum wheel 1 or I
TSB Revision
WHEEL AND TIRE
Scalloped wear Lack of rotation of tires or worn or Rotate the Refer to GROUP
out-of-alignment suspension check the front On-vehicle
suspension Service.
alignment.
TSB Revision
WHEEL AND TIRE On-vehicle Service/Wheel and Tire
WHEEL CHECK
Jack up the vehicle so that the wheels are clear of the floor.
While slowly turning the wheel, measure wheel with
a dial indicator.
Limit:
Radial
Steel wheel; 1.2 mm in.) or less
Aluminum wheel; 1.0 mm in.) or less
Lateral
Steel wheel; 1.2 mm in.) or less
Aluminum wheel; 1.0 mm in.) or less
If wheel exceeds the limit, replace the wheel.
TSB Revision
NOTES
MOUNT
CONTENTS
The engine-transaxle mount is of an inertial axis the front upper part of the engine at the front and
supporting type whose excellent features have the rear upper part of the transaxle at the rear.
ready been proven in many Mitsubishi vehicles. This arrangement effectively suppresses the engine
The inertial supporting type mount
CONSTRUCTION,
Engine (Non-turbo)>
, ,
Engine mount
Transaxle
mount
mount
Rear roll
FRONT stopper
mount
TSB Revision
POWER PLANT MOUNT Specifications/Special Tools/Troubleshooting
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
TOOL
TSB Revision
32-4 POWER PLANT MOUNT
98
71 98
71 85
Removal steps
1. Enaine mount insulator mounting
INSPECTION
l Check each insulator for cracks or damage.
l Check each bracket for deformations or damage.
TSB Revision
POWER PLANT MOUNT Transaxle
TRANSAXLE MOUNTING
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post-installation Operation
l Air Cleaner Assembly Removal and Installation
l Battery Removal and Installation
l Engine Roll Stopper, Centermember Assembly
Removal and Installation (Refer to
69 Nm
3
.
NOTE
l
TSB Revision
32-6 POWER PLANT MOUNT Transaxle
. ,
Transaxle
mount Transaxle side l
stopper TRANSAXLE MOUNT
Align the notches on the stopper with the transaxle mount
bracket with the arrow mark facing toward the
Then install the stopper. ,
INSPECTION
l Check each insulator for cracks or damage.
l Check each bracket for
.
TSB Revision
POWER Engine Roll
,
ENGINE ROLL STOPPER, CENTERMEMBER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
44 Nm
Engine (Non-turbo)>
32
88 Nm
64
TSB Revision I
32-8 POWER PLANT MOUNT Engine Roll. Stopper,
INSTALLATION POINT
FRONT
I.
INSPECTION
l each insulator for cracks damage.
l Check each bracket for damage.
.
,
,
Revision
POWER PLANT MOUNT Crossmember
CROSSMEMBER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post Installation Operation
(1) Power Steering Fluid Draining and Supplying
(Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.)
(2) Centermember Removal and Instrallation
(Refer to
(3) Stay Removal and Installation (Refer to
Compression lower and lateral lower arm
assemblies.)
(4) Front Exhaust Pipe Removal and Installation (Refer
to GROUP 15 Exhaust Pipe and Muffler.)
(5) Stabilizer Bar Removal and Installation
(Refer to GROUP Stabilizer Bar.)
(6) Steering Gear Box Removal and Installation (Refer
to GROUP Power Steering Gear Box.)
44 Nm
32
88 Nm
84
88
00003506
TSB Revision
POWER PLANT MOUNT
BUSHING
(1) Apply soapy water to the contact ‘surface of the
when press-fitting the bush. ,
Nut
Removal Press-fitting
(1) Use the special tool to drive out and press-fit the
member bushing C.
.
.
Inner pipe
INSPECTION
l Check the crossmember for cracks or deformation.
l Check the bushings for cracks or’deterioration.
TSB Revision
FRONT
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
The front suspension is of a multi-link construction by mounting the upper arm in a higher position
with two lower arms which create the ideal virtual than the tires, excellent steering stability and ride
kingpin axis for the suspension system. In addition, comfort are obtained.
<ECLIPSE>
items Medium price Premium price Premium price
High price High price I I
Low Low , I
Coil spring Wire diameter 13.1
O.D. free length 309.5 315.5 124.2 124.4 315.5
mm 3.315 4.890 3.323 4.898 3.315
I 12.185) 12.421) 12.185)
Identification color White Pink White Grav I White pink
Spring constant 43.0 (246) 43.0 (246) 43.0 (246) 43.0 (246)
N/mm I I I
Shock absorber stroke 118 (4.6) 118 (4.6) 116 (4.6) 118 (4.6)
Shock Expansion (Ibs.) 1255 1667 1432 1902 (322 528)
absorber 1167 1579 (267 355) 1481 1952 (333 439)
damping force Contraction 471 -706 (106 520
(0.9
<ECLIPSE
Medium price Premium price Premium price
Coil spring Wire diameter 13.5 85.0 125.0 13.6 85.2 125.2 13.8 85.6 125.6
O.D. free length 304.5 3.346 309.5 3.354 315.0 3.370
mm (in.) 4.921 11.988) 4.929 12.165) 4.945 12.402)
Identification color Cream Purple Cream Red Cream Light blue
Spring constant 43.0 (246) 43.0 (246) 43.0 (246)
N/mm
Shock absorber stroke 118 (4.6) 118 (4.6) 118 (4.6)
Shock Expansion (Ibs.) 1206 1638 (271 368)
absorber
damping force
[at Contraction 471 -706 (106 159)
(0.9
TSB Revision
FRONT Service
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Toe-in mm (in.) (0
.
Steering angle Inner wheel
Outer wheel I
AWD
Camber FWD (Vehicles with wheels)
FWD (Vehicles with wheels), AWD
Caster
Upper arm ball joint breakaway torque Nm 0.3 2.5 (3 22)
Compression lower arm ball joint breakaway torque Nm 0.5 2.5 (4 22)
Lateral lower arm ball joint breakaway torque Nm 1.5 (13) or less
Stabilizer link ball joint breakaway torque Nm
SPECIAL TOOLS
Spring compressor
cover installation”
0 Ball joint remover and
installer
TSB Revision
FRONT __
,
TROUBLESHOOTING .
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Steering wheel is heavy, vibrates Suspension malfunction
or pulls to one side ,,
Ball joint Adjust or replace
Coil spring Adjust or replace
Wheel alignment Adjust or
Unbalanced or worn tires Adjust or replace
Excessive vehicle rolling Broken or deteriorated stabilizer Replace
Shock absorber malfunction
Improper tire inflation pressure
FRONT WHEEL
ADJUSTMENT
Measure wheel alignment with alignment equipment on a
level surface.
The ‘front’ ‘suspension, and should
be serviced to normal to wheel
alignment.
TOE-IN
The suspension wheel be
to
Standard value: 0 3 mm 0 in.
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION On-vehicle Service
NOTE .
1. If the toe-in is not standard value, adjust the
toe-in by undoing, the and the left arid
tie rod by the same amount (in opposite direc-
tions).
2. The toe will move out as the is turned
toward the front of the vehicle and the
is turned toward the rear of the vehicle.
STEERING ANGLE
Standard value:
Inner wheel
(AWD)
Outer wheel
(FWD)
(AWD)
CAMBER
Standard value:
(Vehicles with lbinch wheels)
(Vehicles with wheels), AWD
CASTER
Standard value:
NOTE
1. Camber and caster are preset at the’factory and cannot
be adjusted.
2. If camber is not within the standard value, check
replace bent or damaged parts.
3. For vehicles with aluminum type’ wheels, attach the
camber/caster/kingpin gauge to the drive shaft by ‘using
the special tool. Tighten the special tool, to the same
torque Nm as drive shaft
nut.
Caution
Never subject the wheel bearings to the load
when the drive shaft nuts are loosened.
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION Upper Arm .
UPPER ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
Front Wheel Alignment Adjustment
(Refer to
57
41
Removal steps
1. Upper arm ball joint and knuckle 3. Upper arm assembly
connection 4. Upper arm shaft assembly
2. Upper arm self-locking nut
Caution
1. Use the special tool to loosen the
loosen the nut: do not from the
2. the special tool with cord; etc. to prevent
it from coming
Nut
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION Upper Arm Assembly
00000009
INSPECTION
l Check the bushings for wear and deterioration.
l Check the upper arm for bends or damage.
l Check all bolts for condition and straightness.
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION Upper Arm .,
44
32
88
65
65
Removal steps
1. Stabilizer link mounting nut 5. Damper fork
2. Shock absorber upper mounting 6. Shock absorber assembly
nuts
3. Shock absorber lower mounting Caution
bolt l: Indicates parts which should be tightened,
4. Damper fork mounting bolt and then fully tightened the veh on the ground
in the unladen condition.
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION Shock Absorber
- -
12
Disassembly steps
nut 7. Upper bushing
8. assembly
Upper bushing A . .
4. Upper bracket assembly 10. Dust cover
5. Upper spring pad
6. Collar 12. Shock
(2) While holding the piston rod, remove the self-locking nut.
Caution
Do not use an impact wrench to the
tool bolt.
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION Shock Absorber
REASSEMBLY. SERVICE
COIL SPRING INSTALLATION
(1) Use the special tools to the coil spring and
install it to the shock absorber.
Caution
Do not use an impact wrench to tighten the bolt of
the special tool.
(2) Align the edge of the coil spring to the stepped part of
the shock spring seat.
. ..
SELF-LOCKING NUT
(1)
(2). the special tools and
tighten the to- the ,
Caution
Do not use an impact wrench.
TSB Revision
Compression Lower and
FRONT SUSPENSION Lower Arm
98-118
\
69-78
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION
TSB Revision
Compression Arm and
FRONT SUSPENSION Lateral Lower Arm Assemblies,
TSB Revision
STABILIZER BAR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
39 Nm
28
Removal steps
1. Stabilizer link mounting nut 4. Bushing
2. Stabilizer link 5. Stabilizer bar
3. Stabilizer bar bracket
INSPECTION
l Check the bushings for wear and deterioration.
l Check the stabilizer bar for deterioration or damage.
l Check all bolts for condition and straightness.
TSB Revision
FRONT SUSPENSION ,,
Al
TSB Revision
6
.
NOTES
I’
.
REAR
SUSPENSION-
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
A newly-developed multi-link type of suspension bushing have been rationalized to provide both
has been adopted for the rear suspension. The excellent steering stability and riding comfort.
layout of each arm and the rigidity of each
<ECLIPSE> .
Medium price, High price,’ Premium price-FWD Premium price-AWD
Low price.
Coil spring Wire diameterx 75.2 117.2
length 2.953 4.606 2.953 360.5 2.961
11.929)’ 11.929) 11.830)
Identification Purple 2 Purple 2
color
Spring constant 26.5 (151) 26.5 (151)
Shock absorber stroke mm (in.) 154 (6.1) 154 (6.1) 154 (6.1)
Shock Expansion
absorber
damping
force Contraction
. . .
<ECLIPSE
Items “Medium price ,
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION General Information
Shock absorber
Upper arm
control arm
with aero
Trailing arm
00003694
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Service Specifications/Special
, tools
, .
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value
Toe-in mm (in.) 3
Camber (Vehicles with 1 wheels)
FWD (Vehicles with wheels),
Dimension for positioning upper arm bracket 37.2% 2
Thrust angle
Toe control arm ball joint breakaway torque
Stabilizer link ball joint breakaway torque 3)
SPECIAL TOOLS
Preload socket
.
installation
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Squeaks or other Loose rear suspension mounting bolts and nuts Retighten
normal noise
Malfunction of shock absorber Replace
Worn bushings
Upper arms and/or lower arms and/or toe control
arm deformed or damaged
Trailing arms deformed or damaged
Crossmember deformed or damaged
Poor ride Excessive tire inflation pressure Adjust the pressure
Malfunction of shock absorber Replace
Weak or broken springs
Stabilizer bar and/or stabilizer link
or damaged .
Body tilting Weak or deteriorated bushings Replace
Weak or broken springs
Upper arms and/or lower arms and/or toe control
arm deformed or damaged
Trailing arms deformed or damaged
Crossmember deformed or damaged
TSB Revision
34-6 REAR SUSPENSION Service
REAR WHEEL
ADJUSTMENT ,
Measure. wheel alignment with
ground.
The rear suspension and be serviced to the
normal condition prior to wheel alignment.
..
T O E - I N
Standard 3 3 mm. in.)
Turn the toe control arm bolt to the left or right.
by equal amounts to adjust.
L.H.: Turning clockwise toe-out direction
R.H.: Turning clockwise toe-in
Furthermore, toe adjustment can be made at graduations
of 1.3 mm tn.).
CAMBER’
Standard value:
(Vehicles with wheels)
wheels), AWD
NOTE
1. Camber is preset at the’factory and can not be adjusted.
2. If is not within the, standard value, check and
bent or
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Rear Suspension
.
137-157
99-114 .
l .
11
Removal steps
1. Propeller shaft connection Cap
2. Brake caliper assembly 8. Shock absorber mounting nuts
with disc brakes> 9. Rear wheel-speed sensor connector
3. Brake disc with disc with
brakes> or brake drum <Vehicles 10. Grommet
with drum brakes> 11. Trailing arm mounting bolt
4. Parking brake cable end 12. mounting self-locking
(Refer to GROUP 36 Parking
Brake Cable Brake>.) 13. Rear suspension assembly
(Refer to GROUP 36 Parking
Brake Cable <Drum-In-Disk Brake>.) Caution
5. Brake hose connection indicates parts should temporarily tightened,
<Vehicles with drum brakes> and then fully tightened with the vehicles on theground
in the unladen
6. Upper arm bracket mounting bolts
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Rear Suspension Assembly .
INSPECTION
l Check crossmember for cracks or damage.
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Upper ‘Arm
39 Nm
4 57 Nm
57 Nm
41
Removal steps
1. Upper arm and knuckle connecting
bolt
2. arm assembly mounting Caution
Indicates parts which should be temporarily tightened,
3. Upper arm assembly and then full tightened with the on the ground
in the unla en condition.
4. Upper arm bracket
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Upper Arm Assembly
Upper arm
INSTALLATION
Upper arm
bracket UPPER ARM
Tighten the upper arm installation bolt
that the dimension shown in the at the
value.
Standard value (A) 37.2 2 mm (1.46 in.)
Upper arm bracket
installation nut and bolt
NOTE
If the upper arm bracket is with
standard value, the dimensibn is
follows;
Center of the
arm
INSPECTION
l Check the bushings for wear and deterioration.
l Check the upper arm for bends
l Check all bolts for condition and
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Trailing Arm Assembly
118-137
85-99
137-157
steps
1. Knuckle and trailing arm assembly
connecting bolt Indicates parts which should be
2. Grommet and then fully tightened with the vehicles on the ground
in the unladen condition.
3. Trailing arm assembly mounting bolt
4. Stopper
5. Trailing arm assembly
TSB Revision
2 REAR SUSPENSION Lower Arm and Toe
LOWER ARM AND TOE CONTROL ARM ASSEMBLIES
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
l Wheel Alignment Check and Adjustment
, ,
(Refer to
89-78
39 Nm
Lower arm assembly removal steps Toe control arm assembly removal
1. Lower arm cover steps
<Vehicles with aero parts> 7. Toe control arm ball joint and
2. Stabilizer link ball joint and lower knuckle ,
arm connection 6. control mounting
3. ABS wheel-speed sensor clamp
bolts with 9. arm
4. Lower arm assembly and knuckle ,
connecting bolt Caution
5. Lower arm assembly mounting bolt l Indicates which should tightened,
6. Lower arm assembly and then fully with on the ground
in the unladen
TSB ..
REAR SUSPENSION Lower Arm and Toe Control Arm Assemblies
CONTROL, ARM
Toe control arm side BOLT REMOVAL
Eccentric
Make mating marks on the toe control arm’ and eccentric
cam bolt before removing the bolt.
INSPECTION
l Check the bushings for wear and deterioration.
l Check the lower arm or toe control arm for bends or
damage.
l Check bolts for condition and straightness.
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Shock Absorber
. .
SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY 34100510067
98 Nm
Removal steps
1. Cap
2. Flange nuts
3. Bolt
4. Shock absorber
INSPECTION
l Check the rubber parts for cracks
l Check the shock, absorber for oil leakage
or abnormal noise.
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Shock Absorber
22 Nm
16
. 10
Disassembly steps
nut 7. Collar
8. Cup assembly
Upper bushing A 9. Dust cover
4. Upper bracket assembly 10. Bump rubber
5. Upper spring pad 11. Coil spring
6. Upper bushing 12. Shock absorber assembly
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Shock
(2) Align the edge of the coil spring to the stepped part of
the shock absorber spring seat.
Coil spri
edge
UPPER BRACKET
Bracket
the bracket as shown in the ,
.
Revision
REAR
INSPECTION
l Check the rubber parts
l Check the coil springs for crack, deterioration.
,
STABILIZER BAR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION,
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
l Lower Arm Cover Removal and Installation
<Vehicles with aero (Refer to
9-14
39
2 8
Removal steps
1. Stabilizer link mounting nuts
2. Stabilizer link
3. Stabilizer bar bracket
4. Bushing
5. Stabilizer bar
TSB Revision
SUSPENSION Bar
INSPECTION ,
l Check the bushings for wear and,
l Check the stabilizer bar
l Check all bolts for condition and straightness:-
.
.. ,
TSB Revision
REAR SUSPENSION Stabilizer Bar
Clip ring
Al
TSB Revision
NOTES
SERVICE BRAKES
CONTENTS
NOTE
Vehicles with ABS.
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM
, Front
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE. SYSTEM Service Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value Limit
Brake pedal height mm (in.) ( 6 . 9 - 7 . 1 )
Front disc brake drag force (tangential force of wheel mounting bolts) 69 (15.4) or less
(tbs.)
Front brake disc run-out mm (in.)
Front hub end play mm (in.) 0.05
Rear disc brake drag force (tangential force of wheel mounting bolts) 69 (15.4) or less
(Ibs.)
Rear brake disc thickness mm (in.) 10 8 . 4
TSB Rev i s i o n I
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Tools
, ,
LUBRICANTS
Specified lubricant
Brake fluid or
Brake piston seal Repair kit grease
,
Slide pin boot and slide pin bush inner surfaces
Brake piston boot inner surfaces .
Lock pin boot inner surfaces
Guide pin boot inner surfaces
Piston boot mounting grooves
Piston cup surface
Rear brake shoe and backing plate contact surfaces Brake grease 1
Shoe and lining assembly and auto adjuster assembly con-
tact surfaces
“.
Shoe and lever assembly and auto adjuster assembly con-
tact surfaces
. . .. .
SEALANT
Items Specified sealant
Thread part fitting ATD Part No. 8861 or equivalent sealant ,
Vacuum switch .
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Application
General service tool Compressing front disc
piston
Installation of drum brake
wheel cylinder piston cup
Brake tool set
TSB Rev i s i o n
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Vehicle pulls to one Grease or oil on pad or lining surface Replace
side when brakes are
applied Inadequate contact of pad or lining Correct
Auto adjuster malfunction Adjust
Drum out of round or uneven wear Repair or replace as necessary
Insufficient braking Low or deteriorated brake fluid Refill or change
power
Air in brake system Bleed air from system
Overheated brake rotor due to dragging of pad or
lining
Inadequate contact of pad or lining
Brake booster malfunction
Clogged brake line
Grease or oil on pad or lining surface Replace
Proportioning valve malfunction
Auto adjuster malfunction Adjust
pedal Air in brake system Bleed air from system
(Reduced
to floorboard Worn lining or pad Replace
Broken vacuum hose
Faulty master cylinder
Brake fluid leaks Correct
Auto adjuster malfunction Adjust
Excessive push rod to master cylinder clearance
drag Incomplete release of parking brake Correct
Clogged master cylinder return port
Incorrect parking brake adjustment Adjust
Incorrect push rod to master cylinder clearance
Faulty master cylinder piston return spring Replace
Worn brake pedal return spring
Broken rear drum brake shoe return spring
Lack of lubrication in sliding parts Lubricate
TSB Rev i s i o n
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Troubleshooting .
Groaning clicking or Stones or foreign material trapped inside wheel Remove stones,
rattling noise when covers
brakes are not applied
Loose wheel nuts Retighten
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM . ,
ON-VEHICLE
BRAKE PEDAL
BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT ,
(1) Turn up the carpet, etc. under the brake pedal.
(2). Measure the brake “height as illustrated.
Standard value (A): mm (6.9-7.1 in.)
(3). If the brake pedal height is’not within the standard;
value, adjust as follows.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM
CLEARANCE B E T W E E N B R A K E AND
REWALL
(1) Turn up the carpet, etc. under the brake pedal,
(2) Start the engine, depress the brake pedal with
490 (110 of force.
Standard value 90 mm (3.5 in.)
(3) If the clearance is less than the standard value, check
for air trapped in the brake line,
the lining and the drum, and dragging in the parking
brake.
Adjust and replace defective parts as required.
(4) Turn back the carpet, ,
.
4
with auto-cruise
control system a
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM On-vehicle Service
Good No good
BRAKE BOOSTER OPERATING
For simple checking of the brake booster operation, carry
out the following tests:
1. Run the engine for one or two minutes; and then turn
the engine off.
If the pedal depresses fully the first time but gradually
becomes higher when depressed succeeding times, the
booster is operating properly. If the height remains
unchanged, the booster is defective.
000001
When engine is When engine is 2. With the engine stopped, step on the brake pedal several
stopped started times.
Then step on the brake pedal and start the engine.
If the pedal moves downward slightly, the booster is in
good condition. If there is no change, the booster is
defective.
.
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Service
Caution
If the check valve is defective, replace it as an
assembly unit together with the vacuum hose.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM
.
Pressure gauge VALVE
output
pressure
Input pressure
(2) Check that the output at the standard
value when the input fluid pressure increases;
according to the table
Standard value:
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM
BLEEDING 35199149955
Caution
Use the specified brake fluid. use mixture of the
specified brake fluid and another fluid.
Specified brake fluid:
CYLINDER BLEEDING
The master cylinder has no so if bleeding is
carried out by the following procedure, bleeding of air from
the brake line will become easier.
(1) Fill the reserve tank fluid.
(2). Keep the brake pedal depressed.
(3) Have another person cover the master cylinder outlet
with a finger.
(4) With the outlet still closed, release the brake pedal.
(5) Repeat steps three or four times to fill the inside
of the master cylinder with brake fluid.
Revision
4 SYSTEM Service
196-255 Nm
145-188
Pad assembly 9. Apply grease to the attaching faces of pad and inner
shim and to the attaching faces of outer shims.
Apply so as not to spread it out from the edge of shim.’
Specified grease:
Brake grease SAE
Caution
1. Do, not deposit grease or on pad or
brake disc friction surfaces’.
2. The grease should be so it does not
Grease Grease Al protrude from the surfaces.
10. Be careful that the piston boot does not catch and
as the caliper assembly and lock’ pin are installed.
11. Check brake drag torque as
(1) Start engine and hold brake pedal
[Pedal depression force: approx. 196 (44 Ibs.)]
(2) Stop engine.
(3) Turn brake disc forward. times,
TSB Revision
BRAKE SYSTEM .
7
Caution
To maintain safe braking performance, the disc brake rotors must be kept within allowable service
specifications.
Before re-finishing or re-processing the brake disc surface, the following conditions should be checked.
Inspection items Remarks
Scratches, rust, saturated lining l If the vehicle is not driven for a the of the
and wear discs that are not in contact with lining will become rusty, causing
noise and shudderin .
l If grooves resulting rom excessive disc wear and scratches are
not removed prior to installing a new pad assembly, there will
tarily be inappropriate contact between the disc and the lining (pad).
Run-out or drift Excessive run-out or drift of the discs will increase the pedal depression
resistance due to piston knock-back.
Change in thickness (parallelism) If the thickness of the disc changes, this will cause pedal pulsation,
shuddering and surging.
Inset or warping (flatness) Overheating and improper handling while servicing will cause inset or
warping.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM On-vehicle Service
(2) Remove the brake disc, and then place a dial gauge
as shown in the illustration; then move the hub in
the axial direction and measure the play.
Limit: 0.05 mm in.)
If the play is equivalent to or exceeds the limit,
disassemble the hub knuckle and check each part.
TSB Revision I
BASIC On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision I
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM . .
BRAKE DRUM
<VEHICLES WITH REAR DRUM BRAKES>
1. Remove the brake drum.
2. Measure the inside diameter ‘of “and drum at
two or more locations.
Limit: 231 mm (9.1 in.)
3. Replace brake drums, shoe and when’
wear exceeds the limit value or is badly out of balance.
..
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM On-vehicle Service
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM ,,
<M/T>
30 30 Nm
22 22
10
‘6 6
3
2
Removal steps
1. Brake return spring 9. Brake pedal shaft bolt
10. Bushing
11. Spacer
pin 12. Brake pedal
5. Shift lock cable connection 13. Pedal pad
Brake pedal assembly 14. Stop light switch
7. Cotter pin 15. Pedal support member assembly
8. Link assembly
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Master Cylinder and Brake Booster
10 Nm
15 Nm 7 14 Nin
11 10
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM, Master Cvlinder Brake Booster”
Grease points
Fitting
1410249
SERVICE POINT
BOOSTER REMOVAL Engine
(Turbo) and Engine>
Slide the engine forward and remove the brake booster from
,
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Master Cylinder arid Brake
Straight scale
- -
Straight scale
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Master Brake Booster
‘ I
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Master and ‘Brake
MASTER CYLINDER
DISASSEMBLY AND REASSEMBLY
Brake fluid: or
Disassembly steps
1. Reservoir bracket 11. Connector
2. Reservoir hoses 12. Grommet
3. Reservoir cap assembly 13. Piston stopper ring
4. Diaphragm 14. Primary piston assembly
5. Reservoir cap 15. Secondary piston assembly
6. Brake fluid level sensor 16. Master cylinder body
7. Float
8. Reservoir Caution
9. Pin Do not disassemble the and secondary
10. Retainer assemblies.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Master Cvlinder and’
INSPECTION
Check the inner
or pitting.
Check the primary and secondary pistons for rust, scoring,
wear, damage or wear.
Check the diaphragm for cracks and wear.
TSB Revision
BASIC SYSTEM Front
88 Nm
6 5
Removal steps
1. Brake hose connection
2. Gasket
assembly
INSTALLATION SERVICE
FRONT BRAKE ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
Install the front brake assembly and measure the disc brake
drag torque. (Refer to
INSPECTION
Check the brake disc for damage.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Front Disc Brake
74 Nm
54 2
74 Nm
54
5 7
Brake caliper kit Pad repair kit Seal and boots repair kit
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Front Disc
LUBRICATION POINTS
Inner shi
Caution
The piston seal inside the seal and
boot kit is coated with special
grease. Do not wipe this grease off.
Grease: grease SAE
Brake fluid: or
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Front
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
When disassembling the disc brakes, disassemble both sides
(left and right) as a set.
PISTON BOOT/PISTON
Protect caliper body with cloth. Blow compressed air through
brake hose to remove piston boot and
Caution
Blow air gently.
SEAL REMOVAL
(1) Remove piston seal with finger tip.
Caution
Do not use a flat-tipped screwdriver or other tool to
prevent damage to inner cylinder.
(2) Clean piston surface and, inner cylinder with
trichloro-ethylene, alcohol, or specified brake fluid.
Specified brake fluid:
(2) Install the guide pin and lock pin as illustrated eath
Lock pin head mark of the auide and the pin matches
the indication or located the caliper
body.
TSB Revision
BRAKE SYSTEM Front Disc
INSPECTION
l Check cylinder for wear, rust.
l Check piston surface for wear, damage or rust.
l Check caliper body or sleeve for wear.
l Check pad for damage or adhesion of grease, check
backing metal for damage.
Caution
1. When the limit is exceeded, the brake pads on both
the left and right wheels must be replaced as a set.
2. If there is a significant difference in the thicknesses
of the pads on the left and right check the
sliding condition of the piston, lock pin and guide
pin.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Front Disc Brake’
74 Nm 2
54
3
74 Nm
54
00003546
15
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Front Brake
LUBRICATION POINTS
Inner ter
Cautiqn
The piston seal inside the seal and
boot kit is coated with special
grease, so do not wipe this grease
Brake fluid: or
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE Front Disc . . .
00000449
.
REMOVAL
Piston seal
(1) Remove piston with fingertip.
Caution
Do not use a screwdriver or other tool to prevent
damage to inner cylinder.
(2) Clean piston surface and inner’ cylinder with
trichloro-ethylene, or brake
Specified brake fluid: or
REASSEMBLY
BOOT/BUSHING/LOCK PIN
INSTALLATION
(1) Grease parts as illustrated with grease.
Lock pin
Guide pin
Specified grease: Repair
,
, , .
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Front Disc
INSPECTION
l Check cylinder for wear, damage or rust.
l Check piston surface for wear, damage or rust:
l Check caliper body or sleeve for wear.
l Check pad for damage or adhesion of check
backing metal for damage.
Caution
1. When the limit is exceeded, the brake pads on both
the left and right wheels must be replaced as a set.
2. If there is a significant difference the thicknesses
of the pads on the left and right sides, check
sliding condition of the piston, lock pin and
pin.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear Drum Brake Shoe
21 1 6
Removal steps
1. Brake drum 12. Shoe and lever assembly
2. Lever return spring 13. Retainer
3. Shoe-to-lever spring 14. Wave washer
4. Adjuster lever 15. Parking lever
5. Auto adjuster assembly 16. Shoe and lining assembly
6. Retainer spring 17. Shoe hold-down pin
7. Shoe hold-down cup 18. for the brake pipe
8. Shoe hold-down spring 19. Snap ring
9. Shoe hold-down cup 20. Rear hub assembly
10. Shoe-to-shoe spring 21. Backing plate
11. Shoe and lining assembly
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear Brake
REMOVAL
Pin shoe assembly
RETAINER REMOVAL
Use an flat-tipped screwdriver or the like to up the
retainer joint, and remove the retainer.
Retainer
Parking lever
RETAINER
Pin of shoe assembly
Use pliers or the like to install the retainer on the pin securely.
Retainer
TSB Revision 1
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear Drum
. ,
Removal steps
1. Brake drum
2. spring
3. Shoe-to-shoe spring
4. Auto adjuster assembly
5. Brake pipe connection
6. Wheel cylinder
7. Bleeder screw
TSB Revision
SYSTEM Rear Drum Brake
Grease: Repair kit grease (orange’) Brake fluid: or Wheel cylinder repair kit
Disassembly steps
1. Boots
2. Piston assembly
3. Pistons
4. Piston cups
5. Wheel cylinder body
TSB Revision ,
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear Drum Brake
. .
--
Have the piston cup
lip facing upwards.
..
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear Disc Brake
49-59
36-43
Removal steps .
1. Brake hose connection
2. Rear brake assembly
3. Brake disc
INSPECTION
l Check the brake disc for damage.
l Check the brake disc for thickness.
l Check the brake disc for run-out.
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear disc
74 Nm
54
74
54
14 5
Brake caliper kit Pad repajr kit Seal and boots repair kit
TSB Revision
BASIC B R AKE SYSTEM Rear Disc
LUBRICATION POINTS
I
Grease: Repair kit grease I
Caution
The piston seal inside the seal and
boot kit is coated with special grease.
Do not wipe this grease off.
Brake fluid: or Grease: Repair kit grease
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE SYSTEM Rear Disc Brake
REASSEMBLY SERVICE
BOOT/BUSHING/LOCK PIN’
INSTALLATION
Grease parts as illustrated with specified grease.
Lock
Specified grease: Repair kit grease (orange)
Guide
.
.
INSPECTION
l Check cylinder’for wear, damage or rust.”
l Check piston surface for wear, damage or
l Check caliper body or sleeve for wear.
l Check pad for damage or adhesion of grease, check
backing metal for damage.,
. .
, .
Caution
1. When the limit is exceeded, the both
the left and right wheels must be as a
2. If there is a significant difference In
of the pads on the left and rlght check the
sliding condition of the piston, pin and guide
pin.
,
TSB Revision
PROPORTIONING VALVE ,
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION’ .
Operation Operation
l Brake Fluid Draining l Brake
l Link Assembly Removal l Brake Line fer
Engine (Turbo) and Engine> l Link Assembly Bolts Installation
(Refer to GROUP Control.) Engine
l Intake Manifold (Refer’ to
Engine (Non-turbo)> Intake Manifold
(Refer to Manifold.) Engine
(Refer: GROUP
11
00000074
Removal steps
1. Brake pipe connection
2. Proportioning valve
TSB Revision
BASIC BRAKE ,
TSB Revision
CONTENTS
ABS-ECU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The ABS consists of wheel speed sensors, stop The diagnostic trouble code will not be erased even
light switch, hydraulic unit and the ABS-ECU. If if the ignition switch is turned to OFF.
a problem occurs in the system, the malfunctioning In addition, reading of diagnostic trouble codes,
system can be identified by means of the diagnostic service testing are possible using
function. the scan
Items ,
Wheel speed sensor Magnet coil type
Front ABS rotor teeth 4 3
Rear ABS rotor teeth 43
DIAGRAM
TSB Revision
,
ABS Service Specifications/Special
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS 2
TSB Revision
ABS
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING
Gather information from customer
No
No diagnostic .
trouble code or
No diagnostic
trouble
Check diagnostic trouble codes
(Refer to
Inspection chart for trouble symptoms Inspection chart for diagnostic trouble
(Refer to codes (Refer to
System check sound When starting the engine, a thudding sound can sometimes be heard coming from inside .
the engine compartment, but this is because the system operatioh check is being
performed. This is considered normal.
ABS operation sound 1. Sound of the motor inside the ABS hydraulic unit. operating (whine),
2. Sound is generated along with vibration of the brake’ pedal.
3. When ABS operates, sound is generated from the vehicle chassis due
brake application and release.
(Thump: suspension; squeak: tires)
ABS operation For road surfaces such as snow-covered roads and gravel roads, the braking distance for
(Long braking distance) vehicles with ABS can sometimes be longer than that for other vehicles. Accordingly,
advise the customer to drive safely on such roads by lowering the vehicle speed and not
being overconfident.
TSB Revision
(1) Use the special tool code check
harness) to ground the terminal (1) of the data link
connector.
,
.
NOTE
Diagnostic trouble code No. 16 can be output when the
ABS system fails because of a battery surge.
ABS
Ignition switch ON
OFF
Generator
terminal voltage
I
I
Warning light ON
OFF _ _
ABS-ECU memory .
.. Eliminated
TSB Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
Detection conditions
A: During system check immediately after starting
When driving
TSB Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
NG
Repair
(Refer to
OK
NG NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector Check the following connectors: Repair
l Disconnect the connector and mea- l
sure at the harness side. and
l Resistance value between terminals I
OK
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
l
OK
1
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
TSB Revision
ABS
NG
Repair
(Refer to
N G
Repair
Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
Caution
If the battery voltage drops during check, this code will be output as a current and correct
diagnostic of the problem cannot be made.
Before carrying out the following check, check the battery condition;
NG
Measure at the ABS-ECU connector Repair
549, and ..
l
OK Check the or
. N G
Check the following connector:
OK
Check trouble symptoms Replace ABS-ECU.
NOTE
1. Momentary interruptions within approximately 100 ms are not detected.
2. To inspect the twisted pair wires in the wheel speed sensor, check if there is
cables, and flex the cables to check for any open circuits.
NG
Repair
(Refer to
NG
Wheel speed sensor check Replace the wheel speed sensor.
check (Refer to (Refer to
Wheelspeedsensorbody-side harness
TSB Revision
ABS
Yes
NG
Check the following connector: Repair
l
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
Revision
ABS
O K
NG
NG Check the following Repair
Measure at ABS-ECU connector
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side
l Resistance value between terminals
22-17. 22-19 and
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
TSB Revision
Code No. 51 Valve Probable cause
[Comment] of ABS valve relay
When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ABS-ECU switches relay OFF Malfunction of harness or
and ON for an initial check, compares the voltage of the signal to the valve relay l Malfunction of hydraulic unit
and valve power monitor line voltage to. check whether the valve relay is l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
normal. In addition, normally it monitors whether or not there is power in the valve
power monitor line since the valve relay is normally ON. If the supply of power ,
to the valve power monitor line is interrupted, this diagnostic trouble code will be
output.
OK
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector ) R e p a i r
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side. ,
l Resistance value between terminals
OK
2 27
Check trouble symptom.
OK
OK
.
NG
Repair
l
OK
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
TSB Revision
Code No. 53 Motor relay, motor system
[Comment]
The ABS-ECU outputs this diagnostic trouble code for the motor relay and motor
in the following cases.
l When motor relay is ON and no signal is input to the motor monitor line (when
motor is not operating, etc.)
l
5 seconds or more (when motor continues operating, etc.)
l When the motor relay does not function
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector Check the following ,
l Disconnect the connector and l
OK
Check trouble
NG
Repair
.
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
.
ABS WARNING LIGHT CHECK’
Check that the ABS warning light as-
1. When the ignition switch is turned
warning light illuminates. .
2. When the ignition switch is turned to “START”, to
the engine, the ABS warning light
1 second.
3. If the is other’ above, check
diagnostic trouble codes.
Revision
6 ABS
Get an understanding of the trouble symptoms and check according to the inspection
Trouble symptom Inspection Reference
page
Communication with scan Communication with all systems is not possible. 1
tool is not possible.
Communication with is not possible. 2 __
When the ignition key is turned to “ON” (engine ABS warning light 3
does not illuminate.
After the engine starts, the ABS warning light remains illuminated.
When the ignition key is turned to “START”, the ABS warning light 5
not illuminate.
After the ignition key is turned to “ON”, the ABS warning light blinks once, and 6
when turned to “START”, it illuminates. When returned to “ON”, the light flashes
once, and then switches off.
Faulty ABS operation Unequal braking power on both sides 7
Insufficient braking power
ABS operates under normal braking conditions
ABS operates before vehicle stops under normal
braking conditions
Large brake pedal vibration (Caution 2.)
Caution
1. if steering movements are made when driving at high speed, or when driving on road surfaces
with low frictional resistance, or when passing over bumps, the ABS may operate even though
sudden braking is not being applied. Because of this, when getting information from the customer,
check if the occurred driving under such conditions as these.
2. During ABS operation, changes in the feeling of the brake (vibration may occur or
may not be able to be depressed). Such changes are due to intermittent changes in hydraulic
pressure inside the brake line to prevent the from locking, and is considered normal.
TSB Revision ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE , . , ,
, __ ,
, .
Communication with scan not possible.
(Communication with all is not Probable cause
[Comment] l
The reason is probably a defect in supply system (including ground) for .
the diagnostic line.
....
OK .
NG NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector Repair
l Disconnect the connector and mea- * and
sure at the harness side.
l Ignition switch ON
OK
l Voltage between terminal 18 and Check trouble symptoms
ground.
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK Check the harness between fuse No. .
13 the junction block and
ABS-ECU. Repair, if necessary. .
TSB Revision
ABS Troubleshooting , ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3
When ignition key is turned to “ON” (engine stopped),
ABS warning light does not illuminate
[Comment]
When power is supplied to the ABS-ECU, the valve relay changes from to
ON by the initial check, and thus even if there is a problem with the circuit between
ABS light and ABS-ECU, the light will illuminate once when the valve relay
is OFF.
Accordingly, the cause of the light not illuminating is probably an open circuit in the
light power circuit, a blown light bulb, or an open circuit in both the circuit between
the ABS light and the ABS-ECU and the circuit between the ABS
light and the ABS valve relay.
When other lights also do not illuminate, the cause is probably a blown fuse.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4
Even after the engine is started, the ABS Warning light , .
remains illuminated. .
[Comment] l Malfunction of combination meter
There is probably a short in the ABS warning light illumination circuit. l Malfunction of ABS valve relay
l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
. ,
NOTE
This trouble symptom is limited to cases where communication with the scan tool is’
is normal) and the diagnostic trouble code is a normal diagnostic trouble code. .
YES
Disconnect the ABS-ECU connector Short circuit inside the combination or in the harness
Does the light remain illuminated? between the meter and
NO
.
TSB Revision
When ignition key is turned ABS warning light Probable .
does not illuminate.
[Comment] l o f
The ABS-ECU uses the the which is cut when the ignition switch is’ l
turned to “START”. The ABS light uses power which is not cut even
when the ignition switch is turned to “START”.
Accordingly, because the power to the ABS-ECU is stopped in “START” position,
if the light does not illuminate at this time, the cause is a problem in the __
light illumination circuit in the valve relay.
NG NG
Measure at hydraulic unit connector Repair _..
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Voltaae between terminal and bodv
trouble symptom.
voltage
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
The ABS warning light flashes once after the ignition key Probable cause
is turned to “ON”. The light when
is turned to “START”, and when the is to
it flashes once.
I
[Comment] l Malfunction of wiring harness or
When power flows, the ABS-ECU turns on the warning light for approximately second l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
while it performs a valve relay test. If there is a break in the harness between the
ECU and the light illuminates only when the valve relay is off in valve
relay test, etc.
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector Check the connectors: Repair
l Disconnect the connector and mea- and
sure at the harness side.
TSB Revision I
ABS Troubfeshooting , .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
Break operation is abnormal
[Comment] l Malfunction of wheel speed
This varies depending on the driving conditions and the road surface conditions, so l Malfunction of ABS rotor
problem diagnosis is difficult. However, if a normal diagnostic trouble code is displayed, l Malfunction of wheel bearing
carry out the following of hydraulic
Malfunction of ABS-ECU
NG
Repair
(Refer to
1 NG
Hydraulic unit check (Refer to ABS rotor check (Refer to Replace the rotor.
OK
NG
Wheel bearing end play check Repair
Refer to GROUP 26 On-vehicle
Service.
Refer to GROUP 27 On-vehicle
Service. I
I
Repair
OK
The sensor harness and connector
should be moved while these checks
are carded out.
OK
NG
Repair
.
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Replace ABS-ECU.
TSB Revision
ABS
TSB Revision
ABS Troubleshooting . ,
Ignition OFF o v
Rear solenoid valve (Output)
Ignition switch: ON Battery positive
voltage
Stop light switch (Input) Ignition switch: ON (stop light switch ON) 5 or more
29
Ignition switch: OFF (stop light switch OFF) 1.5 or more
TSB Revision
RESISTANCE AND CONTINUITY CHECK
1. Turn. the ignition switch to OFF.
2. Disconnect the ABS-ECU connector.
3. Measure the resistance and check for continuity between
the terminals of the ABS-ECU connector
while referring to the check chart.
TSB Revision
On-vehicle. Service
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
Caution
Use the specified brake fluid. Avoid using a mixture of
the specified brake fluid and other fluid.
Specified brake fluid: or
MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.
BRAKE LINE BLEEDING
Refer to GROUP On-vehicle Service.
Caution
For with ABS, be sure to filter/strain the brake
fluid ‘being added to the master cylinder reservoir tank.
Debris may damage the HU.
Output voltage .
When measuring with a voltmeter:
or more
When measuring with an oscilloscope:
p-p or more
TSB Revision
Service
, ,
Caution
Connector terminal arrangement 1. Use the special tool to
terminal and resistance.
2. The connector for
is t h e
Terminal arrangement shown on the arrangement shown on the special tool
special tool connector So take the readings from
the special tool when checking.
Example
0 0 0 0 0 0 7 6
connector Terminal
number the-special tool connector
18 1
If output voltage is lower than the above values, the
reason be follows:
l Faulty wheel sensor.
,
I
Inspecting Wave Forms With An Oscilloscope
Use the following method to observe the output voltage wave
L-L-- form from each wheel sensor with an oscilloscope
l Start the engine, and rotate the front wheels by engaging
,
gear (vehicles with manual transaxle) or range
(vehicles with automatic transaxle). Turn the rear wheels
manually so that they rotate at a constant speed.
NOTE
1. Check the connection of the sensor harness and
connector before using the oscilloscope.
When idling (5-6 km/h) -I--- 2. The wave form measurements can also be taken while
gear (manual transaxle) or the vehicle is actually moving.
i range (automatic
.-i--~---;--;---c--?---c--:---;--~--- 3. The output voltage will be low when the wheel speed
is low, and similarly it will be higher as the wheel speed
increases.
Revision
On-vehicle Service .
Points In Waveform Measurement
Symptom Probable causes
Too small or zero waveform Faulty wheel speed sensor Replace sensor
amplitude . .
Waveform amplitude fluctuates Axle hub eccentric or with large Replace
cessively (this is no problem if the
minimum amplitude is 100 or
more)
NOTE
The wheel speed sensor cable moves following motion of the front or rear suspension. Therefore, it is that
it has an open circuit only when driving on rough roads and it functions normally on ordinary roads. is, therefore,
recommended to observe sensor output voltage waveform also under conditions, such as rough road driving.
Revision
ABS
Caution
Turn the ignition switch off before connecting or
disconnecting the scan tool.
1. up the vehicle and support the vehicle with rigid
racks placed at the specified jack-up points or place the
wheels which are checked on the rollers of the braking
force tester.
Caution
1. The roller of the braking force tester and the tire
be dry during testing.
2. When testing the front brakes, apply the parking
brake, and when testing the rear brakes, stop the
front by chocking them.
2. Release the parking brake, and feel the drag force (drag
torque) on each road wheel. . __
When using the braking force tester, take a reading of’
the brake drag force.
3. Turn the ignition key to ‘the OFF position and
scan tool as shown in the diagram.
4. After checking that the shift lever or
lever is in neutral, start the engine.
NOTE
1. At this time, the ABS system will switch scan
tool mode -and the warning light will
2. When the ABS has’ been interrupted by the -fail-safe
function, the tool actuator testing cannot be
used.
5. Use the scan tool to force-drive the actuator.
TSB Revision
ABS On-vehicle Service
Rear wheel
Depressed ---!---;---t---!---:---~---;---:---i---~--
I Scan tool actuator test
Released , ,, (Item Nos. 04, 05) start --C--y----L--
, ,
Increase in pressure
Reduction in pressure
(when not working)
Steady pressure
Lock
Diagnosis Table
(1) Depress brake pedal to Brake force re- Wheel does not Clogged brake Check and clean
lock wheel. leased for 6 se- lock when brake line other than brake line
(2) Using the scan tool, conds after lock- pedal is de- HU
04
select the wheel to be ing. pressed.
checked and force the Clogged hydrau- Replace HU
actuator to operate. circuit in HU sembly
(3) Turn the selected wheel
manually to check the Brake force is not Incorrect HU Connect
change of brake force. released brake tube con-
05
HU solenoid Replace HU
valve not sembly
tioning correctly
TSB Revision
ABS
__ .
TSB Revision
ABS On-vehicle Service
Motor Relay
When no current Between terminals
flows
Between terminals No continuity
TSB Revision
ABS On-vehicle Service
Engine (Turbo)>
When booster cables are used to start the engine when the
battery is completely
immediately driven without waiting for the battery to
itself to some extent, the engine may, making
1’
driving difficult.
This happens because ABS consumes. a great amount
current for its self-check function. The remedy is to either
allow the battery to recharge or to remove the
fusible link for circuit, thus disabling the anti-lock brake
system.
The ABS warning light will illuminate, when link
(for is removes.
After the battery has sufficiently charged, fusible
link (for and restart the engine; then sure
the warning light is not, illuminated.
ABS Master Cylinder and Brake Booster
15
Master cylinder kit
13
Brake fluid:
19
14
steps
Reservoir bracket Retainer
2. Reservoir hose 12. Connector
3. Reservoir cap assembly 13. Grommet
4. Diaphragm 14. Piston stopper bolt
5. Reservoir cap 15. Gasket
6. Filter 16. Piston stopper ring
7. Brake fluid level sensor 17. Primary piston assembly
8, Float 18. piston assembly
9. Reservoir 19. Master cylinder body
10. Pin
Caution
Do not disassemble the primary and secondary piston assembly.
TSB Revision
ABS Master Cylinder and Brake’ Booster
. . ,
INSPECTION
l <’ Check the inner surface of master cylinder body for
corrosion
l Check the primary and secondary for corrosion,
scoring, damage or wear.
l Check the diaphragm for
ABS
PROPORTIONING VALVE
REMOVAL AND
Operation Post-installation
l Brake Fluid Draining l Brake Fluid. ing
l Link Assembly Mounting Bolts Removal l Brake
Engine (Turbo) and Engine> (Refer to GROUP l Link bolts’ Installation
17 Auto-Cruise Control.) Engine (Turbo and (Refer to GROUP
l Manifold Removal Engine (Non-turbo)> 17 Auto-Cruise
(Refer to GROUP 15 Intake Manifold.) l Intake Engine
(Non-turbo)> (Refer to GROUP 15 Intake
Manifold.)
15 Nm
Removal steps
1. Brake pipe
2. Proportioning valve
TSB Revision
ABS
, ,
the pipes to the shown in
the illustration. ,
1. Proportioning valve Rear
4 2. Proportioning valve ,
3. Proportioning valve
4. Proportioning -valve ,
..
,
,
ABS Hydraulic .
.
HYDRAULIC UNIT .
REMOVAL AND
Operation
l Brake Fluid Draining Power Steering Pipe, Pipe
l Splash Shield (L.H.) Removal Clamp: Engine.
(Refer to GROUP 42 Fender.) (Turbo) and .
l Headlight Assembly (L.H.) Removal GROUP
(Refer to GROUP 54 -Headlight, Front Turn-Signal l ‘Power‘ Steering Oil Reservoir Bolts
Light and Position Light Assembly.) (Turbo) and
l Air Cleaner Assembly Removal Engine (Refer’to GROUP Power Hoses.)
(Non-turbo)> l Relay Installation
l Engine Control Module (ECM) Removal (Non-turbo)>
Engine (Non-turbo)> l Engine Control Module (ECM) Installation
l Relay Box Bracket Removal Engine Engine (Non-turbo)>
(Non-turbo)> l Air Cleaner Assembly Installation Engine
l Power Steering Oil Reservoir Mounting Bolts (Non-turbo)>
Removal Engine (Turbo) and l Headlight Assembly (L.H.) Installation
(Refer to GROUP Power Steering Hoses.) (Refer to GROUP 54 Headlight, Front
l Power Steering Pressure Pipe and Return Pipe Light and Position Light Assembly.)
Clamp Mounting Bolts Removal Engine l Splash Shield (L.H.) Installation
Turbo) and Engine> (Refer to GROUP 42 Fender.)
Refer to GROUP Power Steering Hoses.) l Brake Fluid Supplying
l Brake Lines Bleeding (Refer to
l Hydraulic Unit (Refer to
Removal steps
1. Brake pipe connection
2. Harness connector
3. Hydraulic unit assembly
4. Hydraulic unit
5. Hydraulic unit bracket
TSB Revision I
Caution
1. The hydraulic unit is be
taken when
2. The hydraulic unit is its nuts
and bolts be
3. The hydraulic unit must not be dropped or otherwise
subjected to impact shocks.
4. The hydraulic unit must not be turned upside down
or laid on its side.
INSTALLATION POINT
PIPE
Connect the pipes to the shown in the
illustration.
1. Hydraulic Front
2. Rear
3. Hydraulic unit
4. Hydraulic unit ‘Rear
5. Hydraulic unit Master
6. Hydraulic unit Master cylinder (Primary)
ABS Wheel Speed Sensor
Front ,
Rear
49-59
74-66
4
NOTE
The front ABS rotor, integrated with the drive shaft, can not be dis-
assembled.
TSB Revision
ABS Wheel
Front Rear
INSTALLATION
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR/REAR WHEEL
SPEED
The clearance between the wheel speed ABS
rotor’s toothed surface not’ ‘the
distance between the
rotor’s toothed surface.
Standard value: (1.11-1.12 in.)
Front Rear
INSPECTION
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR CHECK
Check whether any metallic foreign material has adhered
to the parts shown in the illustration at the wheel speed
sensor tip, and it so, remove it.
NOTE
The section shown in the illustration can become
magnetized because of the magnet built into the wheel
Magnetic parts
speed sensor, with the result that foreign metallic material
is attached to it.
(2) Measure the resistance between the wheel speed sensor
terminals.
Standard value:
If the internal resistance of the wheel speed sensor is
0
CC
not within the standard value, replace with a new wheel
speed sensor.
TSB Revision
ABS-ECU
Removal steps
1. Control unit cover
2. ABS-ECU
INSPECTION
ABS-ECU CHECK
Refer to
CONTENTS
G-SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 9 4
GENERAL INFORMATION
The ABS consists of wheel speed sensors, stop be erased even if the ignition switch is turned to
light switch, hydraulic unit and the ABS-ECU. If OFF.
a problem occurs in the system, the malfunctioning In addition, reading of diagnostic trouble codes
system can be identified by means of the diagnostic and service data actuator testing are possible
function, and the trouble symptom memory will’ not using the scan tool.
Specifications
Wheel speed sensor Magnet coil type
Front ABS rotor
Rear ABS rotor teeth
D I A G R A M
1. ABS-ECU
2. Hydraulic unit Data
ABS valve relay 9. switch
4. ABS motor relay 10. ABS light
5. Wheel speed sensor 11. G-sensor
6. ABS rotor
TSB Revision
ABS Service Tools
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
. . .
Hydraulic unit solenoid valve internal resistance
Clearance between the wheel speed sensor (1.11-1.12)
mounting surface and the ABS rotor mm (in.)
G-sensor output voltage In laden, stationary 2.4-2.8
With FRONT mark downward 3.3-3.7
Wheel speed sensor insulation resistance or more
SPECIAL TOOLS
Revision
ABS
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING
Gather information from customer
(Refer to
I I
Inspection chart for trouble symptoms Inspection chart for diagnostic trouble
(Refer to codes (Refer to
cope malfunctions.)
ABS operation sound Sound of the motor inside the ABS hydraulic unit operating (whine)
2. Sound is generated along with vibration of the (scraping)
3. When ABS operates, sound is generated from the vehicle chassis due to
brake application and release.
(Thump: suspension; squeak: tires)
ABS operation For road surfaces such as snow-covered roads and gravel roads, the braking distance for
(Long braking distance) vehicles with ABS can sometimes be longer than that for other Accordingly,
advise the customer to drive safely on such roads by lowering the vehicle speed
being overconfident.
. .
Diagnosis detection condition depends on the diagnostic trouble code.
Make sure that checking requirements listed in the “Comment” are satisfied when checking the trouble
symptom again after the diagnostic trouble code has been erased.
TSB Revision
the scan tool to the connector
check diagnostic trouble codes.
Turn the or .
disconnecting the tool., __
With a voltmeter
Use the special tool to connect a the
output ‘terminal’ and the terminal the
link connector. Then take a reading of the diagnostic
‘codes ‘from the movement of the of the
Revision
. . .
INSPECTION CHART FOR DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
Check according to the for the diagnostic trouble
Detection conditions
A: During system check immediately after starting
B: While driving
Revision
INSPECTION PROCEDURE CLASSIFIED BY DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE
Code No. Wheel speed sensor open circuit Probable cause
[Comment] of wheel Speed
The ABS-ECU detects breaks in the wheel speed sensor wire. Malfunction of wiring harness
l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
TSB Revision
Code No. 15 Wheel sensor svstem
[Comment] of .
This diagnostic trouble code is output when there is an abnormality (other than broken l Malfunction of harness
wire or short circuit) in any of the wheel speed sensor output signals while driving. l Malfunction of ABS rotor
The following can be considered as the cause of the wheel speed sensor output l wheel
abnormality. l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
l Distortion of ABS rotor, teeth missing
l Low frequency noise interference when sensor harness is broken
l Noise interference in sensor signal ,
l Sensor output signal is below the standard value or amplitude modulation is over
the standard value. Using an oscilloscope to measure the wave shape of the
wheel speed sensor output signal is very effective.
l Broken sensor harness
Poor connection of connector
I -
NG
Wheel speed sensor insulation check Repair
(Refer to
OK
OK
Check the harness between dedicated
OK
TSB Revision I
ABS , . ,
.
Code No. Solenoid valve system
[Comment] l Malfunction of hydraulic unit
The ABS-ECU monitors the solenoid valve drive circuit. l of
If no current flows in the solenoid even if the ECU turns the solenoid ON or if it l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
continues to flow even when turned OFF, the ECU determines the solenoid coil wire
is broken/short-circuited or the harness is broken/ short-circuited, and then these
diagnostic trouble codes are output.
,
t Repair
l Disconnect the connector and mea- l
sure at the harness side.
OK
l Resistance value between terminals
22-17 and 22-35. Check trouble symptom.
OK
NG
OK
NG
Repair
.
OK
Check trouble Replace the ABS-ECU.
TSB Revision
[Comment] l of relay
When ignition switch is ON, the, switches the valve relay OFF l
and ON for an check, compares of the signal to the valve relay l of hydraulic unit
and valve power monitor line voltage to check whether the relay operation is .
normal. In addition, normally it monitors whether or not there IS power in the valve
power monitor line since the valve relay is normally ON. If. the of power
to the valve power monitor line is interrupted, this diagnostic trouble code be, . .
output. ,
.
NG
Replace the valve
OK
NG
Measure at unit connector
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Voltage between terminal 12 and body
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between terminals
2 27.
Check trouble symptom.
OK
NG
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Countinuity between terminal 22 and
body ground
OK Countinuitv
OK __
NG
Check the connector: Repair
l
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
ABS , ,
ABS motor relay check (Refer to Replace the ABS motor relay.
OK
Check trouble
NG
OK
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Resistance value between terminal 5 Check the motor ground and repair if
and body ground
OK
OK
OK
NG
Check the Repair
.
OK
TSB Revision
ABS CHECK
ABS
1. When the ignition turned to ABS
warning light flashes 4 times during a to
then off.
2. When the ignition to the
warning light remains
3. When the ignition switch’ turned back to the the
ABS warning light times then
switched off. ,
4. If the illumination is other than the the
diagnostic trouble codes.
ABS Illuminated
light Not illuminated
Ignition
switch
00003625
When the ignition key is turned to “ON” (engine stopped), the ABS warning light does 3
not illuminate.
After the engine starts, the ABS warning light remains illuminated. 4
When the ignition key is turned to “START”, the ABS warning light does not 5
illuminate.
After the ignition key is turned to “ON”, the waining light blinks once, and when 6
turned to “START”, it illuminates. When returned to “ON”, the light flashes once, and
then switches off.
braking power .
ABS operates under normal braking conditions
TSB Revision
ABS
Caution
1. If movements are made when driving at speed, or when driving on road
with low frictional resistance, or when passing over bumps, the ABS may
sudden braking is not being applied. of this, when getting
check if the problem occurred while driving under such conditions
2. During ABS operation changes in the feeling of the brake pedal occur or
may not be able to be depressed). Such changes are due to in hydraulic
pressure inside the brake line to prevent, the wheels from locking,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS ,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 1
Communication with scan tool is not possible. Probable cause
(Communication with all systems is not possible.)
[Comment] l Malfunction of connector
The reason is probably a defect in the power supply system (including ground) for l Malfunction harness
the diagnostic line.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
Communication with scan tool is not possible. Probable cause
(Communication with ABS only is not ,
[Comment] l Blown fuse
When communication with the scan tool is not possible, the cause is probably an l Malfunction of wiring harness or connector
open circuit in the ABS-ECU power circuit or an open circuit in the diagnostic output l Malfunction of ABS power relay
circuit. l Malfunction of ABS-ECU ,
l connector and
OK
NG NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector Repair
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Ignition switch ON
l Voltage between terminal 18 and Check trouble symptom.
bodv around. I
positive voltage
OK Check the harness between No
NG
Measure at ABS-ECU connector Repair
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
sure at the harness side.
l Continuity between terminals
and body ground.
OK:
OK
NG
Repair
l
OK
Check trouble symptom. Replace the ABS-ECU.
TSB Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3
ignition key is turned to “ON’? (engine stopped), Probable
ABS warning light does not illuminate
[Comment] l Blown fuse
When power is supplied to the ABS-ECU, the valve relay changes from to OFF l Burnt out light. bulb
ON by the initial check, and thus even if there is a problem with the circuit between l Malfunction of wiring. or connector
ABS warning light and ABS-ECU, the light will illuminate once when the valve relay
is OFF.
Accordingly, the cause of the light not illuminating is probably an open circuit in the
light power circuit, a blown light bulb, or an open circuit in both the circuit between .
the ABS liaht and the ABS-ECU and the circuit between the ABS
light and the relay.
When other lights also do not illuminate, the cause is probably a blown fuse.
NG ,
NG
Measure at combination meter connector Check
l and
l Disconnect the connector and mea-
OK
,
Check the harnesses between the
valve relay and the combination meter,
and between the ABS-ECU and
combination meter (common section).
Repair, if necessary.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4
,
Even after the engine is started, the ABS warning light Probable cause
remains illuminated.
[Comment] l Malfunction of meter
There is probably a short in the ABS light illumination l Malfunction of valve relay
l Malfunction of ABS-ECU
l Malfunction of wiring
NOTE
This trouble symptom is limited to cases where communication with the scan tool is
supply is normal) and the diagnostic trouble code is a normal diagnostic trouble code.
Disconnect the ABS-ECU connector Short circuit inside the combination meter or in the
Does the ABS warning light remain illuminated? between the combination meter and the ABS-ECU.
NO
TSB Revision
,
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
When ignition key is turned to “START”, ABS warning light Probable
does not illuminate.
[Comment] Malfunction
The ABS-ECU uses the power to the which is cut when the ignition switch is l Malfunction of
turned to “START”. The ABS light uses power which is not cut even
when the ignition switch is turned to “START”. .
Accordingly, because the power to the ABS-ECU is stopped in “START” position,
if the light does not illuminate at this time, the cause is a problem in the ,
light illumination circuit in the valve relay.
NG
Measure at Repair
Disconnect the connector and and
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
The ABS warning light flashes once after the ignition key Probable cause
is turned to “ON”. The light illuminates when the ignition ,
key is turned to “START”, and when the key is returned to
“ON”, it flashes once.
[Comment] Malfunction of harness or connector
When power flows, the ABS-ECU turns on the light for approximately 1 second Malfunction of
while it performs a valve relay test. If there is a break in the harness between the
ECU and the light illuminates only when the valve relay is off in the valve
relay test, etc.
OK
NG
Check trouble symptom. Replace the
TSB Revision
, , .
PROCEDURE 7
Break operation is
[Comment] of wheel __
This depending on the driving conditions and the road surface conditions, so ‘Malfunction
problem diagnosis is difficult. However, if a normal diagnostic trouble code is displayed, l Malfunction of bearing
carry out the following . . .
l of:
.
NG :
W h e e l s p e e d - Repair
(Refer to
NG NG
speed sensor check Replace the wheel speed sensor.
(Refer to GROUP -Wheel Speed
OK Sensor Check.)
OK
Hydraulic unit check (Refer to NG
ABS rotor check (Refer to Replace the rotor.
OK
OK
The sensor harness and connector
should be moved while these
inspections are carried out.
the
.
TSB Revision
t h e ,..,
. I-
. . .
Short-circuiting the positive probe between a
connector terminal and ground could damage the
wiring, the sensor, ABS-ECU, or all three. Use
care to this!
3. If voltmeter any division from standard value, check
the sensor, actuator and related electrical
wiring, then repair or replace.
4. , After replacement, recheck with the voltmeter
the repair has corrected the problem.
TSB Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
Scan disconnected
.
Diagnostic selection (Input) Scan tool: connected
Scan tool: Approx. 12__
Stop light switch (Input) Ignition switch: ON (stop light switch ON) or more
Ignition switch: OFF (stop light switch more
O F F ) , . .
I Revision
ABS Troubleshooting
7
13513413313213113~29~28127126~25124123122~21~20~1~
TSB Revision
ABS On-vehicle ,
ON-VEHICLE .
ABS OPERATION CHECK
WHEEL SPEED OUTPUT VOLTAGE CHECK
1. ‘Lift the vehicle and release the parking brake.
the ECU harness connector and
from the harness side
,. -I-
356 Caution
harness
Set the special tool and use the check connector to
check. not connect the Tool)
marked with except the waveform
on a driving test.
connector to the ECU.
3. Rotate the wheel to be measured at.
1 rotation per second, and. check the output voltage
using a circuit tester or an oscilloscope.
Wheel speed Front left Front right left
Output
When with a voltmeter:
70 or more
When measuring with an
200 or more
..
.
Revision
On-vehicle
10.0
1
TSB Revision
,
Caution
Turn the ignition switch off before
t h e
If the scan tool is disconnected while the ignition switch
the diagnostic trouble codes will be memorized!
the warning’ light’ may
1. Jack up the vehicle and support: the vehicle with rigid;
racks at the specified jack-up
. . place the
wheels which ‘are checked on the rollers of the braking
force tester.
Caution
The roller of the braking force tester the
should be dry during
2. When parking!
the rear brakes, stop
them. ,
2. Release the parking brake, and feel .
torque) ‘each road wheel.
using “the force tester, take “a
‘brake drag
Turn the ignition key to the
scan tool as the
__
TSB
l Depressed
l Released
L o c k
Diagnosis Table
Operation Probable cause Remedy
Normal Abnormal
(1) Depress brake pedal to Brake force does not Clogged brake Check and clean
lock wheel. released for 6 lock when brake line other than brake line
(2) Using the scan tool, secondsafter pedal is HU
select the wheel to be locking. pressed.
checked and force the Clogged hydrau- Replace HU
actuator to operate. circuit in HU assembly
(3) Turn the selected wheel
manually to check the force is Incorrect HU Connect
change of brake force. released brake tube correctly
connection
HU solenoid Replace HU
valve not assembly
tioning correctly
. .
TSB Revision
On-vehicle Service ,
M O T O R
Connect the battery and check to be sure that the sound
of the hydraulic unit motor operating can heard.
.
power should be than
1 second.
, ,
I I .
.
ABS Motor Relay
When no current
, , ,
Between
_ _ __
TSB Revision
ABS On-vehicle Service
1 4
3 2
,
REMEDY FOR A FLAT 35200350072
When booster cables are used to start the engine when the’
battery is completely flat and then the vehicle is
driven without waiting for the battery to
some extent, the engine may misfire, and driving not
be possible.
This happens because ABS consumes a great of’
current for its self-check function; the remedy is to either
allow the battery to recharge sufficiently, or to remove the,
fusible link for ABS circuit, thus disabling the anti-skid brake
system.
The ABS warning light will illuminate the fusible
(for is removes.
After the battery has sufficiently charged, install the fusible
link (for ABS) and restart the engine; then check to be sure
the ABS warning light is not illuminated.
TSB Revision
ABS Wheel Sensor
Front Rear
TSB Revision I
ABS Wheel . , ... ,
Front Rear
FRONT WHEEL SPEED
SPEED SENSOR
The clearance between the wheel speed sensor
rotor’s toothed surface is not but the
distance between the the
. .
rotor’s toothed surface.
ed Standard value: 28.2-28.5 mm (1.11-1.12 in.)
ce
INSPECTION
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR CHECK
Refer to GROUP Wheel Speed Sensor Check.
Revision
G-SENSOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Caution
Do not drop the G-sensor or subject it to shocks.
TSB Revision
ABS G-Sensor
INSPECTION
G-SENSOR CHECK
(1) Disconnect the connector the
special tool (test,; harness set:,, the
terminals the connector.
(2) Turn the ignition of
the following output voltage.
Between and (3) .
Standard value: 2.4-2.6
(3) With the special tool still connected, secure the G-sensor
so that the FRONT mark on the sensor mounting surface
is facing straight down, take a reading of the
following output
Between terminals (2) and (3)
Standard value:
(4) If the voltage outside the standard value; after checking
to be sure that there is no abnormality in the power supply
-and earth, wires, replace the G-sensor.
Revision
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
l Cowl Side Trim (R.H.), Front Scuff Plate Removal
and Installation (Refer to GROUP Trims.)
Removal steps
Control unit cover
2. ABS-ECU
INSPECTION
ABS-ECU CHECK
Refer to
TSB Revision
NOTES
CONTENTS
GENERAL 29199919999
The parking brake is of a mechanical rear-wheel The operation method utilizes a parking brake lever
brake construction in all vehicles. Drum-type or which is in an offset position at the passenger’s
drum in disc-type brakes are employed depending side.
on the vehicle model.
D I A G R A M .
TSB Revision
PARKING BRAKES Service
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Item Standard value Limit I
Parking brake lever stroke Vehicles with brake 3-5 notches
5-7 notches
.
Brake lining thickness mm (in.) 2.8
Brake drum inside diameter mm (in.) 188.0 (6.8) 169.0 (6.7)
LUBRICANTS
.
Items Specified lubricant
Adjuster
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause
<Vehicles with
With the engine idling, forcefully depress pedal’
five of six times and confirm that the pedal stroke stops
changing.
NOTE
If the pedal stroke stops changing, the automatic-adjustment
mechanism is functioning normally, and the clearance between
the shoe and drum is correct.
Revision
PARKING BRAKES
<Vehicles with
Carry out running-in by the replacing
the parking brake linings the rear ‘brake or
when brake performance ‘is
(1) Adjust the parking brake the
(2) Hook a spring scale onto the center of the
lever grip and pull it a of
in a direction perpendicular to the handle.
(3) Drive the vehicle at a constant. speed of km/h
(22-31 mph) for 100 metres (328 ft).
(4) Release ‘the parking brake the for
0 minutes.
(5) Repeat the procedure in steps (2) to (4) 4-5 times.
Caution
Carry out running-in in a place and
pay careful attention to safety.
TSB Revision
PARKING BRAKES Parking . .
CAUTION: SRS
1. When removing and installing the floor console,
do not let it bump against the SRS-ECU or other
components.
2. Before removal of to GROUP
SRS-ECU.
Removal steps
1. Adjusting nut
2. Parking brake stay
3. Bushing
4. Parking brake switch
5. Parking brake lever
TSB Revision
PARKING BRAKES Parking Brake Cable
CAUTION: SRS
1. When removing and installing the floor console,
do not let it bump against the SRS-ECU or other
components.
2. Before removal of SRS-ECU, refer to GROUP
SRS-ECU.
Removal steps
1. Rear brake drum 7. Shoe
2. spring 8. Shoe spring
3. Auto adjuster assembly
4.
5. Shoe-to-shoe
Retainer springspring 10.
11. C
Shoe’ arid
l i p
6. Lever return’ 12. brake
TSB Revision
36-8 PARKING BRAKES Parking Brake Cable
CAUTION: SRS
1. When removing and the floor console,
do not let it bump against the SRS-ECU or other
components.
2. Before removal of SRS-ECU, refer to GROUP
SRS-ECU.
I I .
13 49-59 Nm
36-43
Removal steps
l , 1. Rear brake assembly 8. Strut return spring
2. Rear brake disc Shoe , hold-down cup
3. spring (rear) 10. Shoe spring
4. Shoe-to-anchor spring (front) 11.
5. Adjusting wheel spring 12. Shoe and lining assembly
ä 4 13. Clip
14.
TSB Revision
PARKING BRAKES, parking Brake Brake>
R E M O V A L
REAR BRAKE.
Remove the rear brake assembly and ‘support.
or similar.
,
SHOE HOLD-DOWN
Extend the shoe assembly, and remove the shoe
h o l d - d o w n c u p .
INSTALLATION
ADJUSTER
Install the adjuster so that the shoe adjusting-bolt of left hand
wheel ‘is attached towards the front the’ vehicle, and the
shoe adjusting bolt of right hand wheel is towards the rear
of the vehicle.
Shoe
SPRING INSTALLATION
The the respective shoe-to-anchor different,
so the, spring in the figure has been
NOTE
The shows the left wheel; for the right the
position is symmetrical.
Paint
Shoe-to-anchor spring (rear)
Forward
TSB Revision
REMOVAL AND
,
Post-installation Operation
Parking Brake Lever Stroke Adjustment
(Refer to
54-65
36-43
grease .
Removal steps
1. Rear brake assembly 9. Shoe hold-down cup
2. Rear brake disc 10. Shoe hold-down spring
3. Shoe-to-anchor spring (rear) 11. Shoe hold-down pin
4. Shoe-to-anchor spring (front) 12. Shoe and lining assembly
5. Adjusting wheel spring 13. Clip
ä l 14. Parking brake cable
15. Rear hub assembly
Strut return spring 16. Backing plate
PARKING BRAKES
BRAKE ASSEMBLY
Remove the rear brake assembly and support it with wire
or. similar.
SHOE
-Extend the shoe and lining assembly, and remove the shoe
hold-down cup.
Shoe
Forward
TSB Revision
PARKING BRAKES Parking Drum
INSPECTION
BRAKE LINING AND BRAKE DRUM
(1) Measure the thickness the
Standard value: 2.8 mm in.)
Limit: 1.0 mm in.)
Caution
Replace the brake shoes if “the thickness of brake
lining is the limit value or ,
TSB Revision
CONTENTS
G E N E R A L I N F O R M A T I O N
The type of power steering which is responsive The steering column in all vehicles has a shock
to engine speed has been adopted in all models. absorber mechanism and a tilt steering mechanism.
The main features are as follows. A vane-type oil pump a fluid flow control system
Four-spoke steering wheel has been adopted. In included adopted.
addition, (Supplemental Restraint System) is The gear linkage is an integral rack
provided as a standard in all and
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM ,
Steering wheel
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Cooler pipe
TSB Revision
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard value
Steering wheel free play mm (in.) with engine stopped 15 or less ,
O-ring
TSB Revision
Sealants/Special Tools
SEALANTS .
I t e m s Specified sealant
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Application
or Tie, rod knuckle
548
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Power steering oil
gauge adapter
side)
Engine (Non-turbo)>
steering oil
gauge adapter
side)
or
Engine (Turbo)
Engine>
steering oil
gauge adapter
pump side)
Engine (Turbo)
Engine>
steering oil pressure
adapter (hose side)
,
TSB Revision
Special
socket
l support
Torque wrench socket
.
120 Tool not available roller bearing removal
__
Needle bearing puller
. .
TSB Revision
STEERING Special Tools
.
or
TSB Revision
STEERING On-vehicle”
TSB Revision
STEERING On-vehicle Service
STEERING
TSB Revision
STEERING On-vehicle
Fluid fluctuation
Check fluid in the oil or
difference of the
is stopped; and while it is If the
considerably, air, should be
37200210033
1. Raise the front wheels on a jack, and then support them
with rigid racks.
Disconnect the return hose connection.
3. Connect a plastic hose to the return hose, and drain
into a container.
4. Disconnect the high-tension cable, and then while operat-
ing the starting motor intermittently, turn the steering wheel
all the way to the left and right several times to drain
all of the fluid.
Caution
careful not to position-the
or the fuel rail.
5. Connect the then secure it
c l i p .
6. Fill the up to the lower
of the filter, and air.
BLEEDING
..
Caution
1. During air bleeding, refill the fluid supply so that
the level never falls below the lower of
the filter.
2. If air bleeding is done
the air will be the
fluid; be sure to do
ing.
5. Connect the ignition and’ start the engine
(idle).
6. Turn the steering wheel to the left and right until there
are no air bubbles in
.
Revision
Fluid fluctuation
7. Confirm that fluid is the level
up the specified the
8. Confirm that there is change
when the steering wheel is turned,
9. Check whether or not in the fluid is
within 5 mm in.) when the and
when it is running.
Caution
While engine
1. If the change of
While engine
running stopped or more, the has bled,
from the system, and be bled
,
the fluid level rises suddenly after the engine,
stopped, the air has not completely
3. If air bleeding is not there will be
noises from the flow-control;
valve, ‘and condition the life of,
the pump, etc.. ,
. . .
PRESSURE TEST
Pressure
PUMP RELIEF PRESSURE CHECK
Shut-off valv Disconnect the pressure hose from the oil pump, and
close) then connect the special tools.
2. the air, and then turn the steering wheel several
times while the vehicle is not moving so that the tempera-
ture’ of the fluid rises to approximately
NOTE
l l: Engine
(Turbo) and Engine>
848 (Non-turbo)>
l 2: Engine (Turbo) and
Engine (Non-turbo)>
TSB Revision
STEERING On-vehicle’ Service
... . . .
CHECKING UNDER NO-LOAD
1. Disconnect. the pressure hose from the oil pump, and
Pressure Shut-off valve then connect the special tools.
(Fully open)
2. Bleed the air, and then turn the steering several:
I times the vehicle is not moving so that the tempera-
Thermometer
ture the fluid rises to approximately
NOTE
Engine
(Turbo) and
548 Engine (Non-turbo)>
l 2: Engine (Turbo) and
549 Engine (Non-turbo)>
TSB Revision
STEERING On-vehicle Service,.
NOTE
‘1:
(Turbo) and Engine>
Engine (Non-turbo)>
l 2: Engine (Turbo) and
Engine>
549 Engine (Non-turbo)>
TSB Revision
STEERING
POWER PRESSURE
TSB Revision
4 STEERING Steering
Post-installation Operation
l Checking Steering with , Wheels
Straight Ahead
GROUP Air Bag Module and Clock Spring.
12 Nm
9
Removal steps
1. Air bag module (Refer to GROUP 7. Cover (Refer to GROUP
Air Bag Module and Clock Automatic Transaxle key In-
Spring.) terlock and Shift Lock Mechanism-
2. Steering wheel s*)
3. Lower column cover 8. Key interlock cable (Refer to
4. Column pad GROUP Automatic Trans-
5. Upper column cover axle key Interlock and Shift Lock
6. Clock spring and column switch Mechanisms.)
assembly (Refer to GROUP Retainer attachment bolt
Air Bag Module and Clock Spring.) 10. Steering column assembly
TSB Revision
Steering Wheel
1 . .
Disassembly steps
1. Joint assembly
2. B o o t
3. Outer cover
4. Retainer
5. Bearing
6. Inner cover
TSB Revision
6 STEERING Steering
. Wheel ,
DISASSEMBLY
BOOT REMOVAL
(1) Apply grease to the inside of the
(2) Remove the boot while using a to section.
....
..
Inner cover
INNER COVER
Cover the inside lip of the inner cover pull
the outside of the cover’ onto the joint.
BEARING INSTALLATION
(1)‘ Fill the inside of the bearing grease.
(2) Install the bearings the shaft on the joint assembly.
(3) Wrap plastic tape approximately and one-half times
around the the and
then press fit the bearings into the cover assembly.
BOOT INSTALLATION
Apply grease to the inside of the lip section of the boot,
and then install the boot to the joint.
INSPECTION
l Check the steering shaft for play and round movement.
l Check the joints for play, damage, or rough movement.
l Check the joint bearing for wear and
l Check the dust shield for damage.
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Gear.
69
Nm Nm Nm 51
51-58
Removal steps
1. Joint assembly and gear box 7. Center member assembly
connecting bolt 8. Clamp
2. Power steering pipe connection Gear box assembly
3. Cotter pin Caution
4. Tie rod end and knuckle connec- The fasteners marked should be temporarily tightened
tion before they are finally tightened once the total weight of
5. Stay (L.H.) the engine has been placed on the vehicle body.
6. Stay (R.H.)
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Gear
15
23-26 Nm
24-33 Nm
24-33 Nm
Removal steps
1. Brake fluid reservoir assembly
2. A/C compressor
3. Joint assembly and gear box
bolt
4. Power pipe connection
5. pin
6. Tie rod end and knuckle
tion
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steerina
Removal steps
7. Stay (L.H.)
6. Stay (R.H.)
9. Centermember assembly
10. Clamp
11. Gear box assembly
12. Return tube
Caution
The fasteners marked l be temporarily tightened
before they are finally tightened once the total weight of
the engine has been placed on the body.
INSPECTION
l Check the rubber parts for cracks and breakage.
TSB Revision
STEERING
TSB Revision
Power Steering Gear
22 Nm
Steering
Disassembly steps
1. Feed tube 18. Pinion and valve assembly
2. O-ring
3. Tie rod end locking nut 20. Bali bearing
4. Tie rod end assembly 21. Oil seal
5. Bellows clip 22. Valve housing
6. Bellows band 23.
7. Bellows 24. Rack stopper
8. T i e r o d 25. Rack bushing
9. Tab washer
l Total pinion torque adjustment
10. Locking nut
11. Rack support cover
12. Rack support spring
13. Rack support
14. End plug
15. Self-locking nut 33. Oil seal
16. Valve housing assembly 34. Back-up
17. Oil seal 35. housing
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering ,
Fluid:
Fluid: Automatic Transmission
Automatic Transmission Fluid “DEXRON II”
Fluid II”
Sealant:
ATD Part No. 6663 or
equivalent
Sealant:
ATD Part No. 6663
equivalent
Fluid:
Automatic Transmission Fluid
“DEXRON II”
Grease: Silicone grease-
Revision
STEERING Power Gear ,
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
WASHER REMOVAL
Unstake the tab washer’ fixes the tie rod and rack
with a chisel.
OIL
REMOVAL
Using a plastic hammer, gently tap the pinion to remove it.
.
RING REMOVAL
Cut the seal -ring and remove it from the and valve
assembly and the rack.
Caution
When cutting the seal ring, be careful not to damage
the pinion and valve assembly or the rack.
BA L L SE A L
Using a socket, remove the oil seal and the ball bearing
from the valve housing simultaneously.
,
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Box
REMOVAL
stopper (1) Turn the rack stopper clockwise until the end of the
comes out of the slot in the rack
(2) Turn the rack stopper to the
Caution
Note that if the rack stopper is first
clockwise, the will get caught slot in
the housing and the rack stopper will turn.
REMOVAL
Pull out the rack
At this time also take the rack stopper and bushing,
simultaneously.
.
SEAL REMOVAL
oil seal and remove from rack bushing.
Caution
Do not damage oil seal press fitting
or
BEARING REMOVAL
brass bar Use a bar or special tool to remove, the ball bearing
from the gear housing.
Ball
TSB Revision
STEERING -- Gear
WASHER
Pipe Use a pipe or similar to the
washer and oil seal from the-
Caution
not to damage the inner ,
the gear housing.
.
Oil seal
REASSEMBLY
BACK-UP SEAL
(Guide)
(1) Apply a coating of the specified fluid to the outside of
the oil seal. ,
fluid:
Automatic transmission II”
seal
Back-up washer (2) Using the special tools, press the washer and
the oil seal into the rack housing position
(where the upper press-in guide coincides with
the stepped part of press-in tool).
,
NEEDLE.
bearing
fluid to housing, bearing and oil seal press
Specified fluid:
transmission Fluid
Press fit needle roller special
as valve
.
202
Revision
INSTALLATION
(1) Apply a of the specified fluid outside of’
the seal and O-ring.
Specified
.
Apply coating of teeth
face. ,
.
.. .
Do grease the in
Vent hole
RACK
Wrap the rack end plastic tape, of the
specified fluid, and install the and rack
fluid:
Automatic Fluid
Plastic tape
,
to rack stopper hole
rack stopper clockwise and insert firmly.
Caution
to rack stopper hole while turning rack stop-
per clockwise. ,
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering ,
SEAL .
Apply a coating of the fluid the outside of the
oil. seal. Using the special ‘tools, . oil seal into
valve housing.
Specified fluid:
,
203
Oil seal
S E A L
Using the special the oil seal into the valve housing.
52
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Gear Box
(3) Using the special tools, rotate the pinion gear at the
of one rotation in approximately 4 to 6 seconds to
the total pinion torque.
Standard value: (6-12
[Change in torque: 0.4 Nm (3
Caution
1. When adjusting, set standard value at high-
est value.
2. Assure no ratcheting or operating,
rack towards the shaft direction.
NOTE
When it cannot be adjusted the specified return]
angle, check rack support cover components or replace.
(4) After adjusting, lock rack cover with lock nut.
ROD INSTALLATION .
After installing tie rod to rack, fold end (2 locations)
to tie rod notch.
ii
Concave
TSB Revision
STEERING Steering
(2) plastic
of the bellows band as the
INSPECTION
RACK
l Check the rack tooth surfaces for damage or wear.
l Check the oil seal contact for uneven wear.
l Check the rack for bends.
COVER REPLACEMENT,:
Replace the dust cover by the following,
dust cover has become ‘by
(1) Remove the dust
(2) Pack dust cover interior with
(3) Apply specified sealant to dust lip.
Specified sealant: ATD No.
(4) Using the special’ tool, dust .
rod end bail joint. ,
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Oil Pump Engine,
....
POWER STEERING OIL PUMP
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
On-vehicle Service.)
l Power Fluid Line Bleeding
(Refer to
l Oil Pump Pressure Check to
39 Nm
29 57 Nm
.
39 Nm
29
Removal steps
1. Drive-belt 5. Pressure switch connector
2. Suction hose 6. Oil pump assembly
3. Pressure hose 7. Oil pump bracket
4. Gasket
REMOVAL SERVICE
uc ion ose
Caution
A/C is below oil A/C
compressor with a before hose.
.
,
Revision
STEERING Power Steering Oil Pump
INSTALLATION POINT
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
‘For the with air conditioning, install the oil pump
assembly to the bracket so that it faces toward vehicle
front. Then use the air coriditioning tension adjust
the belt tension. .
37300530043
l Check the drive-belt for cracks
l Check the pulley, assembly for uneven rotation.
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Pump Engine
43
32 20
14 83
13
9
43
32
00003765
Disassembly steps
1. P u l l e y 14. O-ring
2. Pump bracket 15. Flow control valve
3. Pump cover 16. Flow control spring
4. Pump housing gasket 17. Suction connector
5. Side plate 18. O-ring
6. Wave washer 19. Oil pressure switch
7. O-ring 20. O-ring
8. 21. Dowel pin
9. Cam ring 22. Oil seal
10. Snap ring 23. Oil pump body
Caution
Connector Do not disassemble the flow
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Oil Pump Engine
DISASSEMBLY SERVICE
PULLEY REMOVAL
the special tool to pulley,
the pulley mounting
9
or
.
R I N G
Remove the snap ring from the shaft with snap
and separate the rotor from the shaft.
REASSEMBLY SERVICE.
SEAL INSTALLATION
4 47.4 1.8
4 5 18.8 1.9
TSB
STEERING Power Steering Oil Pump Engine (Non-turbo)>
ROTOR INSTALLATION
Punch mark
install the rotor to the shaft so that rotor’s punch mark
is at the pump cover side.
Snap ring (2) After installation of snap ring, lift the rotor and check
that the snap ring has entered the countersunk part.
VANE INSTALLATION
Direct round edge Install the vanes on the rotor, paying close attention to the
to the cam rina
installation direction.
TSB Revision I
STEERING Power Steering Oil
PLATE
up the pin hole of the side plate with the dowel
pin the oil pump body.
..
,.
PULLEY INSTALLATION
Use the special tool to secure the pulley, and then install
the pulley lock nut.
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Oil Pump (Non-turbo)>
INSPECTION
l Check the flow control valve for clogging.
l Check the shaft for wear or
l Check the groove of rotor and vane for “stepped” wear.
l Check the contact surface of cam ring and vanes for
“stepped” wear.
l Check the vanes for damage.
Revision
Power Oil Pump ,
13 16
28 Nm
21
21
Removal steps
1. Drive-belt 5. Pressure switch connector
2. Suction hose 6. Oil pump
hose 7. Oil pump bracket
.
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Pump Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
Suction
INSPECTION
l Check the drive-belt for
l Check the pulley assembly for rdtation.
TSB Revision I
STEERING Power Steering Oil Pump Engine. (Turbo) and ,
DISASSEMBLY REASSEMBLY
6'
Fluid:
Automatic Transmission Fluid Oil seal kit
“DEXRON II”
Nm
13
61 Nm
12
Disassembly steps
1. D r i v e 13. Flow valve
2. Snap ring 14. control spring
3. Pump cover 15. Pressure switch assembly
4. Lock pin 16.
5. Seal washer 17. SW ion connector
6. Vanes n g
7. Cam ring 19. assembly?‘,’
6. Rotor 20. Oil
9. Side plate 21. Oil bpdy
10. O-ring
11. Connector Caution
12. O-ring Do not the flow control
.
TSB Revision
DRIVE PULLEY REMOVAL
Use the special tool to secure the drive pulley, and then
remove the drive pulley mounting nuts.
O-RINGS INSTALLATION
Connector Side plate
Apply specified fluid on O-rings.
No. mm (in.)
11 I
I
I
Suction connector
mounting portion
of oil pump body
“I
5
Terminal assembly
Specified fluid:
Automatic transmission Fluid “DEXRON II”
TSB Revision I
STEERING Power Steering Pump Engine (Turbo) and
ROTOR INSTALLATION
Install the rotor to the pulley assembly so that the rotor’s
punch mark is at the pump cover side.
VANE INSTALLATION
Direct round edge Install the vanes on the rotor, paying close attention to the
to the cam
installation direction.
TSB Revision
STEERING ower Steering Oil Pump Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
INSPECTION
l Check the flow control valve for
Check the pulley assembly for wear or damage.
l Check the groove of rotor and vane for “stepped” wear.
l Check the contact surface of cam ring and vanes for
“stepped” wear.
l Check the vanes for damage.
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Hoses
11 Nm
11
3.9 Nm
2.9
Removal steps
1. Oil reservoir 9. Pressure
hose 10. Return
11. Pressure tubs
tube
5. Suction
Return hose
hose 12. Front fascia bracket
13.
6. Return hose 14. Air guide duct
7. Pressure tube 15. Cooler tubs
8. Return tube
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Hoses Engine .
REMOVAL POINT
PRESSURE HOSE REMOVAL
Caution
A/C compressor is below the oil pump, so cover the
compressor with a shop towel before removing-any
Revision
STEERING Power Steering Hoses Engine (Turbo) and
23-26 Nm
34 Nm
25 11 Nm
11 Nm 8
8
11
8
Removal steps
1. Brake fluid reservoir assembly 10. Return tube
2. Clutch fluid reservoir assembly 11. Pressure tube
3. A/C compressor 12. Pressure hose
4. Oil reservoir 13. Return hose
hose Pressure tube
15. Return tube
Suction hose 16. fascia bracket
8. Return hose 17. Air guide duct
9. Return hose 18. Cooler tube
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Hoses Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
REMOVAL SERVICE
BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
Disconnect the brake fluid level sensor connector and
the brake fluid reservoir assembly from the dash panel with
the hose still attached.
NOTE
Place the removed reservoir assembly in a place where it
will not be a hindrance when removing and installing the
power steering gear box, and tie it with a cord.
CLUTCH FLUID RESERVOIR ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
Remove the clutch fluid reservoir assembly from the dash
panel with the hose still attached.
NOTE
Place the removed reservoir assembly in a place where it
will not be a hindrance when removing and installing the
power steering hoses, and tie it with a cord.
A/C COMPRESSOR REMOVAL
Disconnect the A/C compressor connector remove the
compressor from the compressor bracket with the hose still
attached.
NOTE
Place the removed in a where it will not be a hindrance when
removing and installing the power steering hoses and tie
it with a cord.
Caution
Do not damage the joint between the A/C hose and the
A/C pipe.
TSB Revision
STEERING Power Steering Hoses Engine (Turbo) and
,
White line
TSB Revision
NOTES
CONTENTS
DOOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Door Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Door Glass and Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 ENTRY SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Door Handle and Latch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Door Opening Weatherstrip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Door Trim and Waterproof Film . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
On-vehicle Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
..................................... 66
Sealant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Service Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 SUNROOF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 On-vehicle Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Sealant and Adhesive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
ELECTRIC CONVERTIBLE TOP . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Balance Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Convertible Top Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 UNDER COVER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Convertible Top Bypass Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 WINDSHIELD AND WINDOW GLASS . . . . . . . . 7
Convertible Top Control Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Convertible Top Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 On-vehicle Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Front Roof Weatherstrip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Quarter Window Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Headliner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Quarter Window Glass and
On-vehicle Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Regulator Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Sealant and Adhesive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Drive Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Service Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Driven Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Special Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Rail Weatherstrip and Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Top Cover Retainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Windshield and Window Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
FENDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 TRUNK LID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Fender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Sealants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Trunk Lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
FUEL FILLER DOOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 TRUNK LID LOCK RELEASE HANDLE AND
HOOD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 CABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
BODY Hood
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Improper closure Striker and latch not properly aligned Adjust the alignment
Difficult locking and unlocking Striker and latch not properly aligned Adjust the alignment
Uneven body clearance Incorrectly installed hood Adjust the installation of hood
Uneven height Incorrect hood bumper height Adjust the hood bumper height
TSB Revision
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
00003797
1. Hood lock release handle Hood and hood hinge removal steps
2. Hood weatherstrip l Front deck garnish (Refer to GROUP
3. Hood front weatherstrip 51 Windshield and Washer.)
4. Hood side weatherstrip hose
5. Bumper
6. Hood support rod Hood hinge
7. Hood silencer
9. Hood switch (Vehicles with Hood lock release cable removal
alarm system) steps
l Front bumper and front fascia bracket
(Refer to GROUP 51 Front Bumper.)
l Headlight driver’s side)
(Refer to ROUP 54 Headlight.)
1. Hood lock release handle
8. Hood latch
13. Hood lock release cable
.
TSB Revision
BODY Hood
00000130
INSPECTION
HOOD SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK
Switch position
2
0
mm (in.) 00000129
TSB Revision
Fender
Items Specified , ,
Fender to body panel ATD Part No: 8531 or
Splash shield to fender ATD Part No. 8625 or equivalent
FENDER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and post-installation Operation
Front Bumper Removal and Installation
(Refer to GROUP 51 Front Bumper.)
Sealant:
ATD Part No. or equivalent
..
Sealant:
ATD Part 8531 No. 8848,
00000131
Removal steps
1. Splash shield
l Side air dam
Refer to GROUP 51 Aero Parts.)
2. ront fender panel
TSB Revision
BODY Fuel Filler Door
Removal steps
1. Fuel filler door 4. Fuel filler door lock release handle
2. Fuel filler door hook 5. Fuel filler door lock release cable
3. Release handle cover
TSB Revision
BODY and Window Glass
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS ,
Items Standard’ value
Difference in quarter window glass height from door window glass height mm (in.)
Clearance between quarter window glass sash weatherstrip and door window glass 8.3 2.0
mm (in.) .
Distances between quarter window glass and quarter Front of quarter window
belt moulding and between quarter window glass and glass
quarter belt line outer weatherstrip flushness mm (in.)
Rear of quarter window 9.0 2.0
glass
Quarter window glass tilt mm (in.) 3.0 2.0
S P E C I A L T O O L
Tool Tool number and name
General service tool Removal installation
..,
Glass holder
Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION CHART FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS
WINDSHIELD
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Water leak Defective seal Fill sealant
WINDOW <ECLIPSE>
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
When the power windows are not l Broken wire in ground input signal Check according ‘to Flow’ Chart
lowered fully and the power window circuit (Refer to
main switch’s lock switch is OFF, the l Power window main switch
power windows do not lower (driver’s side) is faulty.
if the convertible top switch l top control module
is set to open or close. However, the is faulty.
power windows lower automatically
when the lock switch is ON.
TSB
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
The door window (power window) also does not operate. Refer to the door on
page 42-4.
NO
NG
Replace
l Power window motor check and (Refer to
NG
Measure at the power window motor connector (L.H.) and . Check the following connectors:
(R.H.)
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
Continuity between terminals (2) and ground
OK: Continuity
When the power windows are not lowered fully the power windows do not lower automatically if
the convertible top switch is set to open or close.
No
The door windows (power windows) also does not lower. Replace the convertible top control
YES
Measure at the convertible top control module connector
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Voltage between terminal (22) andgroundwhenthe ignition
switch is ON. Replace the convertible top control
OK: Battery positive voltage
NG
NG
Check the
OK
Check the harness between the power window main switch and
the convertible too control module. if
Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
When the power windows are not lowered fully and the switch’s lock switch
is OFF, the power windows do not lower automatically if the top switch is set to open
or close. However, the power windows lower automatically’ when the lock switch is ‘ON.
NG
Power window mair switch continuity Replace
and
NG
Repair
control module.
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS ADJUSTMENT
<ECLIPSE
NOTE
Ensure door glass is adjusted properly. Refer to DOOR
WINDOW GLASS ADJUSTMENT Door in order
to ensure that cross section A A and are correct.
1. Remove the quarter trim, (Refer to GROUP’
Trims.)
2. Check that the quarter window glass moves up and down
smoothly. Non-smooth operation may be caused by
improper adjustment, defective quarter window motor,
or binding quarter window guide assembly. Refer to this
section for proper adjustments. Refer to for quarter
window motor testing and guide assembly.
3. After completely opening the electric convertible
completely raise the door window glass and quarter
window glass.
4. Measure gaps, check for sealing ‘quality (wet glass and
look for at least 12.7 mm in.) wide seal all glass-to-seal
locations), check tilt before and after completing each
adjustment.
TSB
and Window Glass
5. Before proceeding with these adjustments,
a) Mark each adjusting stud bolt prior to loosening.
NOTE
Scratch around adjusting stud bolt as point of reference
after starting to adjust
b) Loosen one adjusting stud bolt/nut at a time.
up-stop
installation bolt bolt
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
Section
Quarter
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield Window
B’
B,
Quarter
window
Quarter belt
Quarter line outer
belt mouldi
small
3 Revision
42-14 BODY Windshield and Window Glass
C-C,
Quarter
window glass
Sash
Door weatherstrip
glass
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window
12. Close the convertible top
quarter window glass enters the slit on the rear rail
weatherstrip when the quarter windows are
,
Rear rail
Slit
ail weath
window
00004811
RESERVE ITEMS ,
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
WORKING PROCESS
I
Reusing the glass Replace the glass
I
Application of adhesive
Apply it to the body evenly after 30 min-
utes of primer application.
Cleaning
After removing any adhesive that is sticking out or adhering to the body or
glass with a spatula, etc., clean off with ATD Part No. or equivalent.
I
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield
. and’ ..
WINDSHIELD
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION .
Section A-A
molding
mm (in.)
Section B-B
Section C-C
mm (in.)
Adhesive:
ATD Part No. 8609 Super Fast Urethane ATD Super Fast Urethane Primer or equivalent
Removal steps
1. Windshield 4. Window spacer
2. Windshield molding 5. Window spacer
3. Window spacer 6. Dual-lock fastener
TSB Revision
42-18 BODY Windshield and Window Glass
Revision
BODY Windshield and
Window
mm (in.)
WINDSHIELD
Apply specified double-sided tape the windshield in the
places shown in the illustration, and then
molding. .
Specified adhesive tape: .
ATD Part No. 6362 equivalent
Tape
Section A-A
Windshield
molding
00000136
mm (in.)
Revision
BODY Windshield and Window .
WINDSHIELD INSTALLATION
Glass side Windshield molding
(1) Soak a sponge in the primer, and apply evenly ‘the
glass and the body in the places shown in the illustration.
Specified
ATD Part No. 8808 Super Fast Urethane
or equivalent
Caution
1. Apply the primer evenly around the entire circum-
ference, because it strengthens the adhesive.
Otherwise, a too thick application cause lower-
ing of the adhesive strength.
2. Do not touch the coated
(2) After applying the primer, let it to 30 minutes.
Section A-A
Primer
C-C
00000136
nm (in.)
TSB Revision
BODY and Window
(4) aligning
and evenly so that” it “adheres completely.
Caution
If heat is applied with an infra-red light to shorten
the setting time, keep the surface temperature of the
adhesive
(6) After attaching the windshield to the body, let it stand
far 30 minutes or more, then test for water leakage.
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
00003800
Section A- A
Section B-B
Section C-C
Adhesive:
ATD Part No. 8609 Super Fast Urethane and ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane Primer
equivalent
Removal steps
ä 4 Quarter window glass assembly
Clip grommet
3 : Dual-lock fastener
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window
REMOVAL POINT
,
REMOVAL
(1) For protection of the body apply
‘tape to all around the body where the glass is installed.
(2) Using a cutter knife, cut off window
along its edge.
I I I
(3) Run a wire between the glass and the body
portion of the quarter window and and forth
along the glass to cut through the adhesive.
When doing so, pay attention to the clip grommet.
. .
C a u t i o n
Hold the window glass the to pre-,
vent it from falling when the adhesive& cut through.
Dual-lock
INSTALLATION SERVICE
FASTENER
After making sure that there are no bends or sections
in the dual-lock fasteners, attach the dual-lock fasteners to
the shown in the illustration.,
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
Section B-B
C-C
Primer
(in.)
(3) Within 30 minutes after applying the primer, fill the sealant
gun with adhesive and apply the adhesive evenly around
the entire circumference of the glass.
(Refer to
Specified adhesive:
ATD Part No. 8609 Super Fast Urethane or
equivalent
NOTE
Cut the nozzle tip of the sealant gun into a shape
to facilitate adhesive application.
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window
(4) After
and onto the body
Remove the adhesive
body
clean.
(6) After the
to until the adhesive
Caution
When using an infrared lamp or other means for quick-
er hardening, keep the surface temperature
or lower.
(7) After about 30 minutes or more following bonding of the
quarter glass to the body, check for water leaks.
Caution
1. If the vehicle is to be moved, do so gently.
2. When for water leaks, do not squeeze
the end.
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
12 28
20
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield Window
INSPECTION
POWER WINDOW MOTOR CHECK
(1) Check that the motor runs smoothly when the battery
is connected directly to the motor terminals.
(2) Furthermore, check that the motor operates in reverse
when the terminal connections are switched.
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
0
OFF
Connector A Connector
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield. and Window
Adhesive tape:
or equivalent
Section
mm (in.) ..
Adhesive:
ATD Part No. Super Fast Urethane and ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane prim& equivalent
Removal steps
Harness connector 3. molding
2. glass Dual-lock fasteners
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
Dual-lock fastener
installation position
mm (in.)
MOLDING INSTALLATION
Apply specified double-sided to the glass in the places
shown in the illustration, and then install the molding.
Specified adhesive tape:
ATD Part No. 6382 or equivalent
Section A-A
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window
GLASS INSTALLATION
Glass side molding
(1) a sponge in the primer, and apply evenly to the
glass and the body in the places shown in the illustration.
Specified primer:
ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane
or equivalent
Caution
1. Apply the primer evenly around the entire circum-
ference, because it strengthens the adhesive.
Otherwise, a too thick application will cause lower-
ing of the adhesive strength.
Body side
2. not touch the coated surface.
(2) After applying the primer, let it dry for 3 to 30 minutes.
imer
Section B-B
Section C-C
mm (in.)
TSB Revision
BODY Windshield and Window Glass
TSB Revision
BODY ,
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Items Standard value .
Inside handle play mm (in.) 6.2 or more
Outside handle play mm (in;) 4.4 more
Clearance of door window Adjustment of glass inclination Front pillar 37.0
glass to weatherstrip amount
Roof or convertible 3 1
holder mm (in.)
Distance between door window glass and weatherstrip step line Front pillar 1.6
mm (in.) Roof or Convertible 1 I
SEALANT
Items Specified sealant I
I
Waterproof film ATD Part No. 8625 or equivalent
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Application
General service tool Removal of switch, trim,. etc.
remover
TSB Revision
BODY Door
Diagnostic trouble
codecheckharness
TROUBLESHOOTING
STANDARD FLOW OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING
Does not
reoccur
Gather information from customer. Check trouble symptom. Intermittent malfunction
Reoccurs
to the INSPECTION CHART
FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS.
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
INPUT SIGNAL INSPECTION POINTS
When Using the Scan Tool
1. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector.
Caution
Always turn the ignition switch OFF before discon-
necting or connecting the scan tool.
2. If buzzer of the scan tool sounds once when a switch
is operated (ON/OFF), the ECU input signal for that switch
circuit system is normal.
Ground terminal Using a Voltmeter
1. Use the special tool to connect a voltmeter between the
grounded terminal and the ETACS terminal of data link
connector.
2. If the voltmeter indicator deflects once when a switch
is operated (ON/OFF), the ECU input signal for that switch
circuit system is normal.
TSB Revision
‘Door .
,, ‘I-
POWER WINDOW
INSPECTION CHART FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS
Trouble symptom Probable cause Remedy
When ignition switch is l Broken wire in power window switch circuit. Check to Flow
turned to ON, power or in each harness. (Refer to
windows do not oper- l Power window switch is faulty.
ate. l Power window motor is faulty.
l ETACS-ECU is faulty.
l Convertible top control module is faulty.
<ECLIPSE .
Power windows can be Broken wire in input circuit in door switch. Check Flow
operated even when a l Door switch is faulty. (Refer to
door is opened within l ETACS-ECU is faulty.
30 seconds after the
ignition switch has
been turned to OFF.
After turning the igni- l ETACS-ECU is faulty. Replace the ETACS-ECU.
tion switch to OFF, the
timer does not operate. ..
Power windows can be l ETACS-ECU is faulty. Replace the ETACS-ECU
operated over 30 se-
after the ignition
switch has been turned
to OFF.
Power windows can be l Power window main switch (driver’s side door) Check according to Flow Chart
operated by means of is faulty. (Refer to
the power window sub
switches (passengers’
side), but can not by
means of the power ,
window main switch
(driver’s side).
Passenger’s side pow- l Power window sub switch (passenger’s side Check according to Flow Chart
window can be door) is faulty. (Refer to
by means of the
power window main
switch (driver’s side),
but can not by means
of the power window
sub switches (passen-
gers’ side).
the power win- l Broken wire in power window up signal circuit. to Flow Chart
are not lowered l Convertible top control module. (Refer to
the power
do not lower ‘.
if the con-
top switch is
to open or close.
the power win- l Broken wire in ground input signal circuit. Check according to Chart
are not lowered l Power window main switch (driver’s side door) (Refer to
and the power is faulty.
main switch’s l Convertible top control module is faulty.
ock switch is OFF, the
side
window does not
automatically if
he convertible top
is set to open or
However, the
side
window lowers
when the lock
is ON.
TSB Revision I
42-36 BODY Door:
NG
Check the Scan Tool Input Signal Check the harnesses between the Repair
Ignition switch input signal tion switch and the ETACS-ECU.
OK: The scan tool buzzer sounds once
when the ignition switch is ON.
OK
NG
Power window relay continuity Replace
check (Refer to
. Power window main switch conti-
nuity check (Refer to
. Power window sub switch continu-
ity check (Refer to
. Power window motor check
(driver’s side and passengers’
side) (Refer to
NG
Repair
and
Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
Voltage between terminal (5) Check trouble symptom.
and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
Measure at the window main
switch connector
. Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side.
Continuity between terminal (2) Check the harness between the power
and ground window main Repair,
if necessary.
OK
NG NG
Measure at the power window motor Check the Repair
connector (driver’s side) and and
(passenger’s side).
. Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side. NG
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness between the power
Continuity between terminals window main switch and the power win-
(2) and ground dow motor side and
OK: Continuity gers’ side). if
OK
TSB Revision
A When ignition switch is turned to’ ON,
The quarter window (power window) Power window main switch Measure at the power window motor
check (Refer to connector and
l sub switch continuity (passenger’s side).
check (Refer to
l Power window motor check measure at the harness
side and passengers’ side) (Refer Continuity between
to and ground
Check the harnesses between the igni- window main switch and
tion switch and the ETACS-ECU. window motor, and between the
Thescantool buzzersoundsonce convertible top
I when the ianition switch is ON. power window
Repair window and
top control module. .
NG
Replace
check (Refer to
Replace the top
NG
Measure at the power window
Repair
and
the
Measure at the power main
Check trouble symptom.
switch connector
l Disconnect the connector and
measure at the harness side. Repair
Continuity between terminal (2) and
Check trouble symptom.
ground
window relay and the power window NG
OK: Continuity
OK Check the harness between the pourer
if necessary,
Repair Check the harness between the power
window relay and the ETACS-ECU. Repair
OK
ETACS-ECU.
Revision
42-38 BODY Door
Power windows can be operated even when a door is opened within 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned to OFF.
NG
Check the Scan Tool Input Signal side door switch input circuit system check
Door switch input signal to GROUP 54 Ignition Switch)
OK: The scan tool buzzer sounds once when the door switch is
ON.
OK
the ETACS-ECU
Power windows can be operated by means of the power window sub switches (passengers’ side),
but can not by means of the power main switch (driver’s side).
NG
Replace
(Refer to
OK
NG
Repair
and <ECLIPSE> <ECLIPSE
OK
Check the harness between the power window main switch and
the window if
Passenger’s side power window can be operated by means of the power window main switch (driver’s
side), but can not by means of the power window sub switches (passengers’ side).
NG
Power window sub switch continuity check Replace
(Refer to
OK
NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
and
OK
Check the harness between the power window sub switch and
the power window relay. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
BODY Door
Check the harness between the power window main switch and
the convertible top control module. Repair, if necessary.
When the power windows are not lowered fully and the power window main
lock switch is OFF, the passenger’s side power window does not lower automatically if
the convertible top switch is set to open or close. However, the passenger’s, side.
window lowers automatically when the lock switch ON;
NG
Replace
.
OK
Check the following connectors:
and
NG
Revision
BODY Door
When the central door lock switch is l Malfunction of central door lock Check according to Flow Chart A
operated, all doors are not locked or switch (Refer to
unlocked. Incorrect connector connection
or malfunction of harness
When the driver’s side door lock is l Malfunction of driver’s side door Check according to Chart
turned with the key or if the driver’s lock actuator switch (Refer to
side door inside door lock knob is op- l Incorrect connector connection
another door is not locked or or malfunction of harness
unlocked. l Malfunction of ETACS-ECU
When the driver’s side door lock is l Malfunction of driver’s side door Check according to Flow Chart
turned with key, another door is not key cylinder switch (Refer to
unlocked. l Incorrect connector connection
or malfunction of harness
l Malfunction of ETACS-ECU
the passenger’s side door lock l Malfunction of passenger’s side Check according to Flow Chart
turned with key, another door is not door key cylinder switch (Refer to
or unlocked. Incorrect connector connection
or malfunction of harness
A When the central door lock switch is operated, all doors are not locked or unlocked. I
Measure at the door lock switch connector (L.H.) and Check the harness between the door lock switch and the door
(R.H.) lock power relay Repair, if necessary.
Disconnect the connector and measure at harness side.
L.H.: between terminal and ground
O K : positive voltage Check the harness between the door lock switch and the ground.
R.H.: Voltage between terminal (5) and ground Repair, if
OK: positive voltage
(2) L.H.: Continuity between terminal (2) and ground
OK: Continuity
Continuity between terminal (7) and ground
OK: Continuity
OK
NG
Door lock actuator check (Refer Replace
OK
Check the harness between the door lock actuator and the door
lock power relay 1. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
BODY Door
Measure at the door lock power relay 1 connector and the Check the ‘the fusible and the;
door lock power relay 2 connector power relay 1, and link and door
Disconnect the connector and measure at harness side. power relay 2. if necessary.
Voltage between terminal (7) and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage Check harness the door lock power 1 the
(2) Continuity between terminal (2) and ground ground, and the door relay ground.
OK: Continuity Repair, if necessary.
OK
Measure at the door lock switch connector (L.H.) and Check the harness between the door
(R.H.)
Disconnect the connector and measure at harness side. door lock power relay 2. Repair; if
L.H.: Voltage between terminal (I), (4) and ground
OK: Battery positive voltage Check the harness between the door lock switch and the ground. .
Voltage between terminal (5) and ground Repair, if necessary.
OK: Battery positive voltage
(2) L.H.: Continuity between terminal (2) and ground
OK: Continuity
Continuity between terminal (7) and ground
OK: Continuity
OK
NG
Replace
OK
Check the harness between the door lock actuator and the door
lock power relay and between the door lock actuator and the
door lock power relay 2. Repair, if necessary.
TSB Revision
42-42 BODY Door
When the driver’s side door lock is turned with the key if the driver’s inside
knob is operated, another door is not locked.
.
Check the scan tool input signal
Actuator switch (driver’s side) input signals
OK: The scan tool buzzer sounds once when actuator switch (driv-
er’s side door) is unlocked.
NG
NG
Door lock actuator check Replace
NG
Repair
and
Check the harness between the actuator switch (driver’s side) and
the ground. Repair, if necessary.
When the driver’s side door lock is turned with key, another door is not unlocked.
OK
Check the scan tool input signal Check the harness between the door power relay and the
Key cylinder switch (driver’s side) input signals ETACS-ECU.
OK: The scan tool buzzer sounds once when key cylinder switch
(driver’s side door) is LOCK or UNLOCK.
NG
Check the harness between the key cylinder switch (driver’s side)
and the ground. Repair, if
TSB Revision
BODY
NG
Door lock key cylinder SW
(Refer to
..
NG
Check the following Repair .
and .
OK
If the driver’s side inside lock knob is l Broken wire in input circuit in door
locked under the following conditions, the switch. Chart A
door can not be locked: l Door switch is faulty.
l The key is inserted in the ignition key l
cylinder. .
l The driver’s side door is closed.
If the driver’s side inside lock knob ‘is l Broken wire in input circuit in Check
locked under the following conditions, the switch.
door will be locked: l Door switch is faulty. (Refer-to
l The key is inserted in the ignition key l
cylinder. l Broken wire in input in key
l The driver’s side door is opened. reminder switch.
l ETACS-ECU is faulty
If the driver’s side inside lock knob is Check according to
locked under the following conditions, the reminder switch.
door can not be locked: l Key reminder. switch is faulty. (Refer to
l The key is removed from the ignition l
key cylinder.
l The driver’s side door is opened.
TSB Revision
BODY
TROUBLE SYMPTOM INSPECTION
A If the driver’s side inside lock knob is under the following conditions, the door not
locked:
l The key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder.
l The driver’s side door is closed.
NG
Door switch continuity check Replace
(Refer to
NG
Measure at the door switch connector
the ETACS-ECU
Replace the ETACS-ECU
If the driver’s side inside lock knob is locked under the following conditions, the door will be locked:
l The key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder.
l The driver’s side door is opened.
NG
Replace
Switch.)
NG
Measureatthe Measure at the ETACS-ECU connector Check the harness between the key
ETACS-ECU.
. Disconnect the connector and . Disconnect the connector and if
measure at harness side measure at the side (key
. Voltage between terminal (6) and reminder switch OFF)
ground . Continuity between terminal (17)
OK: Approx. and ground
OK: No continuity
OK
TSB Revision
BODY Door
If the driver’s side inside lock knob is locked under the following conditions, the door can not
locked:
l The key is removed from the ignition key cylinder.
l The driver’s side door is opened.
and
OK
NG
Check the connectors:
and
between (4)
OK
Check trouble symptom.
NG
TSB Revision
BODY Door
Wind noise around Weatherstrip not holding firmly Adjust fit of door
door
Improperly installed weatherstrip or setting of Repair or replace
weatherstrip
TSB Revision
BODY Door
HOW TO LOCATE
(1) Attach cloth tape to every such as panel seams,
projections, molding seams, glass and body seams, etc.
which might conceivably be the source of wind noise.
(2) Then make a road test to check that the places not covered
by tape are not sources of wind noise.
(7) Check to confirm that wind noise occurs when the last
remaining tape is removed, and that noise does not occur
when it is re-attached.
(8) When the source(s) of the wind noise is finally located,
attach butyl tape, body sealer or similar material to obstruct
this source as much as possible.
42-48 BODY Door
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
DOOR FIT ADJUSTMENT
1. Use the special tool to loosen the hinge mounting bolts
on the body
2. When there is a stepped section in the door and body,
use the special loosen the door hinge mounting
bolt on the door side and adjust the door fit.
Caution
Attach protection tape to the fender. edges the
hinge is installed.
3. If the door is hard to open or close, use the shim or
move the striker up and down or left and right to adjust
the linking of the striker and the door latch.
Inner stabilizer
DOOR WINDOW GLASS ADJUSTMENT 423001001~0
Delta sash
1. Remove the door trim and waterproof film. (Refer to
NOTE
Move the window glass down to the lowest position before
removing the delta sash bolt.
4. Lower the door window glass fully. a feeler gage
with a thickness of mm in.) ‘between the
glass stabilizer (nylon fiber the belt line molding
and the glass.
Adjust the two bolts so that the inner stabilizer is pressing
against the glass, and then tighten the inner stabilizer
nuts.
5. Raise the door window glass, and adjust it so that the
following dimensions are at the standard value.
TSB Revision
.
NOTE
Glass longitudinal adjustments should be carried -out at the same time.
bracket
11. Open and close the door and raise and lower the window
glass and check the glass installation against the following
points.
(1) The clearance between the glass and the glass
should be within the range of standard values
<ECLIPSE> when the window is fully closed and the
door is closed gently
Standard value (b): 4.8 mm in.)
Section A-A (c): 6.3 1.0 mm in.)
(e): 13.0 mm , in.)
NOTE
If the clearance is too small, the glass
above the glass when the door is closed. If the clear-
ance is too large, wind noise may be generated at
high vehicle speeds because the glass is not’
Section B-B hooked onto the glass.
(2) The amount of catch of the door catch on the door’
glass and the amount of step between the door glass
and the weatherstrip should be at the standard values
a, under the following
when the door is closed and then-the is closed
fully
when the window is closed fully and then the door
is closed
Standard value (a): 1.6 mm in.)
Section C-C 1.9 mm in.)
<ECLIPSE>
(3) The door glass should slide smoothly over its full
range of movement when the door is closed.
TSB Revision
BODY Door
00000145
DOWN
CIRCUIT BREAKER (INCORPORATED IN THE
UP
POWER WINDOW MOTOR) CHECK
1. Lift the UP switch to fully close the window glass, and
continue to lift the switch for 40 seconds.
2. As soon as the UP switch is released, press the DOWN
switch. The circuit-breaker can be considered good if
at this time the door window glass begins to open within
60 seconds.
6980046
TSB Revision
42-52 BODY Door
DOOR ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Door Post-installation Operation
l Door Adjustment (Refer to
26
20
Nm
16
6
26
20
22
16
22 I
16
TSB Revision
BODY Door
SERVICE POINT
DOOR CHECK
Install the door check so that identification mark
upwards.
INSPECTION
DOOR SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK
TSB Revision
BODY Door
NOTE
Indicates the clip positions
Removal steps
1. Clip 7. Pull handle bracket
2. Regulator handle 8. Door inside handle
3. Escutcheon 9. Door speaker assembly
4. Pull handle box 10. Speaker cover
Waterproof film
5. 6. Cover Door trim
TSB Revision
BODY Door
R E M O V A L
(A, CLIP REMOVAL
Remove the clip by using a shop and then
the regulator handle.
00000124
Front of vehicle
COVER REMOVAL
Remove the cover mounting screw and cover
Cover by pushing it toward the front of the vehicle to ‘remove the
clamp section from the door inside handle.
section
Door inside handle
INSTALLATION SERVICE
REGULATOR INSTALLATION
l i n e (1) Install the escutcheon and the clip to the regulator handle.
(2) Fully close the door glass, and install the regulator handle
so that it faces as shown in the illustration.
,
Front of vehicle
TSB Revision
BODY Door
.
DOOR GLASS AND REGULATOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
Door Trim and Film Removal l Door Window Glass Adjustment (Refer to
l Belt Line Molding Installation (Refer
Belt Line Molding Removal (Refer to l Door Trim and Waterproof Film Installation
(Refer to
10
8 00003676
TSB Revision
BODY Door
INSPECTION
POWER WINDOW MOTOR CHECK
(1) Check that the motor runs smoothly the battery
is connected directly to the terminals:
(2) Furthermore, check that the operates in reverse
when the terminal connections switched:
TSB Revision
BODY Door
Main switch
Power window
driver’s side switch
Switch position Connector A Connector
terminal No. No.
Power window 2131617.1819 5
Driver’s
Side
Switch
Passenger’s UP
Side Switch OFF 0 0
DOWN
OFF 0
Connector A Connector
Sub switch
Door lock switch
Power window switch
TSB Revision
DOOR HANDLE AND LATCH
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
operation Operation
Door Trim Removal (Refer to l Inside Handle Play Adjustment
(Refer to
l Door Trim Installation (Refer to
l Door Fit Adjustment (Refer to
9 Nm
7
00000150
Central door lock switch removal Door handle and latch removal
steps 3. Door inside handle
1. Pull handle box Waterproof film (Refer to
2. Central door lock switch 4. connector with
central door locking system)
5. Door lock key assembly
6. Door latch assembly
7. Door outside handle
TSB Revision
BODY Door
LOCK . INSPECTION
DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR CHECK
<Driver’s side>
(1) After setting the rod to the LOCK position, apply battery
voltage to terminal 3 and check if the rod moves as far
as the UNLOCK position when terminal 4 is grounded.
(2) After setting the rod to the UNLOCK position and applying
battery voltage to terminal 4, check if the rod moves as
far as the LOCK position when terminal 3 is grounded.
(3) When the rod is set to the UNLOCK position, check if
there is continuity between terminal 1 and terminal 2,
and when the rod is set to the LOCK position, check
that there is no continuity.
side>
(1) After setting the rod to the LOCK position, apply battery
voltage to terminal 4 and check if the rod moves as far
as the UNLOCK position when terminal 3 is grounded.
(2) After setting the rod to the UNLOCK position and applying
battery voltage to terminal 3, check if the rod moves as
far as the LOCK position when terminal 4 is grounded.
(3) When the rod is set to the UNLOCK position, check if
there is continuity between, terminal 2 and terminal 1.
Also, when the rod is set to the LOCK position, check
that there is no continuity.
Neutral
Driver’s
Unlock
Passenger’:
side: Lock
BODY Door
side> ,
side>
Switch position Terminal No..
Door lock switch
7 ,
LOCK 0
Neutral (OFF)
.
UNLOCK 0 0
00000152
TSB Revision 1
Door
TSB Revision
BODY Door
1 ’
TSB Revision
BODY
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Improper closure Striker and latch not properly aligned Adjust the alignment
Difficult locking and unlocking Striker and latch not properly aligned Adjust the alignment
Uneven body clearance Incorrectly installed Adjust the installation of
Uneven Incorrect bumper height Adjust the bumper height
TSB Revision
BODY
,
of clearance around
iftgate
TSB Revision
BODY __ .
LUBRICANT POINTS
00003811
INSPECTION
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
CHECK (INCLUDING LATCH)
Switch position Terminal No.
1 2 (Ground)
ON (Latch open) 0 0
OFF (Latch shut)
TSB Revision
BODY Trunk Lid
TRUNK LID
TROUBLESHOOTING <ECLIPSE
Symptom Probable cause Remedy
Improper closure Striker and latch not properly aligned Adjust the alignment
Uneven body clearance Incorrectly installed trunk lid Adjust the installation of trunk lid
Uneven height Incorrect trunk lid bumper height Adjust the trunk lid bumper height
TSB Revision
BODY Trunk Lid
TRUNK LID
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION <ECLIPSE
TSB Revision
BODY Trunk Lid
BUMPER INSTALLATION
Install the bumper as shown in the figure.
Trunk lid
in.)
Bumper
TSB Revision I
BODY Trunk Lid Lock Release Handle and Cable
. .
Adjustment of trunk lid step
frunk lid striker linkage
.
TSB Revision
42-72 BODY Entry System
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION CHART FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS
Trouble symptom Probable cause Remedy
No doors can be The indicator light of the transmitter l Dead transmitter battery Check according to
locked or unlocked. does not illuminate when the trans- l Malfunction of transmitter Flow Chart A
mit switch is pressed. (Refer to
A transmission signal is being sent l Malfunction of central Check according to
from the transmitter (indicator light door locking system Flow Chart
luminates) but the door lock does not l Malfunction of receiver (Refer to
operate. l Malfunction of
ECU
Not all of the doors can be locked or unlocked. l Malfunction of door lock Check according to
actuator Flow Chart
(Refer to
All doors can be locked and unlocked with the transmitter, but l Malfunction of receiver Check according to
the dome light and foot light do not flash or illuminate. Flow Chart
the dome light operation is normal when a door is opened (Refer to
and closed.)
No secret code can be registered. l Malfunction of receiver Check according to
Malfunction of scan tool Flow Chart
(Refer to
When all doors are locked with the transmitter, the theft-alarm l Malfunction of receiver Check according to
system is not set. (The SECURITY indicator doesn’t illuminate, l Malfunction of ETACS- Flow Chart
the alarm doesn’t function.) <Vehicles with theft-alarm ECU. (Refer to
the PANIC switch of the transmitter is pressed, the head- l Malfunction of receiver Check according to
ights do not flash and the horns do not sound. (However, the l Malfunction of ETACS- Flow Chart
heft-alarm functions normally.) <Vehicles with theft-alarm ECU to
em>
Does the indicator light illuminate when the batteries are replaced? Replace the transmitter.
TSB Revision
System
Can the doors be locked and unlocked with the key at the driver’s Check the door locking system. (Refer to
side door?
,
YES
Has the secret code been programmed correctly? l secret (Refer to
YES
Receiver terminal voltage check (Refer to Check the following
and 549
OK
Check the following connectors:
and
NOTE
l : Carry when or or
the code has been programmed
Door lock actuator check (Refer to Replace the door lock actuator.
OK
N G
Check the following connectors:
If driver’s side door does not operate
and
If side door does not
and
OK
Check and repair the harness between the ETACS-ECU and the
door lock actuator of the door that will not operate.
Revision
BODY Entry System
All doors can be locked and unlocked with the transmitter, but the dome light and foot light do
not flash or illuminate. (However, the dome light operation is normal when a door is opened and
closed.)
NG
Measure at the receiver connector Replace the receiver.
l Disconnect the connector and measure at the harness side.
l Set the dome light switch in DOOR position, and then measure
the voltage between terminal (11) and ground.
OK: Battery positive voltage
OK
Check the harnesses between the dome light and foot light and
the receiver. Repair, if necessary.
No
Check the following connectors:
ETACS-ECU possible l Voltage between terminal (16) and and
Yes ground
OK: Battery positive
l (5)
Measure at the data link connector and ground
and the receiver connector OK: Continuity Check trouble symptom.
l Disconnect the connector and
I
sure at the harness side.
l Continuity between following termi- Replace the scan tool.
nals:
Receiver side Data link
connector side
7 1 NG NG
OK: Continuity Check the following connector:
OK I
Repair
OK
the receiver.
TSB Revision
BODY Entry System
When all doors are locked with the transmitter, the theft-alarm system is not set. (The SECURITY
indicator doesn’t illuminate, and the alarm doesn’t function.)
<Vehicles with theft-alarm system>
When all doors are locked with the key, is the theft-alarm system Check the theft-alarm to GROUP 54
set? System.)
Yes
, NG
Check the following connectors: and Repair
OK
When the PANIC switch of the transmitter is pressed, the headlights do not flash and the horns
do not sound. (However, the theft-alarm functions normally.)
with theft-alarm system>
[Comment]
When the PANIC switch is pressed, the receiver sends a PANIC signal to ETACS-ECU. Then the ECU flashes the headlights and sounds
the horns intermittently for approx. three minutes.
The headlights and horns share an operation circuit with the theft-alarm system. Because of this, if the theft-alarm system functions normally,
the harness between the receiver and the ETACS-ECU mav be defective.
NG
Check the operation of the theft-alarm system. (Refer to GROUP
54 Theft-alarm System.)
Carry out troubleshooting for the theft-alarm 1’
Repair
OK
Check trouble 1
NG
NG
harness Check the harness wire between the receiver and ETACS-ECU.
side.
l Voltage between the terminal (15) and ground
OK: (Pulse output)
OK
the receiver.
NOTE
l : Using an oscilloscope
TSB Revision
42-76 BODY Entry System
TSB Revision
BODY Entry System
ENTRY SYSTEM
REMOVAL AND
Pre-removal and Post-installation Operation
l Quarter trim (L.H.) (Refer to GROUP Trims.)
Removal steps
1. Door lock power relay 2
2. Receiver assembly
TSB Revision
BODY Entry System
Removal steps
l Rear seat (Refer to GROUP
Rear Seat.)
1. Door lock power relay 2
(for entry system)
2. Receiver assembly
TSB Revision
BODY Entry System
INSPECTION
DOOR LOCK POWER RELAY 2 CHECK
Refer to
REPLACEMENT
(1) insert a screwdriver in a slit in the transmitter
pry it lightly to open the case. Then take the battery out
of the transmitter.
(2) Install a new battery with its positive side down.
Replacement battery: Coin type battery 2
(3) Firmly close the transmitter case.
(4) Check that the entry system operates properly.
Battery
Caution
When the transmitter is opened, be not to
allow water, dust, etc. to to the
In addition, do not touch the precision electronic
device.
TSB Revision
Entry System
TSB Revision
BODY Under Cover
UNDER COVER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
00003746
1. Front center under cover panel 5. Rear seat under cover panel
2. Lower front bumper plate 6. Rear crossmember under cover
3. Front splash shield panel
4. Under cover side panel 7. Rear floor under cover panel
Revision
42-82 BODY Sunroof
SUNROOF
GENERAL
A motor-driven outer slide-type glass sunroof with a sufficient amount of lighting and a feeling of
a tilt-up mechanism is provided as an option for openness can still be obtained by opening the
all models. Even when the sunroof is fully closed, sunroof sunshade.
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
WATER TEST
1. Close the roof lid tightly.
in.)
2. Hold the hose upward and adjust water fountain to about
50 cm (20 in.) high.
3. Pour water over the roof from about 30 cm (12 in.) above
roof for more than 5 minutes.
Hose
4. While pouring water, check, for leak around the roof lid.
5. In the event of leakage, check the drain pipe, weatherstrip
contact and others.
TSB Revision
BODY Sunroof
OPERATION CHECK
Check the following items. If defective, replace the sunroof control unit.
Caution
Check that the following items are normal before carrying out this operation check.
(1) Installation condition of the sunroof assembly
(2) Installation condition, deforms and foreign material of the sunroof drive cable
(3) Unfitted sunroof lid glass
(4) Sunroof switch and sunroof motor
TSB Revision
B O D Y ,
SUNROOF
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
l Sunroof Fit Adjustment (Refer to
l Water Test (Refer to
44
27 35
TSB Revision
BODY Sunroof
ADHESION POINTS
glass seal
TSB Revision
BODY ,
‘SUNROOF
SUNSHADE REMOVAL
(1) Remove the rear sunroof pushing. in’
the slide blocks to release guide
assembly on one side of the sunshade.
out of roof opening.
(2) Repeat the step (1) for the front ‘sunroof sunshade.
SUNSHADE BLOCK
Spring Squeeze together your fingers on inboard end of the slide
block to allow the slide block to slide. out channel,
and then remove the slide block and spring.
Slide block
Sunroof drive
cable end
42-88 BODY Sunroof
TSB Revision
FRONT SUNROOF SUNSHADE/REAR SUNROOF
SUNSHADE INSTALLATION
(1) Install the front sunroof sunshade first by inserting the
slide blocks on the right side of the sunshade into the
lower slide position of the right guide assembly.
(2) Push the sunshade slide blocks on the left side of the
sunshade into the sunshade to allow the front sunroof
sunshade to drop into position. Once in position, engage
the slide blocks into the lower channel of the left guide
assembly.
INSPECTION
SUNROOF SWITCH CHECK
Operate the sunroof switch and check the continuity between
each of the terminals.
Switch position Terminal
1 3
OPEN 0 0
OFF
CLOSE 0 0
TSB Revision
BODY Convertible Top
TROUBLESHOOTING
INSPECTION CHART FOR TROUBLE SYMPTOMS
,
Trouble symptom Probable cause Remedy
Operation does not take place when l Convertible top switch is faulty Check -according to A
the convertible top switch is set to l Convertible top bypass switch is (Refer to
open and close when the convertible faulty
top bypass switch is set to OFF. l Convertible top control module
is faulty .
Opening or closing with the convert- l Broken wire in convertible top Check Chart ,
ible top switch is not possible. switch power supply circuit (Refer to
l Convertible top switch is faulty
l Convertible top control module
is faulty
l Check according to Flow Chart
A (Refer to
Operation takes place when the l Broken wire in vehicle speed
convertible top switch is set to open sensor circuit
or close during travel. l Convertible control module is
faulty
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible ,.
NG
l Convertible top switch continuity
check (Refer to
l top bypass switch
OK
OK
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible T OP
Operation takes place when the convertible top switch is set to open or close during
travel.
NG
Check trouble symptom
Simulated vehicle speed of 4 km/h and
(2 mph) or more
OK: Convertible too does not ooerate. NG
Check trouble
control mod-
NG
and
OK
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible Top
View A
18
View A
7 6 7
Removal steps
l Quarter belt moulding 3. Strip
(Refer to GROUP 51 Mouldings.) 4. Side attaching hook
Quarter trim, lower 5. Defogger connector
(Refer to GROUP Trims.) l (Refer to GROUP
l Rear speaker
(Refer to GROUP 54 Speaker.) 6. Rear strap
1. drive motor connector 7. Drain trough rear attaching clip
2. Clip 8. Convertible top assembly
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible
SERVICE POINT
CONVERTIBLE TOP ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
(1) Insert rear bow into back of top area first.
Caution
Use care not to rip the drain trough during convertible
top removal.
TSB Revision
42-96 BODY Electric Convertible
DRIVEN GEAR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Removal steps
l Quarter trim, lower (Refer to GROUP
Trims.)
1. Balance link installation screw
2. Bushing
3. Main pivot bolt
4. Bushing
5. driven gear
BUSHING INSTALLATION
bushing” to balance link (shown orientation).
(2) Install balance link into main pivot complete bracket.
(3) Insert balance link installation screw, then tighten the
screw.
TSB Revision
42-98 BODY Electric Convertible Top
HEADLINER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
‘3
Removal steps
1. Snaps
2. Front headliner attaching strap
3. Center headliner attaching strap
4. Headliner
REMOVAL SERVICE POINTS
FRONT HEADLINER ATTACHING STRAP
REMOVAL
From a completely closed position, open the convertible top
half-way.
HEADLINER REMOVAL
Mark the bows lightly at the end of each retainer, then pry
the retainer from the bow. Remove the headliner.
DRIVE MOTOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Post-installation Operation
Convertible top fit adjustment (Refer to
1
20 25
14 -18
2
Removal steps
l Quarter trim, lower (Refer to GROUP NOTE
Trims.) This illustration shows the right side.
l Rear speaker bracket A (Refer to The left side is symmetrical to the right side.
GROUP 54 Speaker.)
1. Rear speaker bracket
2. Spacer
3. drive motor
REMOVAL SERVICE
MOTOR
Remove lower bolts with spacers first, then upper bolts.
INSPECTION
(1) Check that the motor runs smoothly when the battery
is connected directly to the motor terminals.
(2) Furthermore, check that the motor operates in reverse
when the terminal connections are switched.
BODY Electric Convertible
Removal steps
1. Clip
2. Front roof weatherstrip
3. Front pillar weatherstrip holder’
4. Front roof weatherstrip holder
Revision
BODY Electric Convertible Top
Adhesive tape:
ATD Part or equivalent
00004748
4. center
5. center weatherstrip
6. rear rail weatherstrip
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible Top
BALANCE LINK
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Removal steps
Quarter trim, lower NOTE
(Refer to GROUP Trims.) This illustration shows the left side.
1. Front healiner attaching strap The right side is symmetrical to the side.
2. Center headliner attaching strap
3. Bushing
4. Balance link
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible Top
REMOVAL A N D I N S T A L L A T I O N
NOTE
indicates the metal clip position.
Removal steps
1. Stopper
2. Center air outlet assembly
3. Convertible top switch
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible
INSPECTION , ..
Switch position
4 5
OPEN 0 0
CLOSE 0 0
Removal steps
1. Convertible top bypass switch
TSB Revision
BODY Electric Convertible Top
INSPECTION
Switch position Terminal No.
1 2 3
A 0
OFF 0
MANUAL
Removal steps
1. Front side-marker light 4. bumper corner plate
2. Front bumper center plate 5. Pad
3. Front bumper assembly Front fascia bracket
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Front Bumper
Disassembly
1. Front fog light bezel 6. Front bumper
2. Air intake cover 7. Front bumper core
3. Front license plate bracket 8. Front bumper stay assembly
4. Bolt plate 9. Front bumper face
5. Front bumper side plate
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Rear Bumper
REAR BUMPER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post-installation Operation
Rear End Trim and Rear Side Trim Removal and
Installation (Refer to GROUP Trims.)
Removal steps
1. Rear panel garnish
2. Rear combination light
3. Rear bumper upper plate (A)
4. Rear bumper upper plate (B)
5. Connector harness
6. Rear bumper assembly
7. Rear bumper side plate
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Rear, Bumper
8’
Disassembly steps
1. License plate light
2. Back-up light
3. Rear bumper lower plate
4. Rear bumper reinforcement
5. Rear bumper core
6. Rear bumper stay assembly
7. License plate light bracket
8. Rear bumper face
TSB Revision I
51-6 EXTERIOR Garnishes , .
GARNISHES
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
13 Nm 1
9
9 .
Front deck garnish removal steps Rear panel garnish removal steps
1. Wiper arm assembly l Rear end trim
2. Front deck garnish (Refer to GROUP Trims)
3. Rear panel garnish
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Moldings
MOLDINGS
SEALANT AND ADHESIVE
Items Specified sealant and adhesive
Side protector molding Part No. 6382 or equivalent and
ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane Primer or equivalent
MOLDINGS
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
<ECLIPSE>
Adhesive tape:
ATD Part No. 6382 or equivalent
15 mm in.) wide and 1.2 mm in.) thick
Adhesive:
ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane Primer or equivalent
Revision
51-8 EXTERIOR Moldings .
<ECLIPSE
Adhesive tape:
ATD Part No. 6382 or equivalent
15 mm in.) wide and 1.2 mm in.) thick
Adhesive:
ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane Primer or equivalent
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Moldings:
REMOVAL SERVICE
Masking tape
PROTECTOR MOLDING REMOVAL ,
(1) Apply masking tape to the outside circumference of the
side protector molding.
desin spatula
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Moldings
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Aero Parts
AERO PARTS
SEALANT AND ADHESIVE
Specified sealant and adhesive I
Door garnish, Side air dam ATD Part No. 6382 or equivalent and
ATD Part No. 8608 Super Fast Urethane Primer or equivalent
AERO PARTS
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Aero Parts
00005472
I
Adhesive tape:
ATD Part No. 6383 or equivalent
0.2 mm in.) thick
Removal steps
1. Rear spoiler assembly
2. Rear center spoiler assembly
3. Rear spoiler cover
4. Rear side spoiler
5. Bracket
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Wiper and .
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Windshield and Washer
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING HINTS
1. Wipers do not operate. 5. The length of pause for intermittent operation
1) Washer is not operative, either. cannot be varied.
l Check multi-purpose fuse No. 9. l Check variable intermittent. wiper ‘control
l Check ground. switch.
2. Low-speed (or high-speed) wiper operation only Check intermittent wiper relay.
is inoperative. 6. Washer is inoperative.
l Check wiper switch. 1) Wiper is operative on washer-wiper
3. Wipers do not stop. operation.
l Check wiper motor. l Check washer motor.
l Check intermittent wiper relay. 2) Washer-wiper operation’is inoperative also.
l Check wiper switch. l Check washer switch.
4. Intermittent wiper operation is inoperative. 7. Washer-wiper is inoperative.
l Check terminal voltage of steering-column l Check intermittent wiper relay.
switch (with a built-in intermittent wiper
relay) with the intermittent wiper relay
energezed.
Terminal No. Voltage C h e c k
8 ov Intermittent wiper relay or wiper switch
Battery positive voltage Intermittent wiper relay
positive voltage (alternating) (Normal)
TSB Revision
WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
<Non-turbo>
1
,
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Windshield Wiper and Washer
<Turbo> ,
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Windshield Wiper and Washer ,
CAUTION: SRS
Before removal of bag module and clock
spring, refer to the follows:
GROUP SRS Service Precautions.
GROUP Air Bag Module and Clock
Spring.
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Windshield Wiper and Washer
stop
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Windshield Wiper and
COLUMN SWITCH
<Wiper and Washer Switch>
Revision
EXTERIOR Rear Wiper and Washer
GENERAL
OPERATION
Low-speed wiper operation Intermittent wiper ,
l When the wiper switch is placed in the ON l When the wiper switch placed in the
(LO) position with the ignition switch in the ACC position with the ignition switch in ACC or ON
or ON position, the wiper operates continuously position, the intermittent relay is turned
at low speed. on and off.
Auto wiper stop operation l When the contacts are closed, the wiper motor
is energized.
l When the wiper switch is placed in the OFF l When the wiper motor is energized, the relay
position, the cam contacts of wiper motor contacts open; however, the cam contacts keep
causes current to flow through the auto wiper the wiper motor energized until the wiper blades
stop circuit, allowing the wiper blades to cycle return to their stop position.
before they reach to the stop positions.
SERVICE SPECIFICATION
I Standard value I
Rear wiper blade installation position mm (in.) I
TROUBLESHOOTING 51100070043
TROUBLESHOOTING HINTS
1. Wipers does not operate. 4. Wiper does not stop.
1) Windshield wiper is not operative, either. l Check the wiper motor.
l Check the multi-purpose fuse No. 9. l Check the intermittent wiper relay.
2. Low-speed wiper operation is inoperative. l Check the wiper switch.
l Check the wiper switch. 5. Washer is inoperative.
3. Intermittent wiper operation is inoperative. 1) Wiper is operative.
l Check terminal voltage of wiper switch (with l Check the washer motor.
a built-in intermittent wiper relay) with the l Check the washer switch.
intermittent wiper relay energezed. (see
table below.)
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Rear Wiper and
8
- 5
---- 7.4
5.4
Wiper and washer switch removal Washer tank and hose removal
steps steps
l Center air outlet assembly l Quarter upper trim (L.H.),
(Refer to GROUP 55 Ventilators.) quarter lower trim (L.H.) rear end trim,
1. Wiper and washer switch rear side trim, upper
(Refer, to GROUP Trims.)
Wiper motor removal steps 6. Washer nozzle
2. Wiper blade 7. Joint assembly
3. Wiper arm 8. Tube assembly
4. Spacer assembly Hose assembly
lower 10. Washer tank
(Refer to GROUP Trims.) 11. motor
5. Wiper motor
TSB Revision
51-22 EXTERIOR Rear and Washer
Turbo
00003533
Wiper and washer switch removal Washer tank and hose removal
steps steps
l Center air outlet assembly l Quarter upper trim (L.H.), quarter
(Refer to GROUP 55 Ventilators.) lower trim (L.H.), rear end trim, rear
1. Wiper and washer switch side trim, upper trim (Refer to
Wiper motor removal steps Trims)
6. Washer nozzle
2. Wiper blade 7. Joint assembly
3. Wiper arm 8. Tube assembly
4. Spacer assembly 9. Hose assembly
lower trim 10. Tube assembly
(Refer to GROUP Trims.) Spare tire
5. Wiper motor 11. Washer tank
12. Washer motor
TSB Revision
EXTERIOR Rear Wiper
TSB Revision
51-24 EXTERIOR Rear Wiper and Washer
INSPECTION 51100950022
WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK
LO 0
Washer switch OFF
I I I
ON I
Inspection stopped
00003634
TSB Revision
E X T E R I O R D o o r
DOOR MIRROR
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name
Ornament remover
DOOR MIRROR
REMOVAL INSTALLATION
<Electrically controlled
controlled mirror>
.
TSB Revision
51-26 EXTERIOR Door Mirror
section
INSPECTION
ELECTRICALLY CONTROLLED
Check that the mirror moves as described the
each terminal is connected to the
Battery connection terminal Direction of operation
16
1 2 3 UP
4 5 6 7 I
DOWN
LEFT
I RIGHT
Right side 0
TSB Revision
INTERIOR AND
SUPPLEMENTAL
RESTRAINT SYSTEM
CONTENTS
INTERIOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name Application
General Service tool Removal of switch, trim, etc.
Ornament remover
Thread diameter
Effective thread length
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Instrument Panel
14
5
NOTE
(1) Metal clip position
(2) Resin clip position
Removal steps
1. Meter bezel 9. Hood lock release handle
2. Combination meter Instrument under cover
3. Radio and tape player, and box 11. Center air outlet assembly
4. Console side cover 12. Heater control assembly
5. Sunglasses holder 13. Instrument panel switch
6. Stopper 14. Instrument under cover R.H.
7. Glove box 15. Front speaker
8. Passenger’s side air bag module 16. Instrument assembly
assembly
(Refer to GROUP Air Bag
Modules and Clock Spring.)
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Instrument Panel
II
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Instrument
TSB Revision
INTERIOR
.
Disassembly steps
1. Glove box under frame 6. Rheostat
2. Glove box light switch 7. Striker
3. Glove box light bracket 8. Side face garnish
4. Glove box striker 9. wiring harness
5. Defroster garnish
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Floor Console
FLOOR CONSOLE
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name Supersession Application
FLOOR CONSOLE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
When removing and installing the floor console as-
sembly, do not let it bump against the
NOTE
Metal clip position
Removal steps
1. Center console panel 5. Shift lever knob
2. Ashtray and cupholder assembly 6. Floor console assembly
3. Ashtray 7. Ashtray illumination light bracket
4. Cup holder
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Floor Console
Disassembly steps
1. Cup holder 9. Stopper
2. Inner box 10. Floor console lid
3. Floor console lid sub assembly 11. Floor console
Shift lever cover assembly
5. Hinge assembly NOTE
6. Inner lid (1) Vehicles with floor console lid
7. Lock lever (2) l *: Vehicles without floor console lid
8. Spring
Revision
INTERIOR Trims
TRIMS
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name A p p l i c a t i o n
TRIMS
<ECLIPSE>
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
00003812
Metal clip position
Resin clip position
B-B c - c
Clip
Quarter
Clip trim, upper
lip
I I
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Trims
B-B
E-E
Rear end trim
NOTE
Metal clip position
Resin clip position
Revision
<ECLIPSE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
<Interior side>
NOTE
Metal clip position
Resin clip position
00004754
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Trims
<Luggage compartment
Section D-D
Section G-G
Revision
REMOVAL SERVICE POINT ,
END TRIM REMOVAL
(1) Remove the four lower clips of end
(2) Remove the six upper clips of the rear end trim, and
then pull up the trim.
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Headlining
HEADLINING
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name Application
HEADLINING 52100140178
<ECLIPSE>
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post-installation Operation
l Front Pillar Trim and Quarter Trim Upper Removal
and Installation (Refer to
NOTE
Metal clip position
Removal steps
assembly
2. holder
3. Dome light assembly
4. Rear roof rail trim
5. Headlining
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Headlining
00003744
NOTE
Metal clip position
Removal steps
1. assembly
2. holder
3. Rear roof rail trim
4. Sunroof inner weatherstrip
5. Sunroof switch cover
6. Sunroof switch panel
7. Headlining
Adhered joint
INSTALLATION SERVICE POINT
SUNROOF INNER WEATHERSTRIP
INSTALLATION
Install the sunroof inner weatherstrip with its adhered joint
located toward the rear of the vehicle and on its center line.
Front of vehicle
INTERIOR Inside Rear View Mirror
00003741
Removal steps
1. Harness cover
2. Inside rear view mirror
<ECLIPSE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Removal steps
1. Inside rear view mirror stay cover
2. Harness connector
3. rear view mirror
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Inside Rear View Mirror 7
Revision .
INTERIOR Front Seat
FRONT SEAT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
22
1.
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat
Section B-B
Rear tab
tabs
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat
power
manual
8.3
11.3 Nm
8.3
Disassembly steps
1. Clip 14. Front seat cushion frame
2. Height adjuster knob 15. Stay
3. Seat slide adjuster lever 16. Lumber support knob (Driver’s
4. Reclining adjuster lever seat)
5. Power seat switch knob 17. Front seat back assembly
6. Power seat switch cover 18. Headrestraint guide
7. Front seat side shield cover 19. Front seat back cover
8. Front seat hinge cover 20. Front seat back pad
9. Front inner seat belt 21. Front seat back frame
10. Power seat switch 22. Front seat adjuster inner cover
11. Front seat cushion assembly 23. Reclining memory knob
12. Front seat cushion cover 24. Seat adjuster assembly
13. Front seat cushion pad
Revision
INTERIOR Seat
INSPECTION
POWER SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK
Switch position
Rear height UP 0 0
switch 0 0
Down 0 0
0 0
All switches OFF
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Rear Seat
REAR SEAT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
4.9 Nm
5 3.6
4.9 N m
Nm
<ECLIPSE
N O T E
Metal clip position
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Rear Seat
hook hole
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Rear Seat
<Bench
9.4
00005315
Disassembly steps
Rear seat cushion cover
2. Rear seat cushion pad
3. Knob
4. Garnish
5. Rear seat back hinge
6. Rear seat back cover
Rear seat back pad
8. Rear seat back frame
Revision
INTERIOR Rear Seat
ECLIPSE SPYDER
Disassembly steps
1. Rear seat cushion cover
2. Rear seat cushion pad
3. Rear seat back cover
4. Rear seat back pad
TSB Revision I
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt
SPECIAL TOOLS
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
INPUT SIGNAL INSPECTION POINTS
When Using the Scan
1. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector.
Caution
Turn the ignition switch OFF to connect or disconnect
the scan tool.
2. If buzzer of the scan sounds once when the front
seat belt buckle switch (L.H.) is operated (ON/OFF), ‘the
ETACS-ECU input signal for that switch circuit system
is normal.
When Using a Voltmeter
1. Use the special tool a voltmeter between the
ground terminal and the terminal of the data link’
connector.
2. If the voltmeter indicator deflects once when the front
seat belt buckle switch (LH) operated (ON/OFF), the
ETACS-ECU input signal for that circuit system
is normal.
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt
When the seat belts are not fastened and the ignition switch is turned to the ON 4
position, the seat belt warning light illuminates or flashes, but the seat belt warn-
ing buzzer does not sound.
When the seat belts are not fastened and the ignition switch is turned to the ON 5
position, the seat belt warning buzzer sound, but the seat belt warning light does
not illuminate nor flash.
After having the ignition switch turned to the ON position, the seat belt warning
buzzer does not stop sounding for six seconds, even though the seat belt is
buckled immediately.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
Communication with scan tool is not possible. Probable cause
(Communication with the one-shot pulse input signal only
is not possible.)
[Comment] l Malfunction of connector
The cause is probably a defective one-shot pulse input circuit system of the diagnostic l Malfunction of harness wire
line. l Malfunction of ETACS-ECU
OK NG
Check the following connectors: Repair
data link connector and junction block. and
NG OK
Repair Check trouble symptom.
NG
Replace the EATCS-ECU.
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 3 ,
When the seat belts are not fastened and the ignition Probable cause
switch is turned to the ON position, the seat belt warning
buzzer does not sound, and the seat belt warning light
does not illuminate nor flash.
[Comment] Malfunction of connector
It is possible that there is a malfunction of the power supply circuit (including of l Malfunction of harness
grounding) of ETACS-ECU. l Malfunction of ETACS-ECU
NG
Disconnect the junction Repair
and measure at the harness side.
NOTE
Without theft-alarm system
TSB Revision I
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 4 ,
When the seat belts are not fastened and the ignition Probable cause
switch is turned to the ON position, the seat belt warning
light illuminates or flashes, but the seat belt warning .
er does not sound.
[Comment] l Malfunction of front seat belt buckle
It is possible that there is a malfunction of the front seat belt switch circuit. l Malfunction of
l Malfunction of ETACS-ECU
NG
. Front seat belt buckle switch input circuit
sysyem check.
(Refer to
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 5
When the seat belts are not fastened and the ignition Probable cause
switch is turned to the ON position, the seat belt warning.,
buzzer sounds, but the seat belt warning light does not il-
luminate nor flash.
[Comment] l Malfunction of bulb
It is possible that there is a malfunction of the seat belt warning light circuit or l Malfunction of
ECU. l Malfunction of harness wire
l Malfunction of ETACS-ECU
OK
NG NG
the followina connectors:
OK
NG NG
Disconnectthejunction blockconnector Check the following connectors: Repair
and measure at the harness side. and
l Continuity between terminal (5) and
OK: Continuity NG
Check trouble symptom. Check the harness wire between
block and combination
Repair, if necessary.
trouble symptom. Replace the ETACS-ECU.
TSB Revision
Front Seat Belt
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 6
After having the ignition switch turned to the ON position, Probable cause
the seat belt warning buzzer does not stop sounding for
six seconds, even though the seat belt is buckled
ately.
l Malfunction of front seat buckle switch
It is possible that there is a malfunction of me front seat belt buckle switch circuit. Malfunction of
l Malfunction of harness wire
l of
NG
Scan tool input signal check Frontsaatbelt buckle switch input circuit
Front seat belt buckle switch system check
OK: When the front seat belt buckle (Refer to
switch is turned on, the scan tool
sounds once.
OK
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 7
Front seat belt buckle switch input system check
NG
Front seat belt buckle switch Replace
nuity check (Refer to
NG NG
Check the following
Disconnect front seat belt buckle switch and
connector and measure at the har-
ness OK
l
ground. Check trouble symptom.
OK: Approx. 5
Repair
l continuity between the
OK
trouble symptom.
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt
33
000053
Junction
Block
Front outer seat belt removal steps Front Inner seat removal ‘steps
l Rear seat cushion l Front seat
(Refer to (Refer to
1. Quarter trim, lower 12. Harness connector (driver’s side)
(Refer to 13. Front seat hinge cover
2. Coat hanger 14. Front inner seat belt
3. Rear seat belt sash guide cover
4. Rear seat belt anchor plate ETACS-ECU (Seat belt warning
5. Front seat belt sash guide cover light timer and buzzer) removal
6. Front seat belt anchor plate
7. Quarter trim, upper 15. ETACS-ECU (Refer to GROUP 54
(Refer to Ignition Switch.)
8. Adjustable seat belt anchor
9. Fuel harness protector
10. Front outer seat belt
11. Seat belt retractor cover
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt
<ECLIPSE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
44 Nm
33
33
Junction
Block
00005317
Front outer seat belt removal steps ETACS-ECU (Seat belt warning
l Quarter trim, lower (Refer to light timer and buzzer) removal
1. Front outer seat belt 5. ETACS-ECU (Refer to GROUP 54
Front inner seat belt removal steps Ignition Switch.)
l assembly (Refer to
.
2. Harness connector (Driver’s seat)
3. Front seat hinge cover
4. Front inner seat belt
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat Belt ,
INSTALLATION SERVICE
FRONT INNER SEAT BELT
Accurately insert the front inner seat belt claws into the holes
on the seat adjuster.
(2) Accurately insert the belt guide claws into the holes on
the body.
Belt gui
(3) Accurately insert the belt guide 5 claws into the holes
on quarter trim, lower.
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Front Seat. Belt/Rear, Belt
INSPECTION ,
FRONT SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH
CHECK , I’ ,
Switch position
2
ON 0
OFF .
,
REAR SEAT BELT
.,
SPECIAL TOOL
Tool Tool number and name S u p e r s e s s i o n Application
General service tool Removal of switch, trim etc.
TSB Revision .
INTERIOR Rear Seat Belt
44
NOTE
Metal clip position
Rear outer seat belt removal steps Rear inner seat belt removal steps
l Rear seat cushion l Rear seat cushion
, Refer to
4. ear inner seat belt
(Refer to
2. Rear seat belt sash guide cover
3. Rear outer seat belt
Revision
INTERIOR Rear Seat ‘Belt
<ECLIPSE
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
44
33
44
33
Rear outer seat belt removal steps Rear inner seat belt steps
l Quarter trim, side (Refer to l seat cushion (Refer to
1. Rear outer seat belt 2. Rear inner seat belt
TSB Revision
INTERIOR Rear Seat Belt
(2) Accurately insert the anchor plate claws into the holes
on the body.
(3) Install the anchor plate along the bead of the body.
TSB Revision
SUPPLEMENTAL,
SYSTEM
CONTENTS
CAUTION
l Carefully read and observe the information in the SERVICE PRECAUTIONS Prior to any service.
l For information troubleshooting or maintenance, always observe the procedures in the Troubleshooting
or the respectively.
l If any SRS components are removed or replaced in connection with any service procedures, be sure to follow the
dures the COMPONENT SERVICE section for the components involved.
l If you have any questions about the please contact the Tech. Line.
SRS General Information
GENERAL INFORMATION
INTRODUCTION
The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) is tional status of the SRS; spring-interconnec-
signed to supplement the driver’s and front passen- tion located within the the
ger’s seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity It is not until the SRS-ECU in response to the output
of injury to the driver and front passenger by activat- signal from the analog sensor, finds it necessary
ing and deploying both air bags in certain frontal to ignite the air bag, and the safing sensor is
collisions. caused to be ON that the SRS deploys the air
The SRS consists of: two air bag modules; one bag.
located in the center of the steering wheel and Only authorized service personnel should do work
another one located above the glove box, which on or around SRS components. Those service per-
contains. the folded air bag and an inflator unit; sonnel should read this manual carefully before
the SRS air bag control unit (SRS-ECU) located starting any such work. Extreme care must be used
under the floor console assembly, which monitors when servicing the SRS, to avoid to the ser-
the system, and which contains a safing sensor vice personnel (by inadvertent deployment of the
and analog sensor; an SRS warning light located air bag) or to driver (by rendering the SRS inopera-
on the instrument panel, which indicates the tive).
TSB Revision
SRS General
CONSTRUCTION DIAGRAM
VEHICLE IDENTIFI-
CATION CODE
CHART PLATE
SRS-ECU
(incorporated safing sensor
and analog sensor)
Air module
NOTE
This construction diagram displays the general view of the SRS components.
For details, refer to “Schematic” “Configuration Diagrams”
and “Circuit Diagram”
TSB Revision
SRS General Information
WARNING/CAUTION LABELS
A number of caution labels related to the SRS are If labels are dirty or damaged, replace them with
found in the vehicle, as shown in the following new ones.
lustration. Follow label instructions when servicing
SRS.
TSB Revision
SRS General- Jnformation
Label
A WARNING TO AVOID SERIOUS INJURY: DANGER POISON
For maximum safety protection in all types of Keep out of the reach of children. Contains sodium
crashes, you must always wear your safety belt. azide and potassium nitrate contents are poisonous
Do not install rearward-facing child seats in any front and extremely flammable. Contact with acid, water,
passenger seat position. or heavy metals may produce harmful and irritating
Do not sit or lean unnecessarily close to the air bag. gases or explosive compounds. Do not dismantle,
Do not place any objects over the air bag or between incinerate, bring into contact with electricity or store
the air bag and yourself. at temperatures exceeding
See the owner’s manual for further information and FIRST AID: If contents are swallowed induce
explanations. vomiting. For eye contact flush eye for 5
minutes. If gases from acid
inhaled, seek fresh air. In every case, get prompt
medical attention.
For additional information, see material safety data
sheet (MSDS) for this product.
CAUTION: SRS clock spring
This is not a repairable part. Do not disassemble or
tamper. If defective, replace entire unit per service
manual instructions. To re-center: Rotate
until tight. Then rotate in opposite direction
approximately 3 turns and align
3 Driver’s air bag information CAUTION: SRS
This vehicle has an air bag which will supplement Before removal of steering gear box, read service
the in certain frontal collisions. The air bag manual, center front wheels and remove ignition
is not a substitute for the in any type of key.
collision. The driver, and all other occupants, should Failure to do so may damage SRS clock spring and
wear at all times. render SRS system inoperative, risking serious
WARNING! driver injury.
If the warning light does not illuminate for
several seconds when ignition key is turned to
or the engine is started, or if the warning light stays
on while driving, take the vehicle to your nearest
authorized dealer immediately. Also if the vehicle’s
front end is damaged or if the air bag has deployed.
Take the vehicle for service immediately. WARNING: SRS
The air bag system must be inspected by an This air bag module cannot be repaired. ‘Do not
authorized dealer ten years after the vehicle disassemble or tamper.
manufacture date shown on the certification label Do not perform diagnosis. Do not touch with
located on the left front door-latch post or door electrical test equipment or probes.
frame. Refer to service manual for further instructions, and
Read the section of your owner’s manual for special handling.
before driving, for important information, about Storage and disposal procedures. Tampering or
operation, and service of the air bag system. mishandling can result in
When you are going to discard your gas generator DANGER POISON
or vehicle, please see your MITSUBISHI dealer. Keep out of the reach of children.
Contains sodium azide and potassium nitrate
contents are poisonous and extremely flammable.
CAUTION: Contact with acid, water or heavy metals may
Do not disassemble or drop. If defective, refer to produce harmful and irritating gases or explosive
service manual. compounds. Do not dismantle. Incinerate, bring into
contact with electricity or store at temperatures
CAUTION: SRS exceeding
Before replacing steering wheel, read service
manual, center front wheels and align SRS clock If contents are swallowed induce vomiting. For eye
spring neutral marks. Failure to do so may render contact flush eye with water for 15 minutes. If gases
SRS system inoperative, risking serious driver from acid or water contact are inhaled, seek fresh
injury. air. In every case, get prompt medical attention.
TSB Revision
SRS General Information
SCHEMATIC
IGNITION SWITCH
Combination meter
warning light)
Warning
Analog light drive
3 sensor circuit
Microprocessor
I I
I
I
air Passenger’s air bag
drive circuit
Scan tool
interface
circuit
Clock
spring
TSB Revision
SRS General Information
CONFIGURATION DIAGRAMS
Dash panel
-18
TSB Revision
SRS General Information .
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
CAUTION
1. Do not repair, splice or modify SRS wiring (except for specific repairs to the body harness
shown on page replace wiring if necessary, after reading and following all precautions
and procedures in this manual.
2. Do not use an analog ohmmeter to check wiring or components; use only special tools
(refer to and digital multi-meter (refer to
IGNITION
CONDITIONING
AUTO-CRUISE
CONTROL SYSTEM
CHARGING SYSTEM
. COOLING SYSTEM
ELC
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
. IGNIT ION SYSTEM
. METER AND GAUGES
. MFI
23 COMBINATION . AUTO-CRUISE
CONTROL SYSTEM
METER SEAT BELT
WARNING BUZZER
WINDOW
I
DEFOGGER
25
13 14
2
CLOCK
SPRING I
BR
2 2 1
Remarks
TSB Revision
SRS General Information
1
J/B
MICROPROCESSOR (R-E
I
SENSOR SCAN TOOL INTERFACE CIRCUIT
I J/C
J/C
Y-G R-t
4 5 12
a A
DATA LINK CONNECTOR
6
FRONT SIDE
TSB Revision
SRS General Information
COMPONENT LOCATION
TSB Revision
SRS Service Precautions
1. In order to avoid injury to yourself or others If any of these components are diagnosed as
from accidental deployment of the air bag during faulty, they should only be replaced, in
servicing, read and carefully follow all the dance with the COMPONENT SERVICE
cautions and procedures described in this dures in this manual, starting at page
manual. 4. Do not attempt repair the wiring harness
2. Do not use any electrical test equipment on connectors of the SRS. any of the connectors
or near SRS components, except those are diagnosed as faulty, replace the
fied on and harness. If the wires are diagnosed as faulty,
Never use an analog ohmmeter. replace or repair the wiring harness according
3. Never Attempt to Repair the Following to the following
ponents:
SRS Air Bag Control Unit (SRS-ECU)
Clock Spring
Air Bag Module
1 21 pins,
yellows
5 Body wiring harness Clock spling Correct or replace
Air bag module (Driver’s side) body wiring harness
6 Replace clock
7 Body wiring harness Air bag module (Front passenger’s side) Correct or replace
body
8
9, 10
12 .
13 Body wiring harness Junction block (fuse or replace
. harness
14 Body wiring harness Junction block (fuse
16 to 19 ,
20 Body wiring harness Ground Correct or replace
body harness
21
TSB Revision I
SRS Service Precautions/Service Specifications
SW-ECU
To body wiring
5. After disconnecting the battery cable, wait 60 seconds or more before proceeding with the
following work. The SRS system is designed to retain enough voltage to deploy the air bags
for a short time even after the battery has been disconnected, so serious injury may result
from unintended air bag deployment if work is done on the SRS system immediately after
the battery cables are disconnected.
6. SRS components should not be subjected to heat over so remove the SRS-ECU,
air bag module and clock spring before drying or baking the vehicle after painting.
7. Whenever you finish servicing the SRS, check the SRS warning light operation to make sure that
the system functions properly. (Refer to
a. Make certain that the ignition switch is OFF when the scan tool is connected or disconnected.
9. If you have any questions about the SRS, please contact the MMSA Tech. Line.
NOTE
SERIOUS INJURY CAN RESULT FROM UNINTENDED AIR BAG DEPLOYMENT, SO USE ONLY
THE PROCEDURES AND EQUIPMENT SPECIFIED IN THIS MANUAL.
TSB Revision
SRS Special Tools/lest Equipment 3
SPECIAL TOOLS
diagnostic
Checking the S R S
circuitry with a digital multi-mete
ADAPTER HARNESS
TEST EQUIPMENT
Tool Tool name Use
Digital multi-meter Checking the electrical
Use a multi-meter for which the maximum test circuitry with SRS Check Harness
current is 2 or less at the minimum range of
resistance measurement
Revision
SRS Troubleshootina
TROUBLESHOOTING
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING FLOW
Gather information from customer
Inspection chart for trou Inspection chart for diagnostic trouble Intermittent malfunction
(Refer to I codes (Refer to
I
(Refer to How to Cope with Inter-
mittent Malfunctions.)
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION .
CO D ES C H E C K
Connect the scan tool to the data link connector and then
check diagnostic trouble codes.
Cation
Always turn the ignition switch OFF before
or disconnecting the scan tool.
TSB Revision
SRS
Front passenger’s air bag module (squib ignition drive circuit) system
NOTE
For diagnostic trouble codes marked with if the vehicle condition to normal,, the diagnostic
code will be automatically erased, and the SRS warning light will return to normal.
If the vehicle has a discharged battery it will store the diagnostic trouble codes 41 or 42. When these diagnostic
trouble codes are displayed, check the battery.
R e v i s i o n 1
SRS Troubleshooting
,
Insulating tape Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to
Table 1
Code No. Trouble Symptom
15 Safing sensor short-circuited
16 Safing sensor open-circuited
. .
Insulating tape
Caution
I
Turn the ignition the position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
TSB Revision
SRS
Code No. or 62 Driver’s air bag module (squib) system Probable cause
[Comment] l Malfunction of
These diagnostic trouble codes are output if there is abnormal resistance between the input terminals l of harnesses or
of the driver’s air bag module (squib). connectors
Refer to the following table 1 for the trouble causes of each code No. l of bag
l of SRS-ECU
Table 1
Code No. Trouble I
l Short in driver’s air bag module (squib) or harness short
21
l Short in clock spring
Open circuit in driver’s air bag module (squib) or open harness
22 Open circuit in
Malfunction of connector contact
61 The harness wire of the driver’s air bag module (squib) is grounded to the power supply.
62 The harness wire of the driver’s air bag module (squib) is grounded.
tape Caution
Turn the ignition key to the position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to
Battery cable
Yes
check harness SCAN TOOL DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
Disconnectclocksprlngconnector
No
OK
Revision I
8 SRS Troubleshooting
Code No. or 65 Front passenger’s air bag module (squib) Probable cause
system
l of or
[Comment]
These diagnostic trouble codes are output if there is abnormal resistance between the input terminals l
of the front passenger’s air bag module (squib). air bag module (squib)
Refer to the following table 1 for the trouble causes of each code No. l Malfunction of SRS-ECU
Table
Code No. Trouble Symptom
24 Short in front passenger’s air bag module (squib) or harness short
l Open circuit in front passenger’s air bag module (squib) or open harness
25 l Malfunction of connector contact
64 The harness wire of the front passenger’s air bag module (squib) is grounded to the power supply.
65 The harness wire of the front passenger’s air bag module (squib) is grounded. I
Caution
Insulating tape
Battery Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
0 the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
cable
Yes
check harness TOOL DIAGNOSTIC
SCAN
TROUBLE CODE
l Disconnect front passenger’s air
bag module connector
l Connect SRS check harness
connector (1). Check
l Erase diagnostic trouble code
memory.
Are code Nos. or 65 output?
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshooting
Insulating tape
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to
Battery cable
insulating tape
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
Battery cable
NG
Repair
OK
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshooting
Battery cable
TSB Revision
Troubleshooting
Insulating tape
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position,
. the negative battery cable and tape terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer P.
cable
OK: Continuity
OK
NG
l Disconnect SRS-ECU connector
l Connect check harness connector (3)
l Ignition switch: ON
l Voltage between terminal (14) and ground
OK: 9 or more
OK
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshooting
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
Battery cable
I
OK: Continuity
0 0 0 0 3 9 2 4
OK
NG NG
Measure at SRS check harness connector (5). Check the following Repair
l Disconnect SRS-ECU connector connectors:
l Connect SRS check harness connector (3) and
l Ignition switch: ON OK
l Voltage between terminal (13) and ground
OK: or more I Check trouble symptom.
O K
NG
I the
TSB Revision
SRS
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK”
the negative battery cable and tape the
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to
Battery cable
OK: Continuity
OK
l Ignition switch: ON
l Connect terminal (15) to the body ground.
OK: Light illuminates
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshootina
Insulating tape
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds, after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
Battery cable
Repair
Insulating tape
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
Battery cable
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshooting
tape Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative ‘battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to P.
Battery cable
Battery cable
Replace the
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshooting
Battery cable
TSB Revision
SRS Troubleshooting
After the ignition switch is turned to ON, the SRS warning light is still on after Refer to
approximately 7 seconds have passed. diagnostic
trouble code
No. 43.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE 2
Communication with scan tool is not possible. Probable cause
(Communication is not possible with only)
[Comment] l Malfunction of harnesses or connectors
If communication is not possible with the only, the cause is probably an open l Malfunction of
circuit in the on-board diagnostic output circuit of the or in the power circuit
(including ground circuit).
Insulating tape
Caution
Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the battery
cable before doing any further work. (Refer to
SRS Troubleshooting/Maintenance/Post-collision Diagnosis
OK: Continuity
00003824
OK
connector.
OK
MAINTENANCE
The SRS must be inspected by an Authorized
after the car manufacture date. to 00
Service.)
POST-COLLISION DIAGNOSIS
To inspect and service the after a collision
or not the air bags has deployed), perform the following steps.
TSB Revision
SRS Post-collision Diagnosis/Component Service
<Front passenger’s
00000054
Clock Spring
1. Check clock spring connectors and protective tube for
damage, and terminals for deformation.
2. Visually check the case for damage.
Protective tube
TSB Revision
SRS SRS Air Ban Control Unit (SRS-ECU)
Caution
Never attempt to disassemble or repair the 3. After deployment of air, bags, replace
SRS-ECU. If. faulty, replace it. the with, a
2. Do not drop or subject the SRS-ECU to 4. Never use an on or near
pact or vibration. If dents, cracking, ECU, and use only the special test equip
formation, or rust are discovered on the ment described on
SRS-ECU, replace it with a new SRS-ECU.
Discard the old one.
Removal steps
l Post-installation inspection 4.
1. Negative battery cable connec- 5. Shift lever knob
tion 6. Ashtray
2. Inner box 7. Center console panel
3. SRS-ECU and harness connector Floor console assembly
connection 9. Bracket
TSB Revision
SRS SRS Air Bag Control Unit (SRS-ECU)
REMOVAL SERVICE .
Insulating tape
NEGATIVE BATTERY CABLE
INSTALLATION POINTS .
SRS-ECU INSTALLATION
Caution
The SRS may not activate SRS-ECU ‘is not
properly, which result in the SRS system not
ing properly in a collision.
POST-INSTALLATION INSPECTION
Reconnect the negative battery terminal. Turn the ignition
key to the “ON” position. Does the warning light illumi-
nate for about 7 seconds, turn OFF and then remain OFF?
If yes, SRS system is functioning properly. If no, consult page
INSPECTION 52400220045
Check the SRS-ECU case and brackets for dents, cracks
or deformation.
Check connector for damage, and terminals for deforma-
tion.
Caution
If a dent, cracks, deformation or rust is discovered,
replace the SRS-ECU with a new one.
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Modules and Clock Spring
Caution
1. Never attempt to disassemble or repair the Do not place anything on top of bag
air bag module or clock spring. If faulty, modules.
replace it. 4. Do not expose the air module to
2. Do not drop the air bag module or clock temperature over
spring or allow contact with water, grease 5. After deployment of an air bag, replace the
or oil. Replace it if a dent, cracks, clock spring.
deformation or rust are detected. 6. Wear gloves and safety goggles
3. The air bag modules should be stored on handling an air bag that has
a flat surface and placed so that the pad 7. An undeployed air bag module should only
surface is facing upward. be disposed of in accordance with the
specified procedures. (Refer to
41
,
5
4
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Modules and Clock Spring
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Modules and Clock Spring
Caution
1. When disconnecting the air bag module-clock
spring connector, take care not to apply excessive
force to it.
2. The removed module should be stored
in a clean, dry place with the pad cover facing
(3) Connect the scan tool to the data link connector, then
check diagnostic codes.
Caution
Turn the ignition switch off before disconnecting or
connecting the scan tool.
(4) Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
(5) Conduct diagnostic test mode using the scan tool to, en-
sure entire SRS operates properly, except open circuit
of air bag module (diagnostic trouble code 25).
(Refer to and
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Modules and Clock Spring,.
Insulating tape
(6) Turn the ignition key to the “LOCK” position, disconnect
the negative battery cable and tape the terminal.
Caution
Wait at least 60 seconds after disconnecting the bat-
tery cable before doing any further work.
(Refer to
POST-INSTALLATION INSPECTION
(1) After installing the clock spring, the steering wheel, the
SRS column covers and the air bag check
light
wheel for noise, binds or difficult operation.
(2) Reconnect the negative battery terminal. Turn the ignition
key to the “ON” position. Does “SRS” warning light
illuminate for about 7 seconds, turn OFF and then remain
OFF? If yes, SRS system is functioning properly. If no,
consult page
0 0 0 0 0 0 5 5
(5) Install the air bag module on the steering wheel to check
alignment with the wheel.
Protective tube
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Modules and Clock ‘Spring
0 0
0 0
0 0
To To ACC To horn To horn To auto-cruise control
cruise power relay switch switch
control
unit
0 0 0 0 0 0 6 1
View A
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Module Disposal,. Procedures
Before either disposing of a vehicle equipped with ule, be sure to first follow the procedures described
an air bag, or prior to disposing of the air bag below to deploy the air bag.
AIR
Caution
1. If the vehicle is to be scrapped, or otherwise disposed
of, deploy the air bag inside the vehicle. If the vehicle
will continue to be operated and only the air bag mod-
ule is to be disposed of, deploy the air bag outside
the vehicle.
2. Since a large amount of smoke is produced when
the air bag is deployed, select a well-ventilated site.
Moreover, never attempt the test near a smoke sensor.
3. Since there is a loud noise when the air bag is
deployed, avoid areas whenever possible.
If anyone is nearby, give warning of the impending
noise.
4. Suitable ear protection be worn by personnel
performing these procedures or by people in the im-
mediate area.
TSB Revision
SRS Air Baa Module Disposal
Connection Connect two wires, each six meters (20 feet) long or
more, to the two leads of SRS AIR BAG ADAPTER HAR-
Insulation NESS A and cover the connections with insulation tape.
The other ends of the two wires should be connected
to each other (short-circuited), to prevent sudden unex-
pected deployment of the air bag.
TSB Revision
SRS Air Baa Module Procedures
<Driver’s (2) Remove the air bag module from the vehicle.
Connection (Refer to
AIR BAG
Caution
The air bag module be stored on a fiat
HARNESS and placed so that the pad cover face up. Do not
or place anything on top of it.
(3) Connect two wires, each six meters (20 feet) long or
more, to the two leads of SRS AIR BAG ADAPTER HAR-
NESS <driver’s side> or BAG ADAPTER
Insulation tape HARNESS <front passenger’s and cover the con-
nections with insulation tape. The other ends of the
wires should be connected to each other (short-circuited),
Connection
to prevent sudden unexpected deployment of the air bag.
TSB Revision
SRS Air Bag Module Disposal Procedures
Wires side>
1. Install nuts that are no longer needed to the four bolts
on the rear side of the air bag module, and tie on some
thick wire to secure to the wheel.
2. Take the SRS air bag adaptor harness that is connected
to the wires, pass it beneath the old tire and wheel assem-
bly, and connect it to the air bag module.
Air bag module 3. the air bag module into the wheel, and secure
it with wires that are tied to the bolt holes, the air bag
should face upward.
Caution
Leave some space below the wheel for the adaptor
harness. If there is no space, the reaction when the
air bag deploys could damage the adaptor harness.
battery
wire
SRS Air Baa Module Procedures
(4) Tightly seal the air bag module in a strong plastic bag
Strong for disposal.
bag module (5) Be sure to always wash your hands after this
operation.
TSB Revision
CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
The heater system uses a two-way-flow full-air-mix The A/C system is basically the same as the
system that features high performance and low tional system, but a new refrigerant system
operating noise, and includes an independent face been adopted as a response to
air blowing function and a air bypass function. use of chlorofluorocarbons. ,
Specifications
Heater unit type Two-way-flow full-air-mix system
Heater control assembly Dial and lever type
Compressor model Engine (Turbo) and Scroll type
Engine>
Engine (Non-turbo)> Inclined-plate type
Dual pressure switch (psi) High-pressure switch OFF: 3,140 ON: 2,550 (370)
Low-pressure switch OFF: 200 ON: 220 (32)
Refrigerant and quantity (oz.) Approx. 700 740
OPERATION
Condenser fan and radiator fan control l The fin sensor, which senses the
l For the operation of each fan, refer to COOLING temperature. of the air flowing out of the
SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING. evaporator, is deactivated with. temperature
3.2% or below.
Compressor control Here, the engine coolant ‘temperature sensor
l When the air conditioning switch is pushed in senses the temperature of coolant,
(A/C switch: ON) or the air outlet changeover it is turned off at or higher
control knob is moved to the DEF or peratures.
position (defroster switch: ON), the air l The dual pressure switch turns OFF when
conditioning system operates and compressor refrigerant pressure becomes high
control starts. or low, thus the compressor circuit.
(See Table below.)
A/C ON Conditions
Ignition switch ON Remarks
compressor relay is deenergized when
Blower switch ON anv one switch, sensor or control unit shown
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
55-4 AND VENTILATION General Information
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Because R-l refrigerant is a, hydrofluorocarbon Caution
(HFC) which contains hydrogen atoms in place of Do not heat above
chlorine atoms, it will not cause damage to the In most instances, moderate heat is required to
ozone layer. bring the pressure of the refrigerant in its
Ozone filters out harmful radiation from the sun. above the pressure of the system when charging
To assist in protecting the ozone layer, Chrysler or adding refrigerant.
Corporation recommends an R-l refrigerant re- A bucket or large pan of hot water over
cycling device. is all the heat required for this purpose.
Refrigerant R-l is transparent and colorless Do not heat the refrigerant container with a blow
in both the liquid and vapor state. Since it has torch or any other means that would raise tempera-
a boiling point of at atmospher- ture and pressure above this temperature. Do not
ic pressure, it will be a vapor at all normal tempera- weld or steam clean on or near the system compo-
tures and pressures. The vapor is heavier than nents or refrigerant lines.
air, non-flammable, and nonexplosive. The follow-
ing precautions must be observed when handling Caution
R-l Keep containers upright when charging
the system.
Caution When adding into the refrigeration system
Wear safety goggles when servicing the refrig- keep the supply tank or cans in an upright position.
eration system. If the refrigerant container is on its or upside
R-l evaporates so rapidly at normal atmospher- down, liquid refrigerant will enter the
ic pressures and temperatures that it tends to freeze damage the compressor.
anything it contacts. For this reason, extreme care Caution
must be taken to prevent any liquid refrigerant from 1. A leak detector designed
contacting the skin and especially the eyes. Always be used to check refrigerant gas
wear safety goggles when servicing the refrigeration 2. Do not allow liquid refrigerant to
part of the A/C system. Keep a bottle of sterile metal.
mineral oil handy when working on the refrigeration Refrigerant will tarnish bright metal and chrome
system. Should any liquid refrigerant get into the surfaces, and in combination with moisture can
eyes, use a few drops of mineral oil to wash them severely corrode all metal surfaces.
out. is rapidly absorbed by the oil. Next
splash the eyes with plenty of cool water. Call your
doctor immediately even though irritation has
ceased after treatment.
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Service
AND VENTILATION Special Tools
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
I Standard value ‘I
speed Engine (Turbo) and
Engine I I
Engine (Non-turbo) I
up speed 100 in Neutral
Resistor (for blower motor) LO 1.83
MH I 0.31
Revolution pick up sensor standard resistance 185
Engine (Non-turbo)>
[when ambient temperature is
Refrigerant temperature switch ON (continuity) temperature Approx. or less
Engine (Turbo) and
Engine> OFF (no continuity) temperature Approx. or more
(until the temperature drops to approx.
when OFF)
Air gap (Magnetic clutch) mm (in.) Engine (Turbo) and
Engine
Engine (Non-turbo) I
LUBRICANTS
Items Specified lubricants Quantity
Each connection of refrigerant line ND-OIL 8 Engine (Non-turbo)>, SUN PAG 56 As required
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Tool number and name Supersession Application
367 Armature mounting nut of com-
removal and installation
e S p e c i a l s p a n n e r Engine (Turbo) and
Engine>
386
Pin
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING
PROCEDURES
Trouble Problem cause 1 Remedy Reference Reference
symptom page page
Engine Engine
(Non-turbo) (Turbo)
Engine
When the ignitior compressor clutch relay Replace A/C compressor clutch 55-18 55-18
switch is “ON”, is defective relay
the does not
operate. Magnetic clutch is defective Replace the armature plate, rotor 55-34
or clutch coil
Refrigerant leak or overfilling Replenish the refrigerant, repair 0
of refrigerant the leak or take out some of the
refrigerant
Dual pressure switch is defec- Replace the dual pressure switch 55-45
tive
A/C switch is defective Replace the A/C switch 55-23 55-23
Blower switch is defective Replace the blower switch 55-22 55-22
Fin sensor is defective Replace the fin sensor
Refrigerant temperature switch Replace the refrigerant tempera-
is defective Engine (Tur- ture switch
bo) and Engine>
Automatic compressor-ECM Replace the automatic 55-26
is defective
Revolution pick up sensor is Replace the revolution pick up
defective sensor
Engine (Non-turbo)>
conditioning A/C compressor relay is de- Replace A/C compressor clutch 55-18
does not fective relay
when
he air outlet Magnetic clutch is defective Replace the armature plate, rotor 55-34
or clutch coil
knob is Refrigerant leak or overfilling Replenish the refrigerant, repair
noved to the of refrigerant the leak or take out some of the
or
position. refrigerant
Dual pressure switch is defec- Replace the dual pressure switch 55-45
tive
Defroster switch is defective the defroster switch 55-22 55-22
the blower switch 55-22 55-22
temperature Replace the refrigerant tempera-
is defective ture switch
compressor-ECU is Replace the automatic 55-26
sor-ECU
pick up sensor is Replace the revolution pick up
sensor
Engine
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Troubleshooting
fan
Condenser fan relay (LO) is Replace the condenser fan relay 55-18
defective
Condenser fan relay (HI) is Replace the condenser fan relay 55-18 55-18
defective
1 Automatic compressor-ECM power The ignition switch, blower switch Battery positive
supply (output side) and A/C switch are all ON v o l t a g e
2 Automatic compressor-ECM power The ignition switch, Battery
supply (input side) and switch are all ON voltage
3 Automatic compressor-ECM ground o v
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
55-8 AND VENTILATION Troubleshooting/On-vehicle Service
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Terminal No. Name of Signal Check requirements Terminal voltage
compressor clutch relay When the compressor ON conditions Battery positive
are satisfied voltage
2 Automatic compressor-ECM ground ov
4 Automatic compressor-ECM power The ignition switch, blower switch and Battery positive
supply (input side) switch are all ON voltage
5 Automatic compressor-ECM power The ignition switch is ON Battery positive
voltage
Sensor ground ov
Automatic compressor-ECM power The ignition switch, blower switch and Battery positive
supply (output side) switch are all ON voltage
12 Fin sensor power supply The ignition switch, blower switch and
A/C switch are all ON
TROUBLESHOOTING HINTS
<Condenser fan and radiator fan control> <Compressor control>
l Refer to COOLING SYSTEM Refer to
SHOOTING.
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
SIGHT GLASS REFRIGERANT LEVEL TEST
The sight glass is a refrigerant level indicator. To check the
refrigerant level, clean sight glass and start the vehicle,
engine. Push the button to operate the compressor, place
the blower switch to high and move the temperature control
dial to max cool. After operating for a few minutes in this
manner, check the sight glass.
1. If the sight glass is clear, the magnetic clutch is engaged,
discharge line is warm and the compressor
Engine (Turbo) and Engine> I
suction line is cool; the system has a full charge.
2. If the sight glass is clear, the magnetic clutch is engaged
and there is no significant temperature difference between
compressor suction and discharge lines; the system has
most of its refrigerant charge.
3. If the sight glass shows foam or bubbles, the system
could be low on refrigerant or the receiver drier is restricted.
The system has to be tested, leak checked then recharged
with refrigerant.
TSB Revision I
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle Service
00000169
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND On-vehicle Service
CHARGING
1. With the handles turned in all the way (valve closed),
install the adaptor valve to the low-pressure of the
gauge manifold.
2. Connect the charging hose (blue) to the adaptor valve.
3. Connect the quick joint (for low-pressure) to the charging
hose (blue).
4. Connect the quick joint (for low-pressure) to the
sure service valve.
NOTE
The low-pressure service valve should be connected to
the suction hose.
Caution
1. Use tools that are designed for
2. To install the quick joint, press section A firmly
against the service valve until a click is heard.
When connecting, run your hand along the hose
while pressing to ensure that there are no bends
in the hose.
5. Close the high and low-pressure valves of the gauge
manifold.
6. Install the vacuum pump adaptor to the vacuum pump.
7. Connect the vacuum pump plug to the vacuum pump
adaptor.
8. Connect the charging hose (yellow) to the connec-
tion port of the vacuum pump adaptor.
9. Tighten the adaptor valve handle (valve open).
10. Open the low-pressure valve of the gauge manifold.
11. Turn the power switch of the vacuum pump to the ON
position.
NOTE
Even if the vacuum pump power switch is, turned ON,
the vacuum pump will not operate because of the power
supply connection in step (7).
12. Turn the vacuum pump adaptor switch the
side to start the vacuum pump.
Caution
Do not operate the during evacuation.
13. Evacuate to a vacuum reading of 100 (29.5
or higher (takes approx. 10 minutes).
14. Turn the vacuum pump adaptor switch OFF and allow
to stand it for 5 minutes.
Caution
Do not operate the compressor in the vacuum condi-
tion; damage may occur.
15. Carry out a leak test. (Good if the negative pressure
does not drop.)
Caution
If the negative pressure (vacuum) is lost, check for
loose connections. Then, repeat the evacuation proce-
dure from step 12. If negative pressure (vacuum) is
still lost, add 1 lb of refrigerant and check system
using an compatible leak detector.
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle
16. Turn the handle of the valve back all the way
(valve closed), remove it from the gauge manifold and
install the bulk container.
Bulk
Adaptor
valve
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle Service
Bulk container
[Refrigerant container)
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle Service
Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle Service
PERFORMANCE TEST
1. The vehicles to be tested should be in a place that is
not in direct sunlight.
2. Close the high and low-pressure valve of the gauge man-
ifold.
3. Connect the charging hose (blue) to the low-pressure
valve and connect the charging hose (red) to the high-pres-
sure valve of the gauge manifold.
4. Install the quick joint (for low-pressure) to the charging
hose (blue), and connect the quick joint (for high-pressure)
to the charging hose (red).
5. Connect the quick joint (for low-pressure) to the low-pres-
sure service valve and connect the quick joint (for
pressure) to the high-pressure service valve.
NOTE
The high-pressure service valve is on discharge pipe
and the low-pressure service valve is on the suction hose.
Caution
To connect the quick joint, press section A firmly
against the service valve until a click is heard.
When connecting, run your hand along the hose while
pressing to ensure that there are no bends in the
hose.
6. Start the engine.
7. Set the A/C controls as follows:
A/C switch: A/C ON position
Mode selection: Face position
Temperature control: Max. cooling position
Air selection: Recirculation position
Blower switch: HI (Fast) position
8. Adjust engine speed to 1,000 with A/C clutch en-
gaged.
9. Engine should be warmed up with doors and windows
closed.
10. a thermometer in the left center A/C outlet and
operate the engine for 20 minutes.
11. Note the discharge air temperature.
NOTE
If the clutch cycles, take the reading before the clutch
disengages.
TSB Revision 1
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
6 AND VENTILATION On-vehicle Service
Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION On-vehicle Service
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Condenser
fan relay (LO)
Engine>
NC
clutch relay
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Heater
NOTE
metal clip positions.
Removal steps
1. Center panel
2. Floor console (Refer to GROUP
Floor Console.)
3. Radio, tape player and CD player
(Refer to GROUP Radio,
Tape Player, CD
Speaker and Antenna.)
4. Stopper
5. Heater control assembly
TSB Revision
,
AIR
AND VENTILATION Heater
REMOVAL
HEATER CONTROL REMOVAL
(1) Press the lever pin to disconnect the air outlet changeover
damper cable.
(5) Set the knob for the air outlet changeover on the heater
control assembly to the DEF position.
(6) Set the air outlet changeover damper lever of the heater
unit to DEF position and install the cable to the lever
pin.
(7) Push the outer cable in the direction of the arrow so
that there is no looseness, and then secure it with the
clip.
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Heater Control Assembly
INSPECTION
Check each knob and lever for proper operation and
possible damage.
l Check the connection between the lever and cable.
l Check that the cable sides properly.
Check the illumination light for a possible broken filament.
.
0 0
0
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
55-22 AND Heater Control
Disassembly steps
1. Knob 10. Control base assembly
2. Lever assembly 11. Knob assembly A
3. Air conditioning switch 12. Panel case
4. Knob assembly 13. Nut
5. Bulb and socket assembly 14. Control base
6. Defroster switch 15. Blower switch
7. Air outlet changeover damper ca-
ble NOTE
8. Air mix damper cable Parts from No. 11 to No. 14 are not supplied as single
9. Inside/outside air changeover parts.
damper cable
Removal steps
1. Stopper
2. Center air outlet
3. Center panel
4. Air conditioning switch
INSTALLATION POINT
CENTER AIR OUTLET INSTALLATION
(1) Turn the cool air bypass lever of the center air outlet
fully downward.
(2) Pull the cool air bypass damper lever on the heater unit
side all the way toward you, and then connect the cable
to the lever pin.
(3) Push the outer cable in the direction of the arrow so
that there is no looseness, and then secure it with the
clip.
INSPECTION
AIR CONDITIONING SWITCH CONTINUITY CHECK
I Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Heater Unit and Heater Core
Removal steps
l Instrument panel (Refer to GROUP 5. Foot distribution duct
Instrument Panel.) 6. Cooling unit installation bolt and
1. Heater hose connection nut <Vehicles with
2. Center stay 7. Clip
3. Center duct 8. Heater unit
4. Semi rear heater duct 9. Heater core
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Heater Unit
CLIP REMOVAL
‘(1) Use a Philips-head screwdriver to push inward the pin
(at the center of the clip) to a depth of about
in.).
Pin (2) the clip outward to remove. it.
Caution
Do not push the pin inward more than be-
cause it may damage the grommet, or the may
fall in, if pushed too far.
HEATER UNIT
After the cooling unit slightly, remove
the heater unit.
Grommet
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Blower Assembly, and Resistor
<Vehicles with
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Blower Assembly and. Resistor
Grommet I
I
INSPECTION 55100320016
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Cooling Unit
COOLING UNIT
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
and Post-installation Operation CAUTION
Refrigerant Discharging and Charging Plug refrigerant lines to prevent air from mixing
(Refer to when disconnecting them.
Compressor oil:
SUN PAG 56 <Turbo>
6 <Non-turbo>
00003634
Removal steps
1. Drain hose 7. Corner panel
2. Suction pipe Engine 8. Glove box under frame
turbo)> or suction hose 9. Console side cover
gine (Turbo) and Engine> 10. Control unit cover
connection 11. ABS-ECU bracket
3. Liquid pipe connection 12. Harness protector Engine
4. O-ring (Turbo) and Engine>
5. Stopper 13.
6. Glove box 14. Cooling unit
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Cooling Unit
INSTALLATION
U N I T
When replacing the cooling unit with new refill evapo-
rator with a specified amount of compressor oil.
Engine -(Turbo) and Engine>
Compressor oil: SUN PAG 56
Quantity: 60 (2.03
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Compressor oil: ND-OIL 8
Quantity: 40 (1.35
Grommet
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
AND VENTILATION Cooling Unit
7
oil:
SUN PAG 56 Engine
(Turbo) and Engine>
ND-OIL 6 Engine
(Non-turbo)>
00003635
Disassembly steps
1. Clip 5. Evaporator case (lower)
2. Evaporator case (upper) 6. Expansion valve
3. Fin sensor 7. O-ring
Engine (Non-turbo)> 8. Evaporator
4. Automatic compressor-ECM and fin
sensor assembly En-
gine (Turbo) and Engine>
INSPECTION
FIN SENSOR RESISTANCE CHECK
When the resistance value between the sensor terminals
is measured under two or more temperature conditions, the
Resis- resistance value should be close to the values shown in the
tance graph.
NOTE
10 20 30 40 The temperature conditions when testing should not exceed
(14) (50) (68) (86) the range of the characteristic curve in the graph.
Temperature
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor
AND VENTILATION Engine (Turbo) and Engine%
Hose connection,
23-26 Nm
23-26 Nm
23-26 Nm
COMPRESSOR
When doing this work, be careful not to spill the compressor
oil.
INSTALLATION
COMPRESSOR INSTALLATION
If a new compressor is installed, first adjust the amount of
oil according to the procedures described below, and then
install the compressor.
(1) Measure the amount (x of oil within the
removed compressor.
(2) Drain (from the new compressor) the amount of oil calcu-
lated according to the following formula, and then install
then new compressor.
New compressor oil amount
170
..
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor
AND VENTILATION Engine (Turbo) and
INSPECTION 55200420047
l Checking for heat damage of the tension pulley.
l Check for excessive play or deflection of the tension pulley.
l Check for unusual wear of the tension pulley.
Check for hardening of the compressor drive belt.
l Check for unusual wear or abrasion of the compressor
drive belt.
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor and Tension Pulley
55-34 AND VENTILATION Engine (Turbo) and
Disassembly steps
1. Refrigerant-temperature switch 6. Rotor
2. Pulley 7. Snap ring.
l Air gap adjustment
3. N u t
4. Armature plate O-ring
5. Snap ring 11. High-pressure relief valve
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor and Tension Pulley
AND VENTILATION Engine (Turbo) and Engine> 55-35
NUT REMOVAL
Use the special tools to remove the nut.
Crankshaft
NUT INSTALLATION
Use the special tools to remove the nut.
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor and Tension Pulley
55-36 AND VENTILATION Engine (Turbo) and
INSPECTION
l Check the of the armature for scoring or bluing.
l Check the surface of the rotor for scoring or bluing.
l Check the sealing surfaces for cracks, scratches and
deformation.
l Check the front housing for cracks or scoring on the sealing
surfaces.
l Check the compressor shaft for scoring.
No continuity
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor and
AND VENTILATION Engine
HIGH-PRESSURE
The high-pressure relief valve is a safety feature which re-
leases part of the refrigerant inside the system into the atmo-
sphere when the
psi) during air conditioning operation.
Once the pressure inside the system has bean reduced to
2,940 psi) or lower, the ‘valve
closes, thus allowing, continued
If a leak is detected at section A,
relief valve. The valve can be used unless there is a
leak from that section. ,
(2) If a leak is detected at section retighten the valve.
If
. . the leak
. . persists after retightening the valve, replace
tne
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR Compressor and Tension Pulley
55-38 AND VENTILATION Engine (Non-turbo)>
Hose connection
TSB Revision
Compressor ,
AND VENTILATION
REMOVAL SERVICE
COMPRESSOR DRIVE BELT REMOVAL
(1) Loosen nut for holding the tension pulley.
(2) Loosen bolt “B” for adjustment.
(3) Loosen the power steering oil pump fixing bolt.
(Refer to Power Oil Pump
Engine
(4) Remove the ‘compressor drive belt,
REMOVAL
When doing this work, be careful not to
oil.
(3.4
NOTE
(1) (y indicates the amount of oil in the
refrigerant line, the condenser, the evaporator etc.
(2) When replacing the following parts as well as the
compressor, subtract the rated oil amount of the each
part from and from the
new compressor.
Quantity
Evaporator: 40
Condenser: 40 (1.35
Suction hose: 10
Receiver: 10
INSPECTION
l Checking for heat damage of the tension pulley.
l Check for excessive play or deflection of the tension pulley.
l Check for unusual wear of the tension pulley.
l Check for hardening of the compressor drive belt.
l Check for unusual wear or abrasion of the compressor
drive belt.
TSB Revision .
00003640
Bolt mm in.)]
HUB REMOVAL
(1) Remove the clutch hub mounting bolt.
(2) Tighten a mm in.) bolt into the hole of the
clutch hub to remove the serration assembly the shaft
and the clutch hub.
Socket
SEAL INSTALLATION
Use a 21 mm in.) socket to install the shaft seal so
that the O-ring assembly side is facing the front housing.
(3) After installing the front housing, install the clutch hub
mounting bolt to the shaft, and check that the breakaway
torque is within the torque value.
Breakaway torque: Nm (4 or less
TSB
55-42
CLUTCH COIL INSTALLATION
Set the clutch coil pin in the compressor housing notch, and
Pin install the clutch coil.
55266476659
2
HIGH-PRESSURE RELIEF CHECK
The high-pressure relief valve is a safety feature which re-
leases of the inside the system into the
sphere when the high-pressure: level exceeds 3,740 (532
psi) during air conditioning operation.
Once the pressure inside the system has been reduced to
2,940 psi) or lower, the relief valve
closes, thus allowing continued operation.
(1) If a leak is detected at section A, replace the high-pressure
relief valve. The valve can be used unless there is a
leak from that section.
(2) If a leak is detected at section retighten the valve.
If the leak persists after retightening the valve, replace
the packing.
Revision
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
6
0 0 0 0 3 6 4 1
TSB Revision
Engine (Non-turbo)>
Pm-removal and Post-installation Operation CAUTION
Refrigerant Discharging and Charging Plug refrigerant lines to prevent
(Refer to when disconnecting them.
0 0 0 0 4 0 6 9
Receiver:
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Engine (Turbo) and Engine>
and Post-installation Operation CAUTION
Refrigerant Discharging and Charging Plug refrigerant lines to
(Refer to when disconnecting them.
SUN PAG 56
0 0 0 0 3 6 4 3
TSB
Piping or hose connection
TSB Revision
HEATER, AIR
CAUTION: SRS ..
When removing and installing the console as-
sembly from vehicles equipped with do not
let bump against the or other compo-
nents.
NOTE
the metal position.
Removal steps
4. Defroster nozzle
1. Instrument panel (Refer to GROUP hose
Instrument Panel.)
2. Center duct Defroster garnish
3. Duct bracket
VENTILATORS (AIR OUTLET)
A Suspension> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BASIC IDLE SPEED, Adjustment ENGINE (TURBO)
ABS OPERATION AND ENGINE> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check ................................... BATTERY
................................... Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ABS-ECU Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
......................................... Testing Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ...
......................................... BELT
ACCELERATOR CABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Compressor, Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (For Generator), Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (For Power steering pump), Maintenance . . . . . . . . .
ACCELERATOR PEDAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (For Water pump), Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . ...
ADAPTER, Transfer Case .................. Timing ....................
AERO PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AIR BAG CONTROL UNIT (SRS-ECU), SRS . . . . . . . . . . . ...........................
AIR BAG MODULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Timing .............................
Deployed Disposal Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........ . . . . .
Disposal Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Timing, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BLEEDING
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AIR CONDITIONING SWITCH Basic Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .......
ENGINE (TURBO) AND . ..........................................
AIR COOLER, charge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BLOWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AIR FILTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BOLT
ALIGNMENT Hub, Replacement ................... .....
Front Wheel, Check and Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ......................
Wheel, Rear, Check and Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2741
AMPLIFIER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BOOSTER
GEAR AND TRANSFER DRIVE GEAR SET Brake ....................................
................................ .............................
........................................ Brake, Operating Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . O-I
ANTENNA. BOOTS, Shaft, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ARM BRACKET ..............................
Compression, Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BRAKE
Lateral, Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ......................................
Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disc, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Toe Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low-reverse .......... ........
Trailing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ............................
Upper <Front Suspension> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BRAKE BOOSTER
Suspension> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................
ARMS, Rocker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 <Basic Brakes> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL CABLE, Check and BRAKE DISC
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front, Run-out Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL COMPONENT, Check . . . . . . . . . Run-out Correction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTO-CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM, Operation Check . . . . Front, Thickness Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . Rear, Run-out Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE CONTROL COMPONENT Rear, Run-out Correction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>. . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear, Thickness Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Layout ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . BRAKE DRUM
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE KEY INTERLOCK AND SHIFT LOCK Inside Diameter Check with Rear Drum
MECHANISMS .................................................
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SENSOR, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . . BRAKE HOSES, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AXLE BRAKE LINING
Rear, Total Backlash Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thickness ..................................
AXLE OIL BRAKE PAD
Rear, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disc, Front, Check and Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Disc, Rear, Check and Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BRAKE PEDAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Check and Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .......
BACK-UP LIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BRAKE ROTOR, Disc, Front, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BALL JOINT, Tie Rod End, Breakaway Torque Check . . . . . BREAKAWAY TORQUE, Rod End Ball Joint, ...
BALL JOINT SEALS, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BUMPER
BAR Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stabilizer Suspension> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .....
2 ALPHABETICAL INDEX
RADIATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCHEMATIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RADIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SEAL(S)
REAR AXLE, Total Backlash Check .............. Ball Joint, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
REAR AXLE OIL, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil ...............................
REAR BRAKE DISC Steering .......................
Run-out Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SEAT BELT, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Run-out Correction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SEAT BELT, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Thickness Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SEAT
REAR BUMPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........
REAR CLUTCH Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
................................ SELECTOR LEVER
........................................ Operation Check
REAR COMBINATION LIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE .............. .
REAR DISC BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE ....
REAR DISC BRAKE PAD, Check and Replacement . . . . . . SENSOR
REAR DRUM BRAKE LININGS. Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brake Fluid Level, Check . . , . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . , . . . .
REAR DRUM BRAKE SHOE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft Position ENGINE . .
REAR DRUM BRAKE WHEEL CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (TURBO)> . . . . . . . .
REAR HUB .................
........................................ Crankshaft Position ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . .
............................................ ENGINE (TURBO)> . . . . . . . .
Rotary-Sliding Resistance Check ............... .................
REAR SEAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Coolant Temperature
REAR SUSPENSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
REAR VIEW MIRROR, Inside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . .
REAR WASHER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Coolant Temperature, On-vehicle Inspection
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT, Check and Adjustment . . . . . . . .
REAR WHEEL CYLINDERS, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . .
Heated 0 On-vehicle Inspection
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . .
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SWITCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> . . . .
REAR WIPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intake Air Temperature
RECEIVER DRIER, Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ALPHABETICAL, INDEX
TENSION Replacement
Drive Belt, Check and Adjustment . . . . . . . . 11 ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . .....
........ ENGINE (TURBO) ...
............ TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
TENSION PULLEY Check
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . . . .
TRANSAXLE MOUNTING . . . . . . . ................,..
TEST EQUIPMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRANSAXLE OIL
THEFT-ALARM SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Manual, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
THERMOSTAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement
THICKNESS ENGINE ............ ..
Front Brake Disc, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ......
Rear Brake Disc, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TRANSAXLE OIL COOLER
THROTTLE BODY ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . TRANSAXLE OIL LEVEL
THROTTLE BODY MINIMUM AIR FLOW, Check . . . . . . . Check ENGINE (NON-TURBO)>. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
THROTTLE BODY (THROTTLE VALVE AREA) ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> ..
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>, Cleaning .
TRANSAXLE RANGE SENSOR, Continuity Check
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adjustment ENGINE (TURBO) AND TRANSFER
ENGINE> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND
On-vehicle .......................................
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
......................................
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ...
......................................
TIE ROD END BALL JOINT, Breakaway Torque Check . . . .
TRANSFER CASE
TIMING BELT
......................................
........................... .......................................
.............................
TRANSFER CASE ADAPTER
..................................
......................................
TIMING BELT
.......................................
..................................... TRANSFER DRIVEN GEAR .................
........................................... TRANSFER OIL, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TIMING BELT, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRANSFER OIL, Replacement ENGINE AND
TIRE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TIRE INFLATION PRESSURE, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TRANSFER OIL LEVEL
...................................... ENGINE AND ENGINE>
TOE CONTROL ARM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . - -
TORQUE CONVERTER STALL ...........
Testing ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . TRANSFER OIL, Replacement ENGINE (TURBO) AND
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> ENGINE> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TOTAL BACKLASH Rear Axle, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . TRANSFER SHAFT
TRAILING ARM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................................
TRANSAXLE .......................................
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TRIM, Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRIMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
...................................
ENGINE (TURBO) AND TRUNK LID LOCK RELEASE CABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.........
TRUNK LID LOOK RELEASE HANDLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
...................................
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> TUBING AND FITTINGS, Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
........................................... TURBOCHARGER BYPASS VALVE, CHECK . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.................................... TURBOCHARGER WASTE GATE SOLENOID
.................................... Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cleaning and ..................... On-vehicle Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M/T ENGINE (TURBO) AND
................................................
M/T ENGINE (TURBO) AND UNDER COVER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
................................................ UPPER ARM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.................... Suspension> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TRANSAXLECASE ............................ ..
Disassembly ............................
Reassembly ............................
TRANSAXLE CONTROL
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VACUUM
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE> . . . .
EGR Port, Check
A/T ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ENGINE
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ... ENGINE (TURBO) AND ......
TRANSAXLE FLUID Manifold, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 C-l
Automatic, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ......................
ALPHABETICAL INDEX II
. . . . . . . . . . . , WHEEL BEARING End Play Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Purge Port, Check WHEEL CYLINDER, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
AND ...... .........................................
VACUUM CIRCUIT DIAGRAM .........................................
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WHEEL, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . . . . WINDOW GLASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
VACUUM CONTROL VALVE, Check Engine> . . . . . . . WINDSHIELD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
VACUUM HOSES WINDSHIELD WASHER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WINDSHIELD WIPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . . . . WIPER
Routing ENGINE ............. Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND . Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
VALVE
Check, Operation Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cylinder ...........................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
I
Check
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AND .......
Fuel Tank Pressure Relief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Positive Crankcase Ventilation, Check
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND .......
Proportioning, Function Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Purge Control ENGINE ..............
Vacuum Control, Check Engine> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
VALVE BODY
........................................
................................
........................................
VENTILATORS
Air outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WARNING/CAUTION LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WASHER
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WATER HOSE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . . . .
WATER PIPE
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) AND ENGINE>. . . . . . . . . .
WATER PUMP
ENGINE ......................
ENGINE (TURBO) AND .........
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
WATERPROOF FILM, Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WAVEFORM
Check Using an Analyzer
ENGINE (NON-TURBO)> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ENGINE (TURBO) and ENGINE> . . . . . .
Voltage, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ignition Check
ENGINE ON-T ..............
Ignition Secondary Voltage, Check
AND ENGINE> . . . . . . . .
WEAR, Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WEATHERSTRIP, Door Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WHEEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WHEEL ALIGNMENT, Front, Check and Adjustment . . . . . .